Use bool for boolean (GLYPH_DEBUG case).
[emacs.git] / src / xdisp.c
blobb5274b532291214ba097bbc4eb166181368b01d5
1 /* Display generation from window structure and buffer text.
3 Copyright (C) 1985-1988, 1993-1995, 1997-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New redisplay written by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>.
22 Redisplay.
24 Emacs separates the task of updating the display from code
25 modifying global state, e.g. buffer text. This way functions
26 operating on buffers don't also have to be concerned with updating
27 the display.
29 Updating the display is triggered by the Lisp interpreter when it
30 decides it's time to do it. This is done either automatically for
31 you as part of the interpreter's command loop or as the result of
32 calling Lisp functions like `sit-for'. The C function `redisplay'
33 in xdisp.c is the only entry into the inner redisplay code.
35 The following diagram shows how redisplay code is invoked. As you
36 can see, Lisp calls redisplay and vice versa. Under window systems
37 like X, some portions of the redisplay code are also called
38 asynchronously during mouse movement or expose events. It is very
39 important that these code parts do NOT use the C library (malloc,
40 free) because many C libraries under Unix are not reentrant. They
41 may also NOT call functions of the Lisp interpreter which could
42 change the interpreter's state. If you don't follow these rules,
43 you will encounter bugs which are very hard to explain.
45 +--------------+ redisplay +----------------+
46 | Lisp machine |---------------->| Redisplay code |<--+
47 +--------------+ (xdisp.c) +----------------+ |
48 ^ | |
49 +----------------------------------+ |
50 Don't use this path when called |
51 asynchronously! |
53 expose_window (asynchronous) |
55 X expose events -----+
57 What does redisplay do? Obviously, it has to figure out somehow what
58 has been changed since the last time the display has been updated,
59 and to make these changes visible. Preferably it would do that in
60 a moderately intelligent way, i.e. fast.
62 Changes in buffer text can be deduced from window and buffer
63 structures, and from some global variables like `beg_unchanged' and
64 `end_unchanged'. The contents of the display are additionally
65 recorded in a `glyph matrix', a two-dimensional matrix of glyph
66 structures. Each row in such a matrix corresponds to a line on the
67 display, and each glyph in a row corresponds to a column displaying
68 a character, an image, or what else. This matrix is called the
69 `current glyph matrix' or `current matrix' in redisplay
70 terminology.
72 For buffer parts that have been changed since the last update, a
73 second glyph matrix is constructed, the so called `desired glyph
74 matrix' or short `desired matrix'. Current and desired matrix are
75 then compared to find a cheap way to update the display, e.g. by
76 reusing part of the display by scrolling lines.
78 You will find a lot of redisplay optimizations when you start
79 looking at the innards of redisplay. The overall goal of all these
80 optimizations is to make redisplay fast because it is done
81 frequently. Some of these optimizations are implemented by the
82 following functions:
84 . try_cursor_movement
86 This function tries to update the display if the text in the
87 window did not change and did not scroll, only point moved, and
88 it did not move off the displayed portion of the text.
90 . try_window_reusing_current_matrix
92 This function reuses the current matrix of a window when text
93 has not changed, but the window start changed (e.g., due to
94 scrolling).
96 . try_window_id
98 This function attempts to redisplay a window by reusing parts of
99 its existing display. It finds and reuses the part that was not
100 changed, and redraws the rest.
102 . try_window
104 This function performs the full redisplay of a single window
105 assuming that its fonts were not changed and that the cursor
106 will not end up in the scroll margins. (Loading fonts requires
107 re-adjustment of dimensions of glyph matrices, which makes this
108 method impossible to use.)
110 These optimizations are tried in sequence (some can be skipped if
111 it is known that they are not applicable). If none of the
112 optimizations were successful, redisplay calls redisplay_windows,
113 which performs a full redisplay of all windows.
115 Desired matrices.
117 Desired matrices are always built per Emacs window. The function
118 `display_line' is the central function to look at if you are
119 interested. It constructs one row in a desired matrix given an
120 iterator structure containing both a buffer position and a
121 description of the environment in which the text is to be
122 displayed. But this is too early, read on.
124 Characters and pixmaps displayed for a range of buffer text depend
125 on various settings of buffers and windows, on overlays and text
126 properties, on display tables, on selective display. The good news
127 is that all this hairy stuff is hidden behind a small set of
128 interface functions taking an iterator structure (struct it)
129 argument.
131 Iteration over things to be displayed is then simple. It is
132 started by initializing an iterator with a call to init_iterator,
133 passing it the buffer position where to start iteration. For
134 iteration over strings, pass -1 as the position to init_iterator,
135 and call reseat_to_string when the string is ready, to initialize
136 the iterator for that string. Thereafter, calls to
137 get_next_display_element fill the iterator structure with relevant
138 information about the next thing to display. Calls to
139 set_iterator_to_next move the iterator to the next thing.
141 Besides this, an iterator also contains information about the
142 display environment in which glyphs for display elements are to be
143 produced. It has fields for the width and height of the display,
144 the information whether long lines are truncated or continued, a
145 current X and Y position, and lots of other stuff you can better
146 see in dispextern.h.
148 Glyphs in a desired matrix are normally constructed in a loop
149 calling get_next_display_element and then PRODUCE_GLYPHS. The call
150 to PRODUCE_GLYPHS will fill the iterator structure with pixel
151 information about the element being displayed and at the same time
152 produce glyphs for it. If the display element fits on the line
153 being displayed, set_iterator_to_next is called next, otherwise the
154 glyphs produced are discarded. The function display_line is the
155 workhorse of filling glyph rows in the desired matrix with glyphs.
156 In addition to producing glyphs, it also handles line truncation
157 and continuation, word wrap, and cursor positioning (for the
158 latter, see also set_cursor_from_row).
160 Frame matrices.
162 That just couldn't be all, could it? What about terminal types not
163 supporting operations on sub-windows of the screen? To update the
164 display on such a terminal, window-based glyph matrices are not
165 well suited. To be able to reuse part of the display (scrolling
166 lines up and down), we must instead have a view of the whole
167 screen. This is what `frame matrices' are for. They are a trick.
169 Frames on terminals like above have a glyph pool. Windows on such
170 a frame sub-allocate their glyph memory from their frame's glyph
171 pool. The frame itself is given its own glyph matrices. By
172 coincidence---or maybe something else---rows in window glyph
173 matrices are slices of corresponding rows in frame matrices. Thus
174 writing to window matrices implicitly updates a frame matrix which
175 provides us with the view of the whole screen that we originally
176 wanted to have without having to move many bytes around. To be
177 honest, there is a little bit more done, but not much more. If you
178 plan to extend that code, take a look at dispnew.c. The function
179 build_frame_matrix is a good starting point.
181 Bidirectional display.
183 Bidirectional display adds quite some hair to this already complex
184 design. The good news are that a large portion of that hairy stuff
185 is hidden in bidi.c behind only 3 interfaces. bidi.c implements a
186 reordering engine which is called by set_iterator_to_next and
187 returns the next character to display in the visual order. See
188 commentary on bidi.c for more details. As far as redisplay is
189 concerned, the effect of calling bidi_move_to_visually_next, the
190 main interface of the reordering engine, is that the iterator gets
191 magically placed on the buffer or string position that is to be
192 displayed next. In other words, a linear iteration through the
193 buffer/string is replaced with a non-linear one. All the rest of
194 the redisplay is oblivious to the bidi reordering.
196 Well, almost oblivious---there are still complications, most of
197 them due to the fact that buffer and string positions no longer
198 change monotonously with glyph indices in a glyph row. Moreover,
199 for continued lines, the buffer positions may not even be
200 monotonously changing with vertical positions. Also, accounting
201 for face changes, overlays, etc. becomes more complex because
202 non-linear iteration could potentially skip many positions with
203 changes, and then cross them again on the way back...
205 One other prominent effect of bidirectional display is that some
206 paragraphs of text need to be displayed starting at the right
207 margin of the window---the so-called right-to-left, or R2L
208 paragraphs. R2L paragraphs are displayed with R2L glyph rows,
209 which have their reversed_p flag set. The bidi reordering engine
210 produces characters in such rows starting from the character which
211 should be the rightmost on display. PRODUCE_GLYPHS then reverses
212 the order, when it fills up the glyph row whose reversed_p flag is
213 set, by prepending each new glyph to what is already there, instead
214 of appending it. When the glyph row is complete, the function
215 extend_face_to_end_of_line fills the empty space to the left of the
216 leftmost character with special glyphs, which will display as,
217 well, empty. On text terminals, these special glyphs are simply
218 blank characters. On graphics terminals, there's a single stretch
219 glyph of a suitably computed width. Both the blanks and the
220 stretch glyph are given the face of the background of the line.
221 This way, the terminal-specific back-end can still draw the glyphs
222 left to right, even for R2L lines.
224 Bidirectional display and character compositions
226 Some scripts cannot be displayed by drawing each character
227 individually, because adjacent characters change each other's shape
228 on display. For example, Arabic and Indic scripts belong to this
229 category.
231 Emacs display supports this by providing "character compositions",
232 most of which is implemented in composite.c. During the buffer
233 scan that delivers characters to PRODUCE_GLYPHS, if the next
234 character to be delivered is a composed character, the iteration
235 calls composition_reseat_it and next_element_from_composition. If
236 they succeed to compose the character with one or more of the
237 following characters, the whole sequence of characters that where
238 composed is recorded in the `struct composition_it' object that is
239 part of the buffer iterator. The composed sequence could produce
240 one or more font glyphs (called "grapheme clusters") on the screen.
241 Each of these grapheme clusters is then delivered to PRODUCE_GLYPHS
242 in the direction corresponding to the current bidi scan direction
243 (recorded in the scan_dir member of the `struct bidi_it' object
244 that is part of the buffer iterator). In particular, if the bidi
245 iterator currently scans the buffer backwards, the grapheme
246 clusters are delivered back to front. This reorders the grapheme
247 clusters as appropriate for the current bidi context. Note that
248 this means that the grapheme clusters are always stored in the
249 LGSTRING object (see composite.c) in the logical order.
251 Moving an iterator in bidirectional text
252 without producing glyphs
254 Note one important detail mentioned above: that the bidi reordering
255 engine, driven by the iterator, produces characters in R2L rows
256 starting at the character that will be the rightmost on display.
257 As far as the iterator is concerned, the geometry of such rows is
258 still left to right, i.e. the iterator "thinks" the first character
259 is at the leftmost pixel position. The iterator does not know that
260 PRODUCE_GLYPHS reverses the order of the glyphs that the iterator
261 delivers. This is important when functions from the move_it_*
262 family are used to get to certain screen position or to match
263 screen coordinates with buffer coordinates: these functions use the
264 iterator geometry, which is left to right even in R2L paragraphs.
265 This works well with most callers of move_it_*, because they need
266 to get to a specific column, and columns are still numbered in the
267 reading order, i.e. the rightmost character in a R2L paragraph is
268 still column zero. But some callers do not get well with this; a
269 notable example is mouse clicks that need to find the character
270 that corresponds to certain pixel coordinates. See
271 buffer_posn_from_coords in dispnew.c for how this is handled. */
273 #include <config.h>
274 #include <stdio.h>
275 #include <limits.h>
277 #include "lisp.h"
278 #include "atimer.h"
279 #include "keyboard.h"
280 #include "frame.h"
281 #include "window.h"
282 #include "termchar.h"
283 #include "dispextern.h"
284 #include "character.h"
285 #include "buffer.h"
286 #include "charset.h"
287 #include "indent.h"
288 #include "commands.h"
289 #include "keymap.h"
290 #include "macros.h"
291 #include "disptab.h"
292 #include "termhooks.h"
293 #include "termopts.h"
294 #include "intervals.h"
295 #include "coding.h"
296 #include "process.h"
297 #include "region-cache.h"
298 #include "font.h"
299 #include "fontset.h"
300 #include "blockinput.h"
301 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
302 #include TERM_HEADER
303 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
305 #ifndef FRAME_X_OUTPUT
306 #define FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f) ((f)->output_data.x)
307 #endif
309 #define INFINITY 10000000
311 Lisp_Object Qoverriding_local_map, Qoverriding_terminal_local_map;
312 Lisp_Object Qwindow_scroll_functions;
313 static Lisp_Object Qwindow_text_change_functions;
314 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
315 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks;
316 static Lisp_Object QCeval, QCpropertize;
317 Lisp_Object QCfile, QCdata;
318 static Lisp_Object Qfontified;
319 static Lisp_Object Qgrow_only;
320 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay;
321 static Lisp_Object Qbuffer_position, Qposition, Qobject;
322 static Lisp_Object Qright_to_left, Qleft_to_right;
324 /* Cursor shapes. */
325 Lisp_Object Qbar, Qhbar, Qbox, Qhollow;
327 /* Pointer shapes. */
328 static Lisp_Object Qarrow, Qhand;
329 Lisp_Object Qtext;
331 /* Holds the list (error). */
332 static Lisp_Object list_of_error;
334 static Lisp_Object Qfontification_functions;
336 static Lisp_Object Qwrap_prefix;
337 static Lisp_Object Qline_prefix;
338 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_internal;
340 /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay. */
342 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_redisplay;
344 /* Names of text properties relevant for redisplay. */
346 Lisp_Object Qdisplay;
348 Lisp_Object Qspace, QCalign_to;
349 static Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
350 Lisp_Object Qleft_margin, Qright_margin;
351 static Lisp_Object Qspace_width, Qraise;
352 static Lisp_Object Qslice;
353 Lisp_Object Qcenter;
354 static Lisp_Object Qmargin, Qpointer;
355 static Lisp_Object Qline_height;
357 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
359 /* Test if overflow newline into fringe. Called with iterator IT
360 at or past right window margin, and with IT->current_x set. */
362 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(IT) \
363 (!NILP (Voverflow_newline_into_fringe) \
364 && FRAME_WINDOW_P ((IT)->f) \
365 && ((IT)->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L \
366 ? (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0) \
367 : (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0)) \
368 && (IT)->current_x == (IT)->last_visible_x)
370 #else /* !HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
371 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(it) 0
372 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
374 /* Test if the display element loaded in IT, or the underlying buffer
375 or string character, is a space or a TAB character. This is used
376 to determine where word wrapping can occur. */
378 #define IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE(it) \
379 ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER && (it->c == ' ' || it->c == '\t')) \
380 || ((STRINGP (it->string) \
381 && (SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
382 || SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')) \
383 || (it->s \
384 && (it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == ' ' \
385 || it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == '\t')) \
386 || (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) < ZV_BYTE \
387 && (*BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
388 || *BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')))) \
390 /* Name of the face used to highlight trailing whitespace. */
392 static Lisp_Object Qtrailing_whitespace;
394 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight escape glyphs. */
396 static Lisp_Object Qescape_glyph;
398 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight non-breaking spaces. */
400 static Lisp_Object Qnobreak_space;
402 /* The symbol `image' which is the car of the lists used to represent
403 images in Lisp. Also a tool bar style. */
405 Lisp_Object Qimage;
407 /* The image map types. */
408 Lisp_Object QCmap;
409 static Lisp_Object QCpointer;
410 static Lisp_Object Qrect, Qcircle, Qpoly;
412 /* Tool bar styles */
413 Lisp_Object Qboth, Qboth_horiz, Qtext_image_horiz;
415 /* Non-zero means print newline to stdout before next mini-buffer
416 message. */
418 bool noninteractive_need_newline;
420 /* Non-zero means print newline to message log before next message. */
422 static bool message_log_need_newline;
424 /* Three markers that message_dolog uses.
425 It could allocate them itself, but that causes trouble
426 in handling memory-full errors. */
427 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker1;
428 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker2;
429 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker3;
431 /* The buffer position of the first character appearing entirely or
432 partially on the line of the selected window which contains the
433 cursor; <= 0 if not known. Set by set_cursor_from_row, used for
434 redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal. */
436 static struct text_pos this_line_start_pos;
438 /* Number of characters past the end of the line above, including the
439 terminating newline. */
441 static struct text_pos this_line_end_pos;
443 /* The vertical positions and the height of this line. */
445 static int this_line_vpos;
446 static int this_line_y;
447 static int this_line_pixel_height;
449 /* X position at which this display line starts. Usually zero;
450 negative if first character is partially visible. */
452 static int this_line_start_x;
454 /* The smallest character position seen by move_it_* functions as they
455 move across display lines. Used to set MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS of
456 hscrolled lines, see display_line. */
458 static struct text_pos this_line_min_pos;
460 /* Buffer that this_line_.* variables are referring to. */
462 static struct buffer *this_line_buffer;
465 /* Values of those variables at last redisplay are stored as
466 properties on `overlay-arrow-position' symbol. However, if
467 Voverlay_arrow_position is a marker, last-arrow-position is its
468 numerical position. */
470 static Lisp_Object Qlast_arrow_position, Qlast_arrow_string;
472 /* Alternative overlay-arrow-string and overlay-arrow-bitmap
473 properties on a symbol in overlay-arrow-variable-list. */
475 static Lisp_Object Qoverlay_arrow_string, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap;
477 Lisp_Object Qmenu_bar_update_hook;
479 /* Nonzero if an overlay arrow has been displayed in this window. */
481 static bool overlay_arrow_seen;
483 /* Vector containing glyphs for an ellipsis `...'. */
485 static Lisp_Object default_invis_vector[3];
487 /* This is the window where the echo area message was displayed. It
488 is always a mini-buffer window, but it may not be the same window
489 currently active as a mini-buffer. */
491 Lisp_Object echo_area_window;
493 /* List of pairs (MESSAGE . MULTIBYTE). The function save_message
494 pushes the current message and the value of
495 message_enable_multibyte on the stack, the function restore_message
496 pops the stack and displays MESSAGE again. */
498 static Lisp_Object Vmessage_stack;
500 /* Nonzero means multibyte characters were enabled when the echo area
501 message was specified. */
503 static bool message_enable_multibyte;
505 /* Nonzero if we should redraw the mode lines on the next redisplay.
506 If it has value REDISPLAY_SOME, then only redisplay the mode lines where
507 the `redisplay' bit has been set. Otherwise, redisplay all mode lines
508 (the number used is then only used to track down the cause for this
509 full-redisplay). */
511 int update_mode_lines;
513 /* Nonzero if window sizes or contents other than selected-window have changed
514 since last redisplay that finished.
515 If it has value REDISPLAY_SOME, then only redisplay the windows where
516 the `redisplay' bit has been set. Otherwise, redisplay all windows
517 (the number used is then only used to track down the cause for this
518 full-redisplay). */
520 int windows_or_buffers_changed;
522 /* Nonzero after display_mode_line if %l was used and it displayed a
523 line number. */
525 static bool line_number_displayed;
527 /* The name of the *Messages* buffer, a string. */
529 static Lisp_Object Vmessages_buffer_name;
531 /* Current, index 0, and last displayed echo area message. Either
532 buffers from echo_buffers, or nil to indicate no message. */
534 Lisp_Object echo_area_buffer[2];
536 /* The buffers referenced from echo_area_buffer. */
538 static Lisp_Object echo_buffer[2];
540 /* A vector saved used in with_area_buffer to reduce consing. */
542 static Lisp_Object Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
544 /* Non-zero means display_echo_area should display the last echo area
545 message again. Set by redisplay_preserve_echo_area. */
547 static bool display_last_displayed_message_p;
549 /* Nonzero if echo area is being used by print; zero if being used by
550 message. */
552 static bool message_buf_print;
554 /* The symbol `inhibit-menubar-update' and its DEFVAR_BOOL variable. */
556 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_menubar_update;
557 static Lisp_Object Qmessage_truncate_lines;
559 /* Set to 1 in clear_message to make redisplay_internal aware
560 of an emptied echo area. */
562 static bool message_cleared_p;
564 /* A scratch glyph row with contents used for generating truncation
565 glyphs. Also used in direct_output_for_insert. */
567 #define MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS 100
568 static struct glyph_row scratch_glyph_row;
569 static struct glyph scratch_glyphs[MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS];
571 /* Ascent and height of the last line processed by move_it_to. */
573 static int last_max_ascent, last_height;
575 /* Non-zero if there's a help-echo in the echo area. */
577 bool help_echo_showing_p;
579 /* The maximum distance to look ahead for text properties. Values
580 that are too small let us call compute_char_face and similar
581 functions too often which is expensive. Values that are too large
582 let us call compute_char_face and alike too often because we
583 might not be interested in text properties that far away. */
585 #define TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT 100
587 /* SAVE_IT and RESTORE_IT are called when we save a snapshot of the
588 iterator state and later restore it. This is needed because the
589 bidi iterator on bidi.c keeps a stacked cache of its states, which
590 is really a singleton. When we use scratch iterator objects to
591 move around the buffer, we can cause the bidi cache to be pushed or
592 popped, and therefore we need to restore the cache state when we
593 return to the original iterator. */
594 #define SAVE_IT(ITCOPY,ITORIG,CACHE) \
595 do { \
596 if (CACHE) \
597 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 1); \
598 ITCOPY = ITORIG; \
599 CACHE = bidi_shelve_cache (); \
600 } while (0)
602 #define RESTORE_IT(pITORIG,pITCOPY,CACHE) \
603 do { \
604 if (pITORIG != pITCOPY) \
605 *(pITORIG) = *(pITCOPY); \
606 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 0); \
607 CACHE = NULL; \
608 } while (0)
610 /* Functions to mark elements as needing redisplay. */
611 enum { REDISPLAY_SOME = 2}; /* Arbitrary choice. */
613 void
614 redisplay_other_windows (void)
616 if (!windows_or_buffers_changed)
617 windows_or_buffers_changed = REDISPLAY_SOME;
620 void
621 wset_redisplay (struct window *w)
623 /* Beware: selected_window can be nil during early stages. */
624 if (!EQ (make_lisp_ptr (w, Lisp_Vectorlike), selected_window))
625 redisplay_other_windows ();
626 w->redisplay = true;
629 void
630 fset_redisplay (struct frame *f)
632 redisplay_other_windows ();
633 f->redisplay = true;
636 void
637 bset_redisplay (struct buffer *b)
639 int count = buffer_window_count (b);
640 if (count > 0)
642 /* ... it's visible in other window than selected, */
643 if (count > 1 || b != XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->contents))
644 redisplay_other_windows ();
645 /* Even if we don't set windows_or_buffers_changed, do set `redisplay'
646 so that if we later set windows_or_buffers_changed, this buffer will
647 not be omitted. */
648 b->text->redisplay = true;
652 void
653 bset_update_mode_line (struct buffer *b)
655 if (!update_mode_lines)
656 update_mode_lines = REDISPLAY_SOME;
657 b->text->redisplay = true;
660 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
662 /* Non-zero means print traces of redisplay if compiled with
663 GLYPH_DEBUG defined. */
665 bool trace_redisplay_p;
667 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
669 #ifdef DEBUG_TRACE_MOVE
670 /* Non-zero means trace with TRACE_MOVE to stderr. */
671 int trace_move;
673 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) if (trace_move) fprintf x; else (void) 0
674 #else
675 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) (void) 0
676 #endif
678 static Lisp_Object Qauto_hscroll_mode;
680 /* Buffer being redisplayed -- for redisplay_window_error. */
682 static struct buffer *displayed_buffer;
684 /* Value returned from text property handlers (see below). */
686 enum prop_handled
688 HANDLED_NORMALLY,
689 HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS,
690 HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED,
691 HANDLED_RETURN
694 /* A description of text properties that redisplay is interested
695 in. */
697 struct props
699 /* The name of the property. */
700 Lisp_Object *name;
702 /* A unique index for the property. */
703 enum prop_idx idx;
705 /* A handler function called to set up iterator IT from the property
706 at IT's current position. Value is used to steer handle_stop. */
707 enum prop_handled (*handler) (struct it *it);
710 static enum prop_handled handle_face_prop (struct it *);
711 static enum prop_handled handle_invisible_prop (struct it *);
712 static enum prop_handled handle_display_prop (struct it *);
713 static enum prop_handled handle_composition_prop (struct it *);
714 static enum prop_handled handle_overlay_change (struct it *);
715 static enum prop_handled handle_fontified_prop (struct it *);
717 /* Properties handled by iterators. */
719 static struct props it_props[] =
721 {&Qfontified, FONTIFIED_PROP_IDX, handle_fontified_prop},
722 /* Handle `face' before `display' because some sub-properties of
723 `display' need to know the face. */
724 {&Qface, FACE_PROP_IDX, handle_face_prop},
725 {&Qdisplay, DISPLAY_PROP_IDX, handle_display_prop},
726 {&Qinvisible, INVISIBLE_PROP_IDX, handle_invisible_prop},
727 {&Qcomposition, COMPOSITION_PROP_IDX, handle_composition_prop},
728 {NULL, 0, NULL}
731 /* Value is the position described by X. If X is a marker, value is
732 the marker_position of X. Otherwise, value is X. */
734 #define COERCE_MARKER(X) (MARKERP ((X)) ? Fmarker_position (X) : (X))
736 /* Enumeration returned by some move_it_.* functions internally. */
738 enum move_it_result
740 /* Not used. Undefined value. */
741 MOVE_UNDEFINED,
743 /* Move ended at the requested buffer position or ZV. */
744 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV,
746 /* Move ended at the requested X pixel position. */
747 MOVE_X_REACHED,
749 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that must be
750 continued. */
751 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED,
753 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that would
754 be displayed truncated. */
755 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED,
757 /* Move within a line ended at a line end. */
758 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
761 /* This counter is used to clear the face cache every once in a while
762 in redisplay_internal. It is incremented for each redisplay.
763 Every CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT full redisplays, the face cache is
764 cleared. */
766 #define CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT 500
767 static int clear_face_cache_count;
769 /* Similarly for the image cache. */
771 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
772 #define CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT 101
773 static int clear_image_cache_count;
775 /* Null glyph slice */
776 static struct glyph_slice null_glyph_slice = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
777 #endif
779 /* True while redisplay_internal is in progress. */
781 bool redisplaying_p;
783 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_free_realized_faces;
784 static Lisp_Object Qmode_line_default_help_echo;
786 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
787 (The display is done in read_char.) */
789 Lisp_Object help_echo_string;
790 Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
791 Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
792 ptrdiff_t help_echo_pos;
794 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
796 Lisp_Object previous_help_echo_string;
798 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
800 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
802 /* Non-zero means an hourglass cursor is currently shown. */
803 bool hourglass_shown_p;
805 /* If non-null, an asynchronous timer that, when it expires, displays
806 an hourglass cursor on all frames. */
807 struct atimer *hourglass_atimer;
809 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
811 /* Name of the face used to display glyphless characters. */
812 static Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char;
814 /* Symbol for the purpose of Vglyphless_char_display. */
815 static Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char_display;
817 /* Method symbols for Vglyphless_char_display. */
818 static Lisp_Object Qhex_code, Qempty_box, Qthin_space, Qzero_width;
820 /* Default number of seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass
821 cursor. */
822 #define DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY 1
824 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
826 /* Default pixel width of `thin-space' display method. */
827 #define THIN_SPACE_WIDTH 1
829 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
831 /* Function prototypes. */
833 static void setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *, int);
834 static void set_iterator_to_next (struct it *, int);
835 static void mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *, int);
836 static int single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
837 static int display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
838 static int row_for_charpos_p (struct glyph_row *, ptrdiff_t);
839 static int cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *);
840 static int redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object, bool);
841 static char *decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object, char *, int);
843 static Lisp_Object get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop);
845 static void handle_line_prefix (struct it *);
847 static void pint2str (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
848 static void pint2hrstr (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
849 static struct text_pos run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object,
850 struct text_pos);
851 static int text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *,
852 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
853 static void store_mode_line_noprop_char (char);
854 static int store_mode_line_noprop (const char *, int, int);
855 static void handle_stop (struct it *);
856 static void handle_stop_backwards (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
857 static void vmessage (const char *, va_list) ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (1, 0);
858 static void ensure_echo_area_buffers (void);
859 static void unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object);
860 static Lisp_Object with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *);
861 static int with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *, int,
862 int (*) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object),
863 ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
864 static void clear_garbaged_frames (void);
865 static int current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
866 static int truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
867 static void set_message (Lisp_Object);
868 static int set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
869 static int display_echo_area (struct window *);
870 static int display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
871 static int resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
872 static void unwind_redisplay (void);
873 static int string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *, int *);
874 static struct text_pos display_prop_end (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
875 struct text_pos);
876 static int compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *);
877 static void insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *);
878 static struct glyph_row *get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *,
879 Lisp_Object);
880 static void extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *);
881 static int append_space_for_newline (struct it *, int);
882 static int cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *, int, int);
883 static int try_scrolling (Lisp_Object, int, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
884 static int try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object, struct text_pos, int *);
885 static int trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t);
886 static intmax_t message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
887 static void push_it (struct it *, struct text_pos *);
888 static void iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *);
889 static void pop_it (struct it *);
890 static void sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *);
891 static void redisplay_internal (void);
892 static int echo_area_display (int);
893 static void redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object);
894 static void redisplay_window (Lisp_Object, bool);
895 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object);
896 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object);
897 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object);
898 static int set_cursor_from_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
899 struct glyph_matrix *, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
900 int, int);
901 static int update_menu_bar (struct frame *, int, int);
902 static int try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *);
903 static int try_window_id (struct window *);
904 static int display_line (struct it *);
905 static int display_mode_lines (struct window *);
906 static int display_mode_line (struct window *, enum face_id, Lisp_Object);
907 static int display_mode_element (struct it *, int, int, int, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object, int);
908 static int store_mode_line_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, int, int, int, Lisp_Object);
909 static const char *decode_mode_spec (struct window *, int, int, Lisp_Object *);
910 static void display_menu_bar (struct window *);
911 static ptrdiff_t display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
912 ptrdiff_t *);
913 static int display_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
914 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, struct it *, int, int, int, int);
915 static void compute_line_metrics (struct it *);
916 static void run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *);
917 static int get_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
918 static int get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int);
919 static void next_overlay_string (struct it *);
920 static void reseat (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
921 static void reseat_1 (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
922 static void back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
923 static void reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *, int);
924 static int next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *);
925 static int next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *);
926 static int next_element_from_string (struct it *);
927 static int next_element_from_c_string (struct it *);
928 static int next_element_from_buffer (struct it *);
929 static int next_element_from_composition (struct it *);
930 static int next_element_from_image (struct it *);
931 static int next_element_from_stretch (struct it *);
932 static void load_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
933 static int init_from_display_pos (struct it *, struct window *,
934 struct display_pos *);
935 static void reseat_to_string (struct it *, const char *,
936 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
937 static int get_next_display_element (struct it *);
938 static enum move_it_result
939 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int,
940 enum move_operation_enum);
941 static void get_visually_first_element (struct it *);
942 static void init_to_row_start (struct it *, struct window *,
943 struct glyph_row *);
944 static int init_to_row_end (struct it *, struct window *,
945 struct glyph_row *);
946 static void back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *);
947 static int forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *, int *, struct bidi_it *);
948 static struct text_pos string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos,
949 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t);
950 static struct text_pos string_pos (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
951 static struct text_pos c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t, const char *, bool);
952 static ptrdiff_t number_of_chars (const char *, bool);
953 static void compute_stop_pos (struct it *);
954 static void compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *, struct text_pos,
955 Lisp_Object);
956 static int face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *, int);
957 static ptrdiff_t next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t);
958 static int handle_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
959 Lisp_Object, struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int);
960 static int handle_single_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
961 Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
962 struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
963 static int underlying_face_id (struct it *);
964 static int in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *,
965 struct window *);
967 #define face_before_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 1)
968 #define face_after_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 0)
970 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
972 static void x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object);
973 static void update_tool_bar (struct frame *, int);
974 static int redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *);
975 static void x_draw_bottom_divider (struct window *w);
976 static void notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *,
977 enum glyph_row_area,
978 int, int, int, int);
979 static void append_stretch_glyph (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
980 int, int, int);
983 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
985 static void produce_special_glyphs (struct it *, enum display_element_type);
986 static void show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *, enum draw_glyphs_face);
987 static bool coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *, int, int);
991 /***********************************************************************
992 Window display dimensions
993 ***********************************************************************/
995 /* Return the bottom boundary y-position for text lines in window W.
996 This is the first y position at which a line cannot start.
997 It is relative to the top of the window.
999 This is the height of W minus the height of a mode line, if any. */
1002 window_text_bottom_y (struct window *w)
1004 int height = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w);
1006 height -= WINDOW_BOTTOM_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w);
1008 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1009 height -= CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1011 return height;
1014 /* Return the pixel width of display area AREA of window W.
1015 ANY_AREA means return the total width of W, not including
1016 fringes to the left and right of the window. */
1019 window_box_width (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area)
1021 int pixels = w->pixel_width;
1023 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
1025 pixels -= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
1026 pixels -= WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w);
1028 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1029 pixels -= (WINDOW_MARGINS_WIDTH (w)
1030 + WINDOW_FRINGES_WIDTH (w));
1031 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1032 pixels = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_WIDTH (w);
1033 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1034 pixels = WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_WIDTH (w);
1037 return pixels;
1041 /* Return the pixel height of the display area of window W, not
1042 including mode lines of W, if any. */
1045 window_box_height (struct window *w)
1047 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1048 int height = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w);
1050 eassert (height >= 0);
1052 height -= WINDOW_BOTTOM_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w);
1054 /* Note: the code below that determines the mode-line/header-line
1055 height is essentially the same as that contained in the macro
1056 CURRENT_{MODE,HEADER}_LINE_HEIGHT, except that it checks whether
1057 the appropriate glyph row has its `mode_line_p' flag set,
1058 and if it doesn't, uses estimate_mode_line_height instead. */
1060 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1062 struct glyph_row *ml_row
1063 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1064 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1065 : 0);
1066 if (ml_row && ml_row->mode_line_p)
1067 height -= ml_row->height;
1068 else
1069 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w));
1072 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1074 struct glyph_row *hl_row
1075 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1076 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1077 : 0);
1078 if (hl_row && hl_row->mode_line_p)
1079 height -= hl_row->height;
1080 else
1081 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID);
1084 /* With a very small font and a mode-line that's taller than
1085 default, we might end up with a negative height. */
1086 return max (0, height);
1089 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1090 area AREA of window W. ANY_AREA means return the left edge of the
1091 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1094 window_box_left_offset (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area)
1096 int x;
1098 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1099 return 0;
1101 x = WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
1103 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1104 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1105 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
1106 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1107 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1108 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1109 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA)
1110 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
1112 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)));
1113 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA
1114 && WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w))
1115 x += WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1117 return x;
1121 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1122 area AREA of window W. ANY_AREA means return the right edge of the
1123 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1126 window_box_right_offset (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area)
1128 return window_box_left_offset (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1131 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1132 area AREA of window W. ANY_AREA means return the left edge of the
1133 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1136 window_box_left (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area)
1138 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1139 int x;
1141 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1142 return FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1144 x = (WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w)
1145 + window_box_left_offset (w, area));
1147 return x;
1151 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1152 area AREA of window W. ANY_AREA means return the right edge of the
1153 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1156 window_box_right (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area)
1158 return window_box_left (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1161 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1162 mode lines, in frame-relative coordinates. ANY_AREA means the
1163 whole window, not including the left and right fringes of
1164 the window. Return in *BOX_X and *BOX_Y the frame-relative pixel
1165 coordinates of the upper-left corner of the box. Return in
1166 *BOX_WIDTH, and *BOX_HEIGHT the pixel width and height of the box. */
1168 void
1169 window_box (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area, int *box_x,
1170 int *box_y, int *box_width, int *box_height)
1172 if (box_width)
1173 *box_width = window_box_width (w, area);
1174 if (box_height)
1175 *box_height = window_box_height (w);
1176 if (box_x)
1177 *box_x = window_box_left (w, area);
1178 if (box_y)
1180 *box_y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
1181 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1182 *box_y += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1186 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1188 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1189 mode lines and both fringes of the window. Return in *TOP_LEFT_X
1190 and TOP_LEFT_Y the frame-relative pixel coordinates of the
1191 upper-left corner of the box. Return in *BOTTOM_RIGHT_X, and
1192 *BOTTOM_RIGHT_Y the coordinates of the bottom-right corner of the
1193 box. */
1195 static void
1196 window_box_edges (struct window *w, int *top_left_x, int *top_left_y,
1197 int *bottom_right_x, int *bottom_right_y)
1199 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, top_left_x, top_left_y,
1200 bottom_right_x, bottom_right_y);
1201 *bottom_right_x += *top_left_x;
1202 *bottom_right_y += *top_left_y;
1205 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
1207 /***********************************************************************
1208 Utilities
1209 ***********************************************************************/
1211 /* Return the bottom y-position of the line the iterator IT is in.
1212 This can modify IT's settings. */
1215 line_bottom_y (struct it *it)
1217 int line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
1218 int line_top_y = it->current_y;
1220 if (line_height == 0)
1222 if (last_height)
1223 line_height = last_height;
1224 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
1226 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
1227 line_height = (it->max_ascent || it->max_descent
1228 ? it->max_ascent + it->max_descent
1229 : last_height);
1231 else
1233 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
1235 /* Use the default character height. */
1236 it->glyph_row = NULL;
1237 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
1238 it->c = ' ';
1239 it->len = 1;
1240 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
1241 line_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
1242 it->glyph_row = row;
1246 return line_top_y + line_height;
1249 DEFUN ("line-pixel-height", Fline_pixel_height,
1250 Sline_pixel_height, 0, 0, 0,
1251 doc: /* Return height in pixels of text line in the selected window.
1253 Value is the height in pixels of the line at point. */)
1254 (void)
1256 struct it it;
1257 struct text_pos pt;
1258 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
1260 SET_TEXT_POS (pt, PT, PT_BYTE);
1261 start_display (&it, w, pt);
1262 it.vpos = it.current_y = 0;
1263 last_height = 0;
1264 return make_number (line_bottom_y (&it));
1267 /* Return the default pixel height of text lines in window W. The
1268 value is the canonical height of the W frame's default font, plus
1269 any extra space required by the line-spacing variable or frame
1270 parameter.
1272 Implementation note: this ignores any line-spacing text properties
1273 put on the newline characters. This is because those properties
1274 only affect the _screen_ line ending in the newline (i.e., in a
1275 continued line, only the last screen line will be affected), which
1276 means only a small number of lines in a buffer can ever use this
1277 feature. Since this function is used to compute the default pixel
1278 equivalent of text lines in a window, we can safely ignore those
1279 few lines. For the same reasons, we ignore the line-height
1280 properties. */
1282 default_line_pixel_height (struct window *w)
1284 struct frame *f = WINDOW_XFRAME (w);
1285 int height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
1287 if (!FRAME_INITIAL_P (f) && BUFFERP (w->contents))
1289 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->contents);
1290 Lisp_Object val = BVAR (b, extra_line_spacing);
1292 if (NILP (val))
1293 val = BVAR (&buffer_defaults, extra_line_spacing);
1294 if (!NILP (val))
1296 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (0, val, INT_MAX))
1297 height += XFASTINT (val);
1298 else if (FLOATP (val))
1300 int addon = XFLOAT_DATA (val) * height + 0.5;
1302 if (addon >= 0)
1303 height += addon;
1306 else
1307 height += f->extra_line_spacing;
1310 return height;
1313 /* Subroutine of pos_visible_p below. Extracts a display string, if
1314 any, from the display spec given as its argument. */
1315 static Lisp_Object
1316 string_from_display_spec (Lisp_Object spec)
1318 if (CONSP (spec))
1320 while (CONSP (spec))
1322 if (STRINGP (XCAR (spec)))
1323 return XCAR (spec);
1324 spec = XCDR (spec);
1327 else if (VECTORP (spec))
1329 ptrdiff_t i;
1331 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); i++)
1333 if (STRINGP (AREF (spec, i)))
1334 return AREF (spec, i);
1336 return Qnil;
1339 return spec;
1343 /* Limit insanely large values of W->hscroll on frame F to the largest
1344 value that will still prevent first_visible_x and last_visible_x of
1345 'struct it' from overflowing an int. */
1346 static int
1347 window_hscroll_limited (struct window *w, struct frame *f)
1349 ptrdiff_t window_hscroll = w->hscroll;
1350 int window_text_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
1351 int colwidth = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
1353 if (window_hscroll > (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1)
1354 window_hscroll = (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1;
1356 return window_hscroll;
1359 /* Return 1 if position CHARPOS is visible in window W.
1360 CHARPOS < 0 means return info about WINDOW_END position.
1361 If visible, set *X and *Y to pixel coordinates of top left corner.
1362 Set *RTOP and *RBOT to pixel height of an invisible area of glyph at POS.
1363 Set *ROWH and *VPOS to row's visible height and VPOS (row number). */
1366 pos_visible_p (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos, int *x, int *y,
1367 int *rtop, int *rbot, int *rowh, int *vpos)
1369 struct it it;
1370 void *itdata = bidi_shelve_cache ();
1371 struct text_pos top;
1372 int visible_p = 0;
1373 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
1375 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))))
1376 return visible_p;
1378 if (XBUFFER (w->contents) != current_buffer)
1380 old_buffer = current_buffer;
1381 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->contents));
1384 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (top, w->start);
1385 /* Scrolling a minibuffer window via scroll bar when the echo area
1386 shows long text sometimes resets the minibuffer contents behind
1387 our backs. */
1388 if (CHARPOS (top) > ZV)
1389 SET_TEXT_POS (top, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
1391 /* Compute exact mode line heights. */
1392 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1393 w->mode_line_height
1394 = display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w),
1395 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
1397 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1398 w->header_line_height
1399 = display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
1400 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
1402 start_display (&it, w, top);
1403 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, it.last_visible_y - 1, -1,
1404 (charpos >= 0 ? MOVE_TO_POS : 0) | MOVE_TO_Y);
1406 if (charpos >= 0
1407 && (((!it.bidi_p || it.bidi_it.scan_dir == 1)
1408 && IT_CHARPOS (it) >= charpos)
1409 /* When scanning backwards under bidi iteration, move_it_to
1410 stops at or _before_ CHARPOS, because it stops at or to
1411 the _right_ of the character at CHARPOS. */
1412 || (it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1413 && IT_CHARPOS (it) <= charpos)))
1415 /* We have reached CHARPOS, or passed it. How the call to
1416 move_it_to can overshoot: (i) If CHARPOS is on invisible text
1417 or covered by a display property, move_it_to stops at the end
1418 of the invisible text, to the right of CHARPOS. (ii) If
1419 CHARPOS is in a display vector, move_it_to stops on its last
1420 glyph. */
1421 int top_x = it.current_x;
1422 int top_y = it.current_y;
1423 /* Calling line_bottom_y may change it.method, it.position, etc. */
1424 enum it_method it_method = it.method;
1425 int bottom_y = (last_height = 0, line_bottom_y (&it));
1426 int window_top_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1428 if (top_y < window_top_y)
1429 visible_p = bottom_y > window_top_y;
1430 else if (top_y < it.last_visible_y)
1431 visible_p = true;
1432 if (bottom_y >= it.last_visible_y
1433 && it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1434 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < charpos)
1436 /* When the last line of the window is scanned backwards
1437 under bidi iteration, we could be duped into thinking
1438 that we have passed CHARPOS, when in fact move_it_to
1439 simply stopped short of CHARPOS because it reached
1440 last_visible_y. To see if that's what happened, we call
1441 move_it_to again with a slightly larger vertical limit,
1442 and see if it actually moved vertically; if it did, we
1443 didn't really reach CHARPOS, which is beyond window end. */
1444 struct it save_it = it;
1445 /* Why 10? because we don't know how many canonical lines
1446 will the height of the next line(s) be. So we guess. */
1447 int ten_more_lines = 10 * default_line_pixel_height (w);
1449 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, bottom_y + ten_more_lines, -1,
1450 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
1451 if (it.current_y > top_y)
1452 visible_p = 0;
1454 it = save_it;
1456 if (visible_p)
1458 if (it_method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
1460 /* We stopped on the last glyph of a display vector.
1461 Try and recompute. Hack alert! */
1462 if (charpos < 2 || top.charpos >= charpos)
1463 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1464 else
1466 struct it it2, it2_prev;
1467 /* The idea is to get to the previous buffer
1468 position, consume the character there, and use
1469 the pixel coordinates we get after that. But if
1470 the previous buffer position is also displayed
1471 from a display vector, we need to consume all of
1472 the glyphs from that display vector. */
1473 start_display (&it2, w, top);
1474 move_it_to (&it2, charpos - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1475 /* If we didn't get to CHARPOS - 1, there's some
1476 replacing display property at that position, and
1477 we stopped after it. That is exactly the place
1478 whose coordinates we want. */
1479 if (IT_CHARPOS (it2) != charpos - 1)
1480 it2_prev = it2;
1481 else
1483 /* Iterate until we get out of the display
1484 vector that displays the character at
1485 CHARPOS - 1. */
1486 do {
1487 get_next_display_element (&it2);
1488 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it2);
1489 it2_prev = it2;
1490 set_iterator_to_next (&it2, 1);
1491 } while (it2.method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
1492 && IT_CHARPOS (it2) < charpos);
1494 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2_prev)
1495 || it2_prev.current_x > it2_prev.last_visible_x)
1496 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1497 else
1499 top_x = it2_prev.current_x;
1500 top_y = it2_prev.current_y;
1504 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) != charpos)
1506 Lisp_Object cpos = make_number (charpos);
1507 Lisp_Object spec = Fget_char_property (cpos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
1508 Lisp_Object string = string_from_display_spec (spec);
1509 struct text_pos tpos;
1510 int replacing_spec_p;
1511 bool newline_in_string
1512 = (STRINGP (string)
1513 && memchr (SDATA (string), '\n', SBYTES (string)));
1515 SET_TEXT_POS (tpos, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
1516 replacing_spec_p
1517 = (!NILP (spec)
1518 && handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, Qnil, Qnil, &tpos,
1519 charpos, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it.f)));
1520 /* The tricky code below is needed because there's a
1521 discrepancy between move_it_to and how we set cursor
1522 when PT is at the beginning of a portion of text
1523 covered by a display property or an overlay with a
1524 display property, or the display line ends in a
1525 newline from a display string. move_it_to will stop
1526 _after_ such display strings, whereas
1527 set_cursor_from_row conspires with cursor_row_p to
1528 place the cursor on the first glyph produced from the
1529 display string. */
1531 /* We have overshoot PT because it is covered by a
1532 display property that replaces the text it covers.
1533 If the string includes embedded newlines, we are also
1534 in the wrong display line. Backtrack to the correct
1535 line, where the display property begins. */
1536 if (replacing_spec_p)
1538 Lisp_Object startpos, endpos;
1539 EMACS_INT start, end;
1540 struct it it3;
1541 int it3_moved;
1543 /* Find the first and the last buffer positions
1544 covered by the display string. */
1545 endpos =
1546 Fnext_single_char_property_change (cpos, Qdisplay,
1547 Qnil, Qnil);
1548 startpos =
1549 Fprevious_single_char_property_change (endpos, Qdisplay,
1550 Qnil, Qnil);
1551 start = XFASTINT (startpos);
1552 end = XFASTINT (endpos);
1553 /* Move to the last buffer position before the
1554 display property. */
1555 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1556 move_it_to (&it3, start - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1557 /* Move forward one more line if the position before
1558 the display string is a newline or if it is the
1559 rightmost character on a line that is
1560 continued or word-wrapped. */
1561 if (it3.method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
1562 && (it3.c == '\n'
1563 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (it3)) == '\n'))
1564 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1565 else if (move_it_in_display_line_to (&it3, -1,
1566 it3.current_x
1567 + it3.pixel_width,
1568 MOVE_TO_X)
1569 == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
1571 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1572 /* When we are under word-wrap, the #$@%!
1573 move_it_by_lines moves 2 lines, so we need to
1574 fix that up. */
1575 if (it3.line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
1576 move_it_by_lines (&it3, -1);
1579 /* Record the vertical coordinate of the display
1580 line where we wound up. */
1581 top_y = it3.current_y;
1582 if (it3.bidi_p)
1584 /* When characters are reordered for display,
1585 the character displayed to the left of the
1586 display string could be _after_ the display
1587 property in the logical order. Use the
1588 smallest vertical position of these two. */
1589 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1590 move_it_to (&it3, end + 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1591 if (it3.current_y < top_y)
1592 top_y = it3.current_y;
1594 /* Move from the top of the window to the beginning
1595 of the display line where the display string
1596 begins. */
1597 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1598 move_it_to (&it3, -1, 0, top_y, -1, MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
1599 /* If it3_moved stays zero after the 'while' loop
1600 below, that means we already were at a newline
1601 before the loop (e.g., the display string begins
1602 with a newline), so we don't need to (and cannot)
1603 inspect the glyphs of it3.glyph_row, because
1604 PRODUCE_GLYPHS will not produce anything for a
1605 newline, and thus it3.glyph_row stays at its
1606 stale content it got at top of the window. */
1607 it3_moved = 0;
1608 /* Finally, advance the iterator until we hit the
1609 first display element whose character position is
1610 CHARPOS, or until the first newline from the
1611 display string, which signals the end of the
1612 display line. */
1613 while (get_next_display_element (&it3))
1615 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it3);
1616 if (IT_CHARPOS (it3) == charpos
1617 || ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it3))
1618 break;
1619 it3_moved = 1;
1620 set_iterator_to_next (&it3, 0);
1622 top_x = it3.current_x - it3.pixel_width;
1623 /* Normally, we would exit the above loop because we
1624 found the display element whose character
1625 position is CHARPOS. For the contingency that we
1626 didn't, and stopped at the first newline from the
1627 display string, move back over the glyphs
1628 produced from the string, until we find the
1629 rightmost glyph not from the string. */
1630 if (it3_moved
1631 && newline_in_string
1632 && IT_CHARPOS (it3) != charpos && EQ (it3.object, string))
1634 struct glyph *g = it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1635 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
1637 while (EQ ((g - 1)->object, string))
1639 --g;
1640 top_x -= g->pixel_width;
1642 eassert (g < it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1643 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
1648 *x = top_x;
1649 *y = max (top_y + max (0, it.max_ascent - it.ascent), window_top_y);
1650 *rtop = max (0, window_top_y - top_y);
1651 *rbot = max (0, bottom_y - it.last_visible_y);
1652 *rowh = max (0, (min (bottom_y, it.last_visible_y)
1653 - max (top_y, window_top_y)));
1654 *vpos = it.vpos;
1657 else
1659 /* We were asked to provide info about WINDOW_END. */
1660 struct it it2;
1661 void *it2data = NULL;
1663 SAVE_IT (it2, it, it2data);
1664 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (it)) != '\n')
1665 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
1666 if (charpos < IT_CHARPOS (it)
1667 || (it.what == IT_EOB && charpos == IT_CHARPOS (it)))
1669 visible_p = true;
1670 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
1671 move_it_to (&it2, charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1672 *x = it2.current_x;
1673 *y = it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent - it2.ascent;
1674 *rtop = max (0, -it2.current_y);
1675 *rbot = max (0, ((it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent)
1676 - it.last_visible_y));
1677 *rowh = max (0, (min (it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent,
1678 it.last_visible_y)
1679 - max (it2.current_y,
1680 WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))));
1681 *vpos = it2.vpos;
1683 else
1684 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
1686 bidi_unshelve_cache (itdata, 0);
1688 if (old_buffer)
1689 set_buffer_internal_1 (old_buffer);
1691 if (visible_p && w->hscroll > 0)
1692 *x -=
1693 window_hscroll_limited (w, WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
1694 * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
1696 #if 0
1697 /* Debugging code. */
1698 if (visible_p)
1699 fprintf (stderr, "+pv pt=%d vs=%d --> x=%d y=%d rt=%d rb=%d rh=%d vp=%d\n",
1700 charpos, w->vscroll, *x, *y, *rtop, *rbot, *rowh, *vpos);
1701 else
1702 fprintf (stderr, "-pv pt=%d vs=%d\n", charpos, w->vscroll);
1703 #endif
1705 return visible_p;
1709 /* Return the next character from STR. Return in *LEN the length of
1710 the character. This is like STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH but never
1711 returns an invalid character. If we find one, we return a `?', but
1712 with the length of the invalid character. */
1714 static int
1715 string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *str, int *len)
1717 int c;
1719 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (str, *len);
1720 if (!CHAR_VALID_P (c))
1721 /* We may not change the length here because other places in Emacs
1722 don't use this function, i.e. they silently accept invalid
1723 characters. */
1724 c = '?';
1726 return c;
1731 /* Given a position POS containing a valid character and byte position
1732 in STRING, return the position NCHARS ahead (NCHARS >= 0). */
1734 static struct text_pos
1735 string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t nchars)
1737 eassert (STRINGP (string) && nchars >= 0);
1739 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1741 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (string) + BYTEPOS (pos);
1742 int len;
1744 while (nchars--)
1746 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1747 p += len;
1748 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1749 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1752 else
1753 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, CHARPOS (pos) + nchars, BYTEPOS (pos) + nchars);
1755 return pos;
1759 /* Value is the text position, i.e. character and byte position,
1760 for character position CHARPOS in STRING. */
1762 static struct text_pos
1763 string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, Lisp_Object string)
1765 struct text_pos pos;
1766 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1767 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1768 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, string_char_to_byte (string, charpos));
1769 return pos;
1773 /* Value is a text position, i.e. character and byte position, for
1774 character position CHARPOS in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1775 means recognize multibyte characters. */
1777 static struct text_pos
1778 c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, const char *s, bool multibyte_p)
1780 struct text_pos pos;
1782 eassert (s != NULL);
1783 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1785 if (multibyte_p)
1787 int len;
1789 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, 0, 0);
1790 while (charpos--)
1792 string_char_and_length ((const unsigned char *) s, &len);
1793 s += len;
1794 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1795 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1798 else
1799 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, charpos);
1801 return pos;
1805 /* Value is the number of characters in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P
1806 non-zero means recognize multibyte characters. */
1808 static ptrdiff_t
1809 number_of_chars (const char *s, bool multibyte_p)
1811 ptrdiff_t nchars;
1813 if (multibyte_p)
1815 ptrdiff_t rest = strlen (s);
1816 int len;
1817 const unsigned char *p = (const unsigned char *) s;
1819 for (nchars = 0; rest > 0; ++nchars)
1821 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1822 rest -= len, p += len;
1825 else
1826 nchars = strlen (s);
1828 return nchars;
1832 /* Compute byte position NEWPOS->bytepos corresponding to
1833 NEWPOS->charpos. POS is a known position in string STRING.
1834 NEWPOS->charpos must be >= POS.charpos. */
1836 static void
1837 compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *newpos, struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string)
1839 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1840 eassert (CHARPOS (*newpos) >= CHARPOS (pos));
1842 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1843 *newpos = string_pos_nchars_ahead (pos, string,
1844 CHARPOS (*newpos) - CHARPOS (pos));
1845 else
1846 BYTEPOS (*newpos) = CHARPOS (*newpos);
1849 /* EXPORT:
1850 Return an estimation of the pixel height of mode or header lines on
1851 frame F. FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
1854 estimate_mode_line_height (struct frame *f, enum face_id face_id)
1856 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1857 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1859 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
1861 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
1862 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
1863 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
1865 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1866 if (face)
1868 if (face->font)
1869 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
1870 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1871 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
1875 return height;
1877 #endif
1879 return 1;
1882 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
1883 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
1884 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
1885 not force the value into range. */
1887 void
1888 pixel_to_glyph_coords (struct frame *f, register int pix_x, register int pix_y,
1889 int *x, int *y, NativeRectangle *bounds, int noclip)
1892 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1893 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1895 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to round down
1896 even for negative values. */
1897 if (pix_x < 0)
1898 pix_x -= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1;
1899 if (pix_y < 0)
1900 pix_y -= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1;
1902 pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL (f, pix_x);
1903 pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_Y_TO_LINE (f, pix_y);
1905 if (bounds)
1906 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*bounds,
1907 FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, pix_x),
1908 FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, pix_y),
1909 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1,
1910 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1);
1912 /* PXW: Should we clip pixels before converting to columns/lines? */
1913 if (!noclip)
1915 if (pix_x < 0)
1916 pix_x = 0;
1917 else if (pix_x > FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f))
1918 pix_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f);
1920 if (pix_y < 0)
1921 pix_y = 0;
1922 else if (pix_y > FRAME_LINES (f))
1923 pix_y = FRAME_LINES (f);
1926 #endif
1928 *x = pix_x;
1929 *y = pix_y;
1933 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
1934 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
1935 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
1936 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
1937 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
1938 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
1939 date. */
1941 static struct glyph *
1942 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (struct window *w, int x, int y, int *hpos, int *vpos,
1943 int *dx, int *dy, int *area)
1945 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
1946 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
1947 int x0, i;
1949 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
1950 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
1952 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
1953 if (!row->enabled_p)
1954 return NULL;
1955 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
1956 break;
1959 *vpos = i;
1960 *hpos = 0;
1962 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
1963 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
1964 return NULL;
1966 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
1967 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1969 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1970 x0 = 0;
1972 else
1974 if (x < window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1976 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
1977 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
1979 else if (x < window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1981 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1982 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + min (row->x, 0);
1984 else
1986 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
1987 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
1991 /* Find glyph containing X. */
1992 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
1993 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
1994 x -= x0;
1995 while (glyph < end && x >= glyph->pixel_width)
1997 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
1998 ++glyph;
2001 if (glyph == end)
2002 return NULL;
2004 if (dx)
2006 *dx = x;
2007 *dy = y - (row->y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent);
2010 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
2011 return glyph;
2014 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
2015 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
2017 static void
2018 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (struct window *w, int *x, int *y)
2020 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
2022 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
2023 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
2024 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2025 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2026 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
2028 else
2030 *x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
2031 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
2035 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
2037 /* EXPORT:
2038 Return in RECTS[] at most N clipping rectangles for glyph string S.
2039 Return the number of stored rectangles. */
2042 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *rects, int n)
2044 XRectangle r;
2046 if (n <= 0)
2047 return 0;
2049 if (s->row->full_width_p)
2051 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left_col. */
2052 r.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (s->w);
2053 if (s->row->mode_line_p)
2054 r.width = WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (s->w) - WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (s->w);
2055 else
2056 r.width = WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (s->w);
2058 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
2059 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
2060 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2061 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
2062 else
2063 r.height = s->height;
2065 else
2067 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
2068 r.x = window_box_left (s->w, s->area);
2069 r.width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
2070 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
2073 if (s->clip_head)
2074 if (r.x < s->clip_head->x)
2076 if (r.width >= s->clip_head->x - r.x)
2077 r.width -= s->clip_head->x - r.x;
2078 else
2079 r.width = 0;
2080 r.x = s->clip_head->x;
2082 if (s->clip_tail)
2083 if (r.x + r.width > s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width)
2085 if (s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width >= r.x)
2086 r.width = s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width - r.x;
2087 else
2088 r.width = 0;
2091 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2092 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2093 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2094 if (s->for_overlaps)
2096 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2097 r.height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r.y;
2099 /* Alas, the above simple strategy does not work for the
2100 environments with anti-aliased text: if the same text is
2101 drawn onto the same place multiple times, it gets thicker.
2102 If the overlap we are processing is for the erased cursor, we
2103 take the intersection with the rectangle of the cursor. */
2104 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR)
2106 XRectangle rc, r_save = r;
2108 rc.x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->w->phys_cursor.x);
2109 rc.y = s->w->phys_cursor.y;
2110 rc.width = s->w->phys_cursor_width;
2111 rc.height = s->w->phys_cursor_height;
2113 x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, &rc, &r);
2116 else
2118 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2119 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2120 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2121 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2122 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2123 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2124 else
2125 r.y = max (0, s->row->y);
2128 r.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r.y);
2130 /* If drawing the cursor, don't let glyph draw outside its
2131 advertised boundaries. Cleartype does this under some circumstances. */
2132 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2134 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
2135 int height, max_y;
2137 if (s->x > r.x)
2139 r.width -= s->x - r.x;
2140 r.x = s->x;
2142 r.width = min (r.width, glyph->pixel_width);
2144 /* If r.y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2145 height = min (glyph->ascent + glyph->descent,
2146 min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), s->row->visible_height));
2147 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - height;
2148 max_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, max_y);
2149 if (s->ybase - glyph->ascent > max_y)
2151 r.y = max_y;
2152 r.height = height;
2154 else
2156 /* Don't draw cursor glyph taller than our actual glyph. */
2157 height = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2158 if (height < r.height)
2160 max_y = r.y + r.height;
2161 r.y = min (max_y, max (r.y, s->ybase + glyph->descent - height));
2162 r.height = min (max_y - r.y, height);
2167 if (s->row->clip)
2169 XRectangle r_save = r;
2171 if (! x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, s->row->clip, &r))
2172 r.width = 0;
2175 if ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == 0
2176 || ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == OVERLAPS_BOTH && n == 1))
2178 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2179 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (r, *rects);
2180 #else
2181 *rects = r;
2182 #endif
2183 return 1;
2185 else
2187 /* If we are processing overlapping and allowed to return
2188 multiple clipping rectangles, we exclude the row of the glyph
2189 string from the clipping rectangle. This is to avoid drawing
2190 the same text on the environment with anti-aliasing. */
2191 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2192 XRectangle rs[2];
2193 #else
2194 XRectangle *rs = rects;
2195 #endif
2196 int i = 0, row_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, s->row->y);
2198 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_PRED)
2200 rs[i] = r;
2201 if (r.y + r.height > row_y)
2203 if (r.y < row_y)
2204 rs[i].height = row_y - r.y;
2205 else
2206 rs[i].height = 0;
2208 i++;
2210 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_SUCC)
2212 rs[i] = r;
2213 if (r.y < row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2215 if (r.y + r.height > row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2217 rs[i].y = row_y + s->row->visible_height;
2218 rs[i].height = r.y + r.height - rs[i].y;
2220 else
2221 rs[i].height = 0;
2223 i++;
2226 n = i;
2227 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2228 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
2229 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (rs[i], rects[i]);
2230 #endif
2231 return n;
2235 /* EXPORT:
2236 Return in *NR the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2238 void
2239 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *nr)
2241 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, nr, 1);
2245 /* EXPORT:
2246 Return the position and height of the phys cursor in window W.
2247 Set w->phys_cursor_width to width of phys cursor.
2250 void
2251 get_phys_cursor_geometry (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
2252 struct glyph *glyph, int *xp, int *yp, int *heightp)
2254 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
2255 int x, y, wd, h, h0, y0;
2257 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
2258 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
2259 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
2260 width instead. */
2261 wd = glyph->pixel_width - 1;
2262 #if defined (HAVE_NTGUI) || defined (HAVE_NS)
2263 wd++; /* Why? */
2264 #endif
2266 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
2267 if (x < 0)
2269 wd += x;
2270 x = 0;
2273 if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
2274 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2275 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
2276 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
2278 y = w->phys_cursor.y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent;
2280 /* If y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2281 h0 = min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->visible_height);
2283 h = max (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2284 h0 = min (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2286 y0 = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2287 if (y < y0)
2289 h = max (h - (y0 - y) + 1, h0);
2290 y = y0 - 1;
2292 else
2294 y0 = window_text_bottom_y (w) - h0;
2295 if (y > y0)
2297 h += y - y0;
2298 y = y0;
2302 *xp = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, x);
2303 *yp = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, y);
2304 *heightp = h;
2308 * Remember which glyph the mouse is over.
2311 void
2312 remember_mouse_glyph (struct frame *f, int gx, int gy, NativeRectangle *rect)
2314 Lisp_Object window;
2315 struct window *w;
2316 struct glyph_row *r, *gr, *end_row;
2317 enum window_part part;
2318 enum glyph_row_area area;
2319 int x, y, width, height;
2321 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
2322 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F. */
2324 if (window_resize_pixelwise)
2326 width = height = 1;
2327 goto virtual_glyph;
2329 else if (!f->glyphs_initialized_p
2330 || (window = window_from_coordinates (f, gx, gy, &part, 0),
2331 NILP (window)))
2333 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f);
2334 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f);
2335 goto virtual_glyph;
2338 w = XWINDOW (window);
2339 width = WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
2340 height = WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2342 x = window_relative_x_coord (w, part, gx);
2343 y = gy - WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2345 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
2346 end_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
2348 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
2350 area = TEXT_AREA;
2351 part = ON_MODE_LINE; /* Don't adjust margin. */
2352 goto text_glyph;
2355 switch (part)
2357 case ON_LEFT_MARGIN:
2358 area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
2359 goto text_glyph;
2361 case ON_RIGHT_MARGIN:
2362 area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
2363 goto text_glyph;
2365 case ON_HEADER_LINE:
2366 case ON_MODE_LINE:
2367 gr = (part == ON_HEADER_LINE
2368 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
2369 : MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
2370 gy = gr->y;
2371 area = TEXT_AREA;
2372 goto text_glyph_row_found;
2374 case ON_TEXT:
2375 area = TEXT_AREA;
2377 text_glyph:
2378 gr = 0; gy = 0;
2379 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2380 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2382 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2383 break;
2386 text_glyph_row_found:
2387 if (gr && gy <= y)
2389 struct glyph *g = gr->glyphs[area];
2390 struct glyph *end = g + gr->used[area];
2392 height = gr->height;
2393 for (gx = gr->x; g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
2394 if (gx + g->pixel_width > x)
2395 break;
2397 if (g < end)
2399 if (g->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
2401 /* Don't remember when mouse is over image, as
2402 image may have hot-spots. */
2403 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, 0, 0, 0, 0);
2404 return;
2406 width = g->pixel_width;
2408 else
2410 /* Use nominal char spacing at end of line. */
2411 x -= gx;
2412 gx += (x / width) * width;
2415 if (part != ON_MODE_LINE && part != ON_HEADER_LINE)
2416 gx += window_box_left_offset (w, area);
2418 else
2420 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2421 gx = (x / width) * width;
2422 y -= gy;
2423 gy += (y / height) * height;
2425 break;
2427 case ON_LEFT_FRINGE:
2428 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2429 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w)
2430 : window_box_right_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
2431 width = WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2432 goto row_glyph;
2434 case ON_RIGHT_FRINGE:
2435 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2436 ? window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2437 : window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA));
2438 width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2439 goto row_glyph;
2441 case ON_SCROLL_BAR:
2442 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w)
2444 : (window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2445 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2446 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
2447 : 0)));
2448 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
2450 row_glyph:
2451 gr = 0, gy = 0;
2452 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2453 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2455 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2456 break;
2459 if (gr && gy <= y)
2460 height = gr->height;
2461 else
2463 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2464 y -= gy;
2465 gy += (y / height) * height;
2467 break;
2469 default:
2471 virtual_glyph:
2472 /* If there is no glyph under the mouse, then we divide the screen
2473 into a grid of the smallest glyph in the frame, and use that
2474 as our "glyph". */
2476 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
2477 round down even for negative values. */
2478 if (gx < 0)
2479 gx -= width - 1;
2480 if (gy < 0)
2481 gy -= height - 1;
2483 gx = (gx / width) * width;
2484 gy = (gy / height) * height;
2486 goto store_rect;
2489 gx += WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
2490 gy += WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2492 store_rect:
2493 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, gx, gy, width, height);
2495 /* Visible feedback for debugging. */
2496 #if 0
2497 #if HAVE_X_WINDOWS
2498 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2499 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2500 gx, gy, width, height);
2501 #endif
2502 #endif
2506 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
2508 static void
2509 adjust_window_ends (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, bool current)
2511 eassert (w);
2512 w->window_end_pos = Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row);
2513 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
2514 w->window_end_vpos
2515 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, current ? w->current_matrix : w->desired_matrix);
2518 /***********************************************************************
2519 Lisp form evaluation
2520 ***********************************************************************/
2522 /* Error handler for safe_eval and safe_call. */
2524 static Lisp_Object
2525 safe_eval_handler (Lisp_Object arg, ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
2527 add_to_log ("Error during redisplay: %S signaled %S",
2528 Flist (nargs, args), arg);
2529 return Qnil;
2532 /* Call function FUNC with the rest of NARGS - 1 arguments
2533 following. Return the result, or nil if something went
2534 wrong. Prevent redisplay during the evaluation. */
2536 Lisp_Object
2537 safe_call (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object func, ...)
2539 Lisp_Object val;
2541 if (inhibit_eval_during_redisplay)
2542 val = Qnil;
2543 else
2545 va_list ap;
2546 ptrdiff_t i;
2547 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
2548 struct gcpro gcpro1;
2549 Lisp_Object *args = alloca (nargs * word_size);
2551 args[0] = func;
2552 va_start (ap, func);
2553 for (i = 1; i < nargs; i++)
2554 args[i] = va_arg (ap, Lisp_Object);
2555 va_end (ap);
2557 GCPRO1 (args[0]);
2558 gcpro1.nvars = nargs;
2559 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
2560 /* Use Qt to ensure debugger does not run,
2561 so there is no possibility of wanting to redisplay. */
2562 val = internal_condition_case_n (Ffuncall, nargs, args, Qt,
2563 safe_eval_handler);
2564 UNGCPRO;
2565 val = unbind_to (count, val);
2568 return val;
2572 /* Call function FN with one argument ARG.
2573 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2575 Lisp_Object
2576 safe_call1 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg)
2578 return safe_call (2, fn, arg);
2581 static Lisp_Object Qeval;
2583 Lisp_Object
2584 safe_eval (Lisp_Object sexpr)
2586 return safe_call1 (Qeval, sexpr);
2589 /* Call function FN with two arguments ARG1 and ARG2.
2590 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2592 Lisp_Object
2593 safe_call2 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
2595 return safe_call (3, fn, arg1, arg2);
2600 /***********************************************************************
2601 Debugging
2602 ***********************************************************************/
2604 #if 0
2606 /* Define CHECK_IT to perform sanity checks on iterators.
2607 This is for debugging. It is too slow to do unconditionally. */
2609 static void
2610 check_it (struct it *it)
2612 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
2614 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2615 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
2617 else
2619 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < 0);
2620 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
2622 /* Check that character and byte positions agree. */
2623 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BYTE_TO_CHAR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)));
2627 if (it->dpvec)
2628 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
2629 else
2630 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index < 0);
2633 #define CHECK_IT(IT) check_it ((IT))
2635 #else /* not 0 */
2637 #define CHECK_IT(IT) (void) 0
2639 #endif /* not 0 */
2642 #if defined GLYPH_DEBUG && defined ENABLE_CHECKING
2644 /* Check that the window end of window W is what we expect it
2645 to be---the last row in the current matrix displaying text. */
2647 static void
2648 check_window_end (struct window *w)
2650 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && w->window_end_valid)
2652 struct glyph_row *row;
2653 eassert ((row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->window_end_vpos),
2654 !row->enabled_p
2655 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
2656 || MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix) == 0));
2660 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) check_window_end ((W))
2662 #else
2664 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) (void) 0
2666 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG and ENABLE_CHECKING */
2668 /***********************************************************************
2669 Iterator initialization
2670 ***********************************************************************/
2672 /* Initialize IT for displaying current_buffer in window W, starting
2673 at character position CHARPOS. CHARPOS < 0 means that no buffer
2674 position is specified which is useful when the iterator is assigned
2675 a position later. BYTEPOS is the byte position corresponding to
2676 CHARPOS.
2678 If ROW is not null, calls to produce_glyphs with IT as parameter
2679 will produce glyphs in that row.
2681 BASE_FACE_ID is the id of a base face to use. It must be one of
2682 DEFAULT_FACE_ID for normal text, MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2683 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID for displaying
2684 mode lines, or TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID for displaying the tool-bar.
2686 If ROW is null and BASE_FACE_ID is equal to MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2687 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID, the iterator
2688 will be initialized to use the corresponding mode line glyph row of
2689 the desired matrix of W. */
2691 void
2692 init_iterator (struct it *it, struct window *w,
2693 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos,
2694 struct glyph_row *row, enum face_id base_face_id)
2696 enum face_id remapped_base_face_id = base_face_id;
2698 /* Some precondition checks. */
2699 eassert (w != NULL && it != NULL);
2700 eassert (charpos < 0 || (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer)
2701 && charpos <= ZV));
2703 /* If face attributes have been changed since the last redisplay,
2704 free realized faces now because they depend on face definitions
2705 that might have changed. Don't free faces while there might be
2706 desired matrices pending which reference these faces. */
2707 if (face_change_count && !inhibit_free_realized_faces)
2709 face_change_count = 0;
2710 free_all_realized_faces (Qnil);
2713 /* Perhaps remap BASE_FACE_ID to a user-specified alternative. */
2714 if (! NILP (Vface_remapping_alist))
2715 remapped_base_face_id
2716 = lookup_basic_face (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face_id);
2718 /* Use one of the mode line rows of W's desired matrix if
2719 appropriate. */
2720 if (row == NULL)
2722 if (base_face_id == MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
2723 || base_face_id == MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
2724 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2725 else if (base_face_id == HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID)
2726 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2729 /* Clear IT. */
2730 memset (it, 0, sizeof *it);
2731 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
2732 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
2733 it->base_face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2734 it->string = Qnil;
2735 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
2736 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2737 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
2738 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
2739 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
2740 it->bidi_it.w = w;
2742 /* The window in which we iterate over current_buffer: */
2743 XSETWINDOW (it->window, w);
2744 it->w = w;
2745 it->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2747 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
2749 /* Extra space between lines (on window systems only). */
2750 if (base_face_id == DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2751 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2753 if (NATNUMP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2754 it->extra_line_spacing = XFASTINT (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing));
2755 else if (FLOATP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2756 it->extra_line_spacing = (XFLOAT_DATA (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing))
2757 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
2758 else if (it->f->extra_line_spacing > 0)
2759 it->extra_line_spacing = it->f->extra_line_spacing;
2760 it->max_extra_line_spacing = 0;
2763 /* If realized faces have been removed, e.g. because of face
2764 attribute changes of named faces, recompute them. When running
2765 in batch mode, the face cache of the initial frame is null. If
2766 we happen to get called, make a dummy face cache. */
2767 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f) == NULL)
2768 init_frame_faces (it->f);
2769 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f)->used == 0)
2770 recompute_basic_faces (it->f);
2772 /* Current value of the `slice', `space-width', and 'height' properties. */
2773 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
2774 it->space_width = Qnil;
2775 it->font_height = Qnil;
2776 it->override_ascent = -1;
2778 /* Are control characters displayed as `^C'? */
2779 it->ctl_arrow_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, ctl_arrow));
2781 /* -1 means everything between a CR and the following line end
2782 is invisible. >0 means lines indented more than this value are
2783 invisible. */
2784 it->selective = (INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2785 ? (clip_to_bounds
2786 (-1, XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)),
2787 PTRDIFF_MAX))
2788 : (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2789 ? -1 : 0));
2790 it->selective_display_ellipsis_p
2791 = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display_ellipses));
2793 /* Display table to use. */
2794 it->dp = window_display_table (w);
2796 /* Are multibyte characters enabled in current_buffer? */
2797 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
2799 /* Get the position at which the redisplay_end_trigger hook should
2800 be run, if it is to be run at all. */
2801 if (MARKERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger)
2802 && XMARKER (w->redisplay_end_trigger)->buffer != 0)
2803 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
2804 = marker_position (w->redisplay_end_trigger);
2805 else if (INTEGERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger))
2806 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos =
2807 clip_to_bounds (PTRDIFF_MIN, XINT (w->redisplay_end_trigger), PTRDIFF_MAX);
2809 it->tab_width = SANE_TAB_WIDTH (current_buffer);
2811 /* Are lines in the display truncated? */
2812 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2813 || it->w->hscroll
2814 || (! WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (it->w)
2815 && ((!NILP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2816 && !INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))
2817 || (INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2818 /* PXW: Shall we do something about this? */
2819 && (WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (it->w)
2820 < XINT (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))))))
2821 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2822 else if (NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines)))
2823 it->line_wrap = NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, word_wrap))
2824 ? WINDOW_WRAP : WORD_WRAP;
2825 else
2826 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2828 /* Get dimensions of truncation and continuation glyphs. These are
2829 displayed as fringe bitmaps under X, but we need them for such
2830 frames when the fringes are turned off. But leave the dimensions
2831 zero for tooltip frames, as these glyphs look ugly there and also
2832 sabotage calculations of tooltip dimensions in x-show-tip. */
2833 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
2834 if (!(FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2835 && FRAMEP (tip_frame)
2836 && it->f == XFRAME (tip_frame)))
2837 #endif
2839 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2841 /* We will need the truncation glyph. */
2842 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2843 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
2844 it->truncation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2846 else
2848 /* We will need the continuation glyph. */
2849 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2850 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
2851 it->continuation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2855 /* Reset these values to zero because the produce_special_glyphs
2856 above has changed them. */
2857 it->pixel_width = it->ascent = it->descent = 0;
2858 it->phys_ascent = it->phys_descent = 0;
2860 /* Set this after getting the dimensions of truncation and
2861 continuation glyphs, so that we don't produce glyphs when calling
2862 produce_special_glyphs, above. */
2863 it->glyph_row = row;
2864 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
2866 /* Forget any previous info about this row being reversed. */
2867 if (it->glyph_row)
2868 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = 0;
2870 /* Get the dimensions of the display area. The display area
2871 consists of the visible window area plus a horizontally scrolled
2872 part to the left of the window. All x-values are relative to the
2873 start of this total display area. */
2874 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2876 /* Mode lines, menu bar in terminal frames. */
2877 it->first_visible_x = 0;
2878 it->last_visible_x = WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w);
2880 else
2882 it->first_visible_x
2883 = window_hscroll_limited (it->w, it->f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
2884 it->last_visible_x = (it->first_visible_x
2885 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
2887 /* If we truncate lines, leave room for the truncation glyph(s) at
2888 the right margin. Otherwise, leave room for the continuation
2889 glyph(s). Done only if the window has no fringes. Since we
2890 don't know at this point whether there will be any R2L lines in
2891 the window, we reserve space for truncation/continuation glyphs
2892 even if only one of the fringes is absent. */
2893 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
2894 || (it->bidi_p && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0))
2896 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2897 it->last_visible_x -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
2898 else
2899 it->last_visible_x -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
2902 it->header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w);
2903 it->current_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) + w->vscroll;
2906 /* Leave room for a border glyph. */
2907 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2908 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (it->w))
2909 it->last_visible_x -= 1;
2911 it->last_visible_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
2913 /* For mode lines and alike, arrange for the first glyph having a
2914 left box line if the face specifies a box. */
2915 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2917 struct face *face;
2919 it->face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2921 /* If we have a boxed mode line, make the first character appear
2922 with a left box line. */
2923 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, remapped_base_face_id);
2924 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2925 it->start_of_box_run_p = true;
2928 /* If a buffer position was specified, set the iterator there,
2929 getting overlays and face properties from that position. */
2930 if (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer))
2932 it->end_charpos = ZV;
2933 eassert (charpos == BYTE_TO_CHAR (bytepos));
2934 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = charpos;
2935 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = bytepos;
2937 /* We will rely on `reseat' to set this up properly, via
2938 handle_face_prop. */
2939 it->face_id = it->base_face_id;
2941 it->start = it->current;
2942 /* Do we need to reorder bidirectional text? Not if this is a
2943 unibyte buffer: by definition, none of the single-byte
2944 characters are strong R2L, so no reordering is needed. And
2945 bidi.c doesn't support unibyte buffers anyway. Also, don't
2946 reorder while we are loading loadup.el, since the tables of
2947 character properties needed for reordering are not yet
2948 available. */
2949 it->bidi_p =
2950 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
2951 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering))
2952 && it->multibyte_p;
2954 /* If we are to reorder bidirectional text, init the bidi
2955 iterator. */
2956 if (it->bidi_p)
2958 /* Note the paragraph direction that this buffer wants to
2959 use. */
2960 if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2961 Qleft_to_right))
2962 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2963 else if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2964 Qright_to_left))
2965 it->paragraph_embedding = R2L;
2966 else
2967 it->paragraph_embedding = NEUTRAL_DIR;
2968 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
2969 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
2970 &it->bidi_it);
2973 /* Compute faces etc. */
2974 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
2977 CHECK_IT (it);
2981 /* Initialize IT for the display of window W with window start POS. */
2983 void
2984 start_display (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct text_pos pos)
2986 struct glyph_row *row;
2987 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
2989 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + first_vpos;
2990 init_iterator (it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
2991 it->first_vpos = first_vpos;
2993 /* Don't reseat to previous visible line start if current start
2994 position is in a string or image. */
2995 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
2997 int start_at_line_beg_p;
2998 int first_y = it->current_y;
3000 /* If window start is not at a line start, skip forward to POS to
3001 get the correct continuation lines width. */
3002 start_at_line_beg_p = (CHARPOS (pos) == BEGV
3003 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (pos) - 1) == '\n');
3004 if (!start_at_line_beg_p)
3006 int new_x;
3008 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (it);
3009 move_it_to (it, CHARPOS (pos), -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
3011 new_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width;
3013 /* If lines are continued, this line may end in the middle
3014 of a multi-glyph character (e.g. a control character
3015 displayed as \003, or in the middle of an overlay
3016 string). In this case move_it_to above will not have
3017 taken us to the start of the continuation line but to the
3018 end of the continued line. */
3019 if (it->current_x > 0
3020 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE /* Lines are continued. */
3021 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
3022 new_x > it->last_visible_x
3023 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
3024 system frame. */
3025 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
3026 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
3027 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
3028 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
3029 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
3031 if ((it->current.dpvec_index >= 0
3032 || it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3033 /* If we are on a newline from a display vector or
3034 overlay string, then we are already at the end of
3035 a screen line; no need to go to the next line in
3036 that case, as this line is not really continued.
3037 (If we do go to the next line, C-e will not DTRT.) */
3038 && it->c != '\n')
3040 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
3041 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
3044 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
3046 /* If the character at POS is displayed via a display
3047 vector, move_it_to above stops at the final glyph of
3048 IT->dpvec. To make the caller redisplay that character
3049 again (a.k.a. start at POS), we need to reset the
3050 dpvec_index to the beginning of IT->dpvec. */
3051 else if (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0)
3052 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
3054 /* We're starting a new display line, not affected by the
3055 height of the continued line, so clear the appropriate
3056 fields in the iterator structure. */
3057 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
3058 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
3060 it->current_y = first_y;
3061 it->vpos = 0;
3062 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
3068 /* Return 1 if POS is a position in ellipses displayed for invisible
3069 text. W is the window we display, for text property lookup. */
3071 static int
3072 in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *pos, struct window *w)
3074 Lisp_Object prop, window;
3075 int ellipses_p = 0;
3076 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos);
3078 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3079 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3080 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3081 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3082 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0
3083 && pos->overlay_string_index < 0
3084 && CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) < 0
3085 && charpos > BEGV
3086 && (XSETWINDOW (window, w),
3087 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos),
3088 Qinvisible, window),
3089 !TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop)))
3091 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qinvisible,
3092 window);
3093 ellipses_p = 2 == TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
3096 return ellipses_p;
3100 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W,
3101 starting at position POS that includes overlay string and display
3102 vector/ control character translation position information. Value
3103 is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at POS. */
3105 static int
3106 init_from_display_pos (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct display_pos *pos)
3108 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos), bytepos = BYTEPOS (pos->pos);
3109 int i, overlay_strings_with_newlines = 0;
3111 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3112 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3113 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3114 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3115 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (pos, w))
3117 --charpos;
3118 bytepos = 0;
3121 /* Keep in mind: the call to reseat in init_iterator skips invisible
3122 text, so we might end up at a position different from POS. This
3123 is only a problem when POS is a row start after a newline and an
3124 overlay starts there with an after-string, and the overlay has an
3125 invisible property. Since we don't skip invisible text in
3126 display_line and elsewhere immediately after consuming the
3127 newline before the row start, such a POS will not be in a string,
3128 but the call to init_iterator below will move us to the
3129 after-string. */
3130 init_iterator (it, w, charpos, bytepos, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
3132 /* This only scans the current chunk -- it should scan all chunks.
3133 However, OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE has been increased from 3 in 21.1
3134 to 16 in 22.1 to make this a lesser problem. */
3135 for (i = 0; i < it->n_overlay_strings && i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE; ++i)
3137 const char *s = SSDATA (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3138 const char *e = s + SBYTES (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3140 while (s < e && *s != '\n')
3141 ++s;
3143 if (s < e)
3145 overlay_strings_with_newlines = 1;
3146 break;
3150 /* If position is within an overlay string, set up IT to the right
3151 overlay string. */
3152 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= 0)
3154 int relative_index;
3156 /* If the first overlay string happens to have a `display'
3157 property for an image, the iterator will be set up for that
3158 image, and we have to undo that setup first before we can
3159 correct the overlay string index. */
3160 if (it->method == GET_FROM_IMAGE)
3161 pop_it (it);
3163 /* We already have the first chunk of overlay strings in
3164 IT->overlay_strings. Load more until the one for
3165 pos->overlay_string_index is in IT->overlay_strings. */
3166 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE)
3168 ptrdiff_t n = pos->overlay_string_index / OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3169 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
3170 while (n--)
3172 load_overlay_strings (it, 0);
3173 it->current.overlay_string_index += OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3177 it->current.overlay_string_index = pos->overlay_string_index;
3178 relative_index = (it->current.overlay_string_index
3179 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE);
3180 it->string = it->overlay_strings[relative_index];
3181 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3182 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3183 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
3184 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
3185 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
3186 if (it->bidi_p)
3188 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
3189 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
3190 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
3191 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
3192 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
3193 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
3194 it->bidi_it.w = it->w;
3195 bidi_init_it (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
3196 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
3198 /* Synchronize the state of the bidi iterator with
3199 pos->string_pos. For any string position other than
3200 zero, this will be done automagically when we resume
3201 iteration over the string and get_visually_first_element
3202 is called. But if string_pos is zero, and the string is
3203 to be reordered for display, we need to resync manually,
3204 since it could be that the iteration state recorded in
3205 pos ended at string_pos of 0 moving backwards in string. */
3206 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) == 0)
3208 get_visually_first_element (it);
3209 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) != 0)
3210 do {
3211 /* Paranoia. */
3212 eassert (it->bidi_it.charpos < it->bidi_it.string.schars);
3213 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
3214 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != 0);
3216 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
3217 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos);
3221 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) >= 0)
3223 /* Recorded position is not in an overlay string, but in another
3224 string. This can only be a string from a `display' property.
3225 IT should already be filled with that string. */
3226 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3227 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3228 if (it->bidi_p)
3229 bidi_init_it (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
3230 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
3233 /* Restore position in display vector translations, control
3234 character translations or ellipses. */
3235 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0)
3237 if (it->dpvec == NULL)
3238 get_next_display_element (it);
3239 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index == 0);
3240 it->current.dpvec_index = pos->dpvec_index;
3243 CHECK_IT (it);
3244 return !overlay_strings_with_newlines;
3248 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3249 starting at ROW->start. */
3251 static void
3252 init_to_row_start (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3254 init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->start);
3255 it->start = row->start;
3256 it->continuation_lines_width = row->continuation_lines_width;
3257 CHECK_IT (it);
3261 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3262 starting in the line following ROW, i.e. starting at ROW->end.
3263 Value is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at ROW's
3264 end position. */
3266 static int
3267 init_to_row_end (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3269 int success = 0;
3271 if (init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->end))
3273 if (row->continued_p)
3274 it->continuation_lines_width
3275 = row->continuation_lines_width + row->pixel_width;
3276 CHECK_IT (it);
3277 success = 1;
3280 return success;
3286 /***********************************************************************
3287 Text properties
3288 ***********************************************************************/
3290 /* Called when IT reaches IT->stop_charpos. Handle text property and
3291 overlay changes. Set IT->stop_charpos to the next position where
3292 to stop. */
3294 static void
3295 handle_stop (struct it *it)
3297 enum prop_handled handled;
3298 int handle_overlay_change_p;
3299 struct props *p;
3301 it->dpvec = NULL;
3302 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
3303 handle_overlay_change_p = !it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p;
3304 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
3305 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
3307 /* Use face of preceding text for ellipsis (if invisible) */
3308 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
3309 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
3313 handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3315 /* Call text property handlers. */
3316 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3318 handled = p->handler (it);
3320 if (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3321 break;
3322 else if (handled == HANDLED_RETURN)
3324 /* We still want to show before and after strings from
3325 overlays even if the actual buffer text is replaced. */
3326 if (!handle_overlay_change_p
3327 || it->sp > 1
3328 /* Don't call get_overlay_strings_1 if we already
3329 have overlay strings loaded, because doing so
3330 will load them again and push the iterator state
3331 onto the stack one more time, which is not
3332 expected by the rest of the code that processes
3333 overlay strings. */
3334 || (it->current.overlay_string_index < 0
3335 ? !get_overlay_strings_1 (it, 0, 0)
3336 : 0))
3338 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3339 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3340 /* When handling a display spec, we might load an
3341 empty string. In that case, discard it here. We
3342 used to discard it in handle_single_display_spec,
3343 but that causes get_overlay_strings_1, above, to
3344 ignore overlay strings that we must check. */
3345 if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3346 pop_it (it);
3347 return;
3349 else if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3350 pop_it (it);
3351 else
3353 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = true;
3354 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
3355 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
3356 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3358 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3359 break;
3361 else if (handled == HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED)
3362 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3365 if (handled != HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3367 /* Don't check for overlay strings below when set to deliver
3368 characters from a display vector. */
3369 if (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
3370 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3372 /* Handle overlay changes.
3373 This sets HANDLED to HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS
3374 if it finds overlays. */
3375 if (handle_overlay_change_p)
3376 handled = handle_overlay_change (it);
3379 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3381 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3382 break;
3385 while (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS);
3387 /* Determine where to stop next. */
3388 if (handled == HANDLED_NORMALLY)
3389 compute_stop_pos (it);
3393 /* Compute IT->stop_charpos from text property and overlay change
3394 information for IT's current position. */
3396 static void
3397 compute_stop_pos (struct it *it)
3399 register INTERVAL iv, next_iv;
3400 Lisp_Object object, limit, position;
3401 ptrdiff_t charpos, bytepos;
3403 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3405 /* Strings are usually short, so don't limit the search for
3406 properties. */
3407 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3408 object = it->string;
3409 limit = Qnil;
3410 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
3411 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
3413 else
3415 ptrdiff_t pos;
3417 /* If end_charpos is out of range for some reason, such as a
3418 misbehaving display function, rationalize it (Bug#5984). */
3419 if (it->end_charpos > ZV)
3420 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3421 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3423 /* If next overlay change is in front of the current stop pos
3424 (which is IT->end_charpos), stop there. Note: value of
3425 next_overlay_change is point-max if no overlay change
3426 follows. */
3427 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3428 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
3429 pos = next_overlay_change (charpos);
3430 if (pos < it->stop_charpos)
3431 it->stop_charpos = pos;
3433 /* Set up variables for computing the stop position from text
3434 property changes. */
3435 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
3436 limit = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT);
3439 /* Get the interval containing IT's position. Value is a null
3440 interval if there isn't such an interval. */
3441 position = make_number (charpos);
3442 iv = validate_interval_range (object, &position, &position, 0);
3443 if (iv)
3445 Lisp_Object values_here[LAST_PROP_IDX];
3446 struct props *p;
3448 /* Get properties here. */
3449 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3450 values_here[p->idx] = textget (iv->plist, *p->name);
3452 /* Look for an interval following iv that has different
3453 properties. */
3454 for (next_iv = next_interval (iv);
3455 (next_iv
3456 && (NILP (limit)
3457 || XFASTINT (limit) > next_iv->position));
3458 next_iv = next_interval (next_iv))
3460 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3462 Lisp_Object new_value;
3464 new_value = textget (next_iv->plist, *p->name);
3465 if (!EQ (values_here[p->idx], new_value))
3466 break;
3469 if (p->handler)
3470 break;
3473 if (next_iv)
3475 if (INTEGERP (limit)
3476 && next_iv->position >= XFASTINT (limit))
3477 /* No text property change up to limit. */
3478 it->stop_charpos = min (XFASTINT (limit), it->stop_charpos);
3479 else
3480 /* Text properties change in next_iv. */
3481 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, next_iv->position);
3485 if (it->cmp_it.id < 0)
3487 ptrdiff_t stoppos = it->end_charpos;
3489 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
3490 stoppos = -1;
3491 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos,
3492 stoppos, it->string);
3495 eassert (STRINGP (it->string)
3496 || (it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
3497 && it->stop_charpos >= IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
3501 /* Return the position of the next overlay change after POS in
3502 current_buffer. Value is point-max if no overlay change
3503 follows. This is like `next-overlay-change' but doesn't use
3504 xmalloc. */
3506 static ptrdiff_t
3507 next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t pos)
3509 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
3510 ptrdiff_t endpos;
3511 Lisp_Object *overlays;
3513 /* Get all overlays at the given position. */
3514 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlays, noverlays, &endpos, 1);
3516 /* If any of these overlays ends before endpos,
3517 use its ending point instead. */
3518 for (i = 0; i < noverlays; ++i)
3520 Lisp_Object oend;
3521 ptrdiff_t oendpos;
3523 oend = OVERLAY_END (overlays[i]);
3524 oendpos = OVERLAY_POSITION (oend);
3525 endpos = min (endpos, oendpos);
3528 return endpos;
3531 /* How many characters forward to search for a display property or
3532 display string. Searching too far forward makes the bidi display
3533 sluggish, especially in small windows. */
3534 #define MAX_DISP_SCAN 250
3536 /* Return the character position of a display string at or after
3537 position specified by POSITION. If no display string exists at or
3538 after POSITION, return ZV. A display string is either an overlay
3539 with `display' property whose value is a string, or a `display'
3540 text property whose value is a string. STRING is data about the
3541 string to iterate; if STRING->lstring is nil, we are iterating a
3542 buffer. FRAME_WINDOW_P is non-zero when we are displaying a window
3543 on a GUI frame. DISP_PROP is set to zero if we searched
3544 MAX_DISP_SCAN characters forward without finding any display
3545 strings, non-zero otherwise. It is set to 2 if the display string
3546 uses any kind of `(space ...)' spec that will produce a stretch of
3547 white space in the text area. */
3548 ptrdiff_t
3549 compute_display_string_pos (struct text_pos *position,
3550 struct bidi_string_data *string,
3551 struct window *w,
3552 int frame_window_p, int *disp_prop)
3554 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3555 Lisp_Object object, object1;
3556 Lisp_Object pos, spec, limpos;
3557 int string_p = (string && (STRINGP (string->lstring) || string->s));
3558 ptrdiff_t eob = string_p ? string->schars : ZV;
3559 ptrdiff_t begb = string_p ? 0 : BEGV;
3560 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos = CHARPOS (*position);
3561 ptrdiff_t lim =
3562 (charpos < eob - MAX_DISP_SCAN) ? charpos + MAX_DISP_SCAN : eob;
3563 struct text_pos tpos;
3564 int rv = 0;
3566 if (string && STRINGP (string->lstring))
3567 object1 = object = string->lstring;
3568 else if (w && !string_p)
3570 XSETWINDOW (object, w);
3571 object1 = Qnil;
3573 else
3574 object1 = object = Qnil;
3576 *disp_prop = 1;
3578 if (charpos >= eob
3579 /* We don't support display properties whose values are strings
3580 that have display string properties. */
3581 || string->from_disp_str
3582 /* C strings cannot have display properties. */
3583 || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3585 *disp_prop = 0;
3586 return eob;
3589 /* If the character at CHARPOS is where the display string begins,
3590 return CHARPOS. */
3591 pos = make_number (charpos);
3592 if (STRINGP (object))
3593 bufpos = string->bufpos;
3594 else
3595 bufpos = charpos;
3596 tpos = *position;
3597 if (!NILP (spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object))
3598 && (charpos <= begb
3599 || !EQ (Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qdisplay,
3600 object),
3601 spec))
3602 && (rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos, bufpos,
3603 frame_window_p)))
3605 if (rv == 2)
3606 *disp_prop = 2;
3607 return charpos;
3610 /* Look forward for the first character with a `display' property
3611 that will replace the underlying text when displayed. */
3612 limpos = make_number (lim);
3613 do {
3614 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object1, limpos);
3615 CHARPOS (tpos) = XFASTINT (pos);
3616 if (CHARPOS (tpos) >= lim)
3618 *disp_prop = 0;
3619 break;
3621 if (STRINGP (object))
3622 BYTEPOS (tpos) = string_char_to_byte (object, CHARPOS (tpos));
3623 else
3624 BYTEPOS (tpos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (tpos));
3625 spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object);
3626 if (!STRINGP (object))
3627 bufpos = CHARPOS (tpos);
3628 } while (NILP (spec)
3629 || !(rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos,
3630 bufpos, frame_window_p)));
3631 if (rv == 2)
3632 *disp_prop = 2;
3634 return CHARPOS (tpos);
3637 /* Return the character position of the end of the display string that
3638 started at CHARPOS. If there's no display string at CHARPOS,
3639 return -1. A display string is either an overlay with `display'
3640 property whose value is a string or a `display' text property whose
3641 value is a string. */
3642 ptrdiff_t
3643 compute_display_string_end (ptrdiff_t charpos, struct bidi_string_data *string)
3645 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3646 Lisp_Object object =
3647 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3648 Lisp_Object pos = make_number (charpos);
3649 ptrdiff_t eob =
3650 (STRINGP (object) || (string && string->s)) ? string->schars : ZV;
3652 if (charpos >= eob || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3653 return eob;
3655 /* It could happen that the display property or overlay was removed
3656 since we found it in compute_display_string_pos above. One way
3657 this can happen is if JIT font-lock was called (through
3658 handle_fontified_prop), and jit-lock-functions remove text
3659 properties or overlays from the portion of buffer that includes
3660 CHARPOS. Muse mode is known to do that, for example. In this
3661 case, we return -1 to the caller, to signal that no display
3662 string is actually present at CHARPOS. See bidi_fetch_char for
3663 how this is handled.
3665 An alternative would be to never look for display properties past
3666 it->stop_charpos. But neither compute_display_string_pos nor
3667 bidi_fetch_char that calls it know or care where the next
3668 stop_charpos is. */
3669 if (NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object)))
3670 return -1;
3672 /* Look forward for the first character where the `display' property
3673 changes. */
3674 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
3676 return XFASTINT (pos);
3681 /***********************************************************************
3682 Fontification
3683 ***********************************************************************/
3685 /* Handle changes in the `fontified' property of the current buffer by
3686 calling hook functions from Qfontification_functions to fontify
3687 regions of text. */
3689 static enum prop_handled
3690 handle_fontified_prop (struct it *it)
3692 Lisp_Object prop, pos;
3693 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3695 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
3696 return handled;
3698 /* Get the value of the `fontified' property at IT's current buffer
3699 position. (The `fontified' property doesn't have a special
3700 meaning in strings.) If the value is nil, call functions from
3701 Qfontification_functions. */
3702 if (!STRINGP (it->string)
3703 && it->s == NULL
3704 && !NILP (Vfontification_functions)
3705 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks)
3706 && (pos = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it)),
3707 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil),
3708 /* Ignore the special cased nil value always present at EOB since
3709 no amount of fontifying will be able to change it. */
3710 NILP (prop) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < Z))
3712 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
3713 Lisp_Object val;
3714 struct buffer *obuf = current_buffer;
3715 ptrdiff_t begv = BEGV, zv = ZV;
3716 bool old_clip_changed = current_buffer->clip_changed;
3718 val = Vfontification_functions;
3719 specbind (Qfontification_functions, Qnil);
3721 eassert (it->end_charpos == ZV);
3723 if (!CONSP (val) || EQ (XCAR (val), Qlambda))
3724 safe_call1 (val, pos);
3725 else
3727 Lisp_Object fns, fn;
3728 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
3730 fns = Qnil;
3731 GCPRO2 (val, fns);
3733 for (; CONSP (val); val = XCDR (val))
3735 fn = XCAR (val);
3737 if (EQ (fn, Qt))
3739 /* A value of t indicates this hook has a local
3740 binding; it means to run the global binding too.
3741 In a global value, t should not occur. If it
3742 does, we must ignore it to avoid an endless
3743 loop. */
3744 for (fns = Fdefault_value (Qfontification_functions);
3745 CONSP (fns);
3746 fns = XCDR (fns))
3748 fn = XCAR (fns);
3749 if (!EQ (fn, Qt))
3750 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3753 else
3754 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3757 UNGCPRO;
3760 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
3762 /* Fontification functions routinely call `save-restriction'.
3763 Normally, this tags clip_changed, which can confuse redisplay
3764 (see discussion in Bug#6671). Since we don't perform any
3765 special handling of fontification changes in the case where
3766 `save-restriction' isn't called, there's no point doing so in
3767 this case either. So, if the buffer's restrictions are
3768 actually left unchanged, reset clip_changed. */
3769 if (obuf == current_buffer)
3771 if (begv == BEGV && zv == ZV)
3772 current_buffer->clip_changed = old_clip_changed;
3774 /* There isn't much we can reasonably do to protect against
3775 misbehaving fontification, but here's a fig leaf. */
3776 else if (BUFFER_LIVE_P (obuf))
3777 set_buffer_internal_1 (obuf);
3779 /* The fontification code may have added/removed text.
3780 It could do even a lot worse, but let's at least protect against
3781 the most obvious case where only the text past `pos' gets changed',
3782 as is/was done in grep.el where some escapes sequences are turned
3783 into face properties (bug#7876). */
3784 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3786 /* Return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS only if function fontified
3787 something. This avoids an endless loop if they failed to
3788 fontify the text for which reason ever. */
3789 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil)))
3790 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3793 return handled;
3798 /***********************************************************************
3799 Faces
3800 ***********************************************************************/
3802 /* Set up iterator IT from face properties at its current position.
3803 Called from handle_stop. */
3805 static enum prop_handled
3806 handle_face_prop (struct it *it)
3808 int new_face_id;
3809 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
3811 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
3813 new_face_id
3814 = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
3815 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3816 &next_stop,
3817 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3818 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3819 0, it->base_face_id);
3821 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box face?
3822 Caveat: this can be called for a freshly initialized
3823 iterator; face_id is -1 in this case. We know that the new
3824 face will not change until limit, i.e. if the new face has a
3825 box, all characters up to limit will have one. But, as
3826 usual, we don't know whether limit is really the end. */
3827 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3829 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3830 /* If it->face_id is -1, old_face below will be NULL, see
3831 the definition of FACE_FROM_ID. This will happen if this
3832 is the initial call that gets the face. */
3833 struct face *old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
3835 /* If the value of face_id of the iterator is -1, we have to
3836 look in front of IT's position and see whether there is a
3837 face there that's different from new_face_id. */
3838 if (!old_face && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEG)
3840 int prev_face_id = face_before_it_pos (it);
3842 old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, prev_face_id);
3845 /* If the new face has a box, but the old face does not,
3846 this is the start of a run of characters with box face,
3847 i.e. this character has a shadow on the left side. */
3848 it->start_of_box_run_p = (new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3849 && (old_face == NULL || !old_face->box));
3850 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3853 else
3855 int base_face_id;
3856 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
3857 int i;
3858 Lisp_Object from_overlay
3859 = (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
3860 ? it->string_overlays[it->current.overlay_string_index
3861 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE]
3862 : Qnil);
3864 /* See if we got to this string directly or indirectly from
3865 an overlay property. That includes the before-string or
3866 after-string of an overlay, strings in display properties
3867 provided by an overlay, their text properties, etc.
3869 FROM_OVERLAY is the overlay that brought us here, or nil if none. */
3870 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3871 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3873 if (it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3874 from_overlay
3875 = it->string_overlays[it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index
3876 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE];
3877 else if (! NILP (it->stack[i].from_overlay))
3878 from_overlay = it->stack[i].from_overlay;
3880 if (!NILP (from_overlay))
3881 break;
3884 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3886 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3887 /* For a string from an overlay, the base face depends
3888 only on text properties and ignores overlays. */
3889 base_face_id
3890 = face_for_overlay_string (it->w,
3891 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3892 &next_stop,
3893 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3894 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3896 from_overlay);
3898 else
3900 bufpos = 0;
3902 /* For strings from a `display' property, use the face at
3903 IT's current buffer position as the base face to merge
3904 with, so that overlay strings appear in the same face as
3905 surrounding text, unless they specify their own faces.
3906 For strings from wrap-prefix and line-prefix properties,
3907 use the default face, possibly remapped via
3908 Vface_remapping_alist. */
3909 base_face_id = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p
3910 ? (!NILP (Vface_remapping_alist)
3911 ? lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
3912 : DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
3913 : underlying_face_id (it);
3916 new_face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3917 it->string,
3918 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
3919 bufpos,
3920 &next_stop,
3921 base_face_id, 0);
3923 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box? Caveat:
3924 this can be called for a freshly allocated iterator; face_id
3925 is -1 is this case. We know that the new face will not
3926 change until the next check pos, i.e. if the new face has a
3927 box, all characters up to that position will have a
3928 box. But, as usual, we don't know whether that position
3929 is really the end. */
3930 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3932 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3933 struct face *old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
3935 /* If new face has a box but old face hasn't, this is the
3936 start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has a
3937 shadow on the left side. */
3938 it->start_of_box_run_p
3939 = new_face->box && (old_face == NULL || !old_face->box);
3940 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3944 it->face_id = new_face_id;
3945 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3949 /* Return the ID of the face ``underlying'' IT's current position,
3950 which is in a string. If the iterator is associated with a
3951 buffer, return the face at IT's current buffer position.
3952 Otherwise, use the iterator's base_face_id. */
3954 static int
3955 underlying_face_id (struct it *it)
3957 int face_id = it->base_face_id, i;
3959 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3961 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3962 if (NILP (it->stack[i].string))
3963 face_id = it->stack[i].face_id;
3965 return face_id;
3969 /* Compute the face one character before or after the current position
3970 of IT, in the visual order. BEFORE_P non-zero means get the face
3971 in front (to the left in L2R paragraphs, to the right in R2L
3972 paragraphs) of IT's screen position. Value is the ID of the face. */
3974 static int
3975 face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *it, int before_p)
3977 int face_id, limit;
3978 ptrdiff_t next_check_charpos;
3979 struct it it_copy;
3980 void *it_copy_data = NULL;
3982 eassert (it->s == NULL);
3984 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3986 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos;
3987 int base_face_id;
3989 /* No face change past the end of the string (for the case
3990 we are padding with spaces). No face change before the
3991 string start. */
3992 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string)
3993 || (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 && before_p))
3994 return it->face_id;
3996 if (!it->bidi_p)
3998 /* Set charpos to the position before or after IT's current
3999 position, in the logical order, which in the non-bidi
4000 case is the same as the visual order. */
4001 if (before_p)
4002 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) - 1;
4003 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
4004 /* For composition, we must check the character after the
4005 composition. */
4006 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + it->cmp_it.nchars;
4007 else
4008 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + 1;
4010 else
4012 if (before_p)
4014 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
4015 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
4016 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
4017 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
4018 family of functions. */
4019 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
4020 character on this display line. */
4021 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
4022 return it->face_id;
4023 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
4024 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
4025 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
4026 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
4027 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
4028 cases here. */
4029 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, SCHARS (it_copy.string),
4030 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
4031 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it_copy);
4032 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
4034 else
4036 /* Set charpos to the string position of the character
4037 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
4038 order. */
4039 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
4041 it_copy = *it;
4042 while (n--)
4043 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
4045 charpos = it_copy.bidi_it.charpos;
4048 eassert (0 <= charpos && charpos <= SCHARS (it->string));
4050 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
4051 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
4052 else
4053 bufpos = 0;
4055 base_face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
4057 /* Get the face for ASCII, or unibyte. */
4058 face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
4059 it->string,
4060 charpos,
4061 bufpos,
4062 &next_check_charpos,
4063 base_face_id, 0);
4065 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
4066 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
4067 suitable for unibyte text if IT->string is unibyte. */
4068 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
4070 struct text_pos pos1 = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
4071 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (it->string) + BYTEPOS (pos1);
4072 int c, len;
4073 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4075 c = string_char_and_length (p, &len);
4076 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, charpos, it->string);
4079 else
4081 struct text_pos pos;
4083 if ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= ZV && !before_p)
4084 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV && before_p))
4085 return it->face_id;
4087 limit = IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT;
4088 pos = it->current.pos;
4090 if (!it->bidi_p)
4092 if (before_p)
4093 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
4094 else
4096 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
4098 /* For composition, we must check the position after
4099 the composition. */
4100 pos.charpos += it->cmp_it.nchars;
4101 pos.bytepos += it->len;
4103 else
4104 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
4107 else
4109 if (before_p)
4111 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
4112 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
4113 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
4114 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
4115 family of functions. */
4116 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
4117 character on this display line. */
4118 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
4119 return it->face_id;
4120 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
4121 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
4122 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
4123 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
4124 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
4125 cases here. */
4126 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, ZV,
4127 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
4128 pos = it_copy.current.pos;
4129 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
4131 else
4133 /* Set charpos to the buffer position of the character
4134 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
4135 order. */
4136 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
4138 it_copy = *it;
4139 while (n--)
4140 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
4142 SET_TEXT_POS (pos,
4143 it_copy.bidi_it.charpos, it_copy.bidi_it.bytepos);
4146 eassert (BEGV <= CHARPOS (pos) && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
4148 /* Determine face for CHARSET_ASCII, or unibyte. */
4149 face_id = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
4150 CHARPOS (pos),
4151 &next_check_charpos,
4152 limit, 0, -1);
4154 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
4155 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
4156 suitable for unibyte text if current_buffer is unibyte. */
4157 if (it->multibyte_p)
4159 int c = FETCH_MULTIBYTE_CHAR (BYTEPOS (pos));
4160 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4161 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, CHARPOS (pos), Qnil);
4165 return face_id;
4170 /***********************************************************************
4171 Invisible text
4172 ***********************************************************************/
4174 /* Set up iterator IT from invisible properties at its current
4175 position. Called from handle_stop. */
4177 static enum prop_handled
4178 handle_invisible_prop (struct it *it)
4180 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4181 int invis_p;
4182 Lisp_Object prop;
4184 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4186 Lisp_Object end_charpos, limit, charpos;
4188 /* Get the value of the invisible text property at the
4189 current position. Value will be nil if there is no such
4190 property. */
4191 charpos = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
4192 prop = Fget_text_property (charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4193 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4195 if (invis_p && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
4197 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4198 invisible text. */
4199 int display_ellipsis_p = (invis_p == 2);
4200 ptrdiff_t len, endpos;
4202 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4204 /* Get the position at which the next visible text can be
4205 found in IT->string, if any. */
4206 endpos = len = SCHARS (it->string);
4207 XSETINT (limit, len);
4210 end_charpos = Fnext_single_property_change (charpos, Qinvisible,
4211 it->string, limit);
4212 if (INTEGERP (end_charpos))
4214 endpos = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4215 prop = Fget_text_property (end_charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4216 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4217 if (invis_p == 2)
4218 display_ellipsis_p = true;
4221 while (invis_p && endpos < len);
4223 if (display_ellipsis_p)
4224 it->ellipsis_p = true;
4226 if (endpos < len)
4228 /* Text at END_CHARPOS is visible. Move IT there. */
4229 struct text_pos old;
4230 ptrdiff_t oldpos;
4232 old = it->current.string_pos;
4233 oldpos = CHARPOS (old);
4234 if (it->bidi_p)
4236 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt
4237 && it->bidi_it.charpos < SCHARS (it->string))
4238 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4239 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4240 /* Bidi-iterate out of the invisible text. */
4243 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4245 while (oldpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4246 && it->bidi_it.charpos < endpos);
4248 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4249 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4250 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= endpos)
4251 it->prev_stop = endpos;
4253 else
4255 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4256 compute_string_pos (&it->current.string_pos, old, it->string);
4259 else
4261 /* The rest of the string is invisible. If this is an
4262 overlay string, proceed with the next overlay string
4263 or whatever comes and return a character from there. */
4264 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
4265 && !display_ellipsis_p)
4267 next_overlay_string (it);
4268 /* Don't check for overlay strings when we just
4269 finished processing them. */
4270 handled = HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED;
4272 else
4274 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = SCHARS (it->string);
4275 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = SBYTES (it->string);
4280 else
4282 ptrdiff_t newpos, next_stop, start_charpos, tem;
4283 Lisp_Object pos, overlay;
4285 /* First of all, is there invisible text at this position? */
4286 tem = start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
4287 pos = make_number (tem);
4288 prop = get_char_property_and_overlay (pos, Qinvisible, it->window,
4289 &overlay);
4290 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4292 /* If we are on invisible text, skip over it. */
4293 if (invis_p && start_charpos < it->end_charpos)
4295 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4296 invisible text. */
4297 int display_ellipsis_p = invis_p == 2;
4299 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4301 /* Loop skipping over invisible text. The loop is left at
4302 ZV or with IT on the first char being visible again. */
4305 /* Try to skip some invisible text. Return value is the
4306 position reached which can be equal to where we start
4307 if there is nothing invisible there. This skips both
4308 over invisible text properties and overlays with
4309 invisible property. */
4310 newpos = skip_invisible (tem, &next_stop, ZV, it->window);
4312 /* If we skipped nothing at all we weren't at invisible
4313 text in the first place. If everything to the end of
4314 the buffer was skipped, end the loop. */
4315 if (newpos == tem || newpos >= ZV)
4316 invis_p = 0;
4317 else
4319 /* We skipped some characters but not necessarily
4320 all there are. Check if we ended up on visible
4321 text. Fget_char_property returns the property of
4322 the char before the given position, i.e. if we
4323 get invis_p = 0, this means that the char at
4324 newpos is visible. */
4325 pos = make_number (newpos);
4326 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qinvisible, it->window);
4327 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4330 /* If we ended up on invisible text, proceed to
4331 skip starting with next_stop. */
4332 if (invis_p)
4333 tem = next_stop;
4335 /* If there are adjacent invisible texts, don't lose the
4336 second one's ellipsis. */
4337 if (invis_p == 2)
4338 display_ellipsis_p = true;
4340 while (invis_p);
4342 /* The position newpos is now either ZV or on visible text. */
4343 if (it->bidi_p)
4345 ptrdiff_t bpos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4346 int on_newline
4347 = bpos == ZV_BYTE || FETCH_BYTE (bpos) == '\n';
4348 int after_newline
4349 = newpos <= BEGV || FETCH_BYTE (bpos - 1) == '\n';
4351 /* If the invisible text ends on a newline or on a
4352 character after a newline, we can avoid the costly,
4353 character by character, bidi iteration to NEWPOS, and
4354 instead simply reseat the iterator there. That's
4355 because all bidi reordering information is tossed at
4356 the newline. This is a big win for modes that hide
4357 complete lines, like Outline, Org, etc. */
4358 if (on_newline || after_newline)
4360 struct text_pos tpos;
4361 bidi_dir_t pdir = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4363 SET_TEXT_POS (tpos, newpos, bpos);
4364 reseat_1 (it, tpos, 0);
4365 /* If we reseat on a newline/ZV, we need to prep the
4366 bidi iterator for advancing to the next character
4367 after the newline/EOB, keeping the current paragraph
4368 direction (so that PRODUCE_GLYPHS does TRT wrt
4369 prepending/appending glyphs to a glyph row). */
4370 if (on_newline)
4372 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
4373 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = pdir;
4374 it->bidi_it.ch = (bpos == ZV_BYTE) ? -1 : '\n';
4375 it->bidi_it.nchars = 1;
4376 it->bidi_it.ch_len = 1;
4379 else /* Must use the slow method. */
4381 /* With bidi iteration, the region of invisible text
4382 could start and/or end in the middle of a
4383 non-base embedding level. Therefore, we need to
4384 skip invisible text using the bidi iterator,
4385 starting at IT's current position, until we find
4386 ourselves outside of the invisible text.
4387 Skipping invisible text _after_ bidi iteration
4388 avoids affecting the visual order of the
4389 displayed text when invisible properties are
4390 added or removed. */
4391 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < ZV)
4393 /* If we were `reseat'ed to a new paragraph,
4394 determine the paragraph base direction. We
4395 need to do it now because
4396 next_element_from_buffer may not have a
4397 chance to do it, if we are going to skip any
4398 text at the beginning, which resets the
4399 FIRST_ELT flag. */
4400 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4401 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4405 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4407 while (it->stop_charpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4408 && it->bidi_it.charpos < newpos);
4409 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4410 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4411 /* If we overstepped NEWPOS, record its position in
4412 the iterator, so that we skip invisible text if
4413 later the bidi iteration lands us in the
4414 invisible region again. */
4415 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= newpos)
4416 it->prev_stop = newpos;
4419 else
4421 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = newpos;
4422 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4425 /* If there are before-strings at the start of invisible
4426 text, and the text is invisible because of a text
4427 property, arrange to show before-strings because 20.x did
4428 it that way. (If the text is invisible because of an
4429 overlay property instead of a text property, this is
4430 already handled in the overlay code.) */
4431 if (NILP (overlay)
4432 && get_overlay_strings (it, it->stop_charpos))
4434 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4435 it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p = display_ellipsis_p;
4437 else if (display_ellipsis_p)
4439 /* Make sure that the glyphs of the ellipsis will get
4440 correct `charpos' values. If we would not update
4441 it->position here, the glyphs would belong to the
4442 last visible character _before_ the invisible
4443 text, which confuses `set_cursor_from_row'.
4445 We use the last invisible position instead of the
4446 first because this way the cursor is always drawn on
4447 the first "." of the ellipsis, whenever PT is inside
4448 the invisible text. Otherwise the cursor would be
4449 placed _after_ the ellipsis when the point is after the
4450 first invisible character. */
4451 if (!STRINGP (it->object))
4453 it->position.charpos = newpos - 1;
4454 it->position.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->position.charpos);
4456 it->ellipsis_p = true;
4457 /* Let the ellipsis display before
4458 considering any properties of the following char.
4459 Fixes jasonr@gnu.org 01 Oct 07 bug. */
4460 handled = HANDLED_RETURN;
4465 return handled;
4469 /* Make iterator IT return `...' next.
4470 Replaces LEN characters from buffer. */
4472 static void
4473 setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *it, int len)
4475 /* Use the display table definition for `...'. Invalid glyphs
4476 will be handled by the method returning elements from dpvec. */
4477 if (it->dp && VECTORP (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp)))
4479 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp));
4480 it->dpvec = v->contents;
4481 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
4483 else
4485 /* Default `...'. */
4486 it->dpvec = default_invis_vector;
4487 it->dpend = default_invis_vector + 3;
4490 it->dpvec_char_len = len;
4491 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
4492 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
4494 /* Remember the current face id in case glyphs specify faces.
4495 IT's face is restored in set_iterator_to_next.
4496 saved_face_id was set to preceding char's face in handle_stop. */
4497 if (it->saved_face_id < 0 || it->saved_face_id != it->face_id)
4498 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
4500 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
4501 it->ellipsis_p = true;
4506 /***********************************************************************
4507 'display' property
4508 ***********************************************************************/
4510 /* Set up iterator IT from `display' property at its current position.
4511 Called from handle_stop.
4512 We return HANDLED_RETURN if some part of the display property
4513 overrides the display of the buffer text itself.
4514 Otherwise we return HANDLED_NORMALLY. */
4516 static enum prop_handled
4517 handle_display_prop (struct it *it)
4519 Lisp_Object propval, object, overlay;
4520 struct text_pos *position;
4521 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
4522 /* Nonzero if some property replaces the display of the text itself. */
4523 int display_replaced_p = 0;
4525 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4527 object = it->string;
4528 position = &it->current.string_pos;
4529 bufpos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
4531 else
4533 XSETWINDOW (object, it->w);
4534 position = &it->current.pos;
4535 bufpos = CHARPOS (*position);
4538 /* Reset those iterator values set from display property values. */
4539 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
4540 it->space_width = Qnil;
4541 it->font_height = Qnil;
4542 it->voffset = 0;
4544 /* We don't support recursive `display' properties, i.e. string
4545 values that have a string `display' property, that have a string
4546 `display' property etc. */
4547 if (!it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4548 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4550 propval = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (position->charpos),
4551 Qdisplay, object, &overlay);
4552 if (NILP (propval))
4553 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4554 /* Now OVERLAY is the overlay that gave us this property, or nil
4555 if it was a text property. */
4557 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
4558 object = it->w->contents;
4560 display_replaced_p = handle_display_spec (it, propval, object, overlay,
4561 position, bufpos,
4562 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f));
4564 return display_replaced_p ? HANDLED_RETURN : HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4567 /* Subroutine of handle_display_prop. Returns non-zero if the display
4568 specification in SPEC is a replacing specification, i.e. it would
4569 replace the text covered by `display' property with something else,
4570 such as an image or a display string. If SPEC includes any kind or
4571 `(space ...) specification, the value is 2; this is used by
4572 compute_display_string_pos, which see.
4574 See handle_single_display_spec for documentation of arguments.
4575 frame_window_p is non-zero if the window being redisplayed is on a
4576 GUI frame; this argument is used only if IT is NULL, see below.
4578 IT can be NULL, if this is called by the bidi reordering code
4579 through compute_display_string_pos, which see. In that case, this
4580 function only examines SPEC, but does not otherwise "handle" it, in
4581 the sense that it doesn't set up members of IT from the display
4582 spec. */
4583 static int
4584 handle_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4585 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4586 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int frame_window_p)
4588 int replacing_p = 0;
4589 int rv;
4591 if (CONSP (spec)
4592 /* Simple specifications. */
4593 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qimage)
4594 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace)
4595 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen)
4596 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice)
4597 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4598 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4599 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4600 /* Marginal area specifications. */
4601 && !(CONSP (XCAR (spec)) && EQ (XCAR (XCAR (spec)), Qmargin))
4602 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4603 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe)
4604 && !NILP (XCAR (spec)))
4606 for (; CONSP (spec); spec = XCDR (spec))
4608 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, XCAR (spec), object,
4609 overlay, position, bufpos,
4610 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4612 replacing_p = rv;
4613 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4614 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4615 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4616 break;
4620 else if (VECTORP (spec))
4622 ptrdiff_t i;
4623 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); ++i)
4624 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, AREF (spec, i), object,
4625 overlay, position, bufpos,
4626 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4628 replacing_p = rv;
4629 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4630 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4631 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4632 break;
4635 else
4637 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, spec, object, overlay,
4638 position, bufpos, 0,
4639 frame_window_p)))
4640 replacing_p = rv;
4643 return replacing_p;
4646 /* Value is the position of the end of the `display' property starting
4647 at START_POS in OBJECT. */
4649 static struct text_pos
4650 display_prop_end (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object, struct text_pos start_pos)
4652 Lisp_Object end;
4653 struct text_pos end_pos;
4655 end = Fnext_single_char_property_change (make_number (CHARPOS (start_pos)),
4656 Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
4657 CHARPOS (end_pos) = XFASTINT (end);
4658 if (STRINGP (object))
4659 compute_string_pos (&end_pos, start_pos, it->string);
4660 else
4661 BYTEPOS (end_pos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (XFASTINT (end));
4663 return end_pos;
4667 /* Set up IT from a single `display' property specification SPEC. OBJECT
4668 is the object in which the `display' property was found. *POSITION
4669 is the position in OBJECT at which the `display' property was found.
4670 BUFPOS is the buffer position of OBJECT (different from POSITION if
4671 OBJECT is not a buffer). DISPLAY_REPLACED_P non-zero means that we
4672 previously saw a display specification which already replaced text
4673 display with something else, for example an image; we ignore such
4674 properties after the first one has been processed.
4676 OVERLAY is the overlay this `display' property came from,
4677 or nil if it was a text property.
4679 If SPEC is a `space' or `image' specification, and in some other
4680 cases too, set *POSITION to the position where the `display'
4681 property ends.
4683 If IT is NULL, only examine the property specification in SPEC, but
4684 don't set up IT. In that case, FRAME_WINDOW_P non-zero means SPEC
4685 is intended to be displayed in a window on a GUI frame.
4687 Value is non-zero if something was found which replaces the display
4688 of buffer or string text. */
4690 static int
4691 handle_single_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4692 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4693 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int display_replaced_p,
4694 int frame_window_p)
4696 Lisp_Object form;
4697 Lisp_Object location, value;
4698 struct text_pos start_pos = *position;
4699 int valid_p;
4701 /* If SPEC is a list of the form `(when FORM . VALUE)', evaluate FORM.
4702 If the result is non-nil, use VALUE instead of SPEC. */
4703 form = Qt;
4704 if (CONSP (spec) && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen))
4706 spec = XCDR (spec);
4707 if (!CONSP (spec))
4708 return 0;
4709 form = XCAR (spec);
4710 spec = XCDR (spec);
4713 if (!NILP (form) && !EQ (form, Qt))
4715 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4716 struct gcpro gcpro1;
4718 /* Bind `object' to the object having the `display' property, a
4719 buffer or string. Bind `position' to the position in the
4720 object where the property was found, and `buffer-position'
4721 to the current position in the buffer. */
4723 if (NILP (object))
4724 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
4725 specbind (Qobject, object);
4726 specbind (Qposition, make_number (CHARPOS (*position)));
4727 specbind (Qbuffer_position, make_number (bufpos));
4728 GCPRO1 (form);
4729 form = safe_eval (form);
4730 UNGCPRO;
4731 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4734 if (NILP (form))
4735 return 0;
4737 /* Handle `(height HEIGHT)' specifications. */
4738 if (CONSP (spec)
4739 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4740 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4742 if (it)
4744 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4745 return 0;
4747 it->font_height = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4748 if (!NILP (it->font_height))
4750 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4751 int new_height = -1;
4753 if (CONSP (it->font_height)
4754 && (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus)
4755 || EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qminus))
4756 && CONSP (XCDR (it->font_height))
4757 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)), INT_MAX))
4759 /* `(+ N)' or `(- N)' where N is an integer. */
4760 int steps = XINT (XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)));
4761 if (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus))
4762 steps = - steps;
4763 it->face_id = smaller_face (it->f, it->face_id, steps);
4765 else if (FUNCTIONP (it->font_height))
4767 /* Call function with current height as argument.
4768 Value is the new height. */
4769 Lisp_Object height;
4770 height = safe_call1 (it->font_height,
4771 face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4772 if (NUMBERP (height))
4773 new_height = XFLOATINT (height);
4775 else if (NUMBERP (it->font_height))
4777 /* Value is a multiple of the canonical char height. */
4778 struct face *f;
4780 f = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f,
4781 lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
4782 new_height = (XFLOATINT (it->font_height)
4783 * XINT (f->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]));
4785 else
4787 /* Evaluate IT->font_height with `height' bound to the
4788 current specified height to get the new height. */
4789 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4791 specbind (Qheight, face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4792 value = safe_eval (it->font_height);
4793 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4795 if (NUMBERP (value))
4796 new_height = XFLOATINT (value);
4799 if (new_height > 0)
4800 it->face_id = face_with_height (it->f, it->face_id, new_height);
4804 return 0;
4807 /* Handle `(space-width WIDTH)'. */
4808 if (CONSP (spec)
4809 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4810 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4812 if (it)
4814 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4815 return 0;
4817 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4818 if (NUMBERP (value) && XFLOATINT (value) > 0)
4819 it->space_width = value;
4822 return 0;
4825 /* Handle `(slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT)'. */
4826 if (CONSP (spec)
4827 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice))
4829 Lisp_Object tem;
4831 if (it)
4833 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4834 return 0;
4836 if (tem = XCDR (spec), CONSP (tem))
4838 it->slice.x = XCAR (tem);
4839 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4841 it->slice.y = XCAR (tem);
4842 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4844 it->slice.width = XCAR (tem);
4845 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4846 it->slice.height = XCAR (tem);
4852 return 0;
4855 /* Handle `(raise FACTOR)'. */
4856 if (CONSP (spec)
4857 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4858 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4860 if (it)
4862 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4863 return 0;
4865 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4866 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4867 if (NUMBERP (value))
4869 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4870 it->voffset = - (XFLOATINT (value)
4871 * (FONT_HEIGHT (face->font)));
4873 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4876 return 0;
4879 /* Don't handle the other kinds of display specifications
4880 inside a string that we got from a `display' property. */
4881 if (it && it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4882 return 0;
4884 /* Characters having this form of property are not displayed, so
4885 we have to find the end of the property. */
4886 if (it)
4888 start_pos = *position;
4889 *position = display_prop_end (it, object, start_pos);
4891 value = Qnil;
4893 /* Stop the scan at that end position--we assume that all
4894 text properties change there. */
4895 if (it)
4896 it->stop_charpos = position->charpos;
4898 /* Handle `(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'
4899 and `(right-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'. */
4900 if (CONSP (spec)
4901 && (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4902 || EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe))
4903 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4905 int fringe_bitmap;
4907 if (it)
4909 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4910 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4911 across the text with this property. */
4913 /* Synchronize the bidi iterator with POSITION. This is
4914 needed because we are not going to push the iterator
4915 on behalf of this display property, so there will be
4916 no pop_it call to do this synchronization for us. */
4917 if (it->bidi_p)
4919 it->position = *position;
4920 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4921 *position = it->position;
4923 return 1;
4926 else if (!frame_window_p)
4927 return 1;
4929 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4930 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4931 if (!SYMBOLP (value)
4932 || !(fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (value)))
4933 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4934 across the text with this property. */
4936 if (it && it->bidi_p)
4938 it->position = *position;
4939 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4940 *position = it->position;
4942 return 1;
4945 if (it)
4947 int face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);;
4949 if (CONSP (XCDR (XCDR (spec))))
4951 Lisp_Object face_name = XCAR (XCDR (XCDR (spec)));
4952 int face_id2 = lookup_derived_face (it->f, face_name,
4953 FRINGE_FACE_ID, 0);
4954 if (face_id2 >= 0)
4955 face_id = face_id2;
4958 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4959 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4960 push_it (it, position);
4962 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4963 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
4964 it->image_id = -1; /* no image */
4965 it->position = start_pos;
4966 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->contents : object;
4967 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
4968 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
4969 it->face_id = face_id;
4970 it->from_disp_prop_p = true;
4972 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4973 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4974 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4975 *position = start_pos;
4977 if (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe))
4979 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4980 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4982 else
4984 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4985 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4988 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4989 return 1;
4992 /* Prepare to handle `((margin left-margin) ...)',
4993 `((margin right-margin) ...)' and `((margin nil) ...)'
4994 prefixes for display specifications. */
4995 location = Qunbound;
4996 if (CONSP (spec) && CONSP (XCAR (spec)))
4998 Lisp_Object tem;
5000 value = XCDR (spec);
5001 if (CONSP (value))
5002 value = XCAR (value);
5004 tem = XCAR (spec);
5005 if (EQ (XCAR (tem), Qmargin)
5006 && (tem = XCDR (tem),
5007 tem = CONSP (tem) ? XCAR (tem) : Qnil,
5008 (NILP (tem)
5009 || EQ (tem, Qleft_margin)
5010 || EQ (tem, Qright_margin))))
5011 location = tem;
5014 if (EQ (location, Qunbound))
5016 location = Qnil;
5017 value = spec;
5020 /* After this point, VALUE is the property after any
5021 margin prefix has been stripped. It must be a string,
5022 an image specification, or `(space ...)'.
5024 LOCATION specifies where to display: `left-margin',
5025 `right-margin' or nil. */
5027 valid_p = (STRINGP (value)
5028 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
5029 || ((it ? FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) : frame_window_p)
5030 && valid_image_p (value))
5031 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
5032 || (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace)));
5034 if (valid_p && !display_replaced_p)
5036 int retval = 1;
5038 if (!it)
5040 /* Callers need to know whether the display spec is any kind
5041 of `(space ...)' spec that is about to affect text-area
5042 display. */
5043 if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace) && NILP (location))
5044 retval = 2;
5045 return retval;
5048 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
5049 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
5050 push_it (it, position);
5051 it->from_overlay = overlay;
5052 it->from_disp_prop_p = true;
5054 if (NILP (location))
5055 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
5056 else if (EQ (location, Qleft_margin))
5057 it->area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
5058 else
5059 it->area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
5061 if (STRINGP (value))
5063 it->string = value;
5064 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5065 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5066 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
5067 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
5068 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5069 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5070 it->prev_stop = 0;
5071 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5072 it->string_from_display_prop_p = true;
5073 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5074 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5075 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5076 if (BUFFERP (object))
5077 *position = start_pos;
5079 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5080 object. If the parent object's paragraph direction is
5081 not yet determined, default to L2R. */
5082 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5083 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5084 else
5085 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5087 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
5088 if (it->bidi_p)
5090 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5091 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5092 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
5093 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = bufpos;
5094 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 1;
5095 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5096 it->bidi_it.w = it->w;
5097 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5100 else if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace))
5102 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
5103 it->object = value;
5104 *position = it->position = start_pos;
5105 retval = 1 + (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
5107 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
5108 else
5110 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
5111 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, value);
5112 it->position = start_pos;
5113 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->contents : object;
5114 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
5116 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5117 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5118 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5119 *position = start_pos;
5121 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
5123 return retval;
5126 /* Invalid property or property not supported. Restore
5127 POSITION to what it was before. */
5128 *position = start_pos;
5129 return 0;
5132 /* Check if PROP is a display property value whose text should be
5133 treated as intangible. OVERLAY is the overlay from which PROP
5134 came, or nil if it came from a text property. CHARPOS and BYTEPOS
5135 specify the buffer position covered by PROP. */
5138 display_prop_intangible_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object overlay,
5139 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos)
5141 int frame_window_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (selected_frame));
5142 struct text_pos position;
5144 SET_TEXT_POS (position, charpos, bytepos);
5145 return handle_display_spec (NULL, prop, Qnil, overlay,
5146 &position, charpos, frame_window_p);
5150 /* Return 1 if PROP is a display sub-property value containing STRING.
5152 Implementation note: this and the following function are really
5153 special cases of handle_display_spec and
5154 handle_single_display_spec, and should ideally use the same code.
5155 Until they do, these two pairs must be consistent and must be
5156 modified in sync. */
5158 static int
5159 single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5161 if (EQ (string, prop))
5162 return 1;
5164 /* Skip over `when FORM'. */
5165 if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen))
5167 prop = XCDR (prop);
5168 if (!CONSP (prop))
5169 return 0;
5170 /* Actually, the condition following `when' should be eval'ed,
5171 like handle_single_display_spec does, and we should return
5172 zero if it evaluates to nil. However, this function is
5173 called only when the buffer was already displayed and some
5174 glyph in the glyph matrix was found to come from a display
5175 string. Therefore, the condition was already evaluated, and
5176 the result was non-nil, otherwise the display string wouldn't
5177 have been displayed and we would have never been called for
5178 this property. Thus, we can skip the evaluation and assume
5179 its result is non-nil. */
5180 prop = XCDR (prop);
5183 if (CONSP (prop))
5184 /* Skip over `margin LOCATION'. */
5185 if (EQ (XCAR (prop), Qmargin))
5187 prop = XCDR (prop);
5188 if (!CONSP (prop))
5189 return 0;
5191 prop = XCDR (prop);
5192 if (!CONSP (prop))
5193 return 0;
5196 return EQ (prop, string) || (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), string));
5200 /* Return 1 if STRING appears in the `display' property PROP. */
5202 static int
5203 display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5205 if (CONSP (prop)
5206 && !EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen)
5207 && !(CONSP (XCAR (prop)) && EQ (Qmargin, XCAR (XCAR (prop)))))
5209 /* A list of sub-properties. */
5210 while (CONSP (prop))
5212 if (single_display_spec_string_p (XCAR (prop), string))
5213 return 1;
5214 prop = XCDR (prop);
5217 else if (VECTORP (prop))
5219 /* A vector of sub-properties. */
5220 ptrdiff_t i;
5221 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (prop); ++i)
5222 if (single_display_spec_string_p (AREF (prop, i), string))
5223 return 1;
5225 else
5226 return single_display_spec_string_p (prop, string);
5228 return 0;
5231 /* Look for STRING in overlays and text properties in the current
5232 buffer, between character positions FROM and TO (excluding TO).
5233 BACK_P non-zero means look back (in this case, TO is supposed to be
5234 less than FROM).
5235 Value is the first character position where STRING was found, or
5236 zero if it wasn't found before hitting TO.
5238 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5239 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5241 static ptrdiff_t
5242 string_buffer_position_lim (Lisp_Object string,
5243 ptrdiff_t from, ptrdiff_t to, int back_p)
5245 Lisp_Object limit, prop, pos;
5246 int found = 0;
5248 pos = make_number (max (from, BEGV));
5250 if (!back_p) /* looking forward */
5252 limit = make_number (min (to, ZV));
5253 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5255 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5256 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5257 found = 1;
5258 else
5259 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5260 limit);
5263 else /* looking back */
5265 limit = make_number (max (to, BEGV));
5266 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5268 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5269 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5270 found = 1;
5271 else
5272 pos = Fprevious_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5273 limit);
5277 return found ? XINT (pos) : 0;
5280 /* Determine which buffer position in current buffer STRING comes from.
5281 AROUND_CHARPOS is an approximate position where it could come from.
5282 Value is the buffer position or 0 if it couldn't be determined.
5284 This function is necessary because we don't record buffer positions
5285 in glyphs generated from strings (to keep struct glyph small).
5286 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5287 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5289 static ptrdiff_t
5290 string_buffer_position (Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t around_charpos)
5292 const int MAX_DISTANCE = 1000;
5293 ptrdiff_t found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5294 around_charpos + MAX_DISTANCE,
5297 if (!found)
5298 found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5299 around_charpos - MAX_DISTANCE, 1);
5300 return found;
5305 /***********************************************************************
5306 `composition' property
5307 ***********************************************************************/
5309 /* Set up iterator IT from `composition' property at its current
5310 position. Called from handle_stop. */
5312 static enum prop_handled
5313 handle_composition_prop (struct it *it)
5315 Lisp_Object prop, string;
5316 ptrdiff_t pos, pos_byte, start, end;
5318 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5320 unsigned char *s;
5322 pos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
5323 pos_byte = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
5324 string = it->string;
5325 s = SDATA (string) + pos_byte;
5326 it->c = STRING_CHAR (s);
5328 else
5330 pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5331 pos_byte = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
5332 string = Qnil;
5333 it->c = FETCH_CHAR (pos_byte);
5336 /* If there's a valid composition and point is not inside of the
5337 composition (in the case that the composition is from the current
5338 buffer), draw a glyph composed from the composition components. */
5339 if (find_composition (pos, -1, &start, &end, &prop, string)
5340 && composition_valid_p (start, end, prop)
5341 && (STRINGP (it->string) || (PT <= start || PT >= end)))
5343 if (start < pos)
5344 /* As we can't handle this situation (perhaps font-lock added
5345 a new composition), we just return here hoping that next
5346 redisplay will detect this composition much earlier. */
5347 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5348 if (start != pos)
5350 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5351 pos_byte = string_char_to_byte (it->string, start);
5352 else
5353 pos_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (start);
5355 it->cmp_it.id = get_composition_id (start, pos_byte, end - start,
5356 prop, string);
5358 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
5360 it->cmp_it.ch = -1;
5361 it->cmp_it.nchars = COMPOSITION_LENGTH (prop);
5362 it->cmp_it.nglyphs = -1;
5366 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5371 /***********************************************************************
5372 Overlay strings
5373 ***********************************************************************/
5375 /* The following structure is used to record overlay strings for
5376 later sorting in load_overlay_strings. */
5378 struct overlay_entry
5380 Lisp_Object overlay;
5381 Lisp_Object string;
5382 EMACS_INT priority;
5383 int after_string_p;
5387 /* Set up iterator IT from overlay strings at its current position.
5388 Called from handle_stop. */
5390 static enum prop_handled
5391 handle_overlay_change (struct it *it)
5393 if (!STRINGP (it->string) && get_overlay_strings (it, 0))
5394 return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
5395 else
5396 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5400 /* Set up the next overlay string for delivery by IT, if there is an
5401 overlay string to deliver. Called by set_iterator_to_next when the
5402 end of the current overlay string is reached. If there are more
5403 overlay strings to display, IT->string and
5404 IT->current.overlay_string_index are set appropriately here.
5405 Otherwise IT->string is set to nil. */
5407 static void
5408 next_overlay_string (struct it *it)
5410 ++it->current.overlay_string_index;
5411 if (it->current.overlay_string_index == it->n_overlay_strings)
5413 /* No more overlay strings. Restore IT's settings to what
5414 they were before overlay strings were processed, and
5415 continue to deliver from current_buffer. */
5417 it->ellipsis_p = (it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p != 0);
5418 pop_it (it);
5419 eassert (it->sp > 0
5420 || (NILP (it->string)
5421 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
5422 && it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
5423 && it->stop_charpos <= it->end_charpos));
5424 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5425 it->n_overlay_strings = 0;
5426 it->overlay_strings_charpos = -1;
5427 /* If there's an empty display string on the stack, pop the
5428 stack, to resync the bidi iterator with IT's position. Such
5429 empty strings are pushed onto the stack in
5430 get_overlay_strings_1. */
5431 if (it->sp > 0 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
5432 pop_it (it);
5434 /* If we're at the end of the buffer, record that we have
5435 processed the overlay strings there already, so that
5436 next_element_from_buffer doesn't try it again. */
5437 if (NILP (it->string) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
5438 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = true;
5440 else
5442 /* There are more overlay strings to process. If
5443 IT->current.overlay_string_index has advanced to a position
5444 where we must load IT->overlay_strings with more strings, do
5445 it. We must load at the IT->overlay_strings_charpos where
5446 IT->n_overlay_strings was originally computed; when invisible
5447 text is present, this might not be IT_CHARPOS (Bug#7016). */
5448 int i = it->current.overlay_string_index % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
5450 if (it->current.overlay_string_index && i == 0)
5451 load_overlay_strings (it, it->overlay_strings_charpos);
5453 /* Initialize IT to deliver display elements from the overlay
5454 string. */
5455 it->string = it->overlay_strings[i];
5456 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5457 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, 0, 0);
5458 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5459 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5460 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5461 if (it->cmp_it.stop_pos >= 0)
5462 it->cmp_it.stop_pos = 0;
5463 it->prev_stop = 0;
5464 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5466 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5467 if (it->bidi_p)
5469 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5470 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5471 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5472 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
5473 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5474 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5475 it->bidi_it.w = it->w;
5476 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5480 CHECK_IT (it);
5484 /* Compare two overlay_entry structures E1 and E2. Used as a
5485 comparison function for qsort in load_overlay_strings. Overlay
5486 strings for the same position are sorted so that
5488 1. All after-strings come in front of before-strings, except
5489 when they come from the same overlay.
5491 2. Within after-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay strings
5492 from overlays with higher priorities come first.
5494 2. Within before-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay
5495 strings from overlays with higher priorities come last.
5497 Value is analogous to strcmp. */
5500 static int
5501 compare_overlay_entries (const void *e1, const void *e2)
5503 struct overlay_entry const *entry1 = e1;
5504 struct overlay_entry const *entry2 = e2;
5505 int result;
5507 if (entry1->after_string_p != entry2->after_string_p)
5509 /* Let after-strings appear in front of before-strings if
5510 they come from different overlays. */
5511 if (EQ (entry1->overlay, entry2->overlay))
5512 result = entry1->after_string_p ? 1 : -1;
5513 else
5514 result = entry1->after_string_p ? -1 : 1;
5516 else if (entry1->priority != entry2->priority)
5518 if (entry1->after_string_p)
5519 /* After-strings sorted in order of decreasing priority. */
5520 result = entry2->priority < entry1->priority ? -1 : 1;
5521 else
5522 /* Before-strings sorted in order of increasing priority. */
5523 result = entry1->priority < entry2->priority ? -1 : 1;
5525 else
5526 result = 0;
5528 return result;
5532 /* Load the vector IT->overlay_strings with overlay strings from IT's
5533 current buffer position, or from CHARPOS if that is > 0. Set
5534 IT->n_overlays to the total number of overlay strings found.
5536 Overlay strings are processed OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE strings at
5537 a time. On entry into load_overlay_strings,
5538 IT->current.overlay_string_index gives the number of overlay
5539 strings that have already been loaded by previous calls to this
5540 function.
5542 IT->add_overlay_start contains an additional overlay start
5543 position to consider for taking overlay strings from, if non-zero.
5544 This position comes into play when the overlay has an `invisible'
5545 property, and both before and after-strings. When we've skipped to
5546 the end of the overlay, because of its `invisible' property, we
5547 nevertheless want its before-string to appear.
5548 IT->add_overlay_start will contain the overlay start position
5549 in this case.
5551 Overlay strings are sorted so that after-string strings come in
5552 front of before-string strings. Within before and after-strings,
5553 strings are sorted by overlay priority. See also function
5554 compare_overlay_entries. */
5556 static void
5557 load_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5559 Lisp_Object overlay, window, str, invisible;
5560 struct Lisp_Overlay *ov;
5561 ptrdiff_t start, end;
5562 ptrdiff_t size = 20;
5563 ptrdiff_t n = 0, i, j;
5564 int invis_p;
5565 struct overlay_entry *entries = alloca (size * sizeof *entries);
5566 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5568 if (charpos <= 0)
5569 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5571 /* Append the overlay string STRING of overlay OVERLAY to vector
5572 `entries' which has size `size' and currently contains `n'
5573 elements. AFTER_P non-zero means STRING is an after-string of
5574 OVERLAY. */
5575 #define RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING(OVERLAY, STRING, AFTER_P) \
5576 do \
5578 Lisp_Object priority; \
5580 if (n == size) \
5582 struct overlay_entry *old = entries; \
5583 SAFE_NALLOCA (entries, 2, size); \
5584 memcpy (entries, old, size * sizeof *entries); \
5585 size *= 2; \
5588 entries[n].string = (STRING); \
5589 entries[n].overlay = (OVERLAY); \
5590 priority = Foverlay_get ((OVERLAY), Qpriority); \
5591 entries[n].priority = INTEGERP (priority) ? XINT (priority) : 0; \
5592 entries[n].after_string_p = (AFTER_P); \
5593 ++n; \
5595 while (0)
5597 /* Process overlay before the overlay center. */
5598 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_before; ov; ov = ov->next)
5600 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5601 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5602 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5603 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5605 if (end < charpos)
5606 break;
5608 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5609 position. */
5610 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5611 continue;
5613 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5614 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5615 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5616 continue;
5618 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, both before-
5619 and after-strings from this overlay are visible; start and
5620 end position are indistinguishable. */
5621 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5622 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5624 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5625 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5626 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5627 && SCHARS (str))
5628 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5630 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5631 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5632 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5633 && SCHARS (str))
5634 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5637 /* Process overlays after the overlay center. */
5638 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_after; ov; ov = ov->next)
5640 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5641 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5642 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5643 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5645 if (start > charpos)
5646 break;
5648 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5649 position. */
5650 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5651 continue;
5653 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5654 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5655 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5656 continue;
5658 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, it has a zero
5659 dimension, and both before- and after-strings apply. */
5660 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5661 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5663 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5664 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5665 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5666 && SCHARS (str))
5667 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5669 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5670 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5671 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5672 && SCHARS (str))
5673 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5676 #undef RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING
5678 /* Sort entries. */
5679 if (n > 1)
5680 qsort (entries, n, sizeof *entries, compare_overlay_entries);
5682 /* Record number of overlay strings, and where we computed it. */
5683 it->n_overlay_strings = n;
5684 it->overlay_strings_charpos = charpos;
5686 /* IT->current.overlay_string_index is the number of overlay strings
5687 that have already been consumed by IT. Copy some of the
5688 remaining overlay strings to IT->overlay_strings. */
5689 i = 0;
5690 j = it->current.overlay_string_index;
5691 while (i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE && j < n)
5693 it->overlay_strings[i] = entries[j].string;
5694 it->string_overlays[i++] = entries[j++].overlay;
5697 CHECK_IT (it);
5698 SAFE_FREE ();
5702 /* Get the first chunk of overlay strings at IT's current buffer
5703 position, or at CHARPOS if that is > 0. Value is non-zero if at
5704 least one overlay string was found. */
5706 static int
5707 get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos, int compute_stop_p)
5709 /* Get the first OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE overlay strings to
5710 process. This fills IT->overlay_strings with strings, and sets
5711 IT->n_overlay_strings to the total number of strings to process.
5712 IT->pos.overlay_string_index has to be set temporarily to zero
5713 because load_overlay_strings needs this; it must be set to -1
5714 when no overlay strings are found because a zero value would
5715 indicate a position in the first overlay string. */
5716 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
5717 load_overlay_strings (it, charpos);
5719 /* If we found overlay strings, set up IT to deliver display
5720 elements from the first one. Otherwise set up IT to deliver
5721 from current_buffer. */
5722 if (it->n_overlay_strings)
5724 /* Make sure we know settings in current_buffer, so that we can
5725 restore meaningful values when we're done with the overlay
5726 strings. */
5727 if (compute_stop_p)
5728 compute_stop_pos (it);
5729 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5731 /* Save IT's settings. They are restored after all overlay
5732 strings have been processed. */
5733 eassert (!compute_stop_p || it->sp == 0);
5735 /* When called from handle_stop, there might be an empty display
5736 string loaded. In that case, don't bother saving it. But
5737 don't use this optimization with the bidi iterator, since we
5738 need the corresponding pop_it call to resync the bidi
5739 iterator's position with IT's position, after we are done
5740 with the overlay strings. (The corresponding call to pop_it
5741 in case of an empty display string is in
5742 next_overlay_string.) */
5743 if (!(!it->bidi_p
5744 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string)))
5745 push_it (it, NULL);
5747 /* Set up IT to deliver display elements from the first overlay
5748 string. */
5749 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
5750 it->string = it->overlay_strings[0];
5751 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
5752 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5753 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
5754 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5755 it->prev_stop = 0;
5756 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5757 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5758 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5759 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
5761 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5762 buffer. */
5763 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5764 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5765 else
5766 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5768 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5769 if (it->bidi_p)
5771 ptrdiff_t pos = (charpos > 0 ? charpos : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5773 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5774 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5775 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5776 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = pos;
5777 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5778 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5779 it->bidi_it.w = it->w;
5780 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5782 return 1;
5785 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5786 return 0;
5789 static int
5790 get_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5792 it->string = Qnil;
5793 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5795 (void) get_overlay_strings_1 (it, charpos, 1);
5797 CHECK_IT (it);
5799 /* Value is non-zero if we found at least one overlay string. */
5800 return STRINGP (it->string);
5805 /***********************************************************************
5806 Saving and restoring state
5807 ***********************************************************************/
5809 /* Save current settings of IT on IT->stack. Called, for example,
5810 before setting up IT for an overlay string, to be able to restore
5811 IT's settings to what they were after the overlay string has been
5812 processed. If POSITION is non-NULL, it is the position to save on
5813 the stack instead of IT->position. */
5815 static void
5816 push_it (struct it *it, struct text_pos *position)
5818 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5820 eassert (it->sp < IT_STACK_SIZE);
5821 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5823 p->stop_charpos = it->stop_charpos;
5824 p->prev_stop = it->prev_stop;
5825 p->base_level_stop = it->base_level_stop;
5826 p->cmp_it = it->cmp_it;
5827 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5828 p->face_id = it->face_id;
5829 p->string = it->string;
5830 p->method = it->method;
5831 p->from_overlay = it->from_overlay;
5832 switch (p->method)
5834 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5835 p->u.image.object = it->object;
5836 p->u.image.image_id = it->image_id;
5837 p->u.image.slice = it->slice;
5838 break;
5839 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5840 p->u.stretch.object = it->object;
5841 break;
5843 p->position = position ? *position : it->position;
5844 p->current = it->current;
5845 p->end_charpos = it->end_charpos;
5846 p->string_nchars = it->string_nchars;
5847 p->area = it->area;
5848 p->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
5849 p->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
5850 p->space_width = it->space_width;
5851 p->font_height = it->font_height;
5852 p->voffset = it->voffset;
5853 p->string_from_display_prop_p = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5854 p->string_from_prefix_prop_p = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5855 p->display_ellipsis_p = 0;
5856 p->line_wrap = it->line_wrap;
5857 p->bidi_p = it->bidi_p;
5858 p->paragraph_embedding = it->paragraph_embedding;
5859 p->from_disp_prop_p = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5860 ++it->sp;
5862 /* Save the state of the bidi iterator as well. */
5863 if (it->bidi_p)
5864 bidi_push_it (&it->bidi_it);
5867 static void
5868 iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *it)
5870 int buffer_p = !STRINGP (it->string);
5871 ptrdiff_t eob = (buffer_p ? ZV : it->end_charpos);
5872 ptrdiff_t bob = (buffer_p ? BEGV : 0);
5874 eassert (eob >= CHARPOS (it->position) && CHARPOS (it->position) >= bob);
5876 /* Maybe initialize paragraph direction. If we are at the beginning
5877 of a new paragraph, next_element_from_buffer may not have a
5878 chance to do that. */
5879 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5880 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
5881 /* prev_stop can be zero, so check against BEGV as well. */
5882 while (it->bidi_it.charpos >= bob
5883 && it->prev_stop <= it->bidi_it.charpos
5884 && it->bidi_it.charpos < CHARPOS (it->position)
5885 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5886 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5887 /* Record the stop_pos we just crossed, for when we cross it
5888 back, maybe. */
5889 if (it->bidi_it.charpos > CHARPOS (it->position))
5890 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (it->position);
5891 /* If we ended up not where pop_it put us, resync IT's
5892 positional members with the bidi iterator. */
5893 if (it->bidi_it.charpos != CHARPOS (it->position))
5894 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, it->bidi_it.charpos, it->bidi_it.bytepos);
5895 if (buffer_p)
5896 it->current.pos = it->position;
5897 else
5898 it->current.string_pos = it->position;
5901 /* Restore IT's settings from IT->stack. Called, for example, when no
5902 more overlay strings must be processed, and we return to delivering
5903 display elements from a buffer, or when the end of a string from a
5904 `display' property is reached and we return to delivering display
5905 elements from an overlay string, or from a buffer. */
5907 static void
5908 pop_it (struct it *it)
5910 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5911 int from_display_prop = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5913 eassert (it->sp > 0);
5914 --it->sp;
5915 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5916 it->stop_charpos = p->stop_charpos;
5917 it->prev_stop = p->prev_stop;
5918 it->base_level_stop = p->base_level_stop;
5919 it->cmp_it = p->cmp_it;
5920 it->face_id = p->face_id;
5921 it->current = p->current;
5922 it->position = p->position;
5923 it->string = p->string;
5924 it->from_overlay = p->from_overlay;
5925 if (NILP (it->string))
5926 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, -1, -1);
5927 it->method = p->method;
5928 switch (it->method)
5930 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5931 it->image_id = p->u.image.image_id;
5932 it->object = p->u.image.object;
5933 it->slice = p->u.image.slice;
5934 break;
5935 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5936 it->object = p->u.stretch.object;
5937 break;
5938 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
5939 it->object = it->w->contents;
5940 break;
5941 case GET_FROM_STRING:
5942 it->object = it->string;
5943 break;
5944 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
5945 if (it->s)
5946 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
5947 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
5948 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5949 else
5951 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5952 it->object = it->w->contents;
5955 it->end_charpos = p->end_charpos;
5956 it->string_nchars = p->string_nchars;
5957 it->area = p->area;
5958 it->multibyte_p = p->multibyte_p;
5959 it->avoid_cursor_p = p->avoid_cursor_p;
5960 it->space_width = p->space_width;
5961 it->font_height = p->font_height;
5962 it->voffset = p->voffset;
5963 it->string_from_display_prop_p = p->string_from_display_prop_p;
5964 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = p->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5965 it->line_wrap = p->line_wrap;
5966 it->bidi_p = p->bidi_p;
5967 it->paragraph_embedding = p->paragraph_embedding;
5968 it->from_disp_prop_p = p->from_disp_prop_p;
5969 if (it->bidi_p)
5971 bidi_pop_it (&it->bidi_it);
5972 /* Bidi-iterate until we get out of the portion of text, if any,
5973 covered by a `display' text property or by an overlay with
5974 `display' property. (We cannot just jump there, because the
5975 internal coherency of the bidi iterator state can not be
5976 preserved across such jumps.) We also must determine the
5977 paragraph base direction if the overlay we just processed is
5978 at the beginning of a new paragraph. */
5979 if (from_display_prop
5980 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING))
5981 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
5983 eassert ((BUFFERP (it->object)
5984 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5985 && IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5986 || (STRINGP (it->object)
5987 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5988 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5989 || (CONSP (it->object) && it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH));
5995 /***********************************************************************
5996 Moving over lines
5997 ***********************************************************************/
5999 /* Set IT's current position to the previous line start. */
6001 static void
6002 back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *it)
6004 ptrdiff_t cp = IT_CHARPOS (*it), bp = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
6006 DEC_BOTH (cp, bp);
6007 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = find_newline_no_quit (cp, bp, -1, &IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
6011 /* Move IT to the next line start.
6013 Value is non-zero if a newline was found. Set *SKIPPED_P to 1 if
6014 we skipped over part of the text (as opposed to moving the iterator
6015 continuously over the text). Otherwise, don't change the value
6016 of *SKIPPED_P.
6018 If BIDI_IT_PREV is non-NULL, store into it the state of the bidi
6019 iterator on the newline, if it was found.
6021 Newlines may come from buffer text, overlay strings, or strings
6022 displayed via the `display' property. That's the reason we can't
6023 simply use find_newline_no_quit.
6025 Note that this function may not skip over invisible text that is so
6026 because of text properties and immediately follows a newline. If
6027 it would, function reseat_at_next_visible_line_start, when called
6028 from set_iterator_to_next, would effectively make invisible
6029 characters following a newline part of the wrong glyph row, which
6030 leads to wrong cursor motion. */
6032 static int
6033 forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *it, int *skipped_p,
6034 struct bidi_it *bidi_it_prev)
6036 ptrdiff_t old_selective;
6037 int newline_found_p, n;
6038 const int MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE = 500;
6040 /* If already on a newline, just consume it to avoid unintended
6041 skipping over invisible text below. */
6042 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER
6043 && it->c == '\n'
6044 && CHARPOS (it->position) == IT_CHARPOS (*it))
6046 if (it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
6047 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
6048 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6049 it->c = 0;
6050 return 1;
6053 /* Don't handle selective display in the following. It's (a)
6054 unnecessary because it's done by the caller, and (b) leads to an
6055 infinite recursion because next_element_from_ellipsis indirectly
6056 calls this function. */
6057 old_selective = it->selective;
6058 it->selective = 0;
6060 /* Scan for a newline within MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE display elements
6061 from buffer text. */
6062 for (n = newline_found_p = 0;
6063 !newline_found_p && n < MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE;
6064 n += STRINGP (it->string) ? 0 : 1)
6066 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
6067 return 0;
6068 newline_found_p = it->what == IT_CHARACTER && it->c == '\n';
6069 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
6070 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
6071 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6074 /* If we didn't find a newline near enough, see if we can use a
6075 short-cut. */
6076 if (!newline_found_p)
6078 ptrdiff_t bytepos, start = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6079 ptrdiff_t limit = find_newline_no_quit (start, IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6080 1, &bytepos);
6081 Lisp_Object pos;
6083 eassert (!STRINGP (it->string));
6085 /* If there isn't any `display' property in sight, and no
6086 overlays, we can just use the position of the newline in
6087 buffer text. */
6088 if (it->stop_charpos >= limit
6089 || ((pos = Fnext_single_property_change (make_number (start),
6090 Qdisplay, Qnil,
6091 make_number (limit)),
6092 NILP (pos))
6093 && next_overlay_change (start) == ZV))
6095 if (!it->bidi_p)
6097 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6098 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = bytepos;
6100 else
6102 struct bidi_it bprev;
6104 /* Help bidi.c avoid expensive searches for display
6105 properties and overlays, by telling it that there are
6106 none up to `limit'. */
6107 if (it->bidi_it.disp_pos < limit)
6109 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = limit;
6110 it->bidi_it.disp_prop = 0;
6112 do {
6113 bprev = it->bidi_it;
6114 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6115 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != limit);
6116 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6117 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6118 if (bidi_it_prev)
6119 *bidi_it_prev = bprev;
6121 *skipped_p = newline_found_p = true;
6123 else
6125 while (get_next_display_element (it)
6126 && !newline_found_p)
6128 newline_found_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it);
6129 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
6130 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
6131 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6136 it->selective = old_selective;
6137 return newline_found_p;
6141 /* Set IT's current position to the previous visible line start. Skip
6142 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6143 selective display. Caution: this does not change IT->current_x and
6144 IT->hpos. */
6146 static void
6147 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6149 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6151 back_to_previous_line_start (it);
6153 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6154 break;
6156 /* If selective > 0, then lines indented more than its value are
6157 invisible. */
6158 if (it->selective > 0
6159 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6160 it->selective))
6161 continue;
6163 /* Check the newline before point for invisibility. */
6165 Lisp_Object prop;
6166 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1),
6167 Qinvisible, it->window);
6168 if (TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop))
6169 continue;
6172 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6173 break;
6176 struct it it2;
6177 void *it2data = NULL;
6178 ptrdiff_t pos;
6179 ptrdiff_t beg, end;
6180 Lisp_Object val, overlay;
6182 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
6184 /* If newline is part of a composition, continue from start of composition */
6185 if (find_composition (IT_CHARPOS (*it), -1, &beg, &end, &val, Qnil)
6186 && beg < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
6187 goto replaced;
6189 /* If newline is replaced by a display property, find start of overlay
6190 or interval and continue search from that point. */
6191 pos = --IT_CHARPOS (it2);
6192 --IT_BYTEPOS (it2);
6193 it2.sp = 0;
6194 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6195 it2.string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6196 it2.from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6197 if (handle_display_prop (&it2) == HANDLED_RETURN
6198 && !NILP (val = get_char_property_and_overlay
6199 (make_number (pos), Qdisplay, Qnil, &overlay))
6200 && (OVERLAYP (overlay)
6201 ? (beg = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay)))
6202 : get_property_and_range (pos, Qdisplay, &val, &beg, &end, Qnil)))
6204 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6205 goto replaced;
6208 /* Newline is not replaced by anything -- so we are done. */
6209 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6210 break;
6212 replaced:
6213 if (beg < BEGV)
6214 beg = BEGV;
6215 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = beg;
6216 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (current_buffer, beg);
6220 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
6222 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
6223 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEGV
6224 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6225 CHECK_IT (it);
6229 /* Reseat iterator IT at the previous visible line start. Skip
6230 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6231 selective display. At the end, update IT's overlay information,
6232 face information etc. */
6234 void
6235 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6237 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
6238 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
6239 CHECK_IT (it);
6243 /* Reseat iterator IT on the next visible line start in the current
6244 buffer. ON_NEWLINE_P non-zero means position IT on the newline
6245 preceding the line start. Skip over invisible text that is so
6246 because of selective display. Compute faces, overlays etc at the
6247 new position. Note that this function does not skip over text that
6248 is invisible because of text properties. */
6250 static void
6251 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *it, int on_newline_p)
6253 int newline_found_p, skipped_p = 0;
6254 struct bidi_it bidi_it_prev;
6256 newline_found_p = forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6258 /* Skip over lines that are invisible because they are indented
6259 more than the value of IT->selective. */
6260 if (it->selective > 0)
6261 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV
6262 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6263 it->selective))
6265 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == BEGV
6266 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6267 newline_found_p =
6268 forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6271 /* Position on the newline if that's what's requested. */
6272 if (on_newline_p && newline_found_p)
6274 if (STRINGP (it->string))
6276 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) > 0)
6278 if (!it->bidi_p)
6280 --IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
6281 --IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
6283 else
6285 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state
6286 it had on the newline, and resync the IT's
6287 position with that. */
6288 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6289 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6290 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6294 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6296 if (!it->bidi_p)
6298 --IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6299 --IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
6301 else
6303 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state it
6304 had on the newline and resync IT with that. */
6305 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6306 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6307 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6309 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6312 else if (skipped_p)
6313 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6315 CHECK_IT (it);
6320 /***********************************************************************
6321 Changing an iterator's position
6322 ***********************************************************************/
6324 /* Change IT's current position to POS in current_buffer. If FORCE_P
6325 is non-zero, always check for text properties at the new position.
6326 Otherwise, text properties are only looked up if POS >=
6327 IT->check_charpos of a property. */
6329 static void
6330 reseat (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int force_p)
6332 ptrdiff_t original_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6334 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
6336 /* Determine where to check text properties. Avoid doing it
6337 where possible because text property lookup is very expensive. */
6338 if (force_p
6339 || CHARPOS (pos) > it->stop_charpos
6340 || CHARPOS (pos) < original_pos)
6342 if (it->bidi_p)
6344 /* For bidi iteration, we need to prime prev_stop and
6345 base_level_stop with our best estimations. */
6346 /* Implementation note: Of course, POS is not necessarily a
6347 stop position, so assigning prev_pos to it is a lie; we
6348 should have called compute_stop_backwards. However, if
6349 the current buffer does not include any R2L characters,
6350 that call would be a waste of cycles, because the
6351 iterator will never move back, and thus never cross this
6352 "fake" stop position. So we delay that backward search
6353 until the time we really need it, in next_element_from_buffer. */
6354 if (CHARPOS (pos) != it->prev_stop)
6355 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6356 if (CHARPOS (pos) < it->base_level_stop)
6357 it->base_level_stop = 0; /* meaning it's unknown */
6358 handle_stop (it);
6360 else
6362 handle_stop (it);
6363 it->prev_stop = it->base_level_stop = 0;
6368 CHECK_IT (it);
6372 /* Change IT's buffer position to POS. SET_STOP_P non-zero means set
6373 IT->stop_pos to POS, also. */
6375 static void
6376 reseat_1 (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int set_stop_p)
6378 /* Don't call this function when scanning a C string. */
6379 eassert (it->s == NULL);
6381 /* POS must be a reasonable value. */
6382 eassert (CHARPOS (pos) >= BEGV && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
6384 it->current.pos = it->position = pos;
6385 it->end_charpos = ZV;
6386 it->dpvec = NULL;
6387 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6388 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6389 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = -1;
6390 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6391 it->string = Qnil;
6392 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
6393 it->object = it->w->contents;
6394 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
6395 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
6396 it->sp = 0;
6397 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6398 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 0;
6400 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6401 it->face_before_selective_p = 0;
6402 if (it->bidi_p)
6404 bidi_init_it (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6405 &it->bidi_it);
6406 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6407 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6408 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6409 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6410 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6411 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = 0;
6412 it->bidi_it.w = it->w;
6415 if (set_stop_p)
6417 it->stop_charpos = CHARPOS (pos);
6418 it->base_level_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6420 /* This make the information stored in it->cmp_it invalidate. */
6421 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
6425 /* Set up IT for displaying a string, starting at CHARPOS in window W.
6426 If S is non-null, it is a C string to iterate over. Otherwise,
6427 STRING gives a Lisp string to iterate over.
6429 If PRECISION > 0, don't return more then PRECISION number of
6430 characters from the string.
6432 If FIELD_WIDTH > 0, return padding spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6433 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means an infinite
6434 field width.
6436 MULTIBYTE = 0 means disable processing of multibyte characters,
6437 MULTIBYTE > 0 means enable it,
6438 MULTIBYTE < 0 means use IT->multibyte_p.
6440 IT must be initialized via a prior call to init_iterator before
6441 calling this function. */
6443 static void
6444 reseat_to_string (struct it *it, const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
6445 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t precision, int field_width,
6446 int multibyte)
6448 /* No text property checks performed by default, but see below. */
6449 it->stop_charpos = -1;
6451 /* Set iterator position and end position. */
6452 memset (&it->current, 0, sizeof it->current);
6453 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6454 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6455 eassert (charpos >= 0);
6457 /* If STRING is specified, use its multibyteness, otherwise use the
6458 setting of MULTIBYTE, if specified. */
6459 if (multibyte >= 0)
6460 it->multibyte_p = multibyte > 0;
6462 /* Bidirectional reordering of strings is controlled by the default
6463 value of bidi-display-reordering. Don't try to reorder while
6464 loading loadup.el, as the necessary character property tables are
6465 not yet available. */
6466 it->bidi_p =
6467 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
6468 && !NILP (BVAR (&buffer_defaults, bidi_display_reordering));
6470 if (s == NULL)
6472 eassert (STRINGP (string));
6473 it->string = string;
6474 it->s = NULL;
6475 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (string);
6476 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
6477 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, string);
6479 if (it->bidi_p)
6481 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = string;
6482 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6483 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6484 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6485 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6486 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6487 it->bidi_it.w = it->w;
6488 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
6489 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
6492 else
6494 it->s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6495 it->string = Qnil;
6497 /* Note that we use IT->current.pos, not it->current.string_pos,
6498 for displaying C strings. */
6499 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6500 if (it->multibyte_p)
6502 it->current.pos = c_string_pos (charpos, s, 1);
6503 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = number_of_chars (s, 1);
6505 else
6507 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = charpos;
6508 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = strlen (s);
6511 if (it->bidi_p)
6513 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6514 it->bidi_it.string.s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6515 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6516 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6517 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6518 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6519 it->bidi_it.w = it->w;
6520 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6521 &it->bidi_it);
6523 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
6526 /* PRECISION > 0 means don't return more than PRECISION characters
6527 from the string. */
6528 if (precision > 0 && it->end_charpos - charpos > precision)
6530 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = charpos + precision;
6531 if (it->bidi_p)
6532 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6535 /* FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6536 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH == 0 means don't pad,
6537 FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means infinite field width. This is useful for
6538 padding with `-' at the end of a mode line. */
6539 if (field_width < 0)
6540 field_width = INFINITY;
6541 /* Implementation note: We deliberately don't enlarge
6542 it->bidi_it.string.schars here to fit it->end_charpos, because
6543 the bidi iterator cannot produce characters out of thin air. */
6544 if (field_width > it->end_charpos - charpos)
6545 it->end_charpos = charpos + field_width;
6547 /* Use the standard display table for displaying strings. */
6548 if (DISP_TABLE_P (Vstandard_display_table))
6549 it->dp = XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_display_table);
6551 it->stop_charpos = charpos;
6552 it->prev_stop = charpos;
6553 it->base_level_stop = 0;
6554 if (it->bidi_p)
6556 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 1;
6557 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6558 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = -1;
6560 if (s == NULL && it->multibyte_p)
6562 ptrdiff_t endpos = SCHARS (it->string);
6563 if (endpos > it->end_charpos)
6564 endpos = it->end_charpos;
6565 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, -1, endpos,
6566 it->string);
6568 CHECK_IT (it);
6573 /***********************************************************************
6574 Iteration
6575 ***********************************************************************/
6577 /* Map enum it_method value to corresponding next_element_from_* function. */
6579 static int (* get_next_element[NUM_IT_METHODS]) (struct it *it) =
6581 next_element_from_buffer,
6582 next_element_from_display_vector,
6583 next_element_from_string,
6584 next_element_from_c_string,
6585 next_element_from_image,
6586 next_element_from_stretch
6589 #define GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT(it) (*get_next_element[(it)->method]) (it)
6592 /* Return 1 iff a character at CHARPOS (and BYTEPOS) is composed
6593 (possibly with the following characters). */
6595 #define CHAR_COMPOSED_P(IT,CHARPOS,BYTEPOS,END_CHARPOS) \
6596 ((IT)->cmp_it.id >= 0 \
6597 || ((IT)->cmp_it.stop_pos == (CHARPOS) \
6598 && composition_reseat_it (&(IT)->cmp_it, CHARPOS, BYTEPOS, \
6599 END_CHARPOS, (IT)->w, \
6600 FACE_FROM_ID ((IT)->f, (IT)->face_id), \
6601 (IT)->string)))
6604 /* Lookup the char-table Vglyphless_char_display for character C (-1
6605 if we want information for no-font case), and return the display
6606 method symbol. By side-effect, update it->what and
6607 it->glyphless_method. This function is called from
6608 get_next_display_element for each character element, and from
6609 x_produce_glyphs when no suitable font was found. */
6611 Lisp_Object
6612 lookup_glyphless_char_display (int c, struct it *it)
6614 Lisp_Object glyphless_method = Qnil;
6616 if (CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
6617 && CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)) >= 1)
6619 if (c >= 0)
6621 glyphless_method = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, c);
6622 if (CONSP (glyphless_method))
6623 glyphless_method = FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
6624 ? XCAR (glyphless_method)
6625 : XCDR (glyphless_method);
6627 else
6628 glyphless_method = XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0];
6631 retry:
6632 if (NILP (glyphless_method))
6634 if (c >= 0)
6635 /* The default is to display the character by a proper font. */
6636 return Qnil;
6637 /* The default for the no-font case is to display an empty box. */
6638 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6640 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qzero_width))
6642 if (c >= 0)
6643 return glyphless_method;
6644 /* This method can't be used for the no-font case. */
6645 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6647 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qthin_space))
6648 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE;
6649 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qempty_box))
6650 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX;
6651 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qhex_code))
6652 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE;
6653 else if (STRINGP (glyphless_method))
6654 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM;
6655 else
6657 /* Invalid value. We use the default method. */
6658 glyphless_method = Qnil;
6659 goto retry;
6661 it->what = IT_GLYPHLESS;
6662 return glyphless_method;
6665 /* Merge escape glyph face and cache the result. */
6667 static struct frame *last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
6668 static int last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6669 static int last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6671 static int
6672 merge_escape_glyph_face (struct it *it)
6674 int face_id;
6676 if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6677 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6678 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6679 else
6681 /* Merge the `escape-glyph' face into the current face. */
6682 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0, it->face_id);
6683 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6684 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6685 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6687 return face_id;
6690 /* Likewise for glyphless glyph face. */
6692 static struct frame *last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
6693 static int last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6694 static int last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6697 merge_glyphless_glyph_face (struct it *it)
6699 int face_id;
6701 if (it->f == last_glyphless_glyph_frame
6702 && it->face_id == last_glyphless_glyph_face_id)
6703 face_id = last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id;
6704 else
6706 /* Merge the `glyphless-char' face into the current face. */
6707 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qglyphless_char, 0, it->face_id);
6708 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = it->f;
6709 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6710 last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6712 return face_id;
6715 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
6716 display element from the current position of IT. Value is zero if
6717 end of buffer (or C string) is reached. */
6719 static int
6720 get_next_display_element (struct it *it)
6722 /* Non-zero means that we found a display element. Zero means that
6723 we hit the end of what we iterate over. Performance note: the
6724 function pointer `method' used here turns out to be faster than
6725 using a sequence of if-statements. */
6726 int success_p;
6728 get_next:
6729 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
6731 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6733 /* UAX#9, L4: "A character is depicted by a mirrored glyph if
6734 and only if (a) the resolved directionality of that character
6735 is R..." */
6736 /* FIXME: Do we need an exception for characters from display
6737 tables? */
6738 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.type == STRONG_R)
6739 it->c = bidi_mirror_char (it->c);
6740 /* Map via display table or translate control characters.
6741 IT->c, IT->len etc. have been set to the next character by
6742 the function call above. If we have a display table, and it
6743 contains an entry for IT->c, translate it. Don't do this if
6744 IT->c itself comes from a display table, otherwise we could
6745 end up in an infinite recursion. (An alternative could be to
6746 count the recursion depth of this function and signal an
6747 error when a certain maximum depth is reached.) Is it worth
6748 it? */
6749 if (success_p && it->dpvec == NULL)
6751 Lisp_Object dv;
6752 struct charset *unibyte = CHARSET_FROM_ID (charset_unibyte);
6753 int nonascii_space_p = 0;
6754 int nonascii_hyphen_p = 0;
6755 int c = it->c; /* This is the character to display. */
6757 if (! it->multibyte_p && ! ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
6759 eassert (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c));
6760 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment)
6762 c = DECODE_CHAR (unibyte, c);
6763 if (c < 0)
6764 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6766 else
6767 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6770 if (it->dp
6771 && (dv = DISP_CHAR_VECTOR (it->dp, c),
6772 VECTORP (dv)))
6774 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (dv);
6776 /* Return the first character from the display table
6777 entry, if not empty. If empty, don't display the
6778 current character. */
6779 if (v->header.size)
6781 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6782 it->dpvec = v->contents;
6783 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
6784 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6785 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
6786 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6787 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6788 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6790 else
6792 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6794 goto get_next;
6797 if (! NILP (lookup_glyphless_char_display (c, it)))
6799 if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
6800 goto done;
6801 /* Don't display this character. */
6802 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6803 goto get_next;
6806 /* If `nobreak-char-display' is non-nil, we display
6807 non-ASCII spaces and hyphens specially. */
6808 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && ! NILP (Vnobreak_char_display))
6810 if (c == 0xA0)
6811 nonascii_space_p = true;
6812 else if (c == 0xAD || c == 0x2010 || c == 0x2011)
6813 nonascii_hyphen_p = true;
6816 /* Translate control characters into `\003' or `^C' form.
6817 Control characters coming from a display table entry are
6818 currently not translated because we use IT->dpvec to hold
6819 the translation. This could easily be changed but I
6820 don't believe that it is worth doing.
6822 The characters handled by `nobreak-char-display' must be
6823 translated too.
6825 Non-printable characters and raw-byte characters are also
6826 translated to octal form. */
6827 if (((c < ' ' || c == 127) /* ASCII control chars. */
6828 ? (it->area != TEXT_AREA
6829 /* In mode line, treat \n, \t like other crl chars. */
6830 || (c != '\t'
6831 && it->glyph_row
6832 && (it->glyph_row->mode_line_p || it->avoid_cursor_p))
6833 || (c != '\n' && c != '\t'))
6834 : (nonascii_space_p
6835 || nonascii_hyphen_p
6836 || CHAR_BYTE8_P (c)
6837 || ! CHAR_PRINTABLE_P (c))))
6839 /* C is a control character, non-ASCII space/hyphen,
6840 raw-byte, or a non-printable character which must be
6841 displayed either as '\003' or as `^C' where the '\\'
6842 and '^' can be defined in the display table. Fill
6843 IT->ctl_chars with glyphs for what we have to
6844 display. Then, set IT->dpvec to these glyphs. */
6845 Lisp_Object gc;
6846 int ctl_len;
6847 int face_id;
6848 int lface_id = 0;
6849 int escape_glyph;
6851 /* Handle control characters with ^. */
6853 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && it->ctl_arrow_p)
6855 int g;
6857 g = '^'; /* default glyph for Control */
6858 /* Set IT->ctl_chars[0] to the glyph for `^'. */
6859 if (it->dp
6860 && (gc = DISP_CTRL_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6862 g = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6863 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6866 face_id = (lface_id
6867 ? merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id, it->face_id)
6868 : merge_escape_glyph_face (it));
6870 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], g);
6871 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], c ^ 0100);
6872 ctl_len = 2;
6873 goto display_control;
6876 /* Handle non-ascii space in the mode where it only gets
6877 highlighting. */
6879 if (nonascii_space_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6881 /* Merge `nobreak-space' into the current face. */
6882 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qnobreak_space, 0,
6883 it->face_id);
6884 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], ' ');
6885 ctl_len = 1;
6886 goto display_control;
6889 /* Handle sequences that start with the "escape glyph". */
6891 /* the default escape glyph is \. */
6892 escape_glyph = '\\';
6894 if (it->dp
6895 && (gc = DISP_ESCAPE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6897 escape_glyph = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6898 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6901 face_id = (lface_id
6902 ? merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id, it->face_id)
6903 : merge_escape_glyph_face (it));
6905 /* Draw non-ASCII hyphen with just highlighting: */
6907 if (nonascii_hyphen_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6909 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], '-');
6910 ctl_len = 1;
6911 goto display_control;
6914 /* Draw non-ASCII space/hyphen with escape glyph: */
6916 if (nonascii_space_p || nonascii_hyphen_p)
6918 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6919 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], nonascii_space_p ? ' ' : '-');
6920 ctl_len = 2;
6921 goto display_control;
6925 char str[10];
6926 int len, i;
6928 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
6929 /* Display \200 instead of \17777600. */
6930 c = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
6931 len = sprintf (str, "%03o", c);
6933 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6934 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
6935 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[i + 1], str[i]);
6936 ctl_len = len + 1;
6939 display_control:
6940 /* Set up IT->dpvec and return first character from it. */
6941 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6942 it->dpvec = it->ctl_chars;
6943 it->dpend = it->dpvec + ctl_len;
6944 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6945 it->dpvec_face_id = face_id;
6946 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6947 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6948 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6949 goto get_next;
6951 it->char_to_display = c;
6953 else if (success_p)
6955 it->char_to_display = it->c;
6959 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
6960 /* Adjust face id for a multibyte character. There are no multibyte
6961 character in unibyte text. */
6962 if ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER || it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
6963 && it->multibyte_p
6964 && success_p
6965 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
6967 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
6969 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch >= 0)
6971 /* Automatic composition with glyph-string. */
6972 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
6974 it->face_id = face_for_font (it->f, LGSTRING_FONT (gstring), face);
6976 else
6978 ptrdiff_t pos = (it->s ? -1
6979 : STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
6980 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
6981 int c;
6983 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6984 c = it->char_to_display;
6985 else
6987 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
6988 int i;
6990 c = ' ';
6991 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
6992 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with
6993 padding space on the left or right. */
6994 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
6995 break;
6997 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, pos, it->string);
7000 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
7002 done:
7003 /* Is this character the last one of a run of characters with
7004 box? If yes, set IT->end_of_box_run_p to 1. */
7005 if (it->face_box_p
7006 && it->s == NULL)
7008 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING && it->sp)
7010 int face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
7011 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
7013 if (face)
7015 if (face->box == FACE_NO_BOX)
7017 /* If the box comes from face properties in a
7018 display string, check faces in that string. */
7019 int string_face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
7020 it->end_of_box_run_p
7021 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, string_face_id)->box
7022 == FACE_NO_BOX);
7024 /* Otherwise, the box comes from the underlying face.
7025 If this is the last string character displayed, check
7026 the next buffer location. */
7027 else if ((IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string) - 1)
7028 && (it->current.overlay_string_index
7029 == it->n_overlay_strings - 1))
7031 ptrdiff_t ignore;
7032 int next_face_id;
7033 struct text_pos pos = it->current.pos;
7034 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
7036 next_face_id = face_at_buffer_position
7037 (it->w, CHARPOS (pos), &ignore,
7038 (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT), 0,
7039 -1);
7040 it->end_of_box_run_p
7041 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, next_face_id)->box
7042 == FACE_NO_BOX);
7046 /* next_element_from_display_vector sets this flag according to
7047 faces of the display vector glyphs, see there. */
7048 else if (it->method != GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
7050 int face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
7051 it->end_of_box_run_p
7052 = (face_id != it->face_id
7053 && FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id)->box == FACE_NO_BOX);
7056 /* If we reached the end of the object we've been iterating (e.g., a
7057 display string or an overlay string), and there's something on
7058 IT->stack, proceed with what's on the stack. It doesn't make
7059 sense to return zero if there's unprocessed stuff on the stack,
7060 because otherwise that stuff will never be displayed. */
7061 if (!success_p && it->sp > 0)
7063 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
7064 success_p = get_next_display_element (it);
7067 /* Value is 0 if end of buffer or string reached. */
7068 return success_p;
7072 /* Move IT to the next display element.
7074 RESEAT_P non-zero means if called on a newline in buffer text,
7075 skip to the next visible line start.
7077 Functions get_next_display_element and set_iterator_to_next are
7078 separate because I find this arrangement easier to handle than a
7079 get_next_display_element function that also increments IT's
7080 position. The way it is we can first look at an iterator's current
7081 display element, decide whether it fits on a line, and if it does,
7082 increment the iterator position. The other way around we probably
7083 would either need a flag indicating whether the iterator has to be
7084 incremented the next time, or we would have to implement a
7085 decrement position function which would not be easy to write. */
7087 void
7088 set_iterator_to_next (struct it *it, int reseat_p)
7090 /* Reset flags indicating start and end of a sequence of characters
7091 with box. Reset them at the start of this function because
7092 moving the iterator to a new position might set them. */
7093 it->start_of_box_run_p = it->end_of_box_run_p = 0;
7095 switch (it->method)
7097 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
7098 /* The current display element of IT is a character from
7099 current_buffer. Advance in the buffer, and maybe skip over
7100 invisible lines that are so because of selective display. */
7101 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it) && reseat_p)
7102 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
7103 else if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7105 /* We are currently getting glyphs from a composition. */
7106 int i;
7108 if (! it->bidi_p)
7110 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7111 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7112 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7114 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7116 else
7118 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7119 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7120 IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7121 it->end_charpos, Qnil);
7124 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7126 /* Composition created while scanning forward. */
7127 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the first
7128 character of the next grapheme cluster, or to the
7129 character visually after the current composition. */
7130 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7131 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7132 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7133 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7135 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7137 /* Proceed to the next grapheme cluster. */
7138 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7140 else
7142 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7143 Find the next stop position. */
7144 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7145 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7146 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7147 where to stop. */
7148 stop = -1;
7149 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7150 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7153 else
7155 /* Composition created while scanning backward. */
7156 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the last
7157 character of the previous grapheme cluster, or the
7158 character visually after the current composition. */
7159 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7160 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7161 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7162 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7163 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7165 /* Proceed to the previous grapheme cluster. */
7166 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7168 else
7170 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7171 Find the next stop position. */
7172 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7173 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7174 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7175 where to stop. */
7176 stop = -1;
7177 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7178 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7182 else
7184 eassert (it->len != 0);
7186 if (!it->bidi_p)
7188 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7189 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7191 else
7193 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7194 /* If this is a new paragraph, determine its base
7195 direction (a.k.a. its base embedding level). */
7196 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
7197 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
7198 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7199 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7200 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7201 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7203 /* As the scan direction was changed, we must
7204 re-compute the stop position for composition. */
7205 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7206 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7207 stop = -1;
7208 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7209 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7212 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
7214 break;
7216 case GET_FROM_C_STRING:
7217 /* Current display element of IT is from a C string. */
7218 if (!it->bidi_p
7219 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it means
7220 next_element_from_c_string is padding the string with
7221 blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi iterator,
7222 because it cannot deal with such virtual characters. */
7223 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7225 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7226 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7228 else
7230 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7231 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7232 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7234 break;
7236 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
7237 /* Current display element of IT is from a display table entry.
7238 Advance in the display table definition. Reset it to null if
7239 end reached, and continue with characters from buffers/
7240 strings. */
7241 ++it->current.dpvec_index;
7243 /* Restore face of the iterator to what they were before the
7244 display vector entry (these entries may contain faces). */
7245 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7247 if (it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index >= it->dpend)
7249 int recheck_faces = it->ellipsis_p;
7251 if (it->s)
7252 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
7253 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
7254 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
7255 else
7257 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7258 it->object = it->w->contents;
7261 it->dpvec = NULL;
7262 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
7264 /* Skip over characters which were displayed via IT->dpvec. */
7265 if (it->dpvec_char_len < 0)
7266 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7267 else if (it->dpvec_char_len > 0)
7269 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING
7270 && it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
7271 && it->n_overlay_strings > 0)
7272 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = true;
7273 it->len = it->dpvec_char_len;
7274 set_iterator_to_next (it, reseat_p);
7277 /* Maybe recheck faces after display vector. */
7278 if (recheck_faces)
7279 it->stop_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7281 break;
7283 case GET_FROM_STRING:
7284 /* Current display element is a character from a Lisp string. */
7285 eassert (it->s == NULL && STRINGP (it->string));
7286 /* Don't advance past string end. These conditions are true
7287 when set_iterator_to_next is called at the end of
7288 get_next_display_element, in which case the Lisp string is
7289 already exhausted, and all we want is pop the iterator
7290 stack. */
7291 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7293 /* This is an overlay string, so there's no padding with
7294 spaces, and the number of characters in the string is
7295 where the string ends. */
7296 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7297 goto consider_string_end;
7299 else
7301 /* Not an overlay string. There could be padding, so test
7302 against it->end_charpos. */
7303 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7304 goto consider_string_end;
7306 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7308 int i;
7310 if (! it->bidi_p)
7312 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7313 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7314 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7315 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7316 else
7318 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7319 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7320 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7321 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7322 it->end_charpos, it->string);
7325 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7327 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7328 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7329 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7330 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7332 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7333 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7334 else
7336 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7337 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7338 stop = -1;
7339 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7340 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7341 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7342 it->string);
7345 else
7347 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7348 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7349 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7350 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7351 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7352 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7353 else
7355 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7356 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7357 stop = -1;
7358 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7359 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7360 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7361 it->string);
7365 else
7367 if (!it->bidi_p
7368 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it
7369 means next_element_from_string is padding the string
7370 with blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi
7371 iterator, because it cannot deal with such virtual
7372 characters. */
7373 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7375 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7376 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7378 else
7380 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7382 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7383 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7384 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7385 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7387 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7389 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7390 stop = -1;
7391 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7392 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7393 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7394 it->string);
7399 consider_string_end:
7401 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7403 /* IT->string is an overlay string. Advance to the
7404 next, if there is one. */
7405 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7407 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
7408 next_overlay_string (it);
7409 if (it->ellipsis_p)
7410 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
7413 else
7415 /* IT->string is not an overlay string. If we reached
7416 its end, and there is something on IT->stack, proceed
7417 with what is on the stack. This can be either another
7418 string, this time an overlay string, or a buffer. */
7419 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == SCHARS (it->string)
7420 && it->sp > 0)
7422 pop_it (it);
7423 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7424 goto consider_string_end;
7427 break;
7429 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
7430 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
7431 /* The position etc with which we have to proceed are on
7432 the stack. The position may be at the end of a string,
7433 if the `display' property takes up the whole string. */
7434 eassert (it->sp > 0);
7435 pop_it (it);
7436 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7437 goto consider_string_end;
7438 break;
7440 default:
7441 /* There are no other methods defined, so this should be a bug. */
7442 emacs_abort ();
7445 eassert (it->method != GET_FROM_STRING
7446 || (STRINGP (it->string)
7447 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0));
7450 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
7451 display element which comes from a display table entry or from the
7452 result of translating a control character to one of the forms `^C'
7453 or `\003'.
7455 IT->dpvec holds the glyphs to return as characters.
7456 IT->saved_face_id holds the face id before the display vector--it
7457 is restored into IT->face_id in set_iterator_to_next. */
7459 static int
7460 next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *it)
7462 Lisp_Object gc;
7463 int prev_face_id = it->face_id;
7464 int next_face_id;
7466 /* Precondition. */
7467 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
7469 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7471 /* KFS: This code used to check ip->dpvec[0] instead of the current element.
7472 That seemed totally bogus - so I changed it... */
7473 gc = it->dpvec[it->current.dpvec_index];
7475 if (GLYPH_CODE_P (gc))
7477 struct face *this_face, *prev_face, *next_face;
7479 it->c = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
7480 it->len = CHAR_BYTES (it->c);
7482 /* The entry may contain a face id to use. Such a face id is
7483 the id of a Lisp face, not a realized face. A face id of
7484 zero means no face is specified. */
7485 if (it->dpvec_face_id >= 0)
7486 it->face_id = it->dpvec_face_id;
7487 else
7489 int lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
7490 if (lface_id > 0)
7491 it->face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
7492 it->saved_face_id);
7495 /* Glyphs in the display vector could have the box face, so we
7496 need to set the related flags in the iterator, as
7497 appropriate. */
7498 this_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
7499 prev_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, prev_face_id);
7501 /* Is this character the first character of a box-face run? */
7502 it->start_of_box_run_p = (this_face && this_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
7503 && (!prev_face
7504 || prev_face->box == FACE_NO_BOX));
7506 /* For the last character of the box-face run, we need to look
7507 either at the next glyph from the display vector, or at the
7508 face we saw before the display vector. */
7509 next_face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7510 if (it->current.dpvec_index < it->dpend - it->dpvec - 1)
7512 if (it->dpvec_face_id >= 0)
7513 next_face_id = it->dpvec_face_id;
7514 else
7516 int lface_id =
7517 GLYPH_CODE_FACE (it->dpvec[it->current.dpvec_index + 1]);
7519 if (lface_id > 0)
7520 next_face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
7521 it->saved_face_id);
7524 next_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, next_face_id);
7525 it->end_of_box_run_p = (this_face && this_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
7526 && (!next_face
7527 || next_face->box == FACE_NO_BOX));
7528 it->face_box_p = this_face && this_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
7530 else
7531 /* Display table entry is invalid. Return a space. */
7532 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7534 /* Don't change position and object of the iterator here. They are
7535 still the values of the character that had this display table
7536 entry or was translated, and that's what we want. */
7537 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7538 return 1;
7541 /* Get the first element of string/buffer in the visual order, after
7542 being reseated to a new position in a string or a buffer. */
7543 static void
7544 get_visually_first_element (struct it *it)
7546 int string_p = STRINGP (it->string) || it->s;
7547 ptrdiff_t eob = (string_p ? it->bidi_it.string.schars : ZV);
7548 ptrdiff_t bob = (string_p ? 0 : BEGV);
7550 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7552 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7553 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7555 else
7557 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7558 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7561 if (it->bidi_it.charpos == eob)
7563 /* Nothing to do, but reset the FIRST_ELT flag, like
7564 bidi_paragraph_init does, because we are not going to
7565 call it. */
7566 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
7568 else if (it->bidi_it.charpos == bob
7569 || (!string_p
7570 && (FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos - 1) == '\n'
7571 || FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos) == '\n')))
7573 /* If we are at the beginning of a line/string, we can produce
7574 the next element right away. */
7575 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7576 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7578 else
7580 ptrdiff_t orig_bytepos = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7582 /* We need to prime the bidi iterator starting at the line's or
7583 string's beginning, before we will be able to produce the
7584 next element. */
7585 if (string_p)
7586 it->bidi_it.charpos = it->bidi_it.bytepos = 0;
7587 else
7588 it->bidi_it.charpos = find_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7589 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), -1,
7590 &it->bidi_it.bytepos);
7591 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7594 /* Now return to buffer/string position where we were asked
7595 to get the next display element, and produce that. */
7596 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7598 while (it->bidi_it.bytepos != orig_bytepos
7599 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob);
7602 /* Adjust IT's position information to where we ended up. */
7603 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7605 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7606 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7608 else
7610 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7611 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7614 if (STRINGP (it->string) || !it->s)
7616 ptrdiff_t stop, charpos, bytepos;
7618 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7620 eassert (!it->s);
7621 stop = SCHARS (it->string);
7622 if (stop > it->end_charpos)
7623 stop = it->end_charpos;
7624 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7625 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7627 else
7629 stop = it->end_charpos;
7630 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7631 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7633 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7634 stop = -1;
7635 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos, stop,
7636 it->string);
7640 /* Load IT with the next display element from Lisp string IT->string.
7641 IT->current.string_pos is the current position within the string.
7642 If IT->current.overlay_string_index >= 0, the Lisp string is an
7643 overlay string. */
7645 static int
7646 next_element_from_string (struct it *it)
7648 struct text_pos position;
7650 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
7651 eassert (!it->bidi_p || EQ (it->string, it->bidi_it.string.lstring));
7652 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
7653 position = it->current.string_pos;
7655 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7656 character at IT_STRING_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means
7657 that we were reseat()ed to a new string, whose paragraph
7658 direction is not known. */
7659 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7661 get_visually_first_element (it);
7662 SET_TEXT_POS (position, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7665 /* Time to check for invisible text? */
7666 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
7668 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7670 if (!(!it->bidi_p
7671 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7672 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7674 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find
7675 ourselves far beyond the last computed stop_charpos,
7676 with several other stop positions in between that we
7677 missed. Scan them all now, in buffer's logical
7678 order, until we find and handle the last stop_charpos
7679 that precedes our current position. */
7680 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7681 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7683 else
7685 if (it->bidi_p)
7687 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved
7688 across, for when we will move back across it. */
7689 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7690 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7691 note of the last stop position seen at this
7692 level. */
7693 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7694 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7696 handle_stop (it);
7698 /* Since a handler may have changed IT->method, we must
7699 recurse here. */
7700 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7703 else if (it->bidi_p
7704 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped
7705 on our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need
7706 to handle that stop_pos. */
7707 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7708 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7709 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7710 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7711 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7712 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7714 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we have no better
7715 place for handle_stop_backwards to start from than string
7716 beginning. This happens, e.g., when we were reseated to
7717 the previous screenful of text by vertical-motion. */
7718 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7719 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7720 it->base_level_stop = 0;
7721 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7722 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7726 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7728 /* Get the next character from an overlay string. In overlay
7729 strings, there is no field width or padding with spaces to
7730 do. */
7731 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7733 it->what = IT_EOB;
7734 return 0;
7736 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7737 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7738 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7739 ? -1
7740 : SCHARS (it->string))
7741 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7743 return 1;
7745 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7747 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7748 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7749 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7751 else
7753 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7754 it->len = 1;
7757 else
7759 /* Get the next character from a Lisp string that is not an
7760 overlay string. Such strings come from the mode line, for
7761 example. We may have to pad with spaces, or truncate the
7762 string. See also next_element_from_c_string. */
7763 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7765 it->what = IT_EOB;
7766 return 0;
7768 else if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7770 /* Pad with spaces. */
7771 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7772 CHARPOS (position) = BYTEPOS (position) = -1;
7774 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7775 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7776 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7777 ? -1
7778 : it->string_nchars)
7779 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7781 return 1;
7783 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7785 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7786 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7787 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7789 else
7791 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7792 it->len = 1;
7796 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7797 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7798 it->object = it->string;
7799 it->position = position;
7800 return 1;
7804 /* Load IT with next display element from C string IT->s.
7805 IT->string_nchars is the maximum number of characters to return
7806 from the string. IT->end_charpos may be greater than
7807 IT->string_nchars when this function is called, in which case we
7808 may have to return padding spaces. Value is zero if end of string
7809 reached, including padding spaces. */
7811 static int
7812 next_element_from_c_string (struct it *it)
7814 bool success_p = true;
7816 eassert (it->s);
7817 eassert (!it->bidi_p || it->s == it->bidi_it.string.s);
7818 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7819 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = 0;
7820 it->object = Qnil;
7822 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7823 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7824 we were reseated to a new string, whose paragraph direction is
7825 not known. */
7826 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7827 get_visually_first_element (it);
7829 /* IT's position can be greater than IT->string_nchars in case a
7830 field width or precision has been specified when the iterator was
7831 initialized. */
7832 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7834 /* End of the game. */
7835 it->what = IT_EOB;
7836 success_p = 0;
7838 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7840 /* Pad with spaces. */
7841 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7842 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = -1;
7844 else if (it->multibyte_p)
7845 it->c = string_char_and_length (it->s + IT_BYTEPOS (*it), &it->len);
7846 else
7847 it->c = it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)], it->len = 1;
7849 return success_p;
7853 /* Set up IT to return characters from an ellipsis, if appropriate.
7854 The definition of the ellipsis glyphs may come from a display table
7855 entry. This function fills IT with the first glyph from the
7856 ellipsis if an ellipsis is to be displayed. */
7858 static int
7859 next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *it)
7861 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
7862 setup_for_ellipsis (it, it->len);
7863 else
7865 /* The face at the current position may be different from the
7866 face we find after the invisible text. Remember what it
7867 was in IT->saved_face_id, and signal that it's there by
7868 setting face_before_selective_p. */
7869 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
7870 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7871 it->object = it->w->contents;
7872 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7873 it->face_before_selective_p = true;
7876 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7880 /* Deliver an image display element. The iterator IT is already
7881 filled with image information (done in handle_display_prop). Value
7882 is always 1. */
7885 static int
7886 next_element_from_image (struct it *it)
7888 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
7889 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
7890 return 1;
7894 /* Fill iterator IT with next display element from a stretch glyph
7895 property. IT->object is the value of the text property. Value is
7896 always 1. */
7898 static int
7899 next_element_from_stretch (struct it *it)
7901 it->what = IT_STRETCH;
7902 return 1;
7905 /* Scan backwards from IT's current position until we find a stop
7906 position, or until BEGV. This is called when we find ourself
7907 before both the last known prev_stop and base_level_stop while
7908 reordering bidirectional text. */
7910 static void
7911 compute_stop_pos_backwards (struct it *it)
7913 const int SCAN_BACK_LIMIT = 1000;
7914 struct text_pos pos;
7915 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7916 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7917 ptrdiff_t charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7918 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = charpos;
7919 ptrdiff_t save_stop_pos = it->stop_charpos;
7920 ptrdiff_t save_end_pos = it->end_charpos;
7922 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7923 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7924 it->bidi_p = 0;
7927 it->end_charpos = min (charpos + 1, ZV);
7928 charpos = max (charpos - SCAN_BACK_LIMIT, BEGV);
7929 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7930 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
7931 compute_stop_pos (it);
7932 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7933 if (it->stop_charpos <= charpos)
7934 emacs_abort ();
7936 while (charpos > BEGV && it->stop_charpos >= it->end_charpos);
7938 if (it->stop_charpos <= where_we_are)
7939 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7940 else
7941 it->prev_stop = BEGV;
7942 it->bidi_p = true;
7943 it->current = save_current;
7944 it->position = save_position;
7945 it->stop_charpos = save_stop_pos;
7946 it->end_charpos = save_end_pos;
7949 /* Scan forward from CHARPOS in the current buffer/string, until we
7950 find a stop position > current IT's position. Then handle the stop
7951 position before that. This is called when we bump into a stop
7952 position while reordering bidirectional text. CHARPOS should be
7953 the last previously processed stop_pos (or BEGV/0, if none were
7954 processed yet) whose position is less that IT's current
7955 position. */
7957 static void
7958 handle_stop_backwards (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
7960 int bufp = !STRINGP (it->string);
7961 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = (bufp ? IT_CHARPOS (*it) : IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
7962 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7963 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7964 struct text_pos pos1;
7965 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
7967 /* Scan in strict logical order. */
7968 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7969 it->bidi_p = 0;
7972 it->prev_stop = charpos;
7973 if (bufp)
7975 SET_TEXT_POS (pos1, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7976 reseat_1 (it, pos1, 0);
7978 else
7979 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
7980 compute_stop_pos (it);
7981 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7982 if (it->stop_charpos <= it->prev_stop)
7983 emacs_abort ();
7984 charpos = it->stop_charpos;
7986 while (charpos <= where_we_are);
7988 it->bidi_p = true;
7989 it->current = save_current;
7990 it->position = save_position;
7991 next_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7992 it->stop_charpos = it->prev_stop;
7993 handle_stop (it);
7994 it->stop_charpos = next_stop;
7997 /* Load IT with the next display element from current_buffer. Value
7998 is zero if end of buffer reached. IT->stop_charpos is the next
7999 position at which to stop and check for text properties or buffer
8000 end. */
8002 static int
8003 next_element_from_buffer (struct it *it)
8005 bool success_p = true;
8007 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
8008 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
8009 eassert (!it->bidi_p
8010 || (EQ (it->bidi_it.string.lstring, Qnil)
8011 && it->bidi_it.string.s == NULL));
8013 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
8014 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
8015 we were reseat()ed to a new buffer position, which is potentially
8016 a different paragraph. */
8017 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
8019 get_visually_first_element (it);
8020 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8023 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
8025 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
8027 int overlay_strings_follow_p;
8029 /* End of the game, except when overlay strings follow that
8030 haven't been returned yet. */
8031 if (it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p)
8032 overlay_strings_follow_p = 0;
8033 else
8035 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = true;
8036 overlay_strings_follow_p = get_overlay_strings (it, 0);
8039 if (overlay_strings_follow_p)
8040 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
8041 else
8043 it->what = IT_EOB;
8044 it->position = it->current.pos;
8045 success_p = 0;
8048 else if (!(!it->bidi_p
8049 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
8050 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
8052 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find ourselves
8053 far beyond the last computed stop_charpos, with several
8054 other stop positions in between that we missed. Scan
8055 them all now, in buffer's logical order, until we find
8056 and handle the last stop_charpos that precedes our
8057 current position. */
8058 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
8059 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
8061 else
8063 if (it->bidi_p)
8065 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved across,
8066 for when we will move back across it. */
8067 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
8068 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
8069 note of the last stop position seen at this
8070 level. */
8071 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
8072 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
8074 handle_stop (it);
8075 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
8078 else if (it->bidi_p
8079 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped on
8080 our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need to
8081 handle that stop_pos. */
8082 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
8083 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
8084 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
8085 code below is only needed when we are above the base
8086 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
8087 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
8089 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
8090 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
8092 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we need to find
8093 prev_stop by looking backwards. This happens, e.g., when
8094 we were reseated to the previous screenful of text by
8095 vertical-motion. */
8096 it->base_level_stop = BEGV;
8097 compute_stop_pos_backwards (it);
8098 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->prev_stop);
8100 else
8101 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
8102 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
8104 else
8106 /* No face changes, overlays etc. in sight, so just return a
8107 character from current_buffer. */
8108 unsigned char *p;
8109 ptrdiff_t stop;
8111 /* Maybe run the redisplay end trigger hook. Performance note:
8112 This doesn't seem to cost measurable time. */
8113 if (it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
8114 && it->glyph_row
8115 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos)
8116 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (it);
8118 stop = it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0 ? -1 : it->end_charpos;
8119 if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
8120 stop)
8121 && next_element_from_composition (it))
8123 return 1;
8126 /* Get the next character, maybe multibyte. */
8127 p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8128 if (it->multibyte_p && !ASCII_BYTE_P (*p))
8129 it->c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it->len);
8130 else
8131 it->c = *p, it->len = 1;
8133 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
8134 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
8135 it->object = it->w->contents;
8136 it->position = it->current.pos;
8138 /* Normally we return the character found above, except when we
8139 really want to return an ellipsis for selective display. */
8140 if (it->selective)
8142 if (it->c == '\n')
8144 /* A value of selective > 0 means hide lines indented more
8145 than that number of columns. */
8146 if (it->selective > 0
8147 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1 < ZV
8148 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1,
8149 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) + 1,
8150 it->selective))
8152 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
8153 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
8156 else if (it->c == '\r' && it->selective == -1)
8158 /* A value of selective == -1 means that everything from the
8159 CR to the end of the line is invisible, with maybe an
8160 ellipsis displayed for it. */
8161 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
8162 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
8167 /* Value is zero if end of buffer reached. */
8168 eassert (!success_p || it->what != IT_CHARACTER || it->len > 0);
8169 return success_p;
8173 /* Run the redisplay end trigger hook for IT. */
8175 static void
8176 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *it)
8178 Lisp_Object args[3];
8180 /* IT->glyph_row should be non-null, i.e. we should be actually
8181 displaying something, or otherwise we should not run the hook. */
8182 eassert (it->glyph_row);
8184 /* Set up hook arguments. */
8185 args[0] = Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
8186 args[1] = it->window;
8187 XSETINT (args[2], it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos);
8188 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos = 0;
8190 /* Since we are *trying* to run these functions, don't try to run
8191 them again, even if they get an error. */
8192 wset_redisplay_end_trigger (it->w, Qnil);
8193 Frun_hook_with_args (3, args);
8195 /* Notice if it changed the face of the character we are on. */
8196 handle_face_prop (it);
8200 /* Deliver a composition display element. Unlike the other
8201 next_element_from_XXX, this function is not registered in the array
8202 get_next_element[]. It is called from next_element_from_buffer and
8203 next_element_from_string when necessary. */
8205 static int
8206 next_element_from_composition (struct it *it)
8208 it->what = IT_COMPOSITION;
8209 it->len = it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8210 if (STRINGP (it->string))
8212 if (it->c < 0)
8214 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8215 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8216 return 0;
8218 it->position = it->current.string_pos;
8219 it->object = it->string;
8220 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
8221 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), it->string);
8223 else
8225 if (it->c < 0)
8227 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8228 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8229 if (it->bidi_p)
8231 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
8232 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
8233 /* Resync the bidi iterator with IT's new position.
8234 FIXME: this doesn't support bidirectional text. */
8235 while (it->bidi_it.charpos < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
8236 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
8238 return 0;
8240 it->position = it->current.pos;
8241 it->object = it->w->contents;
8242 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
8243 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), Qnil);
8245 return 1;
8250 /***********************************************************************
8251 Moving an iterator without producing glyphs
8252 ***********************************************************************/
8254 /* Check if iterator is at a position corresponding to a valid buffer
8255 position after some move_it_ call. */
8257 #define IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P(it) \
8258 ((it)->method == GET_FROM_STRING \
8259 ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 \
8260 : 1)
8263 /* Move iterator IT to a specified buffer or X position within one
8264 line on the display without producing glyphs.
8266 OP should be a bit mask including some or all of these bits:
8267 MOVE_TO_X: Stop upon reaching x-position TO_X.
8268 MOVE_TO_POS: Stop upon reaching buffer or string position TO_CHARPOS.
8269 Regardless of OP's value, stop upon reaching the end of the display line.
8271 TO_X is normally a value 0 <= TO_X <= IT->last_visible_x.
8272 This means, in particular, that TO_X includes window's horizontal
8273 scroll amount.
8275 The return value has several possible values that
8276 say what condition caused the scan to stop:
8278 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV
8279 - when TO_POS or ZV was reached.
8281 MOVE_X_REACHED
8282 -when TO_X was reached before TO_POS or ZV were reached.
8284 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8285 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line must
8286 be continued.
8288 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED
8289 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line is
8290 truncated.
8292 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
8293 - when we stopped at a line end, i.e. a newline or a CR and selective
8294 display is on. */
8296 static enum move_it_result
8297 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *it,
8298 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8299 enum move_operation_enum op)
8301 enum move_it_result result = MOVE_UNDEFINED;
8302 struct glyph_row *saved_glyph_row;
8303 struct it wrap_it, atpos_it, atx_it, ppos_it;
8304 void *wrap_data = NULL, *atpos_data = NULL, *atx_data = NULL;
8305 void *ppos_data = NULL;
8306 int may_wrap = 0;
8307 enum it_method prev_method = it->method;
8308 ptrdiff_t prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8309 int saw_smaller_pos = prev_pos < to_charpos;
8311 /* Don't produce glyphs in produce_glyphs. */
8312 saved_glyph_row = it->glyph_row;
8313 it->glyph_row = NULL;
8315 /* Use wrap_it to save a copy of IT wherever a word wrap could
8316 occur. Use atpos_it to save a copy of IT at the desired buffer
8317 position, if found, so that we can scan ahead and check if the
8318 word later overshoots the window edge. Use atx_it similarly, for
8319 pixel positions. */
8320 wrap_it.sp = -1;
8321 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8322 atx_it.sp = -1;
8324 /* Use ppos_it under bidi reordering to save a copy of IT for the
8325 position > CHARPOS that is the closest to CHARPOS. We restore
8326 that position in IT when we have scanned the entire display line
8327 without finding a match for CHARPOS and all the character
8328 positions are greater than CHARPOS. */
8329 if (it->bidi_p)
8331 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8332 SET_TEXT_POS (ppos_it.current.pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
8333 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos)
8334 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8337 #define BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P() \
8338 ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0 \
8339 && BUFFERP (it->object) \
8340 && (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos \
8341 || ((!it->bidi_p \
8342 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)) \
8343 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos) \
8344 || (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION \
8345 && ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos \
8346 && to_charpos >= it->cmp_it.charpos) \
8347 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos \
8348 && to_charpos <= it->cmp_it.charpos)))) \
8349 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER \
8350 || (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR \
8351 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index + 1 >= it->dpend)))
8353 /* If there's a line-/wrap-prefix, handle it. */
8354 if (it->hpos == 0 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8355 && it->current_y < it->last_visible_y)
8356 handle_line_prefix (it);
8358 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8359 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8361 while (1)
8363 int x, i, ascent = 0, descent = 0;
8365 /* Utility macro to reset an iterator with x, ascent, and descent. */
8366 #define IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT(IT) \
8367 ((IT)->current_x = x, (IT)->max_ascent = ascent, \
8368 (IT)->max_descent = descent)
8370 /* Stop if we move beyond TO_CHARPOS (after an image or a
8371 display string or stretch glyph). */
8372 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8373 && BUFFERP (it->object)
8374 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8375 && (((!it->bidi_p
8376 /* When the iterator is at base embedding level, we
8377 are guaranteed that characters are delivered for
8378 display in strictly increasing order of their
8379 buffer positions. */
8380 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
8381 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8382 || (it->bidi_p
8383 && (prev_method == GET_FROM_IMAGE
8384 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRETCH
8385 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRING)
8386 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from left to right. */
8387 && ((prev_pos < to_charpos
8388 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8389 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from right to left. */
8390 || (prev_pos > to_charpos
8391 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)))))
8393 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8395 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8396 break;
8398 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8399 /* If wrap_it is valid, the current position might be in a
8400 word that is wrapped. So, save the iterator in
8401 atpos_it and continue to see if wrapping happens. */
8402 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8405 /* Stop when ZV reached.
8406 We used to stop here when TO_CHARPOS reached as well, but that is
8407 too soon if this glyph does not fit on this line. So we handle it
8408 explicitly below. */
8409 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8411 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8412 break;
8415 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
8417 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8419 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8420 break;
8423 else
8425 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8427 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
8428 may_wrap = 1;
8429 else if (may_wrap)
8431 /* We have reached a glyph that follows one or more
8432 whitespace characters. If the position is
8433 already found, we are done. */
8434 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8436 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8437 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8438 goto done;
8440 if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8442 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8443 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8444 goto done;
8446 /* Otherwise, we can wrap here. */
8447 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
8448 may_wrap = 0;
8453 /* Remember the line height for the current line, in case
8454 the next element doesn't fit on the line. */
8455 ascent = it->max_ascent;
8456 descent = it->max_descent;
8458 /* The call to produce_glyphs will get the metrics of the
8459 display element IT is loaded with. Record the x-position
8460 before this display element, in case it doesn't fit on the
8461 line. */
8462 x = it->current_x;
8464 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
8466 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
8468 prev_method = it->method;
8469 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8470 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8471 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8472 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8473 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8474 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8475 if (it->bidi_p
8476 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8477 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos
8478 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8479 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8480 continue;
8483 /* The number of glyphs we get back in IT->nglyphs will normally
8484 be 1 except when IT->c is (i) a TAB, or (ii) a multi-glyph
8485 character on a terminal frame, or (iii) a line end. For the
8486 second case, IT->nglyphs - 1 padding glyphs will be present.
8487 (On X frames, there is only one glyph produced for a
8488 composite character.)
8490 The behavior implemented below means, for continuation lines,
8491 that as many spaces of a TAB as fit on the current line are
8492 displayed there. For terminal frames, as many glyphs of a
8493 multi-glyph character are displayed in the current line, too.
8494 This is what the old redisplay code did, and we keep it that
8495 way. Under X, the whole shape of a complex character must
8496 fit on the line or it will be completely displayed in the
8497 next line.
8499 Note that both for tabs and padding glyphs, all glyphs have
8500 the same width. */
8501 if (it->nglyphs)
8503 /* More than one glyph or glyph doesn't fit on line. All
8504 glyphs have the same width. */
8505 int single_glyph_width = it->pixel_width / it->nglyphs;
8506 int new_x;
8507 int x_before_this_char = x;
8508 int hpos_before_this_char = it->hpos;
8510 for (i = 0; i < it->nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
8512 new_x = x + single_glyph_width;
8514 /* We want to leave anything reaching TO_X to the caller. */
8515 if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && new_x > to_x)
8517 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8519 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8520 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8521 if (atpos_it.sp < 0)
8523 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8524 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8527 else
8529 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8531 it->current_x = x;
8532 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8533 break;
8535 if (atx_it.sp < 0)
8537 SAVE_IT (atx_it, *it, atx_data);
8538 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atx_it);
8543 if (/* Lines are continued. */
8544 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
8545 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
8546 new_x > it->last_visible_x
8547 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
8548 system frame. */
8549 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8550 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8551 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8552 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8553 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
8555 if (/* IT->hpos == 0 means the very first glyph
8556 doesn't fit on the line, e.g. a wide image. */
8557 it->hpos == 0
8558 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8559 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)))
8561 ++it->hpos;
8562 it->current_x = new_x;
8564 /* The character's last glyph just barely fits
8565 in this row. */
8566 if (i == it->nglyphs - 1)
8568 /* If this is the destination position,
8569 return a position *before* it in this row,
8570 now that we know it fits in this row. */
8571 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8573 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP
8574 || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8576 it->hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8577 it->current_x = x_before_this_char;
8578 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8579 break;
8581 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8582 && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8584 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8585 atpos_it.current_x = x_before_this_char;
8586 atpos_it.hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8590 prev_method = it->method;
8591 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8592 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8593 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8594 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8595 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8596 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8597 /* On graphical terminals, newlines may
8598 "overflow" into the fringe if
8599 overflow-newline-into-fringe is non-nil.
8600 On text terminals, and on graphical
8601 terminals with no right margin, newlines
8602 may overflow into the last glyph on the
8603 display line.*/
8604 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8605 || ((it->bidi_p
8606 && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8607 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8608 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8609 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8611 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8613 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8614 break;
8616 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8618 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8619 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8620 else
8621 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8622 break;
8624 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it)
8625 && (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP
8626 || wrap_it.sp < 0))
8628 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8629 break;
8634 else
8635 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8637 if (wrap_it.sp >= 0)
8639 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
8640 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8641 atx_it.sp = -1;
8644 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_in: continued at %d\n",
8645 IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8646 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8647 break;
8650 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8652 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8653 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8654 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8656 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8657 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8661 if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
8663 /* Glyph is visible. Increment number of glyphs that
8664 would be displayed. */
8665 ++it->hpos;
8669 if (result != MOVE_UNDEFINED)
8670 break;
8672 else if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8674 buffer_pos_reached:
8675 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8676 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8677 break;
8679 else if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && it->current_x >= to_x)
8681 /* Stop when TO_X specified and reached. This check is
8682 necessary here because of lines consisting of a line end,
8683 only. The line end will not produce any glyphs and we
8684 would never get MOVE_X_REACHED. */
8685 eassert (it->nglyphs == 0);
8686 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8687 break;
8690 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're done. */
8691 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8693 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any character
8694 positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS, return
8695 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the unidirectional display
8696 did. */
8697 if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0)
8699 if (!saw_smaller_pos && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8701 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8703 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8704 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8706 else
8707 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8709 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp >= 0
8710 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8711 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8712 else
8713 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8715 else
8716 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8717 break;
8720 prev_method = it->method;
8721 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8722 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8723 /* The current display element has been consumed. Advance
8724 to the next. */
8725 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8726 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8727 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8728 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)
8729 saw_smaller_pos = 1;
8730 if (it->bidi_p
8731 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8732 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8733 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8734 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8736 /* Stop if lines are truncated and IT's current x-position is
8737 past the right edge of the window now. */
8738 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
8739 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
8741 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8742 || ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8743 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8744 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8745 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8747 int at_eob_p = 0;
8749 if ((at_eob_p = !get_next_display_element (it))
8750 || BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ()
8751 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any
8752 character positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS,
8753 return MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the
8754 unidirectional display did. */
8755 || (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8756 && !saw_smaller_pos
8757 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos))
8759 if (it->bidi_p
8760 && !at_eob_p && IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8761 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8762 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8763 break;
8765 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8767 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8768 break;
8771 else if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8772 && !saw_smaller_pos
8773 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8775 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8776 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8777 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8778 break;
8780 result = MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED;
8781 break;
8783 #undef IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT
8786 #undef BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P
8788 /* If we scanned beyond to_pos and didn't find a point to wrap at,
8789 restore the saved iterator. */
8790 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8791 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8792 else if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8793 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8795 done:
8797 if (atpos_data)
8798 bidi_unshelve_cache (atpos_data, 1);
8799 if (atx_data)
8800 bidi_unshelve_cache (atx_data, 1);
8801 if (wrap_data)
8802 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
8803 if (ppos_data)
8804 bidi_unshelve_cache (ppos_data, 1);
8806 /* Restore the iterator settings altered at the beginning of this
8807 function. */
8808 it->glyph_row = saved_glyph_row;
8809 return result;
8812 /* For external use. */
8813 void
8814 move_it_in_display_line (struct it *it,
8815 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8816 enum move_operation_enum op)
8818 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8819 && (op & MOVE_TO_X))
8821 struct it save_it;
8822 void *save_data = NULL;
8823 int skip;
8825 SAVE_IT (save_it, *it, save_data);
8826 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8827 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8828 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8829 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8830 space before the wrap point. */
8831 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
8833 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8834 RESTORE_IT (it, &save_it, save_data);
8835 move_it_in_display_line_to
8836 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8838 else
8839 bidi_unshelve_cache (save_data, 1);
8841 else
8842 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8846 /* Move IT forward until it satisfies one or more of the criteria in
8847 TO_CHARPOS, TO_X, TO_Y, and TO_VPOS.
8849 OP is a bit-mask that specifies where to stop, and in particular,
8850 which of those four position arguments makes a difference. See the
8851 description of enum move_operation_enum.
8853 If TO_CHARPOS is in invisible text, e.g. a truncated part of a
8854 screen line, this function will set IT to the next position that is
8855 displayed to the right of TO_CHARPOS on the screen.
8857 Return the maximum pixel length of any line scanned but never more
8858 than it.last_visible_x. */
8861 move_it_to (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x, int to_y, int to_vpos, int op)
8863 enum move_it_result skip, skip2 = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8864 int line_height, line_start_x = 0, reached = 0;
8865 int max_current_x = 0;
8866 void *backup_data = NULL;
8868 for (;;)
8870 if (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8872 /* If no TO_CHARPOS and no TO_X specified, stop at the
8873 start of the line TO_VPOS. */
8874 if ((op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)) == 0)
8876 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8878 reached = 1;
8879 break;
8881 else
8882 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
8884 else
8886 /* TO_VPOS >= 0 means stop at TO_X in the line at
8887 TO_VPOS, or at TO_POS, whichever comes first. */
8888 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8890 reached = 2;
8891 break;
8894 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8896 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV || it->vpos == to_vpos)
8898 reached = 3;
8899 break;
8901 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED && it->vpos != to_vpos)
8903 /* We have reached TO_X but not in the line we want. */
8904 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos,
8905 -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8906 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8908 reached = 4;
8909 break;
8914 else if (op & MOVE_TO_Y)
8916 struct it it_backup;
8918 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8919 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8921 /* TO_Y specified means stop at TO_X in the line containing
8922 TO_Y---or at TO_CHARPOS if this is reached first. The
8923 problem is that we can't really tell whether the line
8924 contains TO_Y before we have completely scanned it, and
8925 this may skip past TO_X. What we do is to first scan to
8926 TO_X.
8928 If TO_X is not specified, use a TO_X of zero. The reason
8929 is to make the outcome of this function more predictable.
8930 If we didn't use TO_X == 0, we would stop at the end of
8931 the line which is probably not what a caller would expect
8932 to happen. */
8933 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8934 (it, to_charpos, ((op & MOVE_TO_X) ? to_x : 0),
8935 (MOVE_TO_X | (op & MOVE_TO_POS)));
8937 /* If TO_CHARPOS is reached or ZV, we don't have to do more. */
8938 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8939 reached = 5;
8940 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED)
8942 /* If TO_X was reached, we want to know whether TO_Y is
8943 in the line. We know this is the case if the already
8944 scanned glyphs make the line tall enough. Otherwise,
8945 we must check by scanning the rest of the line. */
8946 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8947 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8948 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8950 reached = 6;
8951 break;
8953 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8954 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: from %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8955 skip2 = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1,
8956 op & MOVE_TO_POS);
8957 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8958 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8959 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8961 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8962 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8964 /* If TO_Y is in this line and TO_X was reached
8965 above, we scanned too far. We have to restore
8966 IT's settings to the ones before skipping. But
8967 keep the more accurate values of max_ascent and
8968 max_descent we've found while skipping the rest
8969 of the line, for the sake of callers, such as
8970 pos_visible_p, that need to know the line
8971 height. */
8972 int max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8973 int max_descent = it->max_descent;
8975 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8976 it->max_ascent = max_ascent;
8977 it->max_descent = max_descent;
8978 reached = 6;
8980 else
8982 skip = skip2;
8983 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8984 reached = 7;
8987 else
8989 /* Check whether TO_Y is in this line. */
8990 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8991 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8993 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8994 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8996 if (to_y > it->current_y)
8997 max_current_x = max (it->current_x, max_current_x);
8999 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
9000 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
9001 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
9002 space before the wrap point. */
9003 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
9004 && it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
9006 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
9007 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
9008 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
9009 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
9012 reached = 6;
9016 if (reached)
9018 max_current_x = max (it->current_x, max_current_x);
9019 break;
9022 else if (BUFFERP (it->object)
9023 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
9024 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH)
9025 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
9026 /* Under bidi iteration, a call to set_iterator_to_next
9027 can scan far beyond to_charpos if the initial
9028 portion of the next line needs to be reordered. In
9029 that case, give move_it_in_display_line_to another
9030 chance below. */
9031 && !(it->bidi_p
9032 && it->bidi_it.scan_dir == -1))
9033 skip = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
9034 else
9035 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9037 switch (skip)
9039 case MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV:
9040 max_current_x = max (it->current_x, max_current_x);
9041 reached = 8;
9042 goto out;
9044 case MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR:
9045 max_current_x = max (it->current_x, max_current_x);
9046 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
9047 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
9048 break;
9050 case MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED:
9051 max_current_x = it->last_visible_x;
9052 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
9053 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
9054 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
9055 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
9057 reached = 9;
9058 goto out;
9060 break;
9062 case MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED:
9063 max_current_x = it->last_visible_x;
9064 /* For continued lines ending in a tab, some of the glyphs
9065 associated with the tab are displayed on the current
9066 line. Since it->current_x does not include these glyphs,
9067 we use it->last_visible_x instead. */
9068 if (it->c == '\t')
9070 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
9071 /* When moving by vpos, ensure that the iterator really
9072 advances to the next line (bug#847, bug#969). Fixme:
9073 do we need to do this in other circumstances? */
9074 if (it->current_x != it->last_visible_x
9075 && (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
9076 && !(op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)))
9078 line_start_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width
9079 - it->last_visible_x;
9080 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
9083 else
9084 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
9085 break;
9087 default:
9088 emacs_abort ();
9091 /* Reset/increment for the next run. */
9092 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
9093 it->current_x = line_start_x;
9094 line_start_x = 0;
9095 it->hpos = 0;
9096 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
9097 ++it->vpos;
9098 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
9099 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
9100 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
9103 out:
9105 /* On text terminals, we may stop at the end of a line in the middle
9106 of a multi-character glyph. If the glyph itself is continued,
9107 i.e. it is actually displayed on the next line, don't treat this
9108 stopping point as valid; move to the next line instead (unless
9109 that brings us offscreen). */
9110 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
9111 && op & MOVE_TO_POS
9112 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos
9113 && it->what == IT_CHARACTER
9114 && it->nglyphs > 1
9115 && it->line_wrap == WINDOW_WRAP
9116 && it->current_x == it->last_visible_x - 1
9117 && it->c != '\n'
9118 && it->c != '\t'
9119 && it->vpos < it->w->window_end_vpos)
9121 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
9122 it->current_x = it->hpos = it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
9123 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
9124 ++it->vpos;
9125 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
9126 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
9129 if (backup_data)
9130 bidi_unshelve_cache (backup_data, 1);
9132 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_to: reached %d\n", reached));
9134 return max_current_x;
9138 /* Move iterator IT backward by a specified y-distance DY, DY >= 0.
9140 If DY > 0, move IT backward at least that many pixels. DY = 0
9141 means move IT backward to the preceding line start or BEGV. This
9142 function may move over more than DY pixels if IT->current_y - DY
9143 ends up in the middle of a line; in this case IT->current_y will be
9144 set to the top of the line moved to. */
9146 void
9147 move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *it, int dy)
9149 int nlines, h;
9150 struct it it2, it3;
9151 void *it2data = NULL, *it3data = NULL;
9152 ptrdiff_t start_pos;
9153 int nchars_per_row
9154 = (it->last_visible_x - it->first_visible_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
9155 ptrdiff_t pos_limit;
9157 move_further_back:
9158 eassert (dy >= 0);
9160 start_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9162 /* Estimate how many newlines we must move back. */
9163 nlines = max (1, dy / default_line_pixel_height (it->w));
9164 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
9165 pos_limit = BEGV;
9166 else
9167 pos_limit = max (start_pos - nlines * nchars_per_row, BEGV);
9169 /* Set the iterator's position that many lines back. But don't go
9170 back more than NLINES full screen lines -- this wins a day with
9171 buffers which have very long lines. */
9172 while (nlines-- && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > pos_limit)
9173 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9175 /* Reseat the iterator here. When moving backward, we don't want
9176 reseat to skip forward over invisible text, set up the iterator
9177 to deliver from overlay strings at the new position etc. So,
9178 use reseat_1 here. */
9179 reseat_1 (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9181 /* We are now surely at a line start. */
9182 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0; /* FIXME: this is incorrect when bidi
9183 reordering is in effect. */
9184 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
9186 /* Move forward and see what y-distance we moved. First move to the
9187 start of the next line so that we get its height. We need this
9188 height to be able to tell whether we reached the specified
9189 y-distance. */
9190 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9191 it2.max_ascent = it2.max_descent = 0;
9194 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, it2.vpos + 1,
9195 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9197 while (!(IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (&it2)
9198 /* If we are in a display string which starts at START_POS,
9199 and that display string includes a newline, and we are
9200 right after that newline (i.e. at the beginning of a
9201 display line), exit the loop, because otherwise we will
9202 infloop, since move_it_to will see that it is already at
9203 START_POS and will not move. */
9204 || (it2.method == GET_FROM_STRING
9205 && IT_CHARPOS (it2) == start_pos
9206 && SREF (it2.string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (it2) - 1) == '\n')));
9207 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9208 SAVE_IT (it3, it2, it3data);
9210 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9211 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9212 /* H is the actual vertical distance from the position in *IT
9213 and the starting position. */
9214 h = it2.current_y - it->current_y;
9215 /* NLINES is the distance in number of lines. */
9216 nlines = it2.vpos - it->vpos;
9218 /* Correct IT's y and vpos position
9219 so that they are relative to the starting point. */
9220 it->vpos -= nlines;
9221 it->current_y -= h;
9223 if (dy == 0)
9225 /* DY == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. The
9226 value of nlines is > 0 if continuation lines were involved,
9227 or if the original IT position was at start of a line. */
9228 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9229 if (nlines > 0)
9230 move_it_by_lines (it, nlines);
9231 /* The above code moves us to some position NLINES down,
9232 usually to its first glyph (leftmost in an L2R line), but
9233 that's not necessarily the start of the line, under bidi
9234 reordering. We want to get to the character position
9235 that is immediately after the newline of the previous
9236 line. */
9237 if (it->bidi_p
9238 && !it->continuation_lines_width
9239 && !STRINGP (it->string)
9240 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV
9241 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9243 ptrdiff_t cp = IT_CHARPOS (*it), bp = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
9245 DEC_BOTH (cp, bp);
9246 cp = find_newline_no_quit (cp, bp, -1, NULL);
9247 move_it_to (it, cp, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9249 bidi_unshelve_cache (it3data, 1);
9251 else
9253 /* The y-position we try to reach, relative to *IT.
9254 Note that H has been subtracted in front of the if-statement. */
9255 int target_y = it->current_y + h - dy;
9256 int y0 = it3.current_y;
9257 int y1;
9258 int line_height;
9260 RESTORE_IT (&it3, &it3, it3data);
9261 y1 = line_bottom_y (&it3);
9262 line_height = y1 - y0;
9263 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9264 /* If we did not reach target_y, try to move further backward if
9265 we can. If we moved too far backward, try to move forward. */
9266 if (target_y < it->current_y
9267 /* This is heuristic. In a window that's 3 lines high, with
9268 a line height of 13 pixels each, recentering with point
9269 on the bottom line will try to move -39/2 = 19 pixels
9270 backward. Try to avoid moving into the first line. */
9271 && (it->current_y - target_y
9272 > min (window_box_height (it->w), line_height * 2 / 3))
9273 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9275 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, " not far enough -> move_vert %d\n",
9276 target_y - it->current_y));
9277 dy = it->current_y - target_y;
9278 goto move_further_back;
9280 else if (target_y >= it->current_y + line_height
9281 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
9283 /* Should move forward by at least one line, maybe more.
9285 Note: Calling move_it_by_lines can be expensive on
9286 terminal frames, where compute_motion is used (via
9287 vmotion) to do the job, when there are very long lines
9288 and truncate-lines is nil. That's the reason for
9289 treating terminal frames specially here. */
9291 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9292 move_it_vertically (it, target_y - (it->current_y + line_height));
9293 else
9297 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
9299 while (target_y >= line_bottom_y (it) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV);
9306 /* Move IT by a specified amount of pixel lines DY. DY negative means
9307 move backwards. DY = 0 means move to start of screen line. At the
9308 end, IT will be on the start of a screen line. */
9310 void
9311 move_it_vertically (struct it *it, int dy)
9313 if (dy <= 0)
9314 move_it_vertically_backward (it, -dy);
9315 else
9317 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: from %d, %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it), dy));
9318 move_it_to (it, ZV, -1, it->current_y + dy, -1,
9319 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
9320 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
9322 /* If buffer ends in ZV without a newline, move to the start of
9323 the line to satisfy the post-condition. */
9324 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == ZV
9325 && ZV > BEGV
9326 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9327 move_it_by_lines (it, 0);
9332 /* Move iterator IT past the end of the text line it is in. */
9334 void
9335 move_it_past_eol (struct it *it)
9337 enum move_it_result rc;
9339 rc = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, Z, 0, MOVE_TO_POS);
9340 if (rc == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR)
9341 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
9345 /* Move IT by a specified number DVPOS of screen lines down. DVPOS
9346 negative means move up. DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the
9347 screen line.
9349 Optimization idea: If we would know that IT->f doesn't use
9350 a face with proportional font, we could be faster for
9351 truncate-lines nil. */
9353 void
9354 move_it_by_lines (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t dvpos)
9357 /* The commented-out optimization uses vmotion on terminals. This
9358 gives bad results, because elements like it->what, on which
9359 callers such as pos_visible_p rely, aren't updated. */
9360 /* struct position pos;
9361 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9363 struct text_pos textpos;
9365 pos = *vmotion (IT_CHARPOS (*it), dvpos, it->w);
9366 SET_TEXT_POS (textpos, pos.bufpos, pos.bytepos);
9367 reseat (it, textpos, 1);
9368 it->vpos += pos.vpos;
9369 it->current_y += pos.vpos;
9371 else */
9373 if (dvpos == 0)
9375 /* DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. */
9376 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9377 /* Let next call to line_bottom_y calculate real line height. */
9378 last_height = 0;
9380 else if (dvpos > 0)
9382 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + dvpos, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9383 if (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9385 /* Only move to the next buffer position if we ended up in a
9386 string from display property, not in an overlay string
9387 (before-string or after-string). That is because the
9388 latter don't conceal the underlying buffer position, so
9389 we can ask to move the iterator to the exact position we
9390 are interested in. Note that, even if we are already at
9391 IT_CHARPOS (*it), the call below is not a no-op, as it
9392 will detect that we are at the end of the string, pop the
9393 iterator, and compute it->current_x and it->hpos
9394 correctly. */
9395 move_it_to (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it) + it->string_from_display_prop_p,
9396 -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9399 else
9401 struct it it2;
9402 void *it2data = NULL;
9403 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, i;
9404 int nchars_per_row
9405 = (it->last_visible_x - it->first_visible_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
9406 ptrdiff_t pos_limit;
9408 /* Start at the beginning of the screen line containing IT's
9409 position. This may actually move vertically backwards,
9410 in case of overlays, so adjust dvpos accordingly. */
9411 dvpos += it->vpos;
9412 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9413 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9415 /* Go back -DVPOS buffer lines, but no farther than -DVPOS full
9416 screen lines, and reseat the iterator there. */
9417 start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9418 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
9419 pos_limit = BEGV;
9420 else
9421 pos_limit = max (start_charpos + dvpos * nchars_per_row, BEGV);
9422 for (i = -dvpos; i > 0 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > pos_limit; --i)
9423 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9424 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9426 /* Move further back if we end up in a string or an image. */
9427 while (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9429 /* First try to move to start of display line. */
9430 dvpos += it->vpos;
9431 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9432 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9433 if (IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9434 break;
9435 /* If start of line is still in string or image,
9436 move further back. */
9437 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9438 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9439 dvpos--;
9442 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9444 /* Above call may have moved too far if continuation lines
9445 are involved. Scan forward and see if it did. */
9446 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9447 it2.vpos = it2.current_y = 0;
9448 move_it_to (&it2, start_charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9449 it->vpos -= it2.vpos;
9450 it->current_y -= it2.current_y;
9451 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9453 /* If we moved too far back, move IT some lines forward. */
9454 if (it2.vpos > -dvpos)
9456 int delta = it2.vpos + dvpos;
9458 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
9459 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9460 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + delta, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9461 /* Move back again if we got too far ahead. */
9462 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= start_charpos)
9463 RESTORE_IT (it, &it2, it2data);
9464 else
9465 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
9467 else
9468 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9472 /* Return true if IT points into the middle of a display vector. */
9474 bool
9475 in_display_vector_p (struct it *it)
9477 return (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
9478 && it->current.dpvec_index > 0
9479 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index != it->dpend);
9482 DEFUN ("window-text-pixel-size", Fwindow_text_pixel_size, Swindow_text_pixel_size, 0, 6, 0,
9483 doc: /* Return the size of the text of WINDOW's buffer in pixels.
9484 WINDOW must be a live window and defaults to the selected one. The
9485 return value is a cons of the maximum pixel-width of any text line and
9486 the maximum pixel-height of all text lines.
9488 The optional argument FROM, if non-nil, specifies the first text
9489 position and defaults to the minimum accessible position of the buffer.
9490 If FROM is t, use the minimum accessible position that is not a newline
9491 character. TO, if non-nil, specifies the last text position and
9492 defaults to the maximum accessible position of the buffer. If TO is t,
9493 use the maximum accessible position that is not a newline character.
9495 The optional argument X_LIMIT, if non-nil, specifies the maximum text
9496 width that can be returned. X_LIMIT nil or omitted, means to use the
9497 pixel-width of WINDOW's body; use this if you do not intend to change
9498 the width of WINDOW. Use the maximum width WINDOW may assume if you
9499 intend to change WINDOW's width.
9501 The optional argument Y_LIMIT, if non-nil, specifies the maximum text
9502 height that can be returned. Text lines whose y-coordinate is beyond
9503 Y_LIMIT are ignored. Since calculating the text height of a large
9504 buffer can take some time, it makes sense to specify this argument if
9505 the size of the buffer is unknown.
9507 Optional argument MODE_AND_HEADER_LINE nil or omitted means do not
9508 include the height of the mode- or header-line of WINDOW in the return
9509 value. If it is either the symbol `mode-line' or `header-line', include
9510 only the height of that line, if present, in the return value. If t,
9511 include the height of any of these lines in the return value. */)
9512 (Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object from, Lisp_Object to, Lisp_Object x_limit, Lisp_Object y_limit,
9513 Lisp_Object mode_and_header_line)
9515 struct window *w = decode_live_window (window);
9516 Lisp_Object buf;
9517 struct buffer *b;
9518 struct it it;
9519 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
9520 ptrdiff_t start, end, pos;
9521 struct text_pos startp;
9522 void *itdata = NULL;
9523 int c, max_y = -1, x = 0, y = 0;
9525 buf = w->contents;
9526 CHECK_BUFFER (buf);
9527 b = XBUFFER (buf);
9529 if (b != current_buffer)
9531 old_buffer = current_buffer;
9532 set_buffer_internal (b);
9535 if (NILP (from))
9536 start = BEGV;
9537 else if (EQ (from, Qt))
9539 start = pos = BEGV;
9540 while ((pos++ < ZV) && (c = FETCH_CHAR (pos))
9541 && (c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\n' || c == '\r'))
9542 start = pos;
9543 while ((pos-- > BEGV) && (c = FETCH_CHAR (pos)) && (c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
9544 start = pos;
9546 else
9548 CHECK_NUMBER_COERCE_MARKER (from);
9549 start = min (max (XINT (from), BEGV), ZV);
9552 if (NILP (to))
9553 end = ZV;
9554 else if (EQ (to, Qt))
9556 end = pos = ZV;
9557 while ((pos-- > BEGV) && (c = FETCH_CHAR (pos))
9558 && (c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\n' || c == '\r'))
9559 end = pos;
9560 while ((pos++ < ZV) && (c = FETCH_CHAR (pos)) && (c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
9561 end = pos;
9563 else
9565 CHECK_NUMBER_COERCE_MARKER (to);
9566 end = max (start, min (XINT (to), ZV));
9569 if (!NILP (y_limit))
9571 CHECK_NUMBER (y_limit);
9572 max_y = min (XINT (y_limit), INT_MAX);
9575 itdata = bidi_shelve_cache ();
9576 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, start, CHAR_TO_BYTE (start));
9577 start_display (&it, w, startp);
9579 /** move_it_vertically_backward (&it, 0); **/
9580 if (NILP (x_limit))
9581 x = move_it_to (&it, end, -1, max_y, -1, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
9582 else
9584 CHECK_NUMBER (x_limit);
9585 it.last_visible_x = min (XINT (x_limit), INFINITY);
9586 /* Actually, we never want move_it_to stop at to_x. But to make
9587 sure that move_it_in_display_line_to always moves far enough,
9588 we set it to INT_MAX and specify MOVE_TO_X. */
9589 x = move_it_to (&it, end, INT_MAX, max_y, -1,
9590 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
9593 if (start == end)
9594 y = it.current_y;
9595 else
9597 /* Count last line. */
9598 last_height = 0;
9599 y = line_bottom_y (&it); /* - y; */
9602 if (!EQ (mode_and_header_line, Qheader_line)
9603 && !EQ (mode_and_header_line, Qt))
9604 /* Do not count the header-line which was counted automatically by
9605 start_display. */
9606 y = y - WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
9608 if (EQ (mode_and_header_line, Qmode_line)
9609 || EQ (mode_and_header_line, Qt))
9610 /* Do count the mode-line which is not included automatically by
9611 start_display. */
9612 y = y + WINDOW_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
9614 bidi_unshelve_cache (itdata, 0);
9616 if (old_buffer)
9617 set_buffer_internal (old_buffer);
9619 return Fcons (make_number (x), make_number (y));
9622 /***********************************************************************
9623 Messages
9624 ***********************************************************************/
9627 /* Add a message with format string FORMAT and arguments ARG1 and ARG2
9628 to *Messages*. */
9630 void
9631 add_to_log (const char *format, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
9633 Lisp_Object args[3];
9634 Lisp_Object msg, fmt;
9635 char *buffer;
9636 ptrdiff_t len;
9637 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3, gcpro4;
9638 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9640 fmt = msg = Qnil;
9641 GCPRO4 (fmt, msg, arg1, arg2);
9643 args[0] = fmt = build_string (format);
9644 args[1] = arg1;
9645 args[2] = arg2;
9646 msg = Fformat (3, args);
9648 len = SBYTES (msg) + 1;
9649 buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (len);
9650 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (msg), len);
9652 message_dolog (buffer, len - 1, 1, 0);
9653 SAFE_FREE ();
9655 UNGCPRO;
9659 /* Output a newline in the *Messages* buffer if "needs" one. */
9661 void
9662 message_log_maybe_newline (void)
9664 if (message_log_need_newline)
9665 message_dolog ("", 0, 1, 0);
9669 /* Add a string M of length NBYTES to the message log, optionally
9670 terminated with a newline when NLFLAG is true. MULTIBYTE, if
9671 true, means interpret the contents of M as multibyte. This
9672 function calls low-level routines in order to bypass text property
9673 hooks, etc. which might not be safe to run.
9675 This may GC (insert may run before/after change hooks),
9676 so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9678 void
9679 message_dolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, bool nlflag, bool multibyte)
9681 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) m;
9683 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
9684 return;
9686 if (!NILP (Vmessage_log_max))
9688 struct buffer *oldbuf;
9689 Lisp_Object oldpoint, oldbegv, oldzv;
9690 int old_windows_or_buffers_changed = windows_or_buffers_changed;
9691 ptrdiff_t point_at_end = 0;
9692 ptrdiff_t zv_at_end = 0;
9693 Lisp_Object old_deactivate_mark;
9694 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9696 old_deactivate_mark = Vdeactivate_mark;
9697 oldbuf = current_buffer;
9699 /* Ensure the Messages buffer exists, and switch to it.
9700 If we created it, set the major-mode. */
9702 int newbuffer = 0;
9703 if (NILP (Fget_buffer (Vmessages_buffer_name))) newbuffer = 1;
9705 Fset_buffer (Fget_buffer_create (Vmessages_buffer_name));
9707 if (newbuffer
9708 && !NILP (Ffboundp (intern ("messages-buffer-mode"))))
9709 call0 (intern ("messages-buffer-mode"));
9712 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
9713 bset_cache_long_scans (current_buffer, Qnil);
9715 oldpoint = message_dolog_marker1;
9716 set_marker_restricted_both (oldpoint, Qnil, PT, PT_BYTE);
9717 oldbegv = message_dolog_marker2;
9718 set_marker_restricted_both (oldbegv, Qnil, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
9719 oldzv = message_dolog_marker3;
9720 set_marker_restricted_both (oldzv, Qnil, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
9721 GCPRO1 (old_deactivate_mark);
9723 if (PT == Z)
9724 point_at_end = 1;
9725 if (ZV == Z)
9726 zv_at_end = 1;
9728 BEGV = BEG;
9729 BEGV_BYTE = BEG_BYTE;
9730 ZV = Z;
9731 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9732 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9734 /* Insert the string--maybe converting multibyte to single byte
9735 or vice versa, so that all the text fits the buffer. */
9736 if (multibyte
9737 && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9739 ptrdiff_t i;
9740 int c, char_bytes;
9741 char work[1];
9743 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte
9744 for the *Message* buffer. */
9745 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += char_bytes)
9747 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &char_bytes);
9748 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
9750 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
9751 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
9754 else if (! multibyte
9755 && ! NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9757 ptrdiff_t i;
9758 int c, char_bytes;
9759 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
9760 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte
9761 for the *Message* buffer. */
9762 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
9764 c = msg[i];
9765 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
9766 char_bytes = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
9767 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, char_bytes, 1, 0, 0);
9770 else if (nbytes)
9771 insert_1_both (m, chars_in_text (msg, nbytes), nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
9773 if (nlflag)
9775 ptrdiff_t this_bol, this_bol_byte, prev_bol, prev_bol_byte;
9776 printmax_t dups;
9778 insert_1_both ("\n", 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
9780 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9781 this_bol = PT;
9782 this_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9784 /* See if this line duplicates the previous one.
9785 If so, combine duplicates. */
9786 if (this_bol > BEG)
9788 scan_newline (PT, PT_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9789 prev_bol = PT;
9790 prev_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9792 dups = message_log_check_duplicate (prev_bol_byte,
9793 this_bol_byte);
9794 if (dups)
9796 del_range_both (prev_bol, prev_bol_byte,
9797 this_bol, this_bol_byte, 0);
9798 if (dups > 1)
9800 char dupstr[sizeof " [ times]"
9801 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (printmax_t)];
9803 /* If you change this format, don't forget to also
9804 change message_log_check_duplicate. */
9805 int duplen = sprintf (dupstr, " [%"pMd" times]", dups);
9806 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z - 1, Z_BYTE - 1);
9807 insert_1_both (dupstr, duplen, duplen, 1, 0, 1);
9812 /* If we have more than the desired maximum number of lines
9813 in the *Messages* buffer now, delete the oldest ones.
9814 This is safe because we don't have undo in this buffer. */
9816 if (NATNUMP (Vmessage_log_max))
9818 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE,
9819 -XFASTINT (Vmessage_log_max) - 1, 0);
9820 del_range_both (BEG, BEG_BYTE, PT, PT_BYTE, 0);
9823 BEGV = marker_position (oldbegv);
9824 BEGV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldbegv);
9826 if (zv_at_end)
9828 ZV = Z;
9829 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9831 else
9833 ZV = marker_position (oldzv);
9834 ZV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldzv);
9837 if (point_at_end)
9838 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9839 else
9840 /* We can't do Fgoto_char (oldpoint) because it will run some
9841 Lisp code. */
9842 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (marker_position (oldpoint),
9843 marker_byte_position (oldpoint));
9845 UNGCPRO;
9846 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldpoint));
9847 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldbegv));
9848 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldzv));
9850 /* We called insert_1_both above with its 5th argument (PREPARE)
9851 zero, which prevents insert_1_both from calling
9852 prepare_to_modify_buffer, which in turns prevents us from
9853 incrementing windows_or_buffers_changed even if *Messages* is
9854 shown in some window. So we must manually set
9855 windows_or_buffers_changed here to make up for that. */
9856 windows_or_buffers_changed = old_windows_or_buffers_changed;
9857 bset_redisplay (current_buffer);
9859 set_buffer_internal (oldbuf);
9861 message_log_need_newline = !nlflag;
9862 Vdeactivate_mark = old_deactivate_mark;
9867 /* We are at the end of the buffer after just having inserted a newline.
9868 (Note: We depend on the fact we won't be crossing the gap.)
9869 Check to see if the most recent message looks a lot like the previous one.
9870 Return 0 if different, 1 if the new one should just replace it, or a
9871 value N > 1 if we should also append " [N times]". */
9873 static intmax_t
9874 message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t prev_bol_byte, ptrdiff_t this_bol_byte)
9876 ptrdiff_t i;
9877 ptrdiff_t len = Z_BYTE - 1 - this_bol_byte;
9878 int seen_dots = 0;
9879 unsigned char *p1 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, prev_bol_byte);
9880 unsigned char *p2 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, this_bol_byte);
9882 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9884 if (i >= 3 && p1[i - 3] == '.' && p1[i - 2] == '.' && p1[i - 1] == '.')
9885 seen_dots = 1;
9886 if (p1[i] != p2[i])
9887 return seen_dots;
9889 p1 += len;
9890 if (*p1 == '\n')
9891 return 2;
9892 if (*p1++ == ' ' && *p1++ == '[')
9894 char *pend;
9895 intmax_t n = strtoimax ((char *) p1, &pend, 10);
9896 if (0 < n && n < INTMAX_MAX && strncmp (pend, " times]\n", 8) == 0)
9897 return n + 1;
9899 return 0;
9903 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9904 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is not a
9905 string, clear out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer
9906 text show through.
9908 This function cancels echoing. */
9910 void
9911 message3 (Lisp_Object m)
9913 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9915 GCPRO1 (m);
9916 clear_message (true, true);
9917 cancel_echoing ();
9919 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9920 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9921 if (STRINGP (m))
9923 ptrdiff_t nbytes = SBYTES (m);
9924 bool multibyte = STRING_MULTIBYTE (m);
9925 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9926 char *buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (nbytes);
9927 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (m), nbytes);
9928 message_dolog (buffer, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9929 SAFE_FREE ();
9931 message3_nolog (m);
9933 UNGCPRO;
9937 /* The non-logging version of message3.
9938 This does not cancel echoing, because it is used for echoing.
9939 Perhaps we need to make a separate function for echoing
9940 and make this cancel echoing. */
9942 void
9943 message3_nolog (Lisp_Object m)
9945 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9947 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9949 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9950 putc ('\n', stderr);
9951 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9952 if (STRINGP (m))
9954 Lisp_Object s = ENCODE_SYSTEM (m);
9956 fwrite (SDATA (s), SBYTES (s), 1, stderr);
9958 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9959 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9960 fflush (stderr);
9962 /* Error messages get reported properly by cmd_error, so this must be just an
9963 informative message; if the frame hasn't really been initialized yet, just
9964 toss it. */
9965 else if (INTERACTIVE && sf->glyphs_initialized_p)
9967 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9968 that the selected frame is using. */
9969 Lisp_Object mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9970 Lisp_Object frame = XWINDOW (mini_window)->frame;
9971 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
9973 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9974 Fmake_frame_visible (frame);
9976 if (STRINGP (m) && SCHARS (m) > 0)
9978 set_message (m);
9979 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9980 Fraise_frame (frame);
9981 /* Assume we are not echoing.
9982 (If we are, echo_now will override this.) */
9983 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
9985 else
9986 clear_message (true, true);
9988 do_pending_window_change (0);
9989 echo_area_display (1);
9990 do_pending_window_change (0);
9991 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
9992 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9997 /* Display a null-terminated echo area message M. If M is 0, clear
9998 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through.
10000 The buffer M must continue to exist until after the echo area gets
10001 cleared or some other message gets displayed there. Do not pass
10002 text that is stored in a Lisp string. Do not pass text in a buffer
10003 that was alloca'd. */
10005 void
10006 message1 (const char *m)
10008 message3 (m ? build_unibyte_string (m) : Qnil);
10012 /* The non-logging counterpart of message1. */
10014 void
10015 message1_nolog (const char *m)
10017 message3_nolog (m ? build_unibyte_string (m) : Qnil);
10020 /* Display a message M which contains a single %s
10021 which gets replaced with STRING. */
10023 void
10024 message_with_string (const char *m, Lisp_Object string, int log)
10026 CHECK_STRING (string);
10028 if (noninteractive)
10030 if (m)
10032 /* ENCODE_SYSTEM below can GC and/or relocate the Lisp
10033 String whose data pointer might be passed to us in M. So
10034 we use a local copy. */
10035 char *fmt = xstrdup (m);
10037 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
10038 putc ('\n', stderr);
10039 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
10040 fprintf (stderr, fmt, SDATA (ENCODE_SYSTEM (string)));
10041 if (!cursor_in_echo_area)
10042 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
10043 fflush (stderr);
10044 xfree (fmt);
10047 else if (INTERACTIVE)
10049 /* The frame whose minibuffer we're going to display the message on.
10050 It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need
10051 to use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
10052 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10053 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10055 /* Get the frame containing the minibuffer
10056 that the selected frame is using. */
10057 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10058 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
10060 /* Error messages get reported properly by cmd_error, so this must be
10061 just an informative message; if the frame hasn't really been
10062 initialized yet, just toss it. */
10063 if (f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10065 Lisp_Object args[2], msg;
10066 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10068 args[0] = build_string (m);
10069 args[1] = msg = string;
10070 GCPRO2 (args[0], msg);
10071 gcpro1.nvars = 2;
10073 msg = Fformat (2, args);
10075 if (log)
10076 message3 (msg);
10077 else
10078 message3_nolog (msg);
10080 UNGCPRO;
10082 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
10083 buffer next time. */
10084 message_buf_print = 0;
10090 /* Dump an informative message to the minibuf. If M is 0, clear out
10091 any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through. */
10093 static void
10094 vmessage (const char *m, va_list ap)
10096 if (noninteractive)
10098 if (m)
10100 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
10101 putc ('\n', stderr);
10102 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
10103 vfprintf (stderr, m, ap);
10104 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
10105 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
10106 fflush (stderr);
10109 else if (INTERACTIVE)
10111 /* The frame whose mini-buffer we're going to display the message
10112 on. It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need to
10113 use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
10114 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10115 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10117 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
10118 that the selected frame is using. */
10119 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10120 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
10122 /* Error messages get reported properly by cmd_error, so this must be
10123 just an informative message; if the frame hasn't really been
10124 initialized yet, just toss it. */
10125 if (f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10127 if (m)
10129 ptrdiff_t len;
10130 ptrdiff_t maxsize = FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f);
10131 char *message_buf = alloca (maxsize + 1);
10133 len = doprnt (message_buf, maxsize, m, 0, ap);
10135 message3 (make_string (message_buf, len));
10137 else
10138 message1 (0);
10140 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
10141 buffer next time. */
10142 message_buf_print = 0;
10147 void
10148 message (const char *m, ...)
10150 va_list ap;
10151 va_start (ap, m);
10152 vmessage (m, ap);
10153 va_end (ap);
10157 #if 0
10158 /* The non-logging version of message. */
10160 void
10161 message_nolog (const char *m, ...)
10163 Lisp_Object old_log_max;
10164 va_list ap;
10165 va_start (ap, m);
10166 old_log_max = Vmessage_log_max;
10167 Vmessage_log_max = Qnil;
10168 vmessage (m, ap);
10169 Vmessage_log_max = old_log_max;
10170 va_end (ap);
10172 #endif
10175 /* Display the current message in the current mini-buffer. This is
10176 only called from error handlers in process.c, and is not time
10177 critical. */
10179 void
10180 update_echo_area (void)
10182 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10184 Lisp_Object string;
10185 string = Fcurrent_message ();
10186 message3 (string);
10191 /* Make sure echo area buffers in `echo_buffers' are live.
10192 If they aren't, make new ones. */
10194 static void
10195 ensure_echo_area_buffers (void)
10197 int i;
10199 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
10200 if (!BUFFERP (echo_buffer[i])
10201 || !BUFFER_LIVE_P (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])))
10203 char name[30];
10204 Lisp_Object old_buffer;
10205 int j;
10207 old_buffer = echo_buffer[i];
10208 echo_buffer[i] = Fget_buffer_create
10209 (make_formatted_string (name, " *Echo Area %d*", i));
10210 bset_truncate_lines (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), Qnil);
10211 /* to force word wrap in echo area -
10212 it was decided to postpone this*/
10213 /* XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])->word_wrap = Qt; */
10215 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
10216 if (EQ (old_buffer, echo_area_buffer[j]))
10217 echo_area_buffer[j] = echo_buffer[i];
10222 /* Call FN with args A1..A2 with either the current or last displayed
10223 echo_area_buffer as current buffer.
10225 WHICH zero means use the current message buffer
10226 echo_area_buffer[0]. If that is nil, choose a suitable buffer
10227 from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
10229 WHICH > 0 means use echo_area_buffer[1]. If that is nil, choose a
10230 suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
10232 If WHICH < 0, set echo_area_buffer[1] to echo_area_buffer[0], so
10233 that the current message becomes the last displayed one, make
10234 choose a suitable buffer for echo_area_buffer[0], and clear it.
10236 Value is what FN returns. */
10238 static int
10239 with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *w, int which,
10240 int (*fn) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object),
10241 ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2)
10243 Lisp_Object buffer;
10244 int this_one, the_other, clear_buffer_p, rc;
10245 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10247 /* If buffers aren't live, make new ones. */
10248 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
10250 clear_buffer_p = 0;
10252 if (which == 0)
10253 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
10254 else if (which > 0)
10255 this_one = 1, the_other = 0;
10256 else
10258 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
10259 clear_buffer_p = true;
10261 /* We need a fresh one in case the current echo buffer equals
10262 the one containing the last displayed echo area message. */
10263 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one])
10264 && EQ (echo_area_buffer[this_one], echo_area_buffer[the_other]))
10265 echo_area_buffer[this_one] = Qnil;
10268 /* Choose a suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] is we don't
10269 have one. */
10270 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one]))
10272 echo_area_buffer[this_one]
10273 = (EQ (echo_area_buffer[the_other], echo_buffer[this_one])
10274 ? echo_buffer[the_other]
10275 : echo_buffer[this_one]);
10276 clear_buffer_p = true;
10279 buffer = echo_area_buffer[this_one];
10281 /* Don't get confused by reusing the buffer used for echoing
10282 for a different purpose. */
10283 if (echo_kboard == NULL && EQ (buffer, echo_message_buffer))
10284 cancel_echoing ();
10286 record_unwind_protect (unwind_with_echo_area_buffer,
10287 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (w));
10289 /* Make the echo area buffer current. Note that for display
10290 purposes, it is not necessary that the displayed window's buffer
10291 == current_buffer, except for text property lookup. So, let's
10292 only set that buffer temporarily here without doing a full
10293 Fset_window_buffer. We must also change w->pointm, though,
10294 because otherwise an assertions in unshow_buffer fails, and Emacs
10295 aborts. */
10296 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
10297 if (w)
10299 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10300 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer, BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10303 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
10304 bset_read_only (current_buffer, Qnil);
10305 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10306 specbind (Qinhibit_modification_hooks, Qt);
10308 if (clear_buffer_p && Z > BEG)
10309 del_range (BEG, Z);
10311 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10312 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10314 rc = fn (a1, a2);
10316 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10317 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10319 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10320 return rc;
10324 /* Save state that should be preserved around the call to the function
10325 FN called in with_echo_area_buffer. */
10327 static Lisp_Object
10328 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *w)
10330 int i = 0;
10331 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10333 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10334 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10335 vector = Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
10336 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
10338 if (NILP (vector))
10339 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (9), Qnil);
10341 XSETBUFFER (tmp, current_buffer); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10342 ASET (vector, i, Vdeactivate_mark); ++i;
10343 ASET (vector, i, make_number (windows_or_buffers_changed)); ++i;
10345 if (w)
10347 XSETWINDOW (tmp, w); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10348 ASET (vector, i, w->contents); ++i;
10349 ASET (vector, i, make_number (marker_position (w->pointm))); ++i;
10350 ASET (vector, i, make_number (marker_byte_position (w->pointm))); ++i;
10351 ASET (vector, i, make_number (marker_position (w->start))); ++i;
10352 ASET (vector, i, make_number (marker_byte_position (w->start))); ++i;
10354 else
10356 int end = i + 6;
10357 for (; i < end; ++i)
10358 ASET (vector, i, Qnil);
10361 eassert (i == ASIZE (vector));
10362 return vector;
10366 /* Restore global state from VECTOR which was created by
10367 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data. */
10369 static void
10370 unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object vector)
10372 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 0)));
10373 Vdeactivate_mark = AREF (vector, 1);
10374 windows_or_buffers_changed = XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 2));
10376 if (WINDOWP (AREF (vector, 3)))
10378 struct window *w;
10379 Lisp_Object buffer;
10381 w = XWINDOW (AREF (vector, 3));
10382 buffer = AREF (vector, 4);
10384 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10385 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer,
10386 XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 5)),
10387 XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 6)));
10388 set_marker_both (w->start, buffer,
10389 XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 7)),
10390 XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 8)));
10393 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = vector;
10397 /* Set up the echo area for use by print functions. MULTIBYTE_P
10398 non-zero means we will print multibyte. */
10400 void
10401 setup_echo_area_for_printing (int multibyte_p)
10403 /* If we can't find an echo area any more, exit. */
10404 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10405 Fkill_emacs (Qnil);
10407 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
10409 if (!message_buf_print)
10411 /* A message has been output since the last time we printed.
10412 Choose a fresh echo area buffer. */
10413 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10414 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10415 else
10416 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10418 /* Switch to that buffer and clear it. */
10419 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10420 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10422 if (Z > BEG)
10424 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10425 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10426 /* Note that undo recording is always disabled. */
10427 del_range (BEG, Z);
10428 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10430 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10432 /* Set up the buffer for the multibyteness we need. */
10433 if (multibyte_p
10434 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10435 Fset_buffer_multibyte (multibyte_p ? Qt : Qnil);
10437 /* Raise the frame containing the echo area. */
10438 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
10440 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10441 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10442 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10443 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
10446 message_log_maybe_newline ();
10447 message_buf_print = 1;
10449 else
10451 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10453 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10454 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10455 else
10456 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10459 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10461 /* Someone switched buffers between print requests. */
10462 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10463 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10469 /* Display an echo area message in window W. Value is non-zero if W's
10470 height is changed. If display_last_displayed_message_p is
10471 non-zero, display the message that was last displayed, otherwise
10472 display the current message. */
10474 static int
10475 display_echo_area (struct window *w)
10477 int i, no_message_p, window_height_changed_p;
10479 /* Temporarily disable garbage collections while displaying the echo
10480 area. This is done because a GC can print a message itself.
10481 That message would modify the echo area buffer's contents while a
10482 redisplay of the buffer is going on, and seriously confuse
10483 redisplay. */
10484 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
10486 /* If there is no message, we must call display_echo_area_1
10487 nevertheless because it resizes the window. But we will have to
10488 reset the echo_area_buffer in question to nil at the end because
10489 with_echo_area_buffer will sets it to an empty buffer. */
10490 i = display_last_displayed_message_p ? 1 : 0;
10491 no_message_p = NILP (echo_area_buffer[i]);
10493 window_height_changed_p
10494 = with_echo_area_buffer (w, display_last_displayed_message_p,
10495 display_echo_area_1,
10496 (intptr_t) w, Qnil);
10498 if (no_message_p)
10499 echo_area_buffer[i] = Qnil;
10501 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10502 return window_height_changed_p;
10506 /* Helper for display_echo_area. Display the current buffer which
10507 contains the current echo area message in window W, a mini-window,
10508 a pointer to which is passed in A1. A2..A4 are currently not used.
10509 Change the height of W so that all of the message is displayed.
10510 Value is non-zero if height of W was changed. */
10512 static int
10513 display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2)
10515 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10516 struct window *w = (struct window *) i1;
10517 Lisp_Object window;
10518 struct text_pos start;
10519 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10521 /* Do this before displaying, so that we have a large enough glyph
10522 matrix for the display. If we can't get enough space for the
10523 whole text, display the last N lines. That works by setting w->start. */
10524 window_height_changed_p = resize_mini_window (w, 0);
10526 /* Use the starting position chosen by resize_mini_window. */
10527 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
10529 /* Display. */
10530 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
10531 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
10532 try_window (window, start, 0);
10534 return window_height_changed_p;
10538 /* Resize the echo area window to exactly the size needed for the
10539 currently displayed message, if there is one. If a mini-buffer
10540 is active, don't shrink it. */
10542 void
10543 resize_echo_area_exactly (void)
10545 if (BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0])
10546 && WINDOWP (echo_area_window))
10548 struct window *w = XWINDOW (echo_area_window);
10549 Lisp_Object resize_exactly = (minibuf_level == 0 ? Qt : Qnil);
10550 int resized_p = with_echo_area_buffer (w, 0, resize_mini_window_1,
10551 (intptr_t) w, resize_exactly);
10552 if (resized_p)
10554 windows_or_buffers_changed = 42;
10555 update_mode_lines = 30;
10556 redisplay_internal ();
10562 /* Callback function for with_echo_area_buffer, when used from
10563 resize_echo_area_exactly. A1 contains a pointer to the window to
10564 resize, EXACTLY non-nil means resize the mini-window exactly to the
10565 size of the text displayed. A3 and A4 are not used. Value is what
10566 resize_mini_window returns. */
10568 static int
10569 resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object exactly)
10571 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10572 return resize_mini_window ((struct window *) i1, !NILP (exactly));
10576 /* Resize mini-window W to fit the size of its contents. EXACT_P
10577 means size the window exactly to the size needed. Otherwise, it's
10578 only enlarged until W's buffer is empty.
10580 Set W->start to the right place to begin display. If the whole
10581 contents fit, start at the beginning. Otherwise, start so as
10582 to make the end of the contents appear. This is particularly
10583 important for y-or-n-p, but seems desirable generally.
10585 Value is non-zero if the window height has been changed. */
10588 resize_mini_window (struct window *w, int exact_p)
10590 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10591 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10593 eassert (MINI_WINDOW_P (w));
10595 /* By default, start display at the beginning. */
10596 set_marker_both (w->start, w->contents,
10597 BUF_BEGV (XBUFFER (w->contents)),
10598 BUF_BEGV_BYTE (XBUFFER (w->contents)));
10600 /* Don't resize windows while redisplaying a window; it would
10601 confuse redisplay functions when the size of the window they are
10602 displaying changes from under them. Such a resizing can happen,
10603 for instance, when which-func prints a long message while
10604 we are running fontification-functions. We're running these
10605 functions with safe_call which binds inhibit-redisplay to t. */
10606 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
10607 return 0;
10609 /* Nil means don't try to resize. */
10610 if (NILP (Vresize_mini_windows)
10611 || (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f) == NULL))
10612 return 0;
10614 if (!FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f))
10616 struct it it;
10617 int total_height = (WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)))
10618 + WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w));
10619 int unit = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10620 int height, max_height;
10621 struct text_pos start;
10622 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = NULL;
10624 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->contents))
10626 old_current_buffer = current_buffer;
10627 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->contents));
10630 init_iterator (&it, w, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10632 /* Compute the max. number of lines specified by the user. */
10633 if (FLOATP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10634 max_height = XFLOATINT (Vmax_mini_window_height) * total_height;
10635 else if (INTEGERP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10636 max_height = XINT (Vmax_mini_window_height) * unit;
10637 else
10638 max_height = total_height / 4;
10640 /* Correct that max. height if it's bogus. */
10641 max_height = clip_to_bounds (unit, max_height, total_height);
10643 /* Find out the height of the text in the window. */
10644 if (it.line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
10645 height = unit;
10646 else
10648 last_height = 0;
10649 move_it_to (&it, ZV, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
10650 if (it.max_ascent == 0 && it.max_descent == 0)
10651 height = it.current_y + last_height;
10652 else
10653 height = it.current_y + it.max_ascent + it.max_descent;
10654 height -= min (it.extra_line_spacing, it.max_extra_line_spacing);
10657 /* Compute a suitable window start. */
10658 if (height > max_height)
10660 height = max_height;
10661 init_iterator (&it, w, ZV, ZV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10662 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, height);
10663 start = it.current.pos;
10665 else
10666 SET_TEXT_POS (start, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
10667 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, start);
10669 if (EQ (Vresize_mini_windows, Qgrow_only))
10671 /* Let it grow only, until we display an empty message, in which
10672 case the window shrinks again. */
10673 if (height > WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w))
10675 int old_height = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w);
10677 FRAME_WINDOWS_FROZEN (f) = 1;
10678 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w), 1);
10679 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w) != old_height;
10681 else if (height < WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w)
10682 && (exact_p || BEGV == ZV))
10684 int old_height = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w);
10686 FRAME_WINDOWS_FROZEN (f) = 0;
10687 shrink_mini_window (w, 1);
10688 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w) != old_height;
10691 else
10693 /* Always resize to exact size needed. */
10694 if (height > WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w))
10696 int old_height = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w);
10698 FRAME_WINDOWS_FROZEN (f) = 1;
10699 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w), 1);
10700 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w) != old_height;
10702 else if (height < WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w))
10704 int old_height = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w);
10706 FRAME_WINDOWS_FROZEN (f) = 0;
10707 shrink_mini_window (w, 1);
10709 if (height)
10711 FRAME_WINDOWS_FROZEN (f) = 1;
10712 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w), 1);
10715 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w) != old_height;
10719 if (old_current_buffer)
10720 set_buffer_internal (old_current_buffer);
10723 return window_height_changed_p;
10727 /* Value is the current message, a string, or nil if there is no
10728 current message. */
10730 Lisp_Object
10731 current_message (void)
10733 Lisp_Object msg;
10735 if (!BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10736 msg = Qnil;
10737 else
10739 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, current_message_1,
10740 (intptr_t) &msg, Qnil);
10741 if (NILP (msg))
10742 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10745 return msg;
10749 static int
10750 current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2)
10752 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10753 Lisp_Object *msg = (Lisp_Object *) i1;
10755 if (Z > BEG)
10756 *msg = make_buffer_string (BEG, Z, 1);
10757 else
10758 *msg = Qnil;
10759 return 0;
10763 /* Push the current message on Vmessage_stack for later restoration
10764 by restore_message. Value is non-zero if the current message isn't
10765 empty. This is a relatively infrequent operation, so it's not
10766 worth optimizing. */
10768 bool
10769 push_message (void)
10771 Lisp_Object msg = current_message ();
10772 Vmessage_stack = Fcons (msg, Vmessage_stack);
10773 return STRINGP (msg);
10777 /* Restore message display from the top of Vmessage_stack. */
10779 void
10780 restore_message (void)
10782 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10783 message3_nolog (XCAR (Vmessage_stack));
10787 /* Handler for unwind-protect calling pop_message. */
10789 void
10790 pop_message_unwind (void)
10792 /* Pop the top-most entry off Vmessage_stack. */
10793 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10794 Vmessage_stack = XCDR (Vmessage_stack);
10798 /* Check that Vmessage_stack is nil. Called from emacs.c when Emacs
10799 exits. If the stack is not empty, we have a missing pop_message
10800 somewhere. */
10802 void
10803 check_message_stack (void)
10805 if (!NILP (Vmessage_stack))
10806 emacs_abort ();
10810 /* Truncate to NCHARS what will be displayed in the echo area the next
10811 time we display it---but don't redisplay it now. */
10813 void
10814 truncate_echo_area (ptrdiff_t nchars)
10816 if (nchars == 0)
10817 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10818 else if (!noninteractive
10819 && INTERACTIVE
10820 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10822 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10823 /* Error messages get reported properly by cmd_error, so this must be
10824 just an informative message; if the frame hasn't really been
10825 initialized yet, just toss it. */
10826 if (sf->glyphs_initialized_p)
10827 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, truncate_message_1, nchars, Qnil);
10832 /* Helper function for truncate_echo_area. Truncate the current
10833 message to at most NCHARS characters. */
10835 static int
10836 truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t nchars, Lisp_Object a2)
10838 if (BEG + nchars < Z)
10839 del_range (BEG + nchars, Z);
10840 if (Z == BEG)
10841 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10842 return 0;
10845 /* Set the current message to STRING. */
10847 static void
10848 set_message (Lisp_Object string)
10850 eassert (STRINGP (string));
10852 message_enable_multibyte = STRING_MULTIBYTE (string);
10854 with_echo_area_buffer (0, -1, set_message_1, 0, string);
10855 message_buf_print = 0;
10856 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
10858 if (STRINGP (Vdebug_on_message)
10859 && STRINGP (string)
10860 && fast_string_match (Vdebug_on_message, string) >= 0)
10861 call_debugger (list2 (Qerror, string));
10865 /* Helper function for set_message. First argument is ignored and second
10866 argument has the same meaning as for set_message.
10867 This function is called with the echo area buffer being current. */
10869 static int
10870 set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object string)
10872 eassert (STRINGP (string));
10874 /* Change multibyteness of the echo buffer appropriately. */
10875 if (message_enable_multibyte
10876 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10877 Fset_buffer_multibyte (message_enable_multibyte ? Qt : Qnil);
10879 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, message_truncate_lines ? Qt : Qnil);
10880 if (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering)))
10881 bset_bidi_paragraph_direction (current_buffer, Qleft_to_right);
10883 /* Insert new message at BEG. */
10884 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10886 /* This function takes care of single/multibyte conversion.
10887 We just have to ensure that the echo area buffer has the right
10888 setting of enable_multibyte_characters. */
10889 insert_from_string (string, 0, 0, SCHARS (string), SBYTES (string), 1);
10891 return 0;
10895 /* Clear messages. CURRENT_P non-zero means clear the current
10896 message. LAST_DISPLAYED_P non-zero means clear the message
10897 last displayed. */
10899 void
10900 clear_message (bool current_p, bool last_displayed_p)
10902 if (current_p)
10904 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10905 message_cleared_p = true;
10908 if (last_displayed_p)
10909 echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
10911 message_buf_print = 0;
10914 /* Clear garbaged frames.
10916 This function is used where the old redisplay called
10917 redraw_garbaged_frames which in turn called redraw_frame which in
10918 turn called clear_frame. The call to clear_frame was a source of
10919 flickering. I believe a clear_frame is not necessary. It should
10920 suffice in the new redisplay to invalidate all current matrices,
10921 and ensure a complete redisplay of all windows. */
10923 static void
10924 clear_garbaged_frames (void)
10926 if (frame_garbaged)
10928 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10930 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10932 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
10934 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
10936 if (f->resized_p)
10937 redraw_frame (f);
10938 else
10939 clear_current_matrices (f);
10940 fset_redisplay (f);
10941 f->garbaged = false;
10942 f->resized_p = false;
10946 frame_garbaged = false;
10951 /* Redisplay the echo area of the selected frame. If UPDATE_FRAME_P
10952 is non-zero update selected_frame. Value is non-zero if the
10953 mini-windows height has been changed. */
10955 static int
10956 echo_area_display (int update_frame_p)
10958 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10959 struct window *w;
10960 struct frame *f;
10961 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10962 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10964 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10965 w = XWINDOW (mini_window);
10966 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10968 /* Don't display if frame is invisible or not yet initialized. */
10969 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10970 return 0;
10972 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10973 /* When Emacs starts, selected_frame may be the initial terminal
10974 frame. If we let this through, a message would be displayed on
10975 the terminal. */
10976 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10977 return 0;
10978 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10980 /* Redraw garbaged frames. */
10981 clear_garbaged_frames ();
10983 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || minibuf_level == 0)
10985 echo_area_window = mini_window;
10986 window_height_changed_p = display_echo_area (w);
10987 w->must_be_updated_p = true;
10989 /* Update the display, unless called from redisplay_internal.
10990 Also don't update the screen during redisplay itself. The
10991 update will happen at the end of redisplay, and an update
10992 here could cause confusion. */
10993 if (update_frame_p && !redisplaying_p)
10995 int n = 0;
10997 /* If the display update has been interrupted by pending
10998 input, update mode lines in the frame. Due to the
10999 pending input, it might have been that redisplay hasn't
11000 been called, so that mode lines above the echo area are
11001 garbaged. This looks odd, so we prevent it here. */
11002 if (!display_completed)
11003 n = redisplay_mode_lines (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), false);
11005 if (window_height_changed_p
11006 /* Don't do this if Emacs is shutting down. Redisplay
11007 needs to run hooks. */
11008 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks))
11010 /* Must update other windows. Likewise as in other
11011 cases, don't let this update be interrupted by
11012 pending input. */
11013 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11014 specbind (Qredisplay_dont_pause, Qt);
11015 windows_or_buffers_changed = 44;
11016 redisplay_internal ();
11017 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11019 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && n == 0)
11021 /* Window configuration is the same as before.
11022 Can do with a display update of the echo area,
11023 unless we displayed some mode lines. */
11024 update_single_window (w, 1);
11025 flush_frame (f);
11027 else
11028 update_frame (f, 1, 1);
11030 /* If cursor is in the echo area, make sure that the next
11031 redisplay displays the minibuffer, so that the cursor will
11032 be replaced with what the minibuffer wants. */
11033 if (cursor_in_echo_area)
11034 wset_redisplay (XWINDOW (mini_window));
11037 else if (!EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
11038 wset_redisplay (XWINDOW (mini_window));
11040 /* Last displayed message is now the current message. */
11041 echo_area_buffer[1] = echo_area_buffer[0];
11042 /* Inform read_char that we're not echoing. */
11043 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
11045 /* Prevent redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal by resetting
11046 this_line_start_pos. This is done because the mini-buffer now
11047 displays the message instead of its buffer text. */
11048 if (EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
11049 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
11051 return window_height_changed_p;
11054 /* Nonzero if W's buffer was changed but not saved. */
11056 static int
11057 window_buffer_changed (struct window *w)
11059 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->contents);
11061 eassert (BUFFER_LIVE_P (b));
11063 return (((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b) < BUF_MODIFF (b)) != w->last_had_star));
11066 /* Nonzero if W has %c in its mode line and mode line should be updated. */
11068 static int
11069 mode_line_update_needed (struct window *w)
11071 return (w->column_number_displayed != -1
11072 && !(PT == w->last_point && !window_outdated (w))
11073 && (w->column_number_displayed != current_column ()));
11076 /* Nonzero if window start of W is frozen and may not be changed during
11077 redisplay. */
11079 static bool
11080 window_frozen_p (struct window *w)
11082 if (FRAME_WINDOWS_FROZEN (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))))
11084 Lisp_Object window;
11086 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
11087 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
11088 return 0;
11089 else if (EQ (window, selected_window))
11090 return 0;
11091 else if (MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))
11092 && EQ (window, Vminibuf_scroll_window))
11093 /* This special window can't be frozen too. */
11094 return 0;
11095 else
11096 return 1;
11098 return 0;
11101 /***********************************************************************
11102 Mode Lines and Frame Titles
11103 ***********************************************************************/
11105 /* A buffer for constructing non-propertized mode-line strings and
11106 frame titles in it; allocated from the heap in init_xdisp and
11107 resized as needed in store_mode_line_noprop_char. */
11109 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf;
11111 /* The buffer's end, and a current output position in it. */
11113 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf_end;
11114 static char *mode_line_noprop_ptr;
11116 #define MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN(start) \
11117 ((mode_line_noprop_ptr - mode_line_noprop_buf) - start)
11119 static enum {
11120 MODE_LINE_DISPLAY = 0,
11121 MODE_LINE_TITLE,
11122 MODE_LINE_NOPROP,
11123 MODE_LINE_STRING
11124 } mode_line_target;
11126 /* Alist that caches the results of :propertize.
11127 Each element is (PROPERTIZED-STRING . PROPERTY-LIST). */
11128 static Lisp_Object mode_line_proptrans_alist;
11130 /* List of strings making up the mode-line. */
11131 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_list;
11133 /* Base face property when building propertized mode line string. */
11134 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face;
11135 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face_prop;
11138 /* Unwind data for mode line strings */
11140 static Lisp_Object Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
11142 static Lisp_Object
11143 format_mode_line_unwind_data (struct frame *target_frame,
11144 struct buffer *obuf,
11145 Lisp_Object owin,
11146 int save_proptrans)
11148 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
11150 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
11151 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
11152 vector = Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
11153 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
11155 if (NILP (vector))
11156 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (10), Qnil);
11158 ASET (vector, 0, make_number (mode_line_target));
11159 ASET (vector, 1, make_number (MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0)));
11160 ASET (vector, 2, mode_line_string_list);
11161 ASET (vector, 3, save_proptrans ? mode_line_proptrans_alist : Qt);
11162 ASET (vector, 4, mode_line_string_face);
11163 ASET (vector, 5, mode_line_string_face_prop);
11165 if (obuf)
11166 XSETBUFFER (tmp, obuf);
11167 else
11168 tmp = Qnil;
11169 ASET (vector, 6, tmp);
11170 ASET (vector, 7, owin);
11171 if (target_frame)
11173 /* Similarly to `with-selected-window', if the operation selects
11174 a window on another frame, we must restore that frame's
11175 selected window, and (for a tty) the top-frame. */
11176 ASET (vector, 8, target_frame->selected_window);
11177 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (target_frame))
11178 ASET (vector, 9, FRAME_TTY (target_frame)->top_frame);
11181 return vector;
11184 static void
11185 unwind_format_mode_line (Lisp_Object vector)
11187 Lisp_Object old_window = AREF (vector, 7);
11188 Lisp_Object target_frame_window = AREF (vector, 8);
11189 Lisp_Object old_top_frame = AREF (vector, 9);
11191 mode_line_target = XINT (AREF (vector, 0));
11192 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + XINT (AREF (vector, 1));
11193 mode_line_string_list = AREF (vector, 2);
11194 if (! EQ (AREF (vector, 3), Qt))
11195 mode_line_proptrans_alist = AREF (vector, 3);
11196 mode_line_string_face = AREF (vector, 4);
11197 mode_line_string_face_prop = AREF (vector, 5);
11199 /* Select window before buffer, since it may change the buffer. */
11200 if (!NILP (old_window))
11202 /* If the operation that we are unwinding had selected a window
11203 on a different frame, reset its frame-selected-window. For a
11204 text terminal, reset its top-frame if necessary. */
11205 if (!NILP (target_frame_window))
11207 Lisp_Object frame
11208 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (target_frame_window));
11210 if (!EQ (frame, WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (old_window))))
11211 Fselect_window (target_frame_window, Qt);
11213 if (!NILP (old_top_frame) && !EQ (old_top_frame, frame))
11214 Fselect_frame (old_top_frame, Qt);
11217 Fselect_window (old_window, Qt);
11220 if (!NILP (AREF (vector, 6)))
11222 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 6)));
11223 ASET (vector, 6, Qnil);
11226 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = vector;
11230 /* Store a single character C for the frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf.
11231 Re-allocate mode_line_noprop_buf if necessary. */
11233 static void
11234 store_mode_line_noprop_char (char c)
11236 /* If output position has reached the end of the allocated buffer,
11237 increase the buffer's size. */
11238 if (mode_line_noprop_ptr == mode_line_noprop_buf_end)
11240 ptrdiff_t len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11241 ptrdiff_t size = len;
11242 mode_line_noprop_buf =
11243 xpalloc (mode_line_noprop_buf, &size, 1, STRING_BYTES_BOUND, 1);
11244 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
11245 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + len;
11248 *mode_line_noprop_ptr++ = c;
11252 /* Store part of a frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf, beginning at
11253 mode_line_noprop_ptr. STRING is the string to store. Do not copy
11254 characters that yield more columns than PRECISION; PRECISION <= 0
11255 means copy the whole string. Pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
11256 number of characters have been copied; FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't
11257 pad. Called from display_mode_element when it is used to build a
11258 frame title. */
11260 static int
11261 store_mode_line_noprop (const char *string, int field_width, int precision)
11263 const unsigned char *str = (const unsigned char *) string;
11264 int n = 0;
11265 ptrdiff_t dummy, nbytes;
11267 /* Copy at most PRECISION chars from STR. */
11268 nbytes = strlen (string);
11269 n += c_string_width (str, nbytes, precision, &dummy, &nbytes);
11270 while (nbytes--)
11271 store_mode_line_noprop_char (*str++);
11273 /* Fill up with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH reached. */
11274 while (field_width > 0
11275 && n < field_width)
11277 store_mode_line_noprop_char (' ');
11278 ++n;
11281 return n;
11284 /***********************************************************************
11285 Frame Titles
11286 ***********************************************************************/
11288 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11290 /* Set the title of FRAME, if it has changed. The title format is
11291 Vicon_title_format if FRAME is iconified, otherwise it is
11292 frame_title_format. */
11294 static void
11295 x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object frame)
11297 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11299 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11300 || FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)
11301 || f->explicit_name)
11303 /* Do we have more than one visible frame on this X display? */
11304 Lisp_Object tail, other_frame, fmt;
11305 ptrdiff_t title_start;
11306 char *title;
11307 ptrdiff_t len;
11308 struct it it;
11309 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11311 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, other_frame)
11313 struct frame *tf = XFRAME (other_frame);
11315 if (tf != f
11316 && FRAME_KBOARD (tf) == FRAME_KBOARD (f)
11317 && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (tf)
11318 && !EQ (other_frame, tip_frame)
11319 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (tf) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (tf)))
11320 break;
11323 /* Set global variable indicating that multiple frames exist. */
11324 multiple_frames = CONSP (tail);
11326 /* Switch to the buffer of selected window of the frame. Set up
11327 mode_line_target so that display_mode_element will output into
11328 mode_line_noprop_buf; then display the title. */
11329 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
11330 format_mode_line_unwind_data
11331 (f, current_buffer, selected_window, 0));
11333 Fselect_window (f->selected_window, Qt);
11334 set_buffer_internal_1
11335 (XBUFFER (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->contents));
11336 fmt = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) ? Vicon_title_format : Vframe_title_format;
11338 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_TITLE;
11339 title_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11340 init_iterator (&it, XWINDOW (f->selected_window), -1, -1,
11341 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
11342 display_mode_element (&it, 0, -1, -1, fmt, Qnil, 0);
11343 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (title_start);
11344 title = mode_line_noprop_buf + title_start;
11345 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11347 /* Set the title only if it's changed. This avoids consing in
11348 the common case where it hasn't. (If it turns out that we've
11349 already wasted too much time by walking through the list with
11350 display_mode_element, then we might need to optimize at a
11351 higher level than this.) */
11352 if (! STRINGP (f->name)
11353 || SBYTES (f->name) != len
11354 || memcmp (title, SDATA (f->name), len) != 0)
11355 x_implicitly_set_name (f, make_string (title, len), Qnil);
11359 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11362 /***********************************************************************
11363 Menu Bars
11364 ***********************************************************************/
11366 /* Non-zero if we will not redisplay all visible windows. */
11367 #define REDISPLAY_SOME_P() \
11368 ((windows_or_buffers_changed == 0 \
11369 || windows_or_buffers_changed == REDISPLAY_SOME) \
11370 && (update_mode_lines == 0 \
11371 || update_mode_lines == REDISPLAY_SOME))
11373 /* Prepare for redisplay by updating menu-bar item lists when
11374 appropriate. This can call eval. */
11376 static void
11377 prepare_menu_bars (void)
11379 bool all_windows = windows_or_buffers_changed || update_mode_lines;
11380 bool some_windows = REDISPLAY_SOME_P ();
11381 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
11382 Lisp_Object tooltip_frame;
11384 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11385 tooltip_frame = tip_frame;
11386 #else
11387 tooltip_frame = Qnil;
11388 #endif
11390 if (FUNCTIONP (Vpre_redisplay_function))
11392 Lisp_Object windows = all_windows ? Qt : Qnil;
11393 if (all_windows && some_windows)
11395 Lisp_Object ws = window_list ();
11396 for (windows = Qnil; CONSP (ws); ws = XCDR (ws))
11398 Lisp_Object this = XCAR (ws);
11399 struct window *w = XWINDOW (this);
11400 if (w->redisplay
11401 || XFRAME (w->frame)->redisplay
11402 || XBUFFER (w->contents)->text->redisplay)
11404 windows = Fcons (this, windows);
11408 safe_call1 (Vpre_redisplay_function, windows);
11411 /* Update all frame titles based on their buffer names, etc. We do
11412 this before the menu bars so that the buffer-menu will show the
11413 up-to-date frame titles. */
11414 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11415 if (all_windows)
11417 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11419 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11421 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11422 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f));
11423 if (some_windows
11424 && !f->redisplay
11425 && !w->redisplay
11426 && !XBUFFER (w->contents)->text->redisplay)
11427 continue;
11429 if (!EQ (frame, tooltip_frame)
11430 && (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
11431 || FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) == 1
11432 /* Exclude TTY frames that are obscured because they
11433 are not the top frame on their console. This is
11434 because x_consider_frame_title actually switches
11435 to the frame, which for TTY frames means it is
11436 marked as garbaged, and will be completely
11437 redrawn on the next redisplay cycle. This causes
11438 TTY frames to be completely redrawn, when there
11439 are more than one of them, even though nothing
11440 should be changed on display. */
11441 || (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) == 2 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))))
11442 x_consider_frame_title (frame);
11445 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11447 /* Update the menu bar item lists, if appropriate. This has to be
11448 done before any actual redisplay or generation of display lines. */
11450 if (all_windows)
11452 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11453 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11454 /* 1 means that update_menu_bar has run its hooks
11455 so any further calls to update_menu_bar shouldn't do so again. */
11456 int menu_bar_hooks_run = 0;
11458 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11460 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11462 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11463 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f));
11465 /* Ignore tooltip frame. */
11466 if (EQ (frame, tooltip_frame))
11467 continue;
11469 if (some_windows
11470 && !f->redisplay
11471 && !w->redisplay
11472 && !XBUFFER (w->contents)->text->redisplay)
11473 continue;
11475 /* If a window on this frame changed size, report that to
11476 the user and clear the size-change flag. */
11477 if (FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f))
11479 Lisp_Object functions;
11481 /* Clear flag first in case we get an error below. */
11482 FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f) = 0;
11483 functions = Vwindow_size_change_functions;
11484 GCPRO2 (tail, functions);
11486 while (CONSP (functions))
11488 if (!EQ (XCAR (functions), Qt))
11489 call1 (XCAR (functions), frame);
11490 functions = XCDR (functions);
11492 UNGCPRO;
11495 GCPRO1 (tail);
11496 menu_bar_hooks_run = update_menu_bar (f, 0, menu_bar_hooks_run);
11497 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11498 update_tool_bar (f, 0);
11499 #endif
11500 #ifdef HAVE_NS
11501 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11502 && FRAME_NS_P (f))
11503 ns_set_doc_edited
11504 (f, Fbuffer_modified_p (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->contents));
11505 #endif
11506 UNGCPRO;
11509 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11511 else
11513 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
11514 update_menu_bar (sf, 1, 0);
11515 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11516 update_tool_bar (sf, 1);
11517 #endif
11522 /* Update the menu bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11523 before we start to fill in any display lines, because it can call
11524 eval.
11526 If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save and restore it here.
11528 If HOOKS_RUN is 1, that means a previous call to update_menu_bar
11529 already ran the menu bar hooks for this redisplay, so there
11530 is no need to run them again. The return value is the
11531 updated value of this flag, to pass to the next call. */
11533 static int
11534 update_menu_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data, int hooks_run)
11536 Lisp_Object window;
11537 register struct window *w;
11539 /* If called recursively during a menu update, do nothing. This can
11540 happen when, for instance, an activate-menubar-hook causes a
11541 redisplay. */
11542 if (inhibit_menubar_update)
11543 return hooks_run;
11545 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11546 w = XWINDOW (window);
11548 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11550 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11551 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11552 FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f)
11553 #else
11554 FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
11555 #endif
11556 : FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0)
11558 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11559 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11560 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11561 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11562 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11563 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11564 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11565 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11566 /* This used to test w->update_mode_line, but we believe
11567 there is no need to recompute the menu in that case. */
11568 || update_mode_lines
11569 || window_buffer_changed (w))
11571 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11572 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11574 specbind (Qinhibit_menubar_update, Qt);
11576 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->contents));
11577 if (save_match_data)
11578 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11579 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11581 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11582 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11585 if (!hooks_run)
11587 /* Run the Lucid hook. */
11588 safe_run_hooks (Qactivate_menubar_hook);
11590 /* If it has changed current-menubar from previous value,
11591 really recompute the menu-bar from the value. */
11592 if (! NILP (Vlucid_menu_bar_dirty_flag))
11593 call0 (Qrecompute_lucid_menubar);
11595 safe_run_hooks (Qmenu_bar_update_hook);
11597 hooks_run = 1;
11600 XSETFRAME (Vmenu_updating_frame, f);
11601 fset_menu_bar_items (f, menu_bar_items (FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (f)));
11603 /* Redisplay the menu bar in case we changed it. */
11604 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11605 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11606 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
11608 #if defined (HAVE_NS)
11609 /* All frames on Mac OS share the same menubar. So only
11610 the selected frame should be allowed to set it. */
11611 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
11612 #endif
11613 set_frame_menubar (f, 0, 0);
11615 else
11616 /* On a terminal screen, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11617 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11618 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11619 #else /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11620 /* In the non-toolkit version, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11621 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11622 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11623 #endif /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11625 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11626 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11630 return hooks_run;
11633 /***********************************************************************
11634 Tool-bars
11635 ***********************************************************************/
11637 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11639 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
11640 or -1. */
11642 int last_tool_bar_item;
11644 /* Select `frame' temporarily without running all the code in
11645 do_switch_frame.
11646 FIXME: Maybe do_switch_frame should be trimmed down similarly
11647 when `norecord' is set. */
11648 static void
11649 fast_set_selected_frame (Lisp_Object frame)
11651 if (!EQ (selected_frame, frame))
11653 selected_frame = frame;
11654 selected_window = XFRAME (frame)->selected_window;
11658 /* Update the tool-bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11659 before we start to fill in any display lines. Called from
11660 prepare_menu_bars. If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save
11661 and restore it here. */
11663 static void
11664 update_tool_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data)
11666 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11667 int do_update = FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f);
11668 #else
11669 int do_update = (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11670 && WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)) > 0);
11671 #endif
11673 if (do_update)
11675 Lisp_Object window;
11676 struct window *w;
11678 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11679 w = XWINDOW (window);
11681 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11682 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11683 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11684 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11685 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11686 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11687 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11688 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11689 || w->update_mode_line
11690 || update_mode_lines
11691 || window_buffer_changed (w))
11693 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11694 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11695 Lisp_Object frame, new_tool_bar;
11696 int new_n_tool_bar;
11697 struct gcpro gcpro1;
11699 /* Set current_buffer to the buffer of the selected
11700 window of the frame, so that we get the right local
11701 keymaps. */
11702 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->contents));
11704 /* Save match data, if we must. */
11705 if (save_match_data)
11706 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11708 /* Make sure that we don't accidentally use bogus keymaps. */
11709 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11711 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11712 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11715 GCPRO1 (new_tool_bar);
11717 /* We must temporarily set the selected frame to this frame
11718 before calling tool_bar_items, because the calculation of
11719 the tool-bar keymap uses the selected frame (see
11720 `tool-bar-make-keymap' in tool-bar.el). */
11721 eassert (EQ (selected_window,
11722 /* Since we only explicitly preserve selected_frame,
11723 check that selected_window would be redundant. */
11724 XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window));
11725 record_unwind_protect (fast_set_selected_frame, selected_frame);
11726 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11727 fast_set_selected_frame (frame);
11729 /* Build desired tool-bar items from keymaps. */
11730 new_tool_bar
11731 = tool_bar_items (Fcopy_sequence (f->tool_bar_items),
11732 &new_n_tool_bar);
11734 /* Redisplay the tool-bar if we changed it. */
11735 if (new_n_tool_bar != f->n_tool_bar_items
11736 || NILP (Fequal (new_tool_bar, f->tool_bar_items)))
11738 /* Redisplay that happens asynchronously due to an expose event
11739 may access f->tool_bar_items. Make sure we update both
11740 variables within BLOCK_INPUT so no such event interrupts. */
11741 block_input ();
11742 fset_tool_bar_items (f, new_tool_bar);
11743 f->n_tool_bar_items = new_n_tool_bar;
11744 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11745 unblock_input ();
11748 UNGCPRO;
11750 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11751 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11756 #if ! defined (USE_GTK) && ! defined (HAVE_NS)
11758 /* Set F->desired_tool_bar_string to a Lisp string representing frame
11759 F's desired tool-bar contents. F->tool_bar_items must have
11760 been set up previously by calling prepare_menu_bars. */
11762 static void
11763 build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f)
11765 int i, size, size_needed;
11766 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3;
11767 Lisp_Object image, plist, props;
11769 image = plist = props = Qnil;
11770 GCPRO3 (image, plist, props);
11772 /* Prepare F->desired_tool_bar_string. If we can reuse it, do so.
11773 Otherwise, make a new string. */
11775 /* The size of the string we might be able to reuse. */
11776 size = (STRINGP (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11777 ? SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11778 : 0);
11780 /* We need one space in the string for each image. */
11781 size_needed = f->n_tool_bar_items;
11783 /* Reuse f->desired_tool_bar_string, if possible. */
11784 if (size < size_needed || NILP (f->desired_tool_bar_string))
11785 fset_desired_tool_bar_string
11786 (f, Fmake_string (make_number (size_needed), make_number (' ')));
11787 else
11789 props = list4 (Qdisplay, Qnil, Qmenu_item, Qnil);
11790 Fremove_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (size),
11791 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11794 /* Put a `display' property on the string for the images to display,
11795 put a `menu_item' property on tool-bar items with a value that
11796 is the index of the item in F's tool-bar item vector. */
11797 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i)
11799 #define PROP(IDX) \
11800 AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX))
11802 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P));
11803 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P));
11804 int hmargin, vmargin, relief, idx, end;
11806 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the
11807 button state. */
11808 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES);
11809 if (VECTORP (image))
11811 if (enabled_p)
11812 idx = (selected_p
11813 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED
11814 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED);
11815 else
11816 idx = (selected_p
11817 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED
11818 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED);
11820 eassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx);
11821 image = AREF (image, idx);
11823 else
11824 idx = -1;
11826 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */
11827 if (!valid_image_p (image))
11828 continue;
11830 /* Display the tool-bar button pressed, or depressed. */
11831 plist = Fcopy_sequence (XCDR (image));
11833 /* Compute margin and relief to draw. */
11834 relief = (tool_bar_button_relief >= 0
11835 ? tool_bar_button_relief
11836 : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF);
11837 hmargin = vmargin = relief;
11839 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, Vtool_bar_button_margin,
11840 INT_MAX - max (hmargin, vmargin)))
11842 hmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11843 vmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11845 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11847 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11848 INT_MAX - hmargin))
11849 hmargin += XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11851 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11852 INT_MAX - vmargin))
11853 vmargin += XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11856 if (auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p)
11858 /* Add a `:relief' property to the image spec if the item is
11859 selected. */
11860 if (selected_p)
11862 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief, make_number (-relief));
11863 hmargin -= relief;
11864 vmargin -= relief;
11867 else
11869 /* If image is selected, display it pressed, i.e. with a
11870 negative relief. If it's not selected, display it with a
11871 raised relief. */
11872 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief,
11873 (selected_p
11874 ? make_number (-relief)
11875 : make_number (relief)));
11876 hmargin -= relief;
11877 vmargin -= relief;
11880 /* Put a margin around the image. */
11881 if (hmargin || vmargin)
11883 if (hmargin == vmargin)
11884 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin, make_number (hmargin));
11885 else
11886 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin,
11887 Fcons (make_number (hmargin),
11888 make_number (vmargin)));
11891 /* If button is not enabled, and we don't have special images
11892 for the disabled state, make the image appear disabled by
11893 applying an appropriate algorithm to it. */
11894 if (!enabled_p && idx < 0)
11895 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCconversion, Qdisabled);
11897 /* Put a `display' text property on the string for the image to
11898 display. Put a `menu-item' property on the string that gives
11899 the start of this item's properties in the tool-bar items
11900 vector. */
11901 image = Fcons (Qimage, plist);
11902 props = list4 (Qdisplay, image,
11903 Qmenu_item, make_number (i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS));
11905 /* Let the last image hide all remaining spaces in the tool bar
11906 string. The string can be longer than needed when we reuse a
11907 previous string. */
11908 if (i + 1 == f->n_tool_bar_items)
11909 end = SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11910 else
11911 end = i + 1;
11912 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (i), make_number (end),
11913 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11914 #undef PROP
11917 UNGCPRO;
11921 /* Display one line of the tool-bar of frame IT->f.
11923 HEIGHT specifies the desired height of the tool-bar line.
11924 If the actual height of the glyph row is less than HEIGHT, the
11925 row's height is increased to HEIGHT, and the icons are centered
11926 vertically in the new height.
11928 If HEIGHT is -1, we are counting needed tool-bar lines, so don't
11929 count a final empty row in case the tool-bar width exactly matches
11930 the window width.
11933 static void
11934 display_tool_bar_line (struct it *it, int height)
11936 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
11937 int max_x = it->last_visible_x;
11938 struct glyph *last;
11940 /* Don't extend on a previously drawn tool bar items (Bug#16058). */
11941 clear_glyph_row (row);
11942 row->enabled_p = true;
11943 row->y = it->current_y;
11945 /* Note that this isn't made use of if the face hasn't a box,
11946 so there's no need to check the face here. */
11947 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
11949 while (it->current_x < max_x)
11951 int x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
11952 struct it it_before;
11954 /* Get the next display element. */
11955 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
11957 /* Don't count empty row if we are counting needed tool-bar lines. */
11958 if (height < 0 && !it->hpos)
11959 return;
11960 break;
11963 /* Produce glyphs. */
11964 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
11965 it_before = *it;
11967 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
11969 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
11970 i = 0;
11971 x = it_before.current_x;
11972 while (i < nglyphs)
11974 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
11976 if (x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
11978 /* Glyph doesn't fit on line. Backtrack. */
11979 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
11980 *it = it_before;
11981 /* If this is the only glyph on this line, it will never fit on the
11982 tool-bar, so skip it. But ensure there is at least one glyph,
11983 so we don't accidentally disable the tool-bar. */
11984 if (n_glyphs_before == 0
11985 && (it->vpos > 0 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos-1))
11986 break;
11987 goto out;
11990 ++it->hpos;
11991 x += glyph->pixel_width;
11992 ++i;
11995 /* Stop at line end. */
11996 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
11997 break;
11999 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
12002 out:;
12004 row->displays_text_p = row->used[TEXT_AREA] != 0;
12006 /* Use default face for the border below the tool bar.
12008 FIXME: When auto-resize-tool-bars is grow-only, there is
12009 no additional border below the possibly empty tool-bar lines.
12010 So to make the extra empty lines look "normal", we have to
12011 use the tool-bar face for the border too. */
12012 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
12013 && !EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only))
12014 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
12016 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
12017 last = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
12018 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
12019 if (last == row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])
12020 last->left_box_line_p = 1;
12022 /* Make line the desired height and center it vertically. */
12023 if ((height -= it->max_ascent + it->max_descent) > 0)
12025 /* Don't add more than one line height. */
12026 height %= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
12027 it->max_ascent += height / 2;
12028 it->max_descent += (height + 1) / 2;
12031 compute_line_metrics (it);
12033 /* If line is empty, make it occupy the rest of the tool-bar. */
12034 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
12036 row->height = row->phys_height = it->last_visible_y - row->y;
12037 row->visible_height = row->height;
12038 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
12039 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
12042 row->full_width_p = 1;
12043 row->continued_p = 0;
12044 row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
12045 row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
12047 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
12048 it->current_y += row->height;
12049 ++it->vpos;
12050 ++it->glyph_row;
12054 /* Max tool-bar height. Basically, this is what makes all other windows
12055 disappear when the frame gets too small. Rethink this! */
12057 #define MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT(f) \
12058 ((FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f)))
12060 /* Value is the number of screen lines needed to make all tool-bar
12061 items of frame F visible. The number of actual rows needed is
12062 returned in *N_ROWS if non-NULL. */
12064 static int
12065 tool_bar_height (struct frame *f, int *n_rows, bool pixelwise)
12067 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12068 struct it it;
12069 /* tool_bar_height is called from redisplay_tool_bar after building
12070 the desired matrix, so use (unused) mode-line row as temporary row to
12071 avoid destroying the first tool-bar row. */
12072 struct glyph_row *temp_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
12074 /* Initialize an iterator for iteration over
12075 F->desired_tool_bar_string in the tool-bar window of frame F. */
12076 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, temp_row, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
12077 it.first_visible_x = 0;
12078 /* PXW: Use FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) here? */
12079 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
12080 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
12081 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
12083 while (!ITERATOR_AT_END_P (&it))
12085 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
12086 it.glyph_row = temp_row;
12087 display_tool_bar_line (&it, -1);
12089 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
12091 /* f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0 means "unknown"; -1 means no tool-bar. */
12092 if (n_rows)
12093 *n_rows = it.vpos > 0 ? it.vpos : -1;
12095 if (pixelwise)
12096 return it.current_y;
12097 else
12098 return (it.current_y + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1) / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
12101 #endif /* !USE_GTK && !HAVE_NS */
12103 #if defined USE_GTK || defined HAVE_NS
12104 EXFUN (Ftool_bar_height, 2) ATTRIBUTE_CONST;
12105 EXFUN (Ftool_bar_lines_needed, 1) ATTRIBUTE_CONST;
12106 #endif
12108 DEFUN ("tool-bar-height", Ftool_bar_height, Stool_bar_height,
12109 0, 2, 0,
12110 doc: /* Return the number of lines occupied by the tool bar of FRAME.
12111 If FRAME is nil or omitted, use the selected frame. Optional argument
12112 PIXELWISE non-nil means return the height of the tool bar inpixels. */)
12113 (Lisp_Object frame, Lisp_Object pixelwise)
12115 int height = 0;
12117 #if ! defined (USE_GTK) && ! defined (HAVE_NS)
12118 struct frame *f = decode_any_frame (frame);
12120 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
12121 && WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)) > 0)
12123 update_tool_bar (f, 1);
12124 if (f->n_tool_bar_items)
12126 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
12127 height = tool_bar_height (f, NULL, NILP (pixelwise) ? 0 : 1);
12130 #endif
12132 return make_number (height);
12136 /* Display the tool-bar of frame F. Value is non-zero if tool-bar's
12137 height should be changed. */
12139 static int
12140 redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *f)
12142 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
12144 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
12145 update_frame_tool_bar (f);
12146 return 0;
12148 #else /* !USE_GTK && !HAVE_NS */
12150 struct window *w;
12151 struct it it;
12152 struct glyph_row *row;
12154 /* If frame hasn't a tool-bar window or if it is zero-height, don't
12155 do anything. This means you must start with tool-bar-lines
12156 non-zero to get the auto-sizing effect. Or in other words, you
12157 can turn off tool-bars by specifying tool-bar-lines zero. */
12158 if (!WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
12159 || (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
12160 WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w) == 0))
12161 return 0;
12163 /* Set up an iterator for the tool-bar window. */
12164 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, w->desired_matrix->rows, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
12165 it.first_visible_x = 0;
12166 it.last_visible_x = WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w);
12167 row = it.glyph_row;
12169 /* Build a string that represents the contents of the tool-bar. */
12170 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
12171 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
12172 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But it
12173 doesn't make sense to have an R2L tool bar if the menu bar cannot
12174 be drawn also R2L, and making the menu bar R2L is tricky due
12175 toolkit-specific code that implements it. If an R2L tool bar is
12176 ever supported, display_tool_bar_line should also be augmented to
12177 call unproduce_glyphs like display_line and display_string
12178 do. */
12179 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
12181 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0)
12183 int new_height = tool_bar_height (f, &f->n_tool_bar_rows, 1);
12185 if (new_height != WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w))
12187 Lisp_Object frame;
12188 int new_lines = ((new_height + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1)
12189 / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
12191 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12192 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12193 list1 (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12194 make_number (new_lines))));
12195 /* Always do that now. */
12196 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12197 f->fonts_changed = 1;
12198 return 1;
12202 /* Display as many lines as needed to display all tool-bar items. */
12204 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows > 0)
12206 int border, rows, height, extra;
12208 if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vtool_bar_border))
12209 border = XINT (Vtool_bar_border);
12210 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qinternal_border_width))
12211 border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
12212 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qborder_width))
12213 border = f->border_width;
12214 else
12215 border = 0;
12216 if (border < 0)
12217 border = 0;
12219 rows = f->n_tool_bar_rows;
12220 height = max (1, (it.last_visible_y - border) / rows);
12221 extra = it.last_visible_y - border - height * rows;
12223 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12225 int h = 0;
12226 if (extra > 0 && rows-- > 0)
12228 h = (extra + rows - 1) / rows;
12229 extra -= h;
12231 display_tool_bar_line (&it, height + h);
12234 else
12236 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12237 display_tool_bar_line (&it, 0);
12240 /* It doesn't make much sense to try scrolling in the tool-bar
12241 window, so don't do it. */
12242 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
12243 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
12245 if (!NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
12247 /* Do we really allow the toolbar to occupy the whole frame? */
12248 int max_tool_bar_height = MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
12249 int change_height_p = 0;
12251 /* If we couldn't display everything, change the tool-bar's
12252 height if there is room for more. */
12253 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it) < it.end_charpos
12254 && it.current_y < max_tool_bar_height)
12255 change_height_p = 1;
12257 row = it.glyph_row - 1;
12259 /* If there are blank lines at the end, except for a partially
12260 visible blank line at the end that is smaller than
12261 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT, change the tool-bar's height. */
12262 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
12263 && row->height >= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
12264 change_height_p = 1;
12266 /* If row displays tool-bar items, but is partially visible,
12267 change the tool-bar's height. */
12268 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
12269 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > it.last_visible_y
12270 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < max_tool_bar_height)
12271 change_height_p = 1;
12273 /* Resize windows as needed by changing the `tool-bar-lines'
12274 frame parameter. */
12275 if (change_height_p)
12277 Lisp_Object frame;
12278 int nrows;
12279 int new_height = tool_bar_height (f, &nrows, 1);
12281 change_height_p = ((EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only)
12282 && !f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p)
12283 ? (new_height > WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w))
12284 : (new_height != WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w)));
12285 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12287 if (change_height_p)
12289 int new_lines = ((new_height + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1)
12290 / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
12292 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12293 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12294 list1 (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12295 make_number (new_lines))));
12296 /* Always do that now. */
12297 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12298 f->n_tool_bar_rows = nrows;
12299 f->fonts_changed = 1;
12300 return 1;
12305 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12306 return 0;
12308 #endif /* USE_GTK || HAVE_NS */
12311 #if ! defined (USE_GTK) && ! defined (HAVE_NS)
12313 /* Get information about the tool-bar item which is displayed in GLYPH
12314 on frame F. Return in *PROP_IDX the index where tool-bar item
12315 properties start in F->tool_bar_items. Value is zero if
12316 GLYPH doesn't display a tool-bar item. */
12318 static int
12319 tool_bar_item_info (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph, int *prop_idx)
12321 Lisp_Object prop;
12322 int success_p;
12323 int charpos;
12325 /* This function can be called asynchronously, which means we must
12326 exclude any possibility that Fget_text_property signals an
12327 error. */
12328 charpos = min (SCHARS (f->current_tool_bar_string), glyph->charpos);
12329 charpos = max (0, charpos);
12331 /* Get the text property `menu-item' at pos. The value of that
12332 property is the start index of this item's properties in
12333 F->tool_bar_items. */
12334 prop = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
12335 Qmenu_item, f->current_tool_bar_string);
12336 if (INTEGERP (prop))
12338 *prop_idx = XINT (prop);
12339 success_p = 1;
12341 else
12342 success_p = 0;
12344 return success_p;
12348 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
12349 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
12350 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
12351 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
12352 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
12354 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
12355 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
12356 1 otherwise. */
12358 static int
12359 get_tool_bar_item (struct frame *f, int x, int y, struct glyph **glyph,
12360 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *prop_idx)
12362 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12363 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12364 int area;
12366 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
12367 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, 0, 0, &area);
12368 if (*glyph == NULL)
12369 return -1;
12371 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
12372 f->tool_bar_items. */
12373 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
12374 return -1;
12376 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
12377 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
12378 && *vpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12379 && *vpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12380 && (*vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12381 || *hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
12382 && (*vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12383 || *hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
12384 || hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
12385 return 0;
12387 return 1;
12391 /* EXPORT:
12392 Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
12393 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. DOWN_P is 1 for a button press,
12394 0 for button release. MODIFIERS is event modifiers for button
12395 release. */
12397 void
12398 handle_tool_bar_click (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int down_p,
12399 int modifiers)
12401 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12402 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12403 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
12404 struct glyph *glyph;
12405 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12406 int ts;
12408 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, and mouse-highlight is
12409 non-nil, return. This is so we generate the tool-bar button
12410 click only when the mouse button is released on the same item as
12411 where it was pressed. However, when mouse-highlight is disabled,
12412 generate the click when the button is released regardless of the
12413 highlight, since tool-bar items are not highlighted in that
12414 case. */
12415 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
12416 ts = get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
12417 if (ts == -1
12418 || (ts != 0 && !NILP (Vmouse_highlight)))
12419 return;
12421 /* When mouse-highlight is off, generate the click for the item
12422 where the button was pressed, disregarding where it was
12423 released. */
12424 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight) && !down_p)
12425 prop_idx = last_tool_bar_item;
12427 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
12428 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12429 if (NILP (enabled_p))
12430 return;
12432 if (down_p)
12434 /* Show item in pressed state. */
12435 if (!NILP (Vmouse_highlight))
12436 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
12437 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
12439 else
12441 Lisp_Object key, frame;
12442 struct input_event event;
12443 EVENT_INIT (event);
12445 /* Show item in released state. */
12446 if (!NILP (Vmouse_highlight))
12447 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
12449 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
12451 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12452 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12453 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12454 event.arg = frame;
12455 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12457 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12458 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12459 event.arg = key;
12460 event.modifiers = modifiers;
12461 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12462 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
12467 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
12468 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
12469 note_mouse_highlight. */
12471 static void
12472 note_tool_bar_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
12474 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
12475 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12476 Display_Info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12477 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12478 int hpos, vpos;
12479 struct glyph *glyph;
12480 struct glyph_row *row;
12481 int i;
12482 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12483 int prop_idx;
12484 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12485 int mouse_down_p, rc;
12487 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative X/Y
12488 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
12489 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
12491 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12492 return;
12495 rc = get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
12496 if (rc < 0)
12498 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
12499 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12500 return;
12502 else if (rc == 0)
12503 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
12504 goto set_help_echo;
12506 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12508 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
12509 mouse_down_p = (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo)
12510 && f == dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame);
12512 if (mouse_down_p
12513 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
12514 return;
12516 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12518 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
12519 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12520 if (!NILP (enabled_p) && !NILP (Vmouse_highlight))
12522 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
12523 image is a space. We include this in the highlighted area. */
12524 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
12525 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
12526 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
12528 /* Record this as the current active region. */
12529 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
12530 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
12531 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
12532 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
12534 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
12535 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
12536 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
12537 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
12538 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
12540 /* Display it as active. */
12541 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, draw);
12544 set_help_echo:
12546 /* Set help_echo_string to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
12547 XTread_socket does the rest. */
12548 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
12549 help_echo_pos = -1;
12550 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
12551 if (NILP (help_echo_string))
12552 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
12555 #endif /* !USE_GTK && !HAVE_NS */
12557 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
12561 /************************************************************************
12562 Horizontal scrolling
12563 ************************************************************************/
12565 static int hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object);
12566 static int hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object);
12568 /* For all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW, set their
12569 hscroll value so that PT is (i) visible in the window, and (ii) so
12570 that it is not within a certain margin at the window's left and
12571 right border. Value is non-zero if any window's hscroll has been
12572 changed. */
12574 static int
12575 hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object window)
12577 int hscrolled_p = 0;
12578 int hscroll_relative_p = FLOATP (Vhscroll_step);
12579 int hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12580 double hscroll_step_rel = 0;
12582 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12584 hscroll_step_rel = XFLOAT_DATA (Vhscroll_step);
12585 if (hscroll_step_rel < 0)
12587 hscroll_relative_p = 0;
12588 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12591 else if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vhscroll_step))
12593 hscroll_step_abs = XINT (Vhscroll_step);
12594 if (hscroll_step_abs < 0)
12595 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12597 else
12598 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12600 while (WINDOWP (window))
12602 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12604 if (WINDOWP (w->contents))
12605 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->contents);
12606 else if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
12608 int h_margin;
12609 int text_area_width;
12610 struct glyph_row *current_cursor_row
12611 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12612 struct glyph_row *desired_cursor_row
12613 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12614 struct glyph_row *cursor_row
12615 = (desired_cursor_row->enabled_p
12616 ? desired_cursor_row
12617 : current_cursor_row);
12618 int row_r2l_p = cursor_row->reversed_p;
12620 text_area_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
12622 /* Scroll when cursor is inside this scroll margin. */
12623 h_margin = hscroll_margin * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
12625 if (!NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qauto_hscroll_mode, w->contents))
12626 /* For left-to-right rows, hscroll when cursor is either
12627 (i) inside the right hscroll margin, or (ii) if it is
12628 inside the left margin and the window is already
12629 hscrolled. */
12630 && ((!row_r2l_p
12631 && ((w->hscroll
12632 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12633 || (cursor_row->enabled_p
12634 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12635 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))
12636 /* For right-to-left rows, the logic is similar,
12637 except that rules for scrolling to left and right
12638 are reversed. E.g., if cursor.x <= h_margin, we
12639 need to hscroll "to the right" unconditionally,
12640 and that will scroll the screen to the left so as
12641 to reveal the next portion of the row. */
12642 || (row_r2l_p
12643 && ((cursor_row->enabled_p
12644 /* FIXME: It is confusing to set the
12645 truncated_on_right_p flag when R2L rows
12646 are actually truncated on the left. */
12647 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12648 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12649 || (w->hscroll
12650 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))))
12652 struct it it;
12653 ptrdiff_t hscroll;
12654 struct buffer *saved_current_buffer;
12655 ptrdiff_t pt;
12656 int wanted_x;
12658 /* Find point in a display of infinite width. */
12659 saved_current_buffer = current_buffer;
12660 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->contents);
12662 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12663 pt = PT;
12664 else
12665 pt = clip_to_bounds (BEGV, marker_position (w->pointm), ZV);
12667 /* Move iterator to pt starting at cursor_row->start in
12668 a line with infinite width. */
12669 init_to_row_start (&it, w, cursor_row);
12670 it.last_visible_x = INFINITY;
12671 move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, pt, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
12672 current_buffer = saved_current_buffer;
12674 /* Position cursor in window. */
12675 if (!hscroll_relative_p && hscroll_step_abs == 0)
12676 hscroll = max (0, (it.current_x
12677 - (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it)
12678 ? (text_area_width - 4 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f))
12679 : (text_area_width / 2))))
12680 / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12681 else if ((!row_r2l_p
12682 && w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin)
12683 || (row_r2l_p && w->cursor.x <= h_margin))
12685 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12686 wanted_x = text_area_width * (1 - hscroll_step_rel)
12687 - h_margin;
12688 else
12689 wanted_x = text_area_width
12690 - hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12691 - h_margin;
12692 hscroll
12693 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12695 else
12697 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12698 wanted_x = text_area_width * hscroll_step_rel
12699 + h_margin;
12700 else
12701 wanted_x = hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12702 + h_margin;
12703 hscroll
12704 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12706 hscroll = max (hscroll, w->min_hscroll);
12708 /* Don't prevent redisplay optimizations if hscroll
12709 hasn't changed, as it will unnecessarily slow down
12710 redisplay. */
12711 if (w->hscroll != hscroll)
12713 XBUFFER (w->contents)->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 1;
12714 w->hscroll = hscroll;
12715 hscrolled_p = 1;
12720 window = w->next;
12723 /* Value is non-zero if hscroll of any leaf window has been changed. */
12724 return hscrolled_p;
12728 /* Set hscroll so that cursor is visible and not inside horizontal
12729 scroll margins for all windows in the tree rooted at WINDOW. See
12730 also hscroll_window_tree above. Value is non-zero if any window's
12731 hscroll has been changed. If it has, desired matrices on the frame
12732 of WINDOW are cleared. */
12734 static int
12735 hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object window)
12737 int hscrolled_p = hscroll_window_tree (window);
12738 if (hscrolled_p)
12739 clear_desired_matrices (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))));
12740 return hscrolled_p;
12745 /************************************************************************
12746 Redisplay
12747 ************************************************************************/
12749 /* Variables holding some state of redisplay if GLYPH_DEBUG is defined
12750 to a non-zero value. This is sometimes handy to have in a debugger
12751 session. */
12753 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
12755 /* First and last unchanged row for try_window_id. */
12757 static int debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
12758 static int debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos;
12760 /* Delta vpos and y. */
12762 static int debug_dvpos, debug_dy;
12764 /* Delta in characters and bytes for try_window_id. */
12766 static ptrdiff_t debug_delta, debug_delta_bytes;
12768 /* Values of window_end_pos and window_end_vpos at the end of
12769 try_window_id. */
12771 static ptrdiff_t debug_end_vpos;
12773 /* Append a string to W->desired_matrix->method. FMT is a printf
12774 format string. If trace_redisplay_p is true also printf the
12775 resulting string to stderr. */
12777 static void debug_method_add (struct window *, char const *, ...)
12778 ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (2, 3);
12780 static void
12781 debug_method_add (struct window *w, char const *fmt, ...)
12783 void *ptr = w;
12784 char *method = w->desired_matrix->method;
12785 int len = strlen (method);
12786 int size = sizeof w->desired_matrix->method;
12787 int remaining = size - len - 1;
12788 va_list ap;
12790 if (len && remaining)
12792 method[len] = '|';
12793 --remaining, ++len;
12796 va_start (ap, fmt);
12797 vsnprintf (method + len, remaining + 1, fmt, ap);
12798 va_end (ap);
12800 if (trace_redisplay_p)
12801 fprintf (stderr, "%p (%s): %s\n",
12802 ptr,
12803 ((BUFFERP (w->contents)
12804 && STRINGP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), name)))
12805 ? SSDATA (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), name))
12806 : "no buffer"),
12807 method + len);
12810 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
12813 /* Value is non-zero if all changes in window W, which displays
12814 current_buffer, are in the text between START and END. START is a
12815 buffer position, END is given as a distance from Z. Used in
12816 redisplay_internal for display optimization. */
12818 static int
12819 text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *w,
12820 ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end)
12822 int unchanged_p = 1;
12824 /* If text or overlays have changed, see where. */
12825 if (window_outdated (w))
12827 /* Gap in the line? */
12828 if (GPT < start || Z - GPT < end)
12829 unchanged_p = 0;
12831 /* Changes start in front of the line, or end after it? */
12832 if (unchanged_p
12833 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start - 1
12834 || END_UNCHANGED < end))
12835 unchanged_p = 0;
12837 /* If selective display, can't optimize if changes start at the
12838 beginning of the line. */
12839 if (unchanged_p
12840 && INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
12841 && XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)) > 0
12842 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start || GPT <= start))
12843 unchanged_p = 0;
12845 /* If there are overlays at the start or end of the line, these
12846 may have overlay strings with newlines in them. A change at
12847 START, for instance, may actually concern the display of such
12848 overlay strings as well, and they are displayed on different
12849 lines. So, quickly rule out this case. (For the future, it
12850 might be desirable to implement something more telling than
12851 just BEG/END_UNCHANGED.) */
12852 if (unchanged_p)
12854 if (BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED == start
12855 && overlay_touches_p (start))
12856 unchanged_p = 0;
12857 if (END_UNCHANGED == end
12858 && overlay_touches_p (Z - end))
12859 unchanged_p = 0;
12862 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
12863 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
12864 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
12865 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
12866 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
12867 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
12868 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization. */
12869 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), bidi_display_reordering))
12870 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
12871 unchanged_p = 0;
12874 return unchanged_p;
12878 /* Do a frame update, taking possible shortcuts into account. This is
12879 the main external entry point for redisplay.
12881 If the last redisplay displayed an echo area message and that message
12882 is no longer requested, we clear the echo area or bring back the
12883 mini-buffer if that is in use. */
12885 void
12886 redisplay (void)
12888 redisplay_internal ();
12892 static Lisp_Object
12893 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (Lisp_Object var)
12895 Lisp_Object val;
12897 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_string), STRINGP (val))
12898 return val;
12900 return Voverlay_arrow_string;
12903 /* Return 1 if there are any overlay-arrows in current_buffer. */
12904 static int
12905 overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p (void)
12907 Lisp_Object vlist;
12909 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12910 CONSP (vlist);
12911 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12913 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12914 Lisp_Object val;
12916 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12917 continue;
12918 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12919 if (MARKERP (val)
12920 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer)
12921 return 1;
12923 return 0;
12927 /* Return 1 if any overlay_arrows have moved or overlay-arrow-string
12928 has changed. */
12930 static int
12931 overlay_arrows_changed_p (void)
12933 Lisp_Object vlist;
12935 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12936 CONSP (vlist);
12937 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12939 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12940 Lisp_Object val, pstr;
12942 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12943 continue;
12944 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12945 if (!MARKERP (val))
12946 continue;
12947 if (! EQ (COERCE_MARKER (val),
12948 Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position))
12949 || ! (pstr = overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var),
12950 EQ (pstr, Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_string))))
12951 return 1;
12953 return 0;
12956 /* Mark overlay arrows to be updated on next redisplay. */
12958 static void
12959 update_overlay_arrows (int up_to_date)
12961 Lisp_Object vlist;
12963 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12964 CONSP (vlist);
12965 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12967 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12969 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12970 continue;
12972 if (up_to_date > 0)
12974 Lisp_Object val = find_symbol_value (var);
12975 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position,
12976 COERCE_MARKER (val));
12977 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string,
12978 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var));
12980 else if (up_to_date < 0
12981 || !NILP (Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position)))
12983 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position, Qt);
12984 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string, Qt);
12990 /* Return overlay arrow string to display at row.
12991 Return integer (bitmap number) for arrow bitmap in left fringe.
12992 Return nil if no overlay arrow. */
12994 static Lisp_Object
12995 overlay_arrow_at_row (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row)
12997 Lisp_Object vlist;
12999 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
13000 CONSP (vlist);
13001 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
13003 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
13004 Lisp_Object val;
13006 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
13007 continue;
13009 val = find_symbol_value (var);
13011 if (MARKERP (val)
13012 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer
13013 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == marker_position (val)))
13015 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
13016 /* FIXME: if ROW->reversed_p is set, this should test
13017 the right fringe, not the left one. */
13018 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) > 0)
13020 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13021 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap), SYMBOLP (val))
13023 int fringe_bitmap;
13024 if ((fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (val)) != 0)
13025 return make_number (fringe_bitmap);
13027 #endif
13028 return make_number (-1); /* Use default arrow bitmap. */
13030 return overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var);
13034 return Qnil;
13037 /* Return 1 if point moved out of or into a composition. Otherwise
13038 return 0. PREV_BUF and PREV_PT are the last point buffer and
13039 position. BUF and PT are the current point buffer and position. */
13041 static int
13042 check_point_in_composition (struct buffer *prev_buf, ptrdiff_t prev_pt,
13043 struct buffer *buf, ptrdiff_t pt)
13045 ptrdiff_t start, end;
13046 Lisp_Object prop;
13047 Lisp_Object buffer;
13049 XSETBUFFER (buffer, buf);
13050 /* Check a composition at the last point if point moved within the
13051 same buffer. */
13052 if (prev_buf == buf)
13054 if (prev_pt == pt)
13055 /* Point didn't move. */
13056 return 0;
13058 if (prev_pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && prev_pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
13059 && find_composition (prev_pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
13060 && composition_valid_p (start, end, prop)
13061 && start < prev_pt && end > prev_pt)
13062 /* The last point was within the composition. Return 1 iff
13063 point moved out of the composition. */
13064 return (pt <= start || pt >= end);
13067 /* Check a composition at the current point. */
13068 return (pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
13069 && find_composition (pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
13070 && composition_valid_p (start, end, prop)
13071 && start < pt && end > pt);
13074 /* Reconsider the clip changes of buffer which is displayed in W. */
13076 static void
13077 reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *w)
13079 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->contents);
13081 if (b->clip_changed
13082 && w->window_end_valid
13083 && w->current_matrix->buffer == b
13084 && w->current_matrix->zv == BUF_ZV (b)
13085 && w->current_matrix->begv == BUF_BEGV (b))
13086 b->clip_changed = 0;
13088 /* If display wasn't paused, and W is not a tool bar window, see if
13089 point has been moved into or out of a composition. In that case,
13090 we set b->clip_changed to 1 to force updating the screen. If
13091 b->clip_changed has already been set to 1, we can skip this
13092 check. */
13093 if (!b->clip_changed && w->window_end_valid)
13095 ptrdiff_t pt = (w == XWINDOW (selected_window)
13096 ? PT : marker_position (w->pointm));
13098 if ((w->current_matrix->buffer != b || pt != w->last_point)
13099 && check_point_in_composition (w->current_matrix->buffer,
13100 w->last_point, b, pt))
13101 b->clip_changed = 1;
13105 static void
13106 propagate_buffer_redisplay (void)
13107 { /* Resetting b->text->redisplay is problematic!
13108 We can't just reset it in the case that some window that displays
13109 it has not been redisplayed; and such a window can stay
13110 unredisplayed for a long time if it's currently invisible.
13111 But we do want to reset it at the end of redisplay otherwise
13112 its displayed windows will keep being redisplayed over and over
13113 again.
13114 So we copy all b->text->redisplay flags up to their windows here,
13115 such that mark_window_display_accurate can safely reset
13116 b->text->redisplay. */
13117 Lisp_Object ws = window_list ();
13118 for (; CONSP (ws); ws = XCDR (ws))
13120 struct window *thisw = XWINDOW (XCAR (ws));
13121 struct buffer *thisb = XBUFFER (thisw->contents);
13122 if (thisb->text->redisplay)
13123 thisw->redisplay = true;
13127 #define STOP_POLLING \
13128 do { if (! polling_stopped_here) stop_polling (); \
13129 polling_stopped_here = 1; } while (0)
13131 #define RESUME_POLLING \
13132 do { if (polling_stopped_here) start_polling (); \
13133 polling_stopped_here = 0; } while (0)
13136 /* Perhaps in the future avoid recentering windows if it
13137 is not necessary; currently that causes some problems. */
13139 static void
13140 redisplay_internal (void)
13142 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
13143 struct window *sw;
13144 struct frame *fr;
13145 int pending;
13146 bool must_finish = 0, match_p;
13147 struct text_pos tlbufpos, tlendpos;
13148 int number_of_visible_frames;
13149 ptrdiff_t count;
13150 struct frame *sf;
13151 int polling_stopped_here = 0;
13152 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13154 /* True means redisplay has to consider all windows on all
13155 frames. False, only selected_window is considered. */
13156 bool consider_all_windows_p;
13158 /* True means redisplay has to redisplay the miniwindow. */
13159 bool update_miniwindow_p = false;
13161 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_internal %d\n", redisplaying_p));
13163 /* No redisplay if running in batch mode or frame is not yet fully
13164 initialized, or redisplay is explicitly turned off by setting
13165 Vinhibit_redisplay. */
13166 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (SELECTED_FRAME ())
13167 || !NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
13168 return;
13170 /* Don't examine these until after testing Vinhibit_redisplay.
13171 When Emacs is shutting down, perhaps because its connection to
13172 X has dropped, we should not look at them at all. */
13173 fr = XFRAME (w->frame);
13174 sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
13176 if (!fr->glyphs_initialized_p)
13177 return;
13179 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
13180 if (popup_activated ())
13181 return;
13182 #endif
13184 /* I don't think this happens but let's be paranoid. */
13185 if (redisplaying_p)
13186 return;
13188 /* Record a function that clears redisplaying_p
13189 when we leave this function. */
13190 count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13191 record_unwind_protect_void (unwind_redisplay);
13192 redisplaying_p = 1;
13193 specbind (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, Qnil);
13195 /* Record this function, so it appears on the profiler's backtraces. */
13196 record_in_backtrace (Qredisplay_internal, &Qnil, 0);
13198 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13199 XFRAME (frame)->already_hscrolled_p = 0;
13201 retry:
13202 /* Remember the currently selected window. */
13203 sw = w;
13205 pending = 0;
13206 last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
13207 last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13208 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
13209 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13211 /* If face_change_count is non-zero, init_iterator will free all
13212 realized faces, which includes the faces referenced from current
13213 matrices. So, we can't reuse current matrices in this case. */
13214 if (face_change_count)
13215 windows_or_buffers_changed = 47;
13217 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (sf) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (sf))
13218 && FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame != sf)
13220 /* Since frames on a single ASCII terminal share the same
13221 display area, displaying a different frame means redisplay
13222 the whole thing. */
13223 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (sf);
13224 #ifndef DOS_NT
13225 set_tty_color_mode (FRAME_TTY (sf), sf);
13226 #endif
13227 FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame = sf;
13230 /* Set the visible flags for all frames. Do this before checking for
13231 resized or garbaged frames; they want to know if their frames are
13232 visible. See the comment in frame.h for FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY. */
13233 number_of_visible_frames = 0;
13235 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13237 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13239 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13241 ++number_of_visible_frames;
13242 /* Adjust matrices for visible frames only. */
13243 if (f->fonts_changed)
13245 adjust_frame_glyphs (f);
13246 f->fonts_changed = 0;
13248 /* If cursor type has been changed on the frame
13249 other than selected, consider all frames. */
13250 if (f != sf && f->cursor_type_changed)
13251 update_mode_lines = 31;
13253 clear_desired_matrices (f);
13256 /* Notice any pending interrupt request to change frame size. */
13257 do_pending_window_change (1);
13259 /* do_pending_window_change could change the selected_window due to
13260 frame resizing which makes the selected window too small. */
13261 if (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13262 sw = w;
13264 /* Clear frames marked as garbaged. */
13265 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13267 /* Build menubar and tool-bar items. */
13268 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
13269 prepare_menu_bars ();
13271 reconsider_clip_changes (w);
13273 /* In most cases selected window displays current buffer. */
13274 match_p = XBUFFER (w->contents) == current_buffer;
13275 if (match_p)
13277 /* Detect case that we need to write or remove a star in the mode line. */
13278 if ((SAVE_MODIFF < MODIFF) != w->last_had_star)
13279 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13281 if (mode_line_update_needed (w))
13282 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13285 /* Normally the message* functions will have already displayed and
13286 updated the echo area, but the frame may have been trashed, or
13287 the update may have been preempted, so display the echo area
13288 again here. Checking message_cleared_p captures the case that
13289 the echo area should be cleared. */
13290 if ((!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) && !display_last_displayed_message_p)
13291 || (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]) && display_last_displayed_message_p)
13292 || (message_cleared_p
13293 && minibuf_level == 0
13294 /* If the mini-window is currently selected, this means the
13295 echo-area doesn't show through. */
13296 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))))
13298 int window_height_changed_p = echo_area_display (0);
13300 if (message_cleared_p)
13301 update_miniwindow_p = true;
13303 must_finish = 1;
13305 /* If we don't display the current message, don't clear the
13306 message_cleared_p flag, because, if we did, we wouldn't clear
13307 the echo area in the next redisplay which doesn't preserve
13308 the echo area. */
13309 if (!display_last_displayed_message_p)
13310 message_cleared_p = 0;
13312 if (window_height_changed_p)
13314 windows_or_buffers_changed = 50;
13316 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13317 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13318 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13319 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13322 else if (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window)
13323 && (current_buffer->clip_changed || window_outdated (w))
13324 && resize_mini_window (w, 0))
13326 /* Resized active mini-window to fit the size of what it is
13327 showing if its contents might have changed. */
13328 must_finish = 1;
13330 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13331 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13332 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13333 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13336 if (windows_or_buffers_changed && !update_mode_lines)
13337 /* Code that sets windows_or_buffers_changed doesn't distinguish whether
13338 only the windows's contents needs to be refreshed, or whether the
13339 mode-lines also need a refresh. */
13340 update_mode_lines = (windows_or_buffers_changed == REDISPLAY_SOME
13341 ? REDISPLAY_SOME : 32);
13343 /* If specs for an arrow have changed, do thorough redisplay
13344 to ensure we remove any arrow that should no longer exist. */
13345 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
13346 /* Apparently, this is the only case where we update other windows,
13347 without updating other mode-lines. */
13348 windows_or_buffers_changed = 49;
13350 consider_all_windows_p = (update_mode_lines
13351 || windows_or_buffers_changed);
13353 #define AINC(a,i) \
13354 if (VECTORP (a) && i >= 0 && i < ASIZE (a) && INTEGERP (AREF (a, i))) \
13355 ASET (a, i, make_number (1 + XINT (AREF (a, i))))
13357 AINC (Vredisplay__all_windows_cause, windows_or_buffers_changed);
13358 AINC (Vredisplay__mode_lines_cause, update_mode_lines);
13360 /* Optimize the case that only the line containing the cursor in the
13361 selected window has changed. Variables starting with this_ are
13362 set in display_line and record information about the line
13363 containing the cursor. */
13364 tlbufpos = this_line_start_pos;
13365 tlendpos = this_line_end_pos;
13366 if (!consider_all_windows_p
13367 && CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > 0
13368 && !w->update_mode_line
13369 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
13370 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
13371 && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13372 && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13373 && !XFRAME (w->frame)->cursor_type_changed
13374 /* Make sure recorded data applies to current buffer, etc. */
13375 && this_line_buffer == current_buffer
13376 && match_p
13377 && !w->force_start
13378 && !w->optional_new_start
13379 /* Point must be on the line that we have info recorded about. */
13380 && PT >= CHARPOS (tlbufpos)
13381 && PT <= Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13382 /* All text outside that line, including its final newline,
13383 must be unchanged. */
13384 && text_outside_line_unchanged_p (w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos),
13385 CHARPOS (tlendpos)))
13387 if (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > BEGV
13388 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos) - 1) != '\n'
13389 && (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) == ZV
13390 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos)) == '\n'))
13391 /* Former continuation line has disappeared by becoming empty. */
13392 goto cancel;
13393 else if (window_outdated (w) || MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
13395 /* We have to handle the case of continuation around a
13396 wide-column character (see the comment in indent.c around
13397 line 1340).
13399 For instance, in the following case:
13401 -------- Insert --------
13402 K_A_N_\\ `a' K_A_N_a\ `X_' are wide-column chars.
13403 J_I_ ==> J_I_ `^^' are cursors.
13404 ^^ ^^
13405 -------- --------
13407 As we have to redraw the line above, we cannot use this
13408 optimization. */
13410 struct it it;
13411 int line_height_before = this_line_pixel_height;
13413 /* Note that start_display will handle the case that the
13414 line starting at tlbufpos is a continuation line. */
13415 start_display (&it, w, tlbufpos);
13417 /* Implementation note: It this still necessary? */
13418 if (it.current_x != this_line_start_x)
13419 goto cancel;
13421 TRACE ((stderr, "trying display optimization 1\n"));
13422 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
13423 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
13424 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13425 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13426 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos);
13427 display_line (&it);
13429 /* If line contains point, is not continued,
13430 and ends at same distance from eob as before, we win. */
13431 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0
13432 /* Line is not continued, otherwise this_line_start_pos
13433 would have been set to 0 in display_line. */
13434 && CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
13435 /* Line ends as before. */
13436 && CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos) == CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13437 /* Line has same height as before. Otherwise other lines
13438 would have to be shifted up or down. */
13439 && this_line_pixel_height == line_height_before)
13441 /* If this is not the window's last line, we must adjust
13442 the charstarts of the lines below. */
13443 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
13445 struct glyph_row *row
13446 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos + 1);
13447 ptrdiff_t delta, delta_bytes;
13449 /* We used to distinguish between two cases here,
13450 conditioned by Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos) == ZV, for
13451 when the line ends in a newline or the end of the
13452 buffer's accessible portion. But both cases did
13453 the same, so they were collapsed. */
13454 delta = (Z
13455 - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13456 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row));
13457 delta_bytes = (Z_BYTE
13458 - BYTEPOS (tlendpos)
13459 - MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
13461 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
13462 this_line_vpos + 1,
13463 w->current_matrix->nrows,
13464 delta, delta_bytes);
13467 /* If this row displays text now but previously didn't,
13468 or vice versa, w->window_end_vpos may have to be
13469 adjusted. */
13470 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (it.glyph_row - 1))
13472 if (w->window_end_vpos < this_line_vpos)
13473 w->window_end_vpos = this_line_vpos;
13475 else if (w->window_end_vpos == this_line_vpos
13476 && this_line_vpos > 0)
13477 w->window_end_vpos = this_line_vpos - 1;
13478 w->window_end_valid = 0;
13480 /* Update hint: No need to try to scroll in update_window. */
13481 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
13483 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13484 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13485 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 1");
13486 #endif
13487 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13488 update_window_fringes (w, 0);
13489 #endif
13490 goto update;
13492 else
13493 goto cancel;
13495 else if (/* Cursor position hasn't changed. */
13496 PT == w->last_point
13497 /* Make sure the cursor was last displayed
13498 in this window. Otherwise we have to reposition it. */
13500 /* PXW: Must be converted to pixels, probably. */
13501 && 0 <= w->cursor.vpos
13502 && w->cursor.vpos < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
13504 if (!must_finish)
13506 do_pending_window_change (1);
13507 /* If selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13508 if (WINDOWP (selected_window)
13509 && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13510 goto retry;
13512 /* We used to always goto end_of_redisplay here, but this
13513 isn't enough if we have a blinking cursor. */
13514 if (w->cursor_off_p == w->last_cursor_off_p)
13515 goto end_of_redisplay;
13517 goto update;
13519 /* If highlighting the region, or if the cursor is in the echo area,
13520 then we can't just move the cursor. */
13521 else if (NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
13522 && !cursor_in_echo_area)
13524 struct it it;
13525 struct glyph_row *row;
13527 /* Skip from tlbufpos to PT and see where it is. Note that
13528 PT may be in invisible text. If so, we will end at the
13529 next visible position. */
13530 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos), BYTEPOS (tlbufpos),
13531 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
13532 it.current_x = this_line_start_x;
13533 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13534 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13536 /* The call to move_it_to stops in front of PT, but
13537 moves over before-strings. */
13538 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
13540 if (it.vpos == this_line_vpos
13541 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos),
13542 row->enabled_p))
13544 eassert (this_line_vpos == it.vpos);
13545 eassert (this_line_y == it.current_y);
13546 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
13547 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13548 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13549 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 3");
13550 #endif
13551 goto update;
13553 else
13554 goto cancel;
13557 cancel:
13558 /* Text changed drastically or point moved off of line. */
13559 SET_MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos, false);
13562 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13563 ++clear_face_cache_count;
13564 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13565 ++clear_image_cache_count;
13566 #endif
13568 /* Build desired matrices, and update the display. If
13569 consider_all_windows_p is non-zero, do it for all windows on all
13570 frames. Otherwise do it for selected_window, only. */
13572 if (consider_all_windows_p)
13574 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13575 XFRAME (frame)->updated_p = 0;
13577 propagate_buffer_redisplay ();
13579 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13581 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13583 /* We don't have to do anything for unselected terminal
13584 frames. */
13585 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f))
13586 && !EQ (FRAME_TTY (f)->top_frame, frame))
13587 continue;
13589 retry_frame:
13591 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) || FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || f == sf)
13593 bool gcscrollbars
13594 /* Only GC scrollbars when we redisplay the whole frame. */
13595 = f->redisplay || !REDISPLAY_SOME_P ();
13596 /* Mark all the scroll bars to be removed; we'll redeem
13597 the ones we want when we redisplay their windows. */
13598 if (gcscrollbars && FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook)
13599 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13601 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13602 redisplay_windows (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
13603 /* Remember that the invisible frames need to be redisplayed next
13604 time they're visible. */
13605 else if (!REDISPLAY_SOME_P ())
13606 f->redisplay = true;
13608 /* The X error handler may have deleted that frame. */
13609 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f))
13610 continue;
13612 /* Any scroll bars which redisplay_windows should have
13613 nuked should now go away. */
13614 if (gcscrollbars && FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook)
13615 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13617 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13619 /* If fonts changed on visible frame, display again. */
13620 if (f->fonts_changed)
13622 adjust_frame_glyphs (f);
13623 f->fonts_changed = 0;
13624 goto retry_frame;
13627 /* See if we have to hscroll. */
13628 if (!f->already_hscrolled_p)
13630 f->already_hscrolled_p = 1;
13631 if (hscroll_windows (f->root_window))
13632 goto retry_frame;
13635 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display
13636 update. stdio is not robust about handling
13637 signals, which can cause an apparent I/O error. */
13638 if (interrupt_input)
13639 unrequest_sigio ();
13640 STOP_POLLING;
13642 pending |= update_frame (f, 0, 0);
13643 f->cursor_type_changed = 0;
13644 f->updated_p = 1;
13649 eassert (EQ (XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window, selected_window));
13651 if (!pending)
13653 /* Do the mark_window_display_accurate after all windows have
13654 been redisplayed because this call resets flags in buffers
13655 which are needed for proper redisplay. */
13656 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13658 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13659 if (f->updated_p)
13661 f->redisplay = false;
13662 mark_window_display_accurate (f->root_window, 1);
13663 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
13664 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook (f);
13669 else if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13671 Lisp_Object mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13672 struct frame *mini_frame;
13674 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->contents);
13675 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13676 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13677 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, selected_window,
13678 list_of_error,
13679 redisplay_window_error);
13680 if (update_miniwindow_p)
13681 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, mini_window,
13682 list_of_error,
13683 redisplay_window_error);
13685 /* Compare desired and current matrices, perform output. */
13687 update:
13688 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13689 if (sf->fonts_changed)
13690 goto retry;
13692 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display update.
13693 stdio is not robust about handling signals,
13694 which can cause an apparent I/O error. */
13695 if (interrupt_input)
13696 unrequest_sigio ();
13697 STOP_POLLING;
13699 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13701 if (hscroll_windows (selected_window))
13702 goto retry;
13704 XWINDOW (selected_window)->must_be_updated_p = true;
13705 pending = update_frame (sf, 0, 0);
13706 sf->cursor_type_changed = 0;
13709 /* We may have called echo_area_display at the top of this
13710 function. If the echo area is on another frame, that may
13711 have put text on a frame other than the selected one, so the
13712 above call to update_frame would not have caught it. Catch
13713 it here. */
13714 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13715 mini_frame = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
13717 if (mini_frame != sf && FRAME_WINDOW_P (mini_frame))
13719 XWINDOW (mini_window)->must_be_updated_p = true;
13720 pending |= update_frame (mini_frame, 0, 0);
13721 mini_frame->cursor_type_changed = 0;
13722 if (!pending && hscroll_windows (mini_window))
13723 goto retry;
13727 /* If display was paused because of pending input, make sure we do a
13728 thorough update the next time. */
13729 if (pending)
13731 /* Prevent the optimization at the beginning of
13732 redisplay_internal that tries a single-line update of the
13733 line containing the cursor in the selected window. */
13734 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13736 /* Let the overlay arrow be updated the next time. */
13737 update_overlay_arrows (0);
13739 /* If we pause after scrolling, some rows in the current
13740 matrices of some windows are not valid. */
13741 if (!WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)
13742 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
13743 update_mode_lines = 36;
13745 else
13747 if (!consider_all_windows_p)
13749 /* This has already been done above if
13750 consider_all_windows_p is set. */
13751 if (XBUFFER (w->contents)->text->redisplay
13752 && buffer_window_count (XBUFFER (w->contents)) > 1)
13753 /* This can happen if b->text->redisplay was set during
13754 jit-lock. */
13755 propagate_buffer_redisplay ();
13756 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, 1);
13758 /* Say overlay arrows are up to date. */
13759 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13761 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0)
13762 FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook (sf);
13765 update_mode_lines = 0;
13766 windows_or_buffers_changed = 0;
13769 /* Start SIGIO interrupts coming again. Having them off during the
13770 code above makes it less likely one will discard output, but not
13771 impossible, since there might be stuff in the system buffer here.
13772 But it is much hairier to try to do anything about that. */
13773 if (interrupt_input)
13774 request_sigio ();
13775 RESUME_POLLING;
13777 /* If a frame has become visible which was not before, redisplay
13778 again, so that we display it. Expose events for such a frame
13779 (which it gets when becoming visible) don't call the parts of
13780 redisplay constructing glyphs, so simply exposing a frame won't
13781 display anything in this case. So, we have to display these
13782 frames here explicitly. */
13783 if (!pending)
13785 int new_count = 0;
13787 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13789 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13790 new_count++;
13793 if (new_count != number_of_visible_frames)
13794 windows_or_buffers_changed = 52;
13797 /* Change frame size now if a change is pending. */
13798 do_pending_window_change (1);
13800 /* If we just did a pending size change, or have additional
13801 visible frames, or selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13802 if ((windows_or_buffers_changed && !pending)
13803 || (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw))
13804 goto retry;
13806 /* Clear the face and image caches.
13808 We used to do this only if consider_all_windows_p. But the cache
13809 needs to be cleared if a timer creates images in the current
13810 buffer (e.g. the test case in Bug#6230). */
13812 if (clear_face_cache_count > CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT)
13814 clear_face_cache (0);
13815 clear_face_cache_count = 0;
13818 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13819 if (clear_image_cache_count > CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT)
13821 clear_image_caches (Qnil);
13822 clear_image_cache_count = 0;
13824 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
13826 end_of_redisplay:
13827 if (interrupt_input && interrupts_deferred)
13828 request_sigio ();
13830 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
13831 RESUME_POLLING;
13835 /* Redisplay, but leave alone any recent echo area message unless
13836 another message has been requested in its place.
13838 This is useful in situations where you need to redisplay but no
13839 user action has occurred, making it inappropriate for the message
13840 area to be cleared. See tracking_off and
13841 wait_reading_process_output for examples of these situations.
13843 FROM_WHERE is an integer saying from where this function was
13844 called. This is useful for debugging. */
13846 void
13847 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (int from_where)
13849 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_preserve_echo_area (%d)\n", from_where));
13851 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]))
13853 /* We have a previously displayed message, but no current
13854 message. Redisplay the previous message. */
13855 display_last_displayed_message_p = 1;
13856 redisplay_internal ();
13857 display_last_displayed_message_p = 0;
13859 else
13860 redisplay_internal ();
13862 flush_frame (SELECTED_FRAME ());
13866 /* Function registered with record_unwind_protect in redisplay_internal. */
13868 static void
13869 unwind_redisplay (void)
13871 redisplaying_p = 0;
13875 /* Mark the display of leaf window W as accurate or inaccurate.
13876 If ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of W as accurate. If
13877 ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for W to be redisplayed the next
13878 time redisplay_internal is called. */
13880 static void
13881 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *w, int accurate_p)
13883 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->contents);
13885 w->last_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_MODIFF (b) : 0;
13886 w->last_overlay_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b) : 0;
13887 w->last_had_star = BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b);
13889 if (accurate_p)
13891 b->clip_changed = false;
13892 b->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = false;
13893 eassert (buffer_window_count (b) > 0);
13894 /* Resetting b->text->redisplay is problematic!
13895 In order to make it safer to do it here, redisplay_internal must
13896 have copied all b->text->redisplay to their respective windows. */
13897 b->text->redisplay = false;
13899 BUF_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_MODIFF (b);
13900 BUF_OVERLAY_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b);
13901 BUF_BEG_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_GPT (b) - BUF_BEG (b);
13902 BUF_END_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_Z (b) - BUF_GPT (b);
13904 w->current_matrix->buffer = b;
13905 w->current_matrix->begv = BUF_BEGV (b);
13906 w->current_matrix->zv = BUF_ZV (b);
13908 w->last_cursor_vpos = w->cursor.vpos;
13909 w->last_cursor_off_p = w->cursor_off_p;
13911 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
13912 w->last_point = BUF_PT (b);
13913 else
13914 w->last_point = marker_position (w->pointm);
13916 w->window_end_valid = true;
13917 w->update_mode_line = false;
13920 w->redisplay = !accurate_p;
13924 /* Mark the display of windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW as
13925 accurate or inaccurate. If ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of
13926 windows as accurate. If ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for windows to
13927 be redisplayed the next time redisplay_internal is called. */
13929 void
13930 mark_window_display_accurate (Lisp_Object window, int accurate_p)
13932 struct window *w;
13934 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next)
13936 w = XWINDOW (window);
13937 if (WINDOWP (w->contents))
13938 mark_window_display_accurate (w->contents, accurate_p);
13939 else
13940 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, accurate_p);
13943 if (accurate_p)
13944 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13945 else
13946 /* Force a thorough redisplay the next time by setting
13947 last_arrow_position and last_arrow_string to t, which is
13948 unequal to any useful value of Voverlay_arrow_... */
13949 update_overlay_arrows (-1);
13953 /* Return value in display table DP (Lisp_Char_Table *) for character
13954 C. Since a display table doesn't have any parent, we don't have to
13955 follow parent. Do not call this function directly but use the
13956 macro DISP_CHAR_VECTOR. */
13958 Lisp_Object
13959 disp_char_vector (struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp, int c)
13961 Lisp_Object val;
13963 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
13965 val = dp->ascii;
13966 if (SUB_CHAR_TABLE_P (val))
13967 val = XSUB_CHAR_TABLE (val)->contents[c];
13969 else
13971 Lisp_Object table;
13973 XSETCHAR_TABLE (table, dp);
13974 val = char_table_ref (table, c);
13976 if (NILP (val))
13977 val = dp->defalt;
13978 return val;
13983 /***********************************************************************
13984 Window Redisplay
13985 ***********************************************************************/
13987 /* Redisplay all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW. */
13989 static void
13990 redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object window)
13992 while (!NILP (window))
13994 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
13996 if (WINDOWP (w->contents))
13997 redisplay_windows (w->contents);
13998 else if (BUFFERP (w->contents))
14000 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (w->contents);
14001 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
14002 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
14003 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_0, window,
14004 list_of_error,
14005 redisplay_window_error);
14008 window = w->next;
14012 static Lisp_Object
14013 redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object ignore)
14015 displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff = BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer);
14016 return Qnil;
14019 static Lisp_Object
14020 redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object window)
14022 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
14023 redisplay_window (window, false);
14024 return Qnil;
14027 static Lisp_Object
14028 redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object window)
14030 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
14031 redisplay_window (window, true);
14032 return Qnil;
14036 /* Set cursor position of W. PT is assumed to be displayed in ROW.
14037 DELTA and DELTA_BYTES are the numbers of characters and bytes by
14038 which positions recorded in ROW differ from current buffer
14039 positions.
14041 Return 0 if cursor is not on this row, 1 otherwise. */
14043 static int
14044 set_cursor_from_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
14045 struct glyph_matrix *matrix,
14046 ptrdiff_t delta, ptrdiff_t delta_bytes,
14047 int dy, int dvpos)
14049 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14050 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
14051 struct glyph *cursor = NULL;
14052 /* The last known character position in row. */
14053 ptrdiff_t last_pos = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14054 int x = row->x;
14055 ptrdiff_t pt_old = PT - delta;
14056 ptrdiff_t pos_before = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14057 ptrdiff_t pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14058 struct glyph *glyph_before = glyph - 1, *glyph_after = end;
14059 /* A glyph beyond the edge of TEXT_AREA which we should never
14060 touch. */
14061 struct glyph *glyphs_end = end;
14062 /* Non-zero means we've found a match for cursor position, but that
14063 glyph has the avoid_cursor_p flag set. */
14064 int match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14065 /* Non-zero means we've seen at least one glyph that came from a
14066 display string. */
14067 int string_seen = 0;
14068 /* Largest and smallest buffer positions seen so far during scan of
14069 glyph row. */
14070 ptrdiff_t bpos_max = pos_before;
14071 ptrdiff_t bpos_min = pos_after;
14072 /* Last buffer position covered by an overlay string with an integer
14073 `cursor' property. */
14074 ptrdiff_t bpos_covered = 0;
14075 /* Non-zero means the display string on which to display the cursor
14076 comes from a text property, not from an overlay. */
14077 int string_from_text_prop = 0;
14079 /* Don't even try doing anything if called for a mode-line or
14080 header-line row, since the rest of the code isn't prepared to
14081 deal with such calamities. */
14082 eassert (!row->mode_line_p);
14083 if (row->mode_line_p)
14084 return 0;
14086 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start and the end of
14087 the row. These are special glyphs like truncation marks on
14088 terminal frames. */
14089 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
14091 if (!row->reversed_p)
14093 while (glyph < end
14094 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14095 && glyph->charpos < 0)
14097 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14098 ++glyph;
14100 while (end > glyph
14101 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
14102 /* CHARPOS is zero for blanks and stretch glyphs
14103 inserted by extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
14104 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
14105 --end;
14106 glyph_before = glyph - 1;
14107 glyph_after = end;
14109 else
14111 struct glyph *g;
14113 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to process it from back
14114 to front, so swap the edge pointers. */
14115 glyphs_end = end = glyph - 1;
14116 glyph += row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
14118 while (glyph > end + 1
14119 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14120 && glyph->charpos < 0)
14122 --glyph;
14123 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14125 if (INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos < 0)
14126 --glyph;
14127 /* By default, in reversed rows we put the cursor on the
14128 rightmost (first in the reading order) glyph. */
14129 for (g = end + 1; g < glyph; g++)
14130 x += g->pixel_width;
14131 while (end < glyph
14132 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
14133 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
14134 ++end;
14135 glyph_before = glyph + 1;
14136 glyph_after = end;
14139 else if (row->reversed_p)
14141 /* In R2L rows that don't display text, put the cursor on the
14142 rightmost glyph. Case in point: an empty last line that is
14143 part of an R2L paragraph. */
14144 cursor = end - 1;
14145 /* Avoid placing the cursor on the last glyph of the row, where
14146 on terminal frames we hold the vertical border between
14147 adjacent windows. */
14148 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
14149 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
14150 && cursor == row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1)
14151 cursor--;
14152 x = -1; /* will be computed below, at label compute_x */
14155 /* Step 1: Try to find the glyph whose character position
14156 corresponds to point. If that's not possible, find 2 glyphs
14157 whose character positions are the closest to point, one before
14158 point, the other after it. */
14159 if (!row->reversed_p)
14160 while (/* not marched to end of glyph row */
14161 glyph < end
14162 /* glyph was not inserted by redisplay for internal purposes */
14163 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14165 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14167 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14169 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14170 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14171 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14172 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14173 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14175 /* If we hit point, we've found the glyph on which to
14176 display the cursor. */
14177 if (dpos == 0)
14179 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14180 break;
14182 /* See if we've found a better approximation to
14183 POS_BEFORE or to POS_AFTER. */
14184 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14186 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14187 glyph_before = glyph;
14189 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14191 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14192 glyph_after = glyph;
14195 else if (dpos == 0)
14196 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14198 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14200 Lisp_Object chprop;
14201 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14203 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14204 glyph->object);
14205 if (!NILP (chprop))
14207 /* If the string came from a `display' text property,
14208 look up the buffer position of that property and
14209 use that position to update bpos_max, as if we
14210 actually saw such a position in one of the row's
14211 glyphs. This helps with supporting integer values
14212 of `cursor' property on the display string in
14213 situations where most or all of the row's buffer
14214 text is completely covered by display properties,
14215 so that no glyph with valid buffer positions is
14216 ever seen in the row. */
14217 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14218 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14219 pos_after, 0);
14221 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14222 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14224 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14226 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14227 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14228 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14229 this glyph. Note that, if a `cursor' property on one
14230 of the string's characters has an integer value, we
14231 will break out of the loop below _before_ we get to
14232 the position match above. IOW, integer values of
14233 the `cursor' property override the "exact match for
14234 point" strategy of positioning the cursor. */
14235 /* Implementation note: bpos_max == pt_old when, e.g.,
14236 we are in an empty line, where bpos_max is set to
14237 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS, see above. */
14238 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14240 cursor = glyph;
14241 break;
14245 string_seen = 1;
14247 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14248 ++glyph;
14250 else if (glyph > end) /* row is reversed */
14251 while (!INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14253 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14255 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14257 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14258 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14259 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14260 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14261 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14263 if (dpos == 0)
14265 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14266 break;
14268 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14270 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14271 glyph_before = glyph;
14273 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14275 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14276 glyph_after = glyph;
14279 else if (dpos == 0)
14280 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14282 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14284 Lisp_Object chprop;
14285 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14287 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14288 glyph->object);
14289 if (!NILP (chprop))
14291 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14292 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14293 pos_after, 0);
14295 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14296 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14298 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14300 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14301 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14302 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14303 this glyph. */
14304 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14306 cursor = glyph;
14307 break;
14310 string_seen = 1;
14312 --glyph;
14313 if (glyph == glyphs_end) /* don't dereference outside TEXT_AREA */
14315 x--; /* can't use any pixel_width */
14316 break;
14318 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14321 /* Step 2: If we didn't find an exact match for point, we need to
14322 look for a proper place to put the cursor among glyphs between
14323 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER. */
14324 if (!((row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14325 && BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14326 && !(bpos_max < pt_old && pt_old <= bpos_covered))
14328 /* An empty line has a single glyph whose OBJECT is zero and
14329 whose CHARPOS is the position of a newline on that line.
14330 Note that on a TTY, there are more glyphs after that, which
14331 were produced by extend_face_to_end_of_line, but their
14332 CHARPOS is zero or negative. */
14333 int empty_line_p =
14334 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14335 && INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos > 0
14336 /* On a TTY, continued and truncated rows also have a glyph at
14337 their end whose OBJECT is zero and whose CHARPOS is
14338 positive (the continuation and truncation glyphs), but such
14339 rows are obviously not "empty". */
14340 && !(row->continued_p || row->truncated_on_right_p);
14342 if (row->ends_in_ellipsis_p && pos_after == last_pos)
14344 ptrdiff_t ellipsis_pos;
14346 /* Scan back over the ellipsis glyphs. */
14347 if (!row->reversed_p)
14349 ellipsis_pos = (glyph - 1)->charpos;
14350 while (glyph > row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
14351 && (glyph - 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14352 glyph--, x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14353 /* That loop always goes one position too far, including
14354 the glyph before the ellipsis. So scan forward over
14355 that one. */
14356 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14357 glyph++;
14359 else /* row is reversed */
14361 ellipsis_pos = (glyph + 1)->charpos;
14362 while (glyph < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14363 && (glyph + 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14364 glyph++, x += glyph->pixel_width;
14365 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14366 glyph--;
14369 else if (match_with_avoid_cursor)
14371 cursor = glyph_after;
14372 x = -1;
14374 else if (string_seen)
14376 int incr = row->reversed_p ? -1 : +1;
14378 /* Need to find the glyph that came out of a string which is
14379 present at point. That glyph is somewhere between
14380 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER, and it came from a string
14381 positioned between POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER in the
14382 buffer. */
14383 struct glyph *start, *stop;
14384 ptrdiff_t pos = pos_before;
14386 x = -1;
14388 /* If the row ends in a newline from a display string,
14389 reordering could have moved the glyphs belonging to the
14390 string out of the [GLYPH_BEFORE..GLYPH_AFTER] range. So
14391 in this case we extend the search to the last glyph in
14392 the row that was not inserted by redisplay. */
14393 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
14395 glyph_after = end;
14396 pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14399 /* GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER are the glyphs that
14400 correspond to POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER, respectively. We
14401 need START and STOP in the order that corresponds to the
14402 row's direction as given by its reversed_p flag. If the
14403 directionality of characters between POS_BEFORE and
14404 POS_AFTER is the opposite of the row's base direction,
14405 these characters will have been reordered for display,
14406 and we need to reverse START and STOP. */
14407 if (!row->reversed_p)
14409 start = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14410 stop = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14412 else
14414 start = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14415 stop = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14417 for (glyph = start + incr;
14418 row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop; )
14421 /* Any glyphs that come from the buffer are here because
14422 of bidi reordering. Skip them, and only pay
14423 attention to glyphs that came from some string. */
14424 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14426 Lisp_Object str;
14427 ptrdiff_t tem;
14428 /* If the display property covers the newline, we
14429 need to search for it one position farther. */
14430 ptrdiff_t lim = pos_after
14431 + (pos_after == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14433 string_from_text_prop = 0;
14434 str = glyph->object;
14435 tem = string_buffer_position_lim (str, pos, lim, 0);
14436 if (tem == 0 /* from overlay */
14437 || pos <= tem)
14439 /* If the string from which this glyph came is
14440 found in the buffer at point, or at position
14441 that is closer to point than pos_after, then
14442 we've found the glyph we've been looking for.
14443 If it comes from an overlay (tem == 0), and
14444 it has the `cursor' property on one of its
14445 glyphs, record that glyph as a candidate for
14446 displaying the cursor. (As in the
14447 unidirectional version, we will display the
14448 cursor on the last candidate we find.) */
14449 if (tem == 0
14450 || tem == pt_old
14451 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14453 /* The glyphs from this string could have
14454 been reordered. Find the one with the
14455 smallest string position. Or there could
14456 be a character in the string with the
14457 `cursor' property, which means display
14458 cursor on that character's glyph. */
14459 ptrdiff_t strpos = glyph->charpos;
14461 if (tem)
14463 cursor = glyph;
14464 string_from_text_prop = 1;
14466 for ( ;
14467 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14468 && EQ (glyph->object, str);
14469 glyph += incr)
14471 Lisp_Object cprop;
14472 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
14474 cprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
14475 Qcursor,
14476 glyph->object);
14477 if (!NILP (cprop))
14479 cursor = glyph;
14480 break;
14482 if (tem && glyph->charpos < strpos)
14484 strpos = glyph->charpos;
14485 cursor = glyph;
14489 if (tem == pt_old
14490 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14491 goto compute_x;
14493 if (tem)
14494 pos = tem + 1; /* don't find previous instances */
14496 /* This string is not what we want; skip all of the
14497 glyphs that came from it. */
14498 while ((row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14499 && EQ (glyph->object, str))
14500 glyph += incr;
14502 else
14503 glyph += incr;
14506 /* If we reached the end of the line, and END was from a string,
14507 the cursor is not on this line. */
14508 if (cursor == NULL
14509 && (row->reversed_p ? glyph <= end : glyph >= end)
14510 && (row->reversed_p ? end > glyphs_end : end < glyphs_end)
14511 && STRINGP (end->object)
14512 && row->continued_p)
14513 return 0;
14515 /* A truncated row may not include PT among its character positions.
14516 Setting the cursor inside the scroll margin will trigger
14517 recalculation of hscroll in hscroll_window_tree. But if a
14518 display string covers point, defer to the string-handling
14519 code below to figure this out. */
14520 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p && pt_old < bpos_min)
14522 cursor = glyph_before;
14523 x = -1;
14525 else if ((row->truncated_on_right_p && pt_old > bpos_max)
14526 /* Zero-width characters produce no glyphs. */
14527 || (!empty_line_p
14528 && (row->reversed_p
14529 ? glyph_after > glyphs_end
14530 : glyph_after < glyphs_end)))
14532 cursor = glyph_after;
14533 x = -1;
14537 compute_x:
14538 if (cursor != NULL)
14539 glyph = cursor;
14540 else if (glyph == glyphs_end
14541 && pos_before == pos_after
14542 && STRINGP ((row->reversed_p
14543 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14544 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])->object))
14546 /* If all the glyphs of this row came from strings, put the
14547 cursor on the first glyph of the row. This avoids having the
14548 cursor outside of the text area in this very rare and hard
14549 use case. */
14550 glyph =
14551 row->reversed_p
14552 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14553 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14555 if (x < 0)
14557 struct glyph *g;
14559 /* Need to compute x that corresponds to GLYPH. */
14560 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = row->x; g < glyph; g++)
14562 if (g >= row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA])
14563 emacs_abort ();
14564 x += g->pixel_width;
14568 /* ROW could be part of a continued line, which, under bidi
14569 reordering, might have other rows whose start and end charpos
14570 occlude point. Only set w->cursor if we found a better
14571 approximation to the cursor position than we have from previously
14572 examined candidate rows belonging to the same continued line. */
14573 if (/* We already have a candidate row. */
14574 w->cursor.vpos >= 0
14575 /* That candidate is not the row we are processing. */
14576 && MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) != row
14577 /* Make sure cursor.vpos specifies a row whose start and end
14578 charpos occlude point, and it is valid candidate for being a
14579 cursor-row. This is because some callers of this function
14580 leave cursor.vpos at the row where the cursor was displayed
14581 during the last redisplay cycle. */
14582 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)) <= pt_old
14583 && pt_old <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14584 && cursor_row_p (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)))
14586 struct glyph *g1
14587 = MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) + w->cursor.hpos;
14589 /* Don't consider glyphs that are outside TEXT_AREA. */
14590 if (!(row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end))
14591 return 0;
14592 /* Keep the candidate whose buffer position is the closest to
14593 point or has the `cursor' property. */
14594 if (/* Previous candidate is a glyph in TEXT_AREA of that row. */
14595 w->cursor.hpos >= 0
14596 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)
14597 && ((BUFFERP (g1->object)
14598 && (g1->charpos == pt_old /* An exact match always wins. */
14599 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
14600 && eabs (g1->charpos - pt_old)
14601 < eabs (glyph->charpos - pt_old))))
14602 /* Previous candidate is a glyph from a string that has
14603 a non-nil `cursor' property. */
14604 || (STRINGP (g1->object)
14605 && (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (g1->charpos),
14606 Qcursor, g1->object))
14607 /* Previous candidate is from the same display
14608 string as this one, and the display string
14609 came from a text property. */
14610 || (EQ (g1->object, glyph->object)
14611 && string_from_text_prop)
14612 /* this candidate is from newline and its
14613 position is not an exact match */
14614 || (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14615 && glyph->charpos != pt_old)))))
14616 return 0;
14617 /* If this candidate gives an exact match, use that. */
14618 if (!((BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14619 /* If this candidate is a glyph created for the
14620 terminating newline of a line, and point is on that
14621 newline, it wins because it's an exact match. */
14622 || (!row->continued_p
14623 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14624 && glyph->charpos == 0
14625 && pt_old == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1))
14626 /* Otherwise, keep the candidate that comes from a row
14627 spanning less buffer positions. This may win when one or
14628 both candidate positions are on glyphs that came from
14629 display strings, for which we cannot compare buffer
14630 positions. */
14631 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14632 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14633 < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
14634 return 0;
14636 w->cursor.hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14637 w->cursor.x = x;
14638 w->cursor.vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, matrix) + dvpos;
14639 w->cursor.y = row->y + dy;
14641 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
14643 if (!row->continued_p
14644 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14645 && row->x == 0)
14647 this_line_buffer = XBUFFER (w->contents);
14649 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14650 = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14651 BYTEPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14652 = MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes;
14654 CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14655 = Z - (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14656 BYTEPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14657 = Z_BYTE - (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes);
14659 this_line_y = w->cursor.y;
14660 this_line_pixel_height = row->height;
14661 this_line_vpos = w->cursor.vpos;
14662 this_line_start_x = row->x;
14664 else
14665 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
14668 return 1;
14672 /* Run window scroll functions, if any, for WINDOW with new window
14673 start STARTP. Sets the window start of WINDOW to that position.
14675 We assume that the window's buffer is really current. */
14677 static struct text_pos
14678 run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp)
14680 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14681 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, startp);
14683 eassert (current_buffer == XBUFFER (w->contents));
14685 if (!NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
14687 run_hook_with_args_2 (Qwindow_scroll_functions, window,
14688 make_number (CHARPOS (startp)));
14689 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14690 /* In case the hook functions switch buffers. */
14691 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->contents));
14694 return startp;
14698 /* Make sure the line containing the cursor is fully visible.
14699 A value of 1 means there is nothing to be done.
14700 (Either the line is fully visible, or it cannot be made so,
14701 or we cannot tell.)
14703 If FORCE_P is non-zero, return 0 even if partial visible cursor row
14704 is higher than window.
14706 A value of 0 means the caller should do scrolling
14707 as if point had gone off the screen. */
14709 static int
14710 cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *w, int force_p, int current_matrix_p)
14712 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
14713 struct glyph_row *row;
14714 int window_height;
14716 if (!make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
14717 return 1;
14719 /* It's not always possible to find the cursor, e.g, when a window
14720 is full of overlay strings. Don't do anything in that case. */
14721 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14722 return 1;
14724 matrix = current_matrix_p ? w->current_matrix : w->desired_matrix;
14725 row = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
14727 /* If the cursor row is not partially visible, there's nothing to do. */
14728 if (!MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row))
14729 return 1;
14731 /* If the row the cursor is in is taller than the window's height,
14732 it's not clear what to do, so do nothing. */
14733 window_height = window_box_height (w);
14734 if (row->height >= window_height)
14736 if (!force_p || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
14737 || w->vscroll || w->cursor.vpos == 0)
14738 return 1;
14740 return 0;
14744 /* Try scrolling PT into view in window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P
14745 non-zero means only WINDOW is redisplayed in redisplay_internal.
14746 TEMP_SCROLL_STEP has the same meaning as emacs_scroll_step, and is used
14747 in redisplay_window to bring a partially visible line into view in
14748 the case that only the cursor has moved.
14750 LAST_LINE_MISFIT should be nonzero if we're scrolling because the
14751 last screen line's vertical height extends past the end of the screen.
14753 Value is
14755 1 if scrolling succeeded
14757 0 if scrolling didn't find point.
14759 -1 if new fonts have been loaded so that we must interrupt
14760 redisplay, adjust glyph matrices, and try again. */
14762 enum
14764 SCROLLING_SUCCESS,
14765 SCROLLING_FAILED,
14766 SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14769 /* If scroll-conservatively is more than this, never recenter.
14771 If you change this, don't forget to update the doc string of
14772 `scroll-conservatively' and the Emacs manual. */
14773 #define SCROLL_LIMIT 100
14775 static int
14776 try_scrolling (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p,
14777 ptrdiff_t arg_scroll_conservatively, ptrdiff_t scroll_step,
14778 int temp_scroll_step, int last_line_misfit)
14780 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14781 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
14782 struct text_pos pos, startp;
14783 struct it it;
14784 int this_scroll_margin, scroll_max, rc, height;
14785 int dy = 0, amount_to_scroll = 0, scroll_down_p = 0;
14786 int extra_scroll_margin_lines = last_line_misfit ? 1 : 0;
14787 Lisp_Object aggressive;
14788 /* We will never try scrolling more than this number of lines. */
14789 int scroll_limit = SCROLL_LIMIT;
14790 int frame_line_height = default_line_pixel_height (w);
14791 int window_total_lines
14792 = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / frame_line_height;
14794 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
14795 debug_method_add (w, "try_scrolling");
14796 #endif
14798 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14800 /* Compute scroll margin height in pixels. We scroll when point is
14801 within this distance from the top or bottom of the window. */
14802 if (scroll_margin > 0)
14803 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, window_total_lines / 4)
14804 * frame_line_height;
14805 else
14806 this_scroll_margin = 0;
14808 /* Force arg_scroll_conservatively to have a reasonable value, to
14809 avoid scrolling too far away with slow move_it_* functions. Note
14810 that the user can supply scroll-conservatively equal to
14811 `most-positive-fixnum', which can be larger than INT_MAX. */
14812 if (arg_scroll_conservatively > scroll_limit)
14814 arg_scroll_conservatively = scroll_limit + 1;
14815 scroll_max = scroll_limit * frame_line_height;
14817 else if (scroll_step || arg_scroll_conservatively || temp_scroll_step)
14818 /* Compute how much we should try to scroll maximally to bring
14819 point into view. */
14820 scroll_max = (max (scroll_step,
14821 max (arg_scroll_conservatively, temp_scroll_step))
14822 * frame_line_height);
14823 else if (NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively))
14824 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)))
14825 /* We're trying to scroll because of aggressive scrolling but no
14826 scroll_step is set. Choose an arbitrary one. */
14827 scroll_max = 10 * frame_line_height;
14828 else
14829 scroll_max = 0;
14831 too_near_end:
14833 /* Decide whether to scroll down. */
14834 if (PT > CHARPOS (startp))
14836 int scroll_margin_y;
14838 /* Compute the pixel ypos of the scroll margin, then move IT to
14839 either that ypos or PT, whichever comes first. */
14840 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14841 scroll_margin_y = it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin
14842 - frame_line_height * extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14843 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, scroll_margin_y - 1, -1,
14844 (MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y));
14846 if (PT > CHARPOS (it.current.pos))
14848 int y0 = line_bottom_y (&it);
14849 /* Compute how many pixels below window bottom to stop searching
14850 for PT. This avoids costly search for PT that is far away if
14851 the user limited scrolling by a small number of lines, but
14852 always finds PT if scroll_conservatively is set to a large
14853 number, such as most-positive-fixnum. */
14854 int slack = max (scroll_max, 10 * frame_line_height);
14855 int y_to_move = it.last_visible_y + slack;
14857 /* Compute the distance from the scroll margin to PT or to
14858 the scroll limit, whichever comes first. This should
14859 include the height of the cursor line, to make that line
14860 fully visible. */
14861 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, y_to_move,
14862 -1, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
14863 dy = line_bottom_y (&it) - y0;
14865 if (dy > scroll_max)
14866 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14868 if (dy > 0)
14869 scroll_down_p = 1;
14873 if (scroll_down_p)
14875 /* Point is in or below the bottom scroll margin, so move the
14876 window start down. If scrolling conservatively, move it just
14877 enough down to make point visible. If scroll_step is set,
14878 move it down by scroll_step. */
14879 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14880 amount_to_scroll
14881 = min (max (dy, frame_line_height),
14882 frame_line_height * arg_scroll_conservatively);
14883 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14884 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14885 else
14887 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively);
14888 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14889 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14891 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14892 int aggressive_scroll = float_amount;
14893 if (aggressive_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14894 aggressive_scroll = 1;
14895 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
14896 the window. This could happen if the value of
14897 scroll_up_aggressively is too large and there are
14898 non-zero margins, because scroll_up_aggressively
14899 means put point that fraction of window height
14900 _from_the_bottom_margin_. */
14901 if (aggressive_scroll + 2*this_scroll_margin > height)
14902 aggressive_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin;
14903 amount_to_scroll = dy + aggressive_scroll;
14907 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14908 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14910 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14911 if (arg_scroll_conservatively <= scroll_limit)
14912 move_it_vertically (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14913 else
14915 /* Extra precision for users who set scroll-conservatively
14916 to a large number: make sure the amount we scroll
14917 the window start is never less than amount_to_scroll,
14918 which was computed as distance from window bottom to
14919 point. This matters when lines at window top and lines
14920 below window bottom have different height. */
14921 struct it it1;
14922 void *it1data = NULL;
14923 /* We use a temporary it1 because line_bottom_y can modify
14924 its argument, if it moves one line down; see there. */
14925 int start_y;
14927 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14928 start_y = line_bottom_y (&it1);
14929 do {
14930 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
14931 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14932 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14933 } while (line_bottom_y (&it1) - start_y < amount_to_scroll);
14936 /* If STARTP is unchanged, move it down another screen line. */
14937 if (CHARPOS (it.current.pos) == CHARPOS (startp))
14938 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14939 startp = it.current.pos;
14941 else
14943 struct text_pos scroll_margin_pos = startp;
14944 int y_offset = 0;
14946 /* See if point is inside the scroll margin at the top of the
14947 window. */
14948 if (this_scroll_margin)
14950 int y_start;
14952 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14953 y_start = it.current_y;
14954 move_it_vertically (&it, this_scroll_margin);
14955 scroll_margin_pos = it.current.pos;
14956 /* If we didn't move enough before hitting ZV, request
14957 additional amount of scroll, to move point out of the
14958 scroll margin. */
14959 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == ZV
14960 && it.current_y - y_start < this_scroll_margin)
14961 y_offset = this_scroll_margin - (it.current_y - y_start);
14964 if (PT < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14966 /* Point is in the scroll margin at the top of the window or
14967 above what is displayed in the window. */
14968 int y0, y_to_move;
14970 /* Compute the vertical distance from PT to the scroll
14971 margin position. Move as far as scroll_max allows, or
14972 one screenful, or 10 screen lines, whichever is largest.
14973 Give up if distance is greater than scroll_max or if we
14974 didn't reach the scroll margin position. */
14975 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE);
14976 start_display (&it, w, pos);
14977 y0 = it.current_y;
14978 y_to_move = max (it.last_visible_y,
14979 max (scroll_max, 10 * frame_line_height));
14980 move_it_to (&it, CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos), 0,
14981 y_to_move, -1,
14982 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
14983 dy = it.current_y - y0;
14984 if (dy > scroll_max
14985 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14986 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14988 /* Additional scroll for when ZV was too close to point. */
14989 dy += y_offset;
14991 /* Compute new window start. */
14992 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14994 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14995 amount_to_scroll = max (dy, frame_line_height *
14996 max (scroll_step, temp_scroll_step));
14997 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14998 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14999 else
15001 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
15002 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
15003 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
15005 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
15006 int aggressive_scroll = float_amount;
15007 if (aggressive_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
15008 aggressive_scroll = 1;
15009 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near
15010 bottom of the window, if the value of
15011 scroll_down_aggressively happens to be too
15012 large. */
15013 if (aggressive_scroll + 2*this_scroll_margin > height)
15014 aggressive_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin;
15015 amount_to_scroll = dy + aggressive_scroll;
15019 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
15020 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
15022 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, amount_to_scroll);
15023 startp = it.current.pos;
15027 /* Run window scroll functions. */
15028 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
15030 /* Display the window. Give up if new fonts are loaded, or if point
15031 doesn't appear. */
15032 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15033 rc = SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES;
15034 else if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
15036 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15037 rc = SCROLLING_FAILED;
15039 else
15041 /* Maybe forget recorded base line for line number display. */
15042 if (!just_this_one_p
15043 || current_buffer->clip_changed
15044 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
15045 w->base_line_number = 0;
15047 /* If cursor ends up on a partially visible line,
15048 treat that as being off the bottom of the screen. */
15049 if (! cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, extra_scroll_margin_lines <= 1, 0)
15050 /* It's possible that the cursor is on the first line of the
15051 buffer, which is partially obscured due to a vscroll
15052 (Bug#7537). In that case, avoid looping forever. */
15053 && extra_scroll_margin_lines < w->desired_matrix->nrows - 1)
15055 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15056 ++extra_scroll_margin_lines;
15057 goto too_near_end;
15059 rc = SCROLLING_SUCCESS;
15062 return rc;
15066 /* Compute a suitable window start for window W if display of W starts
15067 on a continuation line. Value is non-zero if a new window start
15068 was computed.
15070 The new window start will be computed, based on W's width, starting
15071 from the start of the continued line. It is the start of the
15072 screen line with the minimum distance from the old start W->start. */
15074 static int
15075 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *w)
15077 struct text_pos pos, start_pos;
15078 int window_start_changed_p = 0;
15080 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start_pos, w->start);
15082 /* If window start is on a continuation line... Window start may be
15083 < BEGV in case there's invisible text at the start of the
15084 buffer (M-x rmail, for example). */
15085 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > BEGV
15086 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start_pos) - 1) != '\n')
15088 struct it it;
15089 struct glyph_row *row;
15091 /* Handle the case that the window start is out of range. */
15092 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) < BEGV)
15093 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15094 else if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > ZV)
15095 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15097 /* Find the start of the continued line. This should be fast
15098 because find_newline is fast (newline cache). */
15099 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0);
15100 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (start_pos), BYTEPOS (start_pos),
15101 row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
15102 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
15104 /* If the line start is "too far" away from the window start,
15105 say it takes too much time to compute a new window start. */
15106 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it)
15107 /* PXW: Do we need upper bounds here? */
15108 < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (w))
15110 int min_distance, distance;
15112 /* Move forward by display lines to find the new window
15113 start. If window width was enlarged, the new start can
15114 be expected to be > the old start. If window width was
15115 decreased, the new window start will be < the old start.
15116 So, we're looking for the display line start with the
15117 minimum distance from the old window start. */
15118 pos = it.current.pos;
15119 min_distance = INFINITY;
15120 while ((distance = eabs (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it))),
15121 distance < min_distance)
15123 min_distance = distance;
15124 pos = it.current.pos;
15125 if (it.line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
15127 /* Under WORD_WRAP, move_it_by_lines is likely to
15128 overshoot and stop not at the first, but the
15129 second character from the left margin. So in
15130 that case, we need a more tight control on the X
15131 coordinate of the iterator than move_it_by_lines
15132 promises in its contract. The method is to first
15133 go to the last (rightmost) visible character of a
15134 line, then move to the leftmost character on the
15135 next line in a separate call. */
15136 move_it_to (&it, ZV, it.last_visible_x, it.current_y, -1,
15137 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15138 move_it_to (&it, ZV, 0,
15139 it.current_y + it.max_ascent + it.max_descent, -1,
15140 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15142 else
15143 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
15146 /* Set the window start there. */
15147 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, pos);
15148 window_start_changed_p = 1;
15152 return window_start_changed_p;
15156 /* Try cursor movement in case text has not changed in window WINDOW,
15157 with window start STARTP. Value is
15159 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS if successful
15161 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED if this method cannot be used
15163 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL if we know we have to scroll the
15164 display. *SCROLL_STEP is set to 1, under certain circumstances, if
15165 we want to scroll as if scroll-step were set to 1. See the code.
15167 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES if we need larger matrices, in
15168 which case we have to abort this redisplay, and adjust matrices
15169 first. */
15171 enum
15173 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS,
15174 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED,
15175 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL,
15176 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
15179 static int
15180 try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp, int *scroll_step)
15182 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15183 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15184 int rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED;
15186 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15187 if (inhibit_try_cursor_movement)
15188 return rc;
15189 #endif
15191 /* Previously, there was a check for Lisp integer in the
15192 if-statement below. Now, this field is converted to
15193 ptrdiff_t, thus zero means invalid position in a buffer. */
15194 eassert (w->last_point > 0);
15195 /* Likewise there was a check whether window_end_vpos is nil or larger
15196 than the window. Now window_end_vpos is int and so never nil, but
15197 let's leave eassert to check whether it fits in the window. */
15198 eassert (w->window_end_vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows);
15200 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15201 not moved off the frame. */
15202 if (/* Point may be in this window. */
15203 PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15204 /* Selective display hasn't changed. */
15205 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15206 /* Function force-mode-line-update is used to force a thorough
15207 redisplay. It sets either windows_or_buffers_changed or
15208 update_mode_lines. So don't take a shortcut here for these
15209 cases. */
15210 && !update_mode_lines
15211 && !windows_or_buffers_changed
15212 && !f->cursor_type_changed
15213 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
15214 /* This code is not used for mini-buffer for the sake of the case
15215 of redisplaying to replace an echo area message; since in
15216 that case the mini-buffer contents per se are usually
15217 unchanged. This code is of no real use in the mini-buffer
15218 since the handling of this_line_start_pos, etc., in redisplay
15219 handles the same cases. */
15220 && !EQ (window, minibuf_window)
15221 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15222 || !overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p ()))
15224 int this_scroll_margin, top_scroll_margin;
15225 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
15226 int frame_line_height = default_line_pixel_height (w);
15227 int window_total_lines
15228 = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / frame_line_height;
15230 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15231 debug_method_add (w, "cursor movement");
15232 #endif
15234 /* Scroll if point within this distance from the top or bottom
15235 of the window. This is a pixel value. */
15236 if (scroll_margin > 0)
15238 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, window_total_lines / 4);
15239 this_scroll_margin *= frame_line_height;
15241 else
15242 this_scroll_margin = 0;
15244 top_scroll_margin = this_scroll_margin;
15245 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
15246 top_scroll_margin += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15248 /* Start with the row the cursor was displayed during the last
15249 not paused redisplay. Give up if that row is not valid. */
15250 if (w->last_cursor_vpos < 0
15251 || w->last_cursor_vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
15252 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15253 else
15255 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->last_cursor_vpos);
15256 if (row->mode_line_p)
15257 ++row;
15258 if (!row->enabled_p)
15259 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15262 if (rc == CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED)
15264 int scroll_p = 0, must_scroll = 0;
15265 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - this_scroll_margin;
15267 if (PT > w->last_point)
15269 /* Point has moved forward. */
15270 while (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < PT
15271 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y)
15273 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15274 ++row;
15277 /* If the end position of a row equals the start
15278 position of the next row, and PT is at that position,
15279 we would rather display cursor in the next line. */
15280 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15281 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15282 && row < MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
15283 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row+1) == PT
15284 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15285 ++row;
15287 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. Note that
15288 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y gives the pixel position at which
15289 the next line would be drawn, and that
15290 this_scroll_margin can be zero. */
15291 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y
15292 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15293 /* Line is completely visible last line in window
15294 and PT is to be set in the next line. */
15295 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y
15296 && PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15297 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15298 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
15299 scroll_p = 1;
15301 else if (PT < w->last_point)
15303 /* Cursor has to be moved backward. Note that PT >=
15304 CHARPOS (startp) because of the outer if-statement. */
15305 while (!row->mode_line_p
15306 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) > PT
15307 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15308 && (MATRIX_ROW_STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)
15309 || (/* STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_STRING_P (row) */
15310 row > w->current_matrix->rows
15311 && (row-1)->ends_in_newline_from_string_p))))
15312 && (row->y > top_scroll_margin
15313 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV))
15315 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15316 --row;
15319 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV,
15320 there is invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that
15321 display starts at some point START > BEGV. It can
15322 happen that we are called with PT somewhere between
15323 BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
15324 if (row < w->current_matrix->rows
15325 || row->mode_line_p)
15327 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
15328 if (row->mode_line_p)
15329 ++row;
15332 /* Due to newlines in overlay strings, we may have to
15333 skip forward over overlay strings. */
15334 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15335 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15336 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15337 ++row;
15339 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. */
15340 if (row->y < top_scroll_margin
15341 && CHARPOS (startp) != BEGV)
15342 scroll_p = 1;
15344 else
15346 /* Cursor did not move. So don't scroll even if cursor line
15347 is partially visible, as it was so before. */
15348 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15351 if (PT < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
15352 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
15354 /* if PT is not in the glyph row, give up. */
15355 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15356 must_scroll = 1;
15358 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15359 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), bidi_display_reordering)))
15361 struct glyph_row *row1;
15363 /* If rows are bidi-reordered and point moved, back up
15364 until we find a row that does not belong to a
15365 continuation line. This is because we must consider
15366 all rows of a continued line as candidates for the
15367 new cursor positioning, since row start and end
15368 positions change non-linearly with vertical position
15369 in such rows. */
15370 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15371 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15372 bidi-reordered rows. */
15373 for (row1 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
15374 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row);
15375 --row)
15377 /* If we hit the beginning of the displayed portion
15378 without finding the first row of a continued
15379 line, give up. */
15380 if (row <= row1)
15382 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15383 break;
15385 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15388 if (must_scroll)
15390 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15391 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row)
15392 /* Make sure this isn't a header line by any chance, since
15393 then MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P might yield non-zero. */
15394 && !row->mode_line_p
15395 && make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
15397 if (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15398 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15399 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
15400 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15401 else if (row->height > window_box_height (w))
15403 /* If we end up in a partially visible line, let's
15404 make it fully visible, except when it's taller
15405 than the window, in which case we can't do much
15406 about it. */
15407 *scroll_step = 1;
15408 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15410 else
15412 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15413 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 1))
15414 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15415 else
15416 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15419 else if (scroll_p)
15420 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15421 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15422 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), bidi_display_reordering)))
15424 /* With bidi-reordered rows, there could be more than
15425 one candidate row whose start and end positions
15426 occlude point. We need to let set_cursor_from_row
15427 find the best candidate. */
15428 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15429 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15430 bidi-reordered rows. */
15431 int rv = 0;
15435 int at_zv_p = 0, exact_match_p = 0;
15437 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) <= PT
15438 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15439 && cursor_row_p (row))
15440 rv |= set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
15441 0, 0, 0, 0);
15442 /* As soon as we've found the exact match for point,
15443 or the first suitable row whose ends_at_zv_p flag
15444 is set, we are done. */
15445 at_zv_p =
15446 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->ends_at_zv_p;
15447 if (rv && !at_zv_p
15448 && w->cursor.hpos >= 0
15449 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (w->current_matrix,
15450 w->cursor.vpos))
15452 struct glyph_row *candidate =
15453 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
15454 struct glyph *g =
15455 candidate->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
15456 ptrdiff_t endpos = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (candidate);
15458 exact_match_p =
15459 (BUFFERP (g->object) && g->charpos == PT)
15460 || (INTEGERP (g->object)
15461 && (g->charpos == PT
15462 || (g->charpos == 0 && endpos - 1 == PT)));
15464 if (rv && (at_zv_p || exact_match_p))
15466 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15467 break;
15469 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y)
15470 break;
15471 ++row;
15473 while (((MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15474 || row->continued_p)
15475 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y)
15476 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15477 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y));
15478 /* If we didn't find any candidate rows, or exited the
15479 loop before all the candidates were examined, signal
15480 to the caller that this method failed. */
15481 if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15482 && !(rv
15483 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15484 && !row->continued_p))
15485 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15486 else if (rv)
15487 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15489 else
15493 if (set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0))
15495 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15496 break;
15498 ++row;
15500 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15501 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15502 && cursor_row_p (row));
15507 return rc;
15510 #if !defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS || defined USE_GTK
15511 static
15512 #endif
15513 void
15514 set_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
15516 ptrdiff_t start, end, whole;
15518 /* Calculate the start and end positions for the current window.
15519 At some point, it would be nice to choose between scrollbars
15520 which reflect the whole buffer size, with special markers
15521 indicating narrowing, and scrollbars which reflect only the
15522 visible region.
15524 Note that mini-buffers sometimes aren't displaying any text. */
15525 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15526 || (w == XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15527 && NILP (echo_area_buffer[0])))
15529 struct buffer *buf = XBUFFER (w->contents);
15530 whole = BUF_ZV (buf) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15531 start = marker_position (w->start) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15532 /* I don't think this is guaranteed to be right. For the
15533 moment, we'll pretend it is. */
15534 end = BUF_Z (buf) - w->window_end_pos - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15536 if (end < start)
15537 end = start;
15538 if (whole < (end - start))
15539 whole = end - start;
15541 else
15542 start = end = whole = 0;
15544 /* Indicate what this scroll bar ought to be displaying now. */
15545 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15546 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15547 (w, end - start, whole, start);
15551 /* Redisplay leaf window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P non-zero means only
15552 selected_window is redisplayed.
15554 We can return without actually redisplaying the window if fonts has been
15555 changed on window's frame. In that case, redisplay_internal will retry. */
15557 static void
15558 redisplay_window (Lisp_Object window, bool just_this_one_p)
15560 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15561 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15562 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->contents);
15563 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
15564 struct text_pos lpoint, opoint, startp;
15565 int update_mode_line;
15566 int tem;
15567 struct it it;
15568 /* Record it now because it's overwritten. */
15569 bool current_matrix_up_to_date_p = false;
15570 bool used_current_matrix_p = false;
15571 /* This is less strict than current_matrix_up_to_date_p.
15572 It indicates that the buffer contents and narrowing are unchanged. */
15573 bool buffer_unchanged_p = false;
15574 int temp_scroll_step = 0;
15575 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
15576 int rc;
15577 int centering_position = -1;
15578 int last_line_misfit = 0;
15579 ptrdiff_t beg_unchanged, end_unchanged;
15580 int frame_line_height;
15582 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15583 opoint = lpoint;
15585 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15586 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
15587 #endif
15589 if (!just_this_one_p
15590 && REDISPLAY_SOME_P ()
15591 && !w->redisplay
15592 && !f->redisplay
15593 && !buffer->text->redisplay)
15594 return;
15596 /* Make sure that both W's markers are valid. */
15597 eassert (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == buffer);
15598 eassert (XMARKER (w->pointm)->buffer == buffer);
15600 restart:
15601 reconsider_clip_changes (w);
15602 frame_line_height = default_line_pixel_height (w);
15604 /* Has the mode line to be updated? */
15605 update_mode_line = (w->update_mode_line
15606 || update_mode_lines
15607 || buffer->clip_changed
15608 || buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p);
15610 if (!just_this_one_p)
15611 /* If `just_this_one_p' is set, we apparently set must_be_updated_p more
15612 cleverly elsewhere. */
15613 w->must_be_updated_p = true;
15615 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
15617 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window)
15618 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
15620 if (update_mode_line)
15621 /* We may have to update a tty frame's menu bar or a
15622 tool-bar. Example `M-x C-h C-h C-g'. */
15623 goto finish_menu_bars;
15624 else
15625 /* We've already displayed the echo area glyphs in this window. */
15626 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15628 else if ((w != XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15629 || minibuf_level == 0)
15630 /* When buffer is nonempty, redisplay window normally. */
15631 && BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->contents)) == BUF_BEG (XBUFFER (w->contents))
15632 /* Quail displays non-mini buffers in minibuffer window.
15633 In that case, redisplay the window normally. */
15634 && !NILP (Fmemq (w->contents, Vminibuffer_list)))
15636 /* W is a mini-buffer window, but it's not active, so clear
15637 it. */
15638 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
15639 struct glyph_row *row;
15640 int y;
15642 for (y = 0, row = w->desired_matrix->rows;
15643 y < yb;
15644 y += row->height, ++row)
15645 blank_row (w, row, y);
15646 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15649 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15652 /* Otherwise set up data on this window; select its buffer and point
15653 value. */
15654 /* Really select the buffer, for the sake of buffer-local
15655 variables. */
15656 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->contents));
15658 current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15659 = (w->window_end_valid
15660 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15661 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
15662 && !window_outdated (w));
15664 /* Run the window-bottom-change-functions
15665 if it is possible that the text on the screen has changed
15666 (either due to modification of the text, or any other reason). */
15667 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15668 && !NILP (Vwindow_text_change_functions))
15670 safe_run_hooks (Qwindow_text_change_functions);
15671 goto restart;
15674 beg_unchanged = BEG_UNCHANGED;
15675 end_unchanged = END_UNCHANGED;
15677 SET_TEXT_POS (opoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15679 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
15681 buffer_unchanged_p
15682 = (w->window_end_valid
15683 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15684 && !window_outdated (w));
15686 /* When windows_or_buffers_changed is non-zero, we can't rely
15687 on the window end being valid, so set it to zero there. */
15688 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
15690 /* If window starts on a continuation line, maybe adjust the
15691 window start in case the window's width changed. */
15692 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer)
15693 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w);
15695 w->window_end_valid = false;
15696 /* If so, we also can't rely on current matrix
15697 and should not fool try_cursor_movement below. */
15698 current_matrix_up_to_date_p = false;
15701 /* Some sanity checks. */
15702 CHECK_WINDOW_END (w);
15703 if (Z == Z_BYTE && CHARPOS (opoint) != BYTEPOS (opoint))
15704 emacs_abort ();
15705 if (BYTEPOS (opoint) < CHARPOS (opoint))
15706 emacs_abort ();
15708 if (mode_line_update_needed (w))
15709 update_mode_line = 1;
15711 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any other
15712 window, set up appropriate value. */
15713 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
15715 ptrdiff_t new_pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
15716 ptrdiff_t new_pt_byte = marker_byte_position (w->pointm);
15717 if (new_pt < BEGV)
15719 new_pt = BEGV;
15720 new_pt_byte = BEGV_BYTE;
15721 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15723 else if (new_pt > (ZV - 1))
15725 new_pt = ZV;
15726 new_pt_byte = ZV_BYTE;
15727 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15730 /* We don't use SET_PT so that the point-motion hooks don't run. */
15731 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (new_pt, new_pt_byte);
15734 /* If any of the character widths specified in the display table
15735 have changed, invalidate the width run cache. It's true that
15736 this may be a bit late to catch such changes, but the rest of
15737 redisplay goes (non-fatally) haywire when the display table is
15738 changed, so why should we worry about doing any better? */
15739 if (current_buffer->width_run_cache)
15741 struct Lisp_Char_Table *disptab = buffer_display_table ();
15743 if (! disptab_matches_widthtab
15744 (disptab, XVECTOR (BVAR (current_buffer, width_table))))
15746 invalidate_region_cache (current_buffer,
15747 current_buffer->width_run_cache,
15748 BEG, Z);
15749 recompute_width_table (current_buffer, disptab);
15753 /* If window-start is screwed up, choose a new one. */
15754 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer != current_buffer)
15755 goto recenter;
15757 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15759 /* If someone specified a new starting point but did not insist,
15760 check whether it can be used. */
15761 if (w->optional_new_start
15762 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15763 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15765 w->optional_new_start = 0;
15766 start_display (&it, w, startp);
15767 move_it_to (&it, PT, 0, it.last_visible_y, -1,
15768 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15769 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == PT)
15770 w->force_start = 1;
15771 /* IT may overshoot PT if text at PT is invisible. */
15772 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) > PT && CHARPOS (startp) <= PT)
15773 w->force_start = 1;
15776 force_start:
15778 /* Handle case where place to start displaying has been specified,
15779 unless the specified location is outside the accessible range. */
15780 if (w->force_start || window_frozen_p (w))
15782 /* We set this later on if we have to adjust point. */
15783 int new_vpos = -1;
15785 w->force_start = 0;
15786 w->vscroll = 0;
15787 w->window_end_valid = 0;
15789 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15790 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15791 w->base_line_number = 0;
15793 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that.
15794 Also, run the hook window-scroll-functions
15795 because we have scrolled. */
15796 /* Note, we do this after clearing force_start because
15797 if there's an error, it is better to forget about force_start
15798 than to get into an infinite loop calling the hook functions
15799 and having them get more errors. */
15800 if (!update_mode_line
15801 || ! NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
15803 update_mode_line = 1;
15804 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15805 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
15808 if (CHARPOS (startp) < BEGV)
15809 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15810 else if (CHARPOS (startp) > ZV)
15811 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15813 /* Redisplay, then check if cursor has been set during the
15814 redisplay. Give up if new fonts were loaded. */
15815 /* We used to issue a CHECK_MARGINS argument to try_window here,
15816 but this causes scrolling to fail when point begins inside
15817 the scroll margin (bug#148) -- cyd */
15818 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15820 w->force_start = 1;
15821 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15822 goto need_larger_matrices;
15825 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0 && !window_frozen_p (w))
15827 /* If point does not appear, try to move point so it does
15828 appear. The desired matrix has been built above, so we
15829 can use it here. */
15830 new_vpos = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15833 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
15835 /* Point does appear, but on a line partly visible at end of window.
15836 Move it back to a fully-visible line. */
15837 new_vpos = window_box_height (w);
15839 else if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
15841 /* Some people insist on not letting point enter the scroll
15842 margin, even though this part handles windows that didn't
15843 scroll at all. */
15844 int window_total_lines
15845 = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / frame_line_height;
15846 int margin = min (scroll_margin, window_total_lines / 4);
15847 int pixel_margin = margin * frame_line_height;
15848 bool header_line = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w);
15850 /* Note: We add an extra FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT, because the loop
15851 below, which finds the row to move point to, advances by
15852 the Y coordinate of the _next_ row, see the definition of
15853 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y. */
15854 if (w->cursor.vpos < margin + header_line)
15856 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
15857 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15858 goto try_to_scroll;
15860 else
15862 int window_height = window_box_height (w);
15864 if (header_line)
15865 window_height += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15866 if (w->cursor.y >= window_height - pixel_margin)
15868 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
15869 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15870 goto try_to_scroll;
15875 /* If we need to move point for either of the above reasons,
15876 now actually do it. */
15877 if (new_vpos >= 0)
15879 struct glyph_row *row;
15881 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
15882 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < new_vpos)
15883 ++row;
15885 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
15886 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
15888 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window))
15889 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, PT, PT_BYTE);
15890 else if (current_buffer == old)
15891 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15893 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15895 /* If we are highlighting the region, then we just changed
15896 the region, so redisplay to show it. */
15897 /* FIXME: We need to (re)run pre-redisplay-function! */
15898 /* if (markpos_of_region () >= 0)
15900 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15901 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15902 goto need_larger_matrices;
15907 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15908 debug_method_add (w, "forced window start");
15909 #endif
15910 goto done;
15913 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15914 not moved off the frame, and we are not retrying after hscroll.
15915 (current_matrix_up_to_date_p is nonzero when retrying.) */
15916 if (current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15917 && (rc = try_cursor_movement (window, startp, &temp_scroll_step),
15918 rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED))
15920 switch (rc)
15922 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS:
15923 used_current_matrix_p = 1;
15924 goto done;
15926 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL:
15927 goto try_to_scroll;
15929 default:
15930 emacs_abort ();
15933 /* If current starting point was originally the beginning of a line
15934 but no longer is, find a new starting point. */
15935 else if (w->start_at_line_beg
15936 && !(CHARPOS (startp) <= BEGV
15937 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n'))
15939 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15940 debug_method_add (w, "recenter 1");
15941 #endif
15942 goto recenter;
15945 /* Try scrolling with try_window_id. Value is > 0 if update has
15946 been done, it is -1 if we know that the same window start will
15947 not work. It is 0 if unsuccessful for some other reason. */
15948 else if ((tem = try_window_id (w)) != 0)
15950 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15951 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_id %d", tem);
15952 #endif
15954 if (f->fonts_changed)
15955 goto need_larger_matrices;
15956 if (tem > 0)
15957 goto done;
15959 /* Otherwise try_window_id has returned -1 which means that we
15960 don't want the alternative below this comment to execute. */
15962 else if (CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15963 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV
15964 && PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15965 && (CHARPOS (startp) < ZV
15966 /* Avoid starting at end of buffer. */
15967 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
15968 || !window_outdated (w)))
15970 int d1, d2, d3, d4, d5, d6;
15972 /* If first window line is a continuation line, and window start
15973 is inside the modified region, but the first change is before
15974 current window start, we must select a new window start.
15976 However, if this is the result of a down-mouse event (e.g. by
15977 extending the mouse-drag-overlay), we don't want to select a
15978 new window start, since that would change the position under
15979 the mouse, resulting in an unwanted mouse-movement rather
15980 than a simple mouse-click. */
15981 if (!w->start_at_line_beg
15982 && NILP (do_mouse_tracking)
15983 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEGV
15984 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEG + beg_unchanged
15985 && CHARPOS (startp) <= Z - end_unchanged
15986 /* Even if w->start_at_line_beg is nil, a new window may
15987 start at a line_beg, since that's how set_buffer_window
15988 sets it. So, we need to check the return value of
15989 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line. (See also
15990 bug#197). */
15991 && XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer
15992 && compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w)
15993 /* It doesn't make sense to force the window start like we
15994 do at label force_start if it is already known that point
15995 will not be visible in the resulting window, because
15996 doing so will move point from its correct position
15997 instead of scrolling the window to bring point into view.
15998 See bug#9324. */
15999 && pos_visible_p (w, PT, &d1, &d2, &d3, &d4, &d5, &d6))
16001 w->force_start = 1;
16002 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
16003 goto force_start;
16006 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16007 debug_method_add (w, "same window start");
16008 #endif
16010 /* Try to redisplay starting at same place as before.
16011 If point has not moved off frame, accept the results. */
16012 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
16013 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
16014 because a window scroll function can have changed the
16015 buffer. */
16016 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
16017 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16018 || !(used_current_matrix_p
16019 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
16021 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "1"));
16022 if (try_window (window, startp, TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS) < 0)
16023 /* -1 means we need to scroll.
16024 0 means we need new matrices, but fonts_changed
16025 is set in that case, so we will detect it below. */
16026 goto try_to_scroll;
16029 if (f->fonts_changed)
16030 goto need_larger_matrices;
16032 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
16034 if (!just_this_one_p
16035 || current_buffer->clip_changed
16036 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
16037 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
16038 w->base_line_number = 0;
16040 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 1, 0))
16042 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16043 last_line_misfit = 1;
16045 /* Drop through and scroll. */
16046 else
16047 goto done;
16049 else
16050 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16053 try_to_scroll:
16055 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that. */
16056 if (!update_mode_line)
16058 update_mode_line = 1;
16059 w->update_mode_line = 1;
16062 /* Try to scroll by specified few lines. */
16063 if ((scroll_conservatively
16064 || emacs_scroll_step
16065 || temp_scroll_step
16066 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively))
16067 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively)))
16068 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
16069 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
16071 /* The function returns -1 if new fonts were loaded, 1 if
16072 successful, 0 if not successful. */
16073 int ss = try_scrolling (window, just_this_one_p,
16074 scroll_conservatively,
16075 emacs_scroll_step,
16076 temp_scroll_step, last_line_misfit);
16077 switch (ss)
16079 case SCROLLING_SUCCESS:
16080 goto done;
16082 case SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES:
16083 goto need_larger_matrices;
16085 case SCROLLING_FAILED:
16086 break;
16088 default:
16089 emacs_abort ();
16093 /* Finally, just choose a place to start which positions point
16094 according to user preferences. */
16096 recenter:
16098 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16099 debug_method_add (w, "recenter");
16100 #endif
16102 /* Forget any previously recorded base line for line number display. */
16103 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
16104 w->base_line_number = 0;
16106 /* Determine the window start relative to point. */
16107 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
16108 it.current_y = it.last_visible_y;
16109 if (centering_position < 0)
16111 int window_total_lines
16112 = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / frame_line_height;
16113 int margin =
16114 scroll_margin > 0
16115 ? min (scroll_margin, window_total_lines / 4)
16116 : 0;
16117 ptrdiff_t margin_pos = CHARPOS (startp);
16118 Lisp_Object aggressive;
16119 int scrolling_up;
16121 /* If there is a scroll margin at the top of the window, find
16122 its character position. */
16123 if (margin
16124 /* Cannot call start_display if startp is not in the
16125 accessible region of the buffer. This can happen when we
16126 have just switched to a different buffer and/or changed
16127 its restriction. In that case, startp is initialized to
16128 the character position 1 (BEGV) because we did not yet
16129 have chance to display the buffer even once. */
16130 && BEGV <= CHARPOS (startp) && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
16132 struct it it1;
16133 void *it1data = NULL;
16135 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
16136 start_display (&it1, w, startp);
16137 move_it_vertically (&it1, margin * frame_line_height);
16138 margin_pos = IT_CHARPOS (it1);
16139 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
16141 scrolling_up = PT > margin_pos;
16142 aggressive =
16143 scrolling_up
16144 ? BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)
16145 : BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
16147 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16148 && (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT || NUMBERP (aggressive)))
16150 int pt_offset = 0;
16152 /* Setting scroll-conservatively overrides
16153 scroll-*-aggressively. */
16154 if (!scroll_conservatively && NUMBERP (aggressive))
16156 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive);
16158 pt_offset = float_amount * WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
16159 if (pt_offset == 0 && float_amount > 0)
16160 pt_offset = 1;
16161 if (pt_offset && margin > 0)
16162 margin -= 1;
16164 /* Compute how much to move the window start backward from
16165 point so that point will be displayed where the user
16166 wants it. */
16167 if (scrolling_up)
16169 centering_position = it.last_visible_y;
16170 if (pt_offset)
16171 centering_position -= pt_offset;
16172 centering_position -=
16173 frame_line_height * (1 + margin + (last_line_misfit != 0))
16174 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16175 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
16176 the window. */
16177 if (centering_position < margin * frame_line_height)
16178 centering_position = margin * frame_line_height;
16180 else
16181 centering_position = margin * frame_line_height + pt_offset;
16183 else
16184 /* Set the window start half the height of the window backward
16185 from point. */
16186 centering_position = window_box_height (w) / 2;
16188 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, centering_position);
16190 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (it) >= BEGV);
16192 /* The function move_it_vertically_backward may move over more
16193 than the specified y-distance. If it->w is small, e.g. a
16194 mini-buffer window, we may end up in front of the window's
16195 display area. Start displaying at the start of the line
16196 containing PT in this case. */
16197 if (it.current_y <= 0)
16199 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
16200 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, 0);
16201 it.current_y = 0;
16204 it.current_x = it.hpos = 0;
16206 /* Set the window start position here explicitly, to avoid an
16207 infinite loop in case the functions in window-scroll-functions
16208 get errors. */
16209 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, IT_CHARPOS (it), IT_BYTEPOS (it));
16211 /* Run scroll hooks. */
16212 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, it.current.pos);
16214 /* Redisplay the window. */
16215 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
16216 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16217 || f->cursor_type_changed
16218 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
16219 because it can have changed the buffer. */
16220 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
16221 || !just_this_one_p
16222 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16223 || !(used_current_matrix_p
16224 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
16225 try_window (window, startp, 0);
16227 /* If new fonts have been loaded (due to fontsets), give up. We
16228 have to start a new redisplay since we need to re-adjust glyph
16229 matrices. */
16230 if (f->fonts_changed)
16231 goto need_larger_matrices;
16233 /* If cursor did not appear assume that the middle of the window is
16234 in the first line of the window. Do it again with the next line.
16235 (Imagine a window of height 100, displaying two lines of height
16236 60. Moving back 50 from it->last_visible_y will end in the first
16237 line.) */
16238 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16240 if (w->window_end_valid && PT >= Z - w->window_end_pos)
16242 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16243 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
16244 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16246 else if (PT < IT_CHARPOS (it))
16248 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16249 move_it_by_lines (&it, -1);
16250 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16252 else
16254 /* Not much we can do about it. */
16258 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV, there is
16259 invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that display starts at
16260 some point START > BEGV. It can happen that we are called with
16261 PT somewhere between BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
16262 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16264 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows;
16265 if (row->mode_line_p)
16266 ++row;
16267 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
16270 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
16272 /* If vscroll is enabled, disable it and try again. */
16273 if (w->vscroll)
16275 w->vscroll = 0;
16276 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16277 goto recenter;
16280 /* Users who set scroll-conservatively to a large number want
16281 point just above/below the scroll margin. If we ended up
16282 with point's row partially visible, move the window start to
16283 make that row fully visible and out of the margin. */
16284 if (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT)
16286 int window_total_lines
16287 = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * frame_line_height;
16288 int margin =
16289 scroll_margin > 0
16290 ? min (scroll_margin, window_total_lines / 4)
16291 : 0;
16292 int move_down = w->cursor.vpos >= window_total_lines / 2;
16294 move_it_by_lines (&it, move_down ? margin + 1 : -(margin + 1));
16295 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16296 if (1 == try_window (window, it.current.pos,
16297 TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS))
16298 goto done;
16301 /* If centering point failed to make the whole line visible,
16302 put point at the top instead. That has to make the whole line
16303 visible, if it can be done. */
16304 if (centering_position == 0)
16305 goto done;
16307 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16308 centering_position = 0;
16309 goto recenter;
16312 done:
16314 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
16315 w->start_at_line_beg = (CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
16316 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n');
16318 /* Display the mode line, if we must. */
16319 if ((update_mode_line
16320 /* If window not full width, must redo its mode line
16321 if (a) the window to its side is being redone and
16322 (b) we do a frame-based redisplay. This is a consequence
16323 of how inverted lines are drawn in frame-based redisplay. */
16324 || (!just_this_one_p
16325 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16326 && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))
16327 /* Line number to display. */
16328 || w->base_line_pos > 0
16329 /* Column number is displayed and different from the one displayed. */
16330 || (w->column_number_displayed != -1
16331 && (w->column_number_displayed != current_column ())))
16332 /* This means that the window has a mode line. */
16333 && (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16334 || WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)))
16337 display_mode_lines (w);
16339 /* If mode line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16340 immediate redisplay using the correct mode line height. */
16341 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16342 && CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16344 f->fonts_changed = 1;
16345 w->mode_line_height = -1;
16346 MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16347 = DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16350 /* If header line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16351 immediate redisplay using the correct header line height. */
16352 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16353 && CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16355 f->fonts_changed = 1;
16356 w->header_line_height = -1;
16357 MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16358 = DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16361 if (f->fonts_changed)
16362 goto need_larger_matrices;
16365 if (!line_number_displayed && w->base_line_pos != -1)
16367 w->base_line_pos = 0;
16368 w->base_line_number = 0;
16371 finish_menu_bars:
16373 /* When we reach a frame's selected window, redo the frame's menu bar. */
16374 if (update_mode_line
16375 && EQ (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), window))
16377 int redisplay_menu_p = 0;
16379 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16381 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
16382 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
16383 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f);
16384 #else
16385 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16386 #endif
16388 else
16389 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16391 if (redisplay_menu_p)
16392 display_menu_bar (w);
16394 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16395 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16397 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
16398 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
16399 redisplay_tool_bar (f);
16400 #else
16401 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
16402 && (FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f) > 0
16403 || !NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
16404 && redisplay_tool_bar (f))
16405 ignore_mouse_drag_p = 1;
16406 #endif
16408 #endif
16411 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16412 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16413 && update_window_fringes (w, (just_this_one_p
16414 || (!used_current_matrix_p && !overlay_arrow_seen)
16415 || w->pseudo_window_p)))
16417 update_begin (f);
16418 block_input ();
16419 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
16421 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
16422 x_draw_right_divider (w);
16423 else
16424 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
16426 unblock_input ();
16427 update_end (f);
16430 if (WINDOW_BOTTOM_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
16431 x_draw_bottom_divider (w);
16432 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
16434 /* We go to this label, with fonts_changed set, if it is
16435 necessary to try again using larger glyph matrices.
16436 We have to redeem the scroll bar even in this case,
16437 because the loop in redisplay_internal expects that. */
16438 need_larger_matrices:
16440 finish_scroll_bars:
16442 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
16444 /* Set the thumb's position and size. */
16445 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
16447 /* Note that we actually used the scroll bar attached to this
16448 window, so it shouldn't be deleted at the end of redisplay. */
16449 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook)
16450 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook) (w);
16453 /* Restore current_buffer and value of point in it. The window
16454 update may have changed the buffer, so first make sure `opoint'
16455 is still valid (Bug#6177). */
16456 if (CHARPOS (opoint) < BEGV)
16457 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
16458 else if (CHARPOS (opoint) > ZV)
16459 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
16460 else
16461 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (opoint), BYTEPOS (opoint));
16463 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
16464 /* Avoid an abort in TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH if the buffer has become
16465 shorter. This can be caused by log truncation in *Messages*. */
16466 if (CHARPOS (lpoint) <= ZV)
16467 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
16469 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
16473 /* Build the complete desired matrix of WINDOW with a window start
16474 buffer position POS.
16476 Value is 1 if successful. It is zero if fonts were loaded during
16477 redisplay which makes re-adjusting glyph matrices necessary, and -1
16478 if point would appear in the scroll margins.
16479 (We check the former only if TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE is
16480 unset in FLAGS, and the latter only if TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS is
16481 set in FLAGS.) */
16484 try_window (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos pos, int flags)
16486 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
16487 struct it it;
16488 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL;
16489 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16490 int frame_line_height = default_line_pixel_height (w);
16492 /* Make POS the new window start. */
16493 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos));
16495 /* Mark cursor position as unknown. No overlay arrow seen. */
16496 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16497 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
16499 /* Initialize iterator and info to start at POS. */
16500 start_display (&it, w, pos);
16502 /* Display all lines of W. */
16503 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16505 if (display_line (&it))
16506 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16507 if (f->fonts_changed && !(flags & TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE))
16508 return 0;
16511 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
16512 if ((flags & TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS)
16513 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
16515 int this_scroll_margin;
16516 int window_total_lines
16517 = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / frame_line_height;
16519 if (scroll_margin > 0)
16521 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, window_total_lines / 4);
16522 this_scroll_margin *= frame_line_height;
16524 else
16525 this_scroll_margin = 0;
16527 if ((w->cursor.y >= 0 /* not vscrolled */
16528 && w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
16529 && CHARPOS (pos) > BEGV
16530 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV)
16531 /* rms: considering make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p here
16532 seems to give wrong results. We don't want to recenter
16533 when the last line is partly visible, we want to allow
16534 that case to be handled in the usual way. */
16535 || w->cursor.y > it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin - 1)
16537 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16538 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16539 return -1;
16543 /* If bottom moved off end of frame, change mode line percentage. */
16544 if (w->window_end_pos <= 0 && Z != IT_CHARPOS (it))
16545 w->update_mode_line = 1;
16547 /* Set window_end_pos to the offset of the last character displayed
16548 on the window from the end of current_buffer. Set
16549 window_end_vpos to its row number. */
16550 if (last_text_row)
16552 eassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (last_text_row));
16553 adjust_window_ends (w, last_text_row, 0);
16554 eassert
16555 (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix,
16556 w->window_end_vpos)));
16558 else
16560 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16561 w->window_end_pos = Z - ZV;
16562 w->window_end_vpos = 0;
16565 /* But that is not valid info until redisplay finishes. */
16566 w->window_end_valid = 0;
16567 return 1;
16572 /************************************************************************
16573 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has not changed
16574 ************************************************************************/
16576 /* Try redisplay of window W showing an unchanged buffer with a
16577 different window start than the last time it was displayed by
16578 reusing its current matrix. Value is non-zero if successful.
16579 W->start is the new window start. */
16581 static int
16582 try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *w)
16584 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16585 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
16586 struct it it;
16587 struct run run;
16588 struct text_pos start, new_start;
16589 int nrows_scrolled, i;
16590 struct glyph_row *last_text_row;
16591 struct glyph_row *last_reused_text_row;
16592 struct glyph_row *start_row;
16593 int start_vpos, min_y, max_y;
16595 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16596 if (inhibit_try_window_reusing)
16597 return 0;
16598 #endif
16600 if (/* This function doesn't handle terminal frames. */
16601 !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16602 /* Don't try to reuse the display if windows have been split
16603 or such. */
16604 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16605 || f->cursor_type_changed)
16606 return 0;
16608 /* Can't do this if showing trailing whitespace. */
16609 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
16610 return 0;
16612 /* If top-line visibility has changed, give up. */
16613 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16614 != MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->mode_line_p)
16615 return 0;
16617 /* Give up if old or new display is scrolled vertically. We could
16618 make this function handle this, but right now it doesn't. */
16619 start_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16620 if (w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row))
16621 return 0;
16623 /* The variable new_start now holds the new window start. The old
16624 start `start' can be determined from the current matrix. */
16625 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (new_start, w->start);
16626 start = start_row->minpos;
16627 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16629 /* Clear the desired matrix for the display below. */
16630 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16632 if (CHARPOS (new_start) <= CHARPOS (start))
16634 /* Don't use this method if the display starts with an ellipsis
16635 displayed for invisible text. It's not easy to handle that case
16636 below, and it's certainly not worth the effort since this is
16637 not a frequent case. */
16638 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (&start_row->start, w))
16639 return 0;
16641 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "twu1"));
16643 /* Display up to a row that can be reused. The variable
16644 last_text_row is set to the last row displayed that displays
16645 text. Note that it.vpos == 0 if or if not there is a
16646 header-line; it's not the same as the MATRIX_ROW_VPOS! */
16647 start_display (&it, w, new_start);
16648 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16649 last_text_row = last_reused_text_row = NULL;
16651 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !f->fonts_changed)
16653 /* If we have reached into the characters in the START row,
16654 that means the line boundaries have changed. So we
16655 can't start copying with the row START. Maybe it will
16656 work to start copying with the following row. */
16657 while (IT_CHARPOS (it) > CHARPOS (start))
16659 /* Advance to the next row as the "start". */
16660 start_row++;
16661 start = start_row->minpos;
16662 /* If there are no more rows to try, or just one, give up. */
16663 if (start_row == MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix) - 1
16664 || w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row)
16665 || CHARPOS (start) == ZV)
16667 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16668 return 0;
16671 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16673 /* If we have reached alignment, we can copy the rest of the
16674 rows. */
16675 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == CHARPOS (start)
16676 /* Don't accept "alignment" inside a display vector,
16677 since start_row could have started in the middle of
16678 that same display vector (thus their character
16679 positions match), and we have no way of telling if
16680 that is the case. */
16681 && it.current.dpvec_index < 0)
16682 break;
16684 if (display_line (&it))
16685 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16689 /* A value of current_y < last_visible_y means that we stopped
16690 at the previous window start, which in turn means that we
16691 have at least one reusable row. */
16692 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16694 struct glyph_row *row;
16696 /* IT.vpos always starts from 0; it counts text lines. */
16697 nrows_scrolled = it.vpos - (start_row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix));
16699 /* Find PT if not already found in the lines displayed. */
16700 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16702 int dy = it.current_y - start_row->y;
16704 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16705 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, row, NULL, dy);
16706 if (row)
16707 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0,
16708 dy, nrows_scrolled);
16709 else
16711 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16712 return 0;
16716 /* Scroll the display. Do it before the current matrix is
16717 changed. The problem here is that update has not yet
16718 run, i.e. part of the current matrix is not up to date.
16719 scroll_run_hook will clear the cursor, and use the
16720 current matrix to get the height of the row the cursor is
16721 in. */
16722 run.current_y = start_row->y;
16723 run.desired_y = it.current_y;
16724 run.height = it.last_visible_y - it.current_y;
16726 if (run.height > 0 && run.current_y != run.desired_y)
16728 update_begin (f);
16729 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16730 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16731 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16732 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16733 update_end (f);
16736 /* Shift current matrix down by nrows_scrolled lines. */
16737 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16738 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16739 start_vpos,
16740 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16741 nrows_scrolled);
16743 /* Disable lines that must be updated. */
16744 for (i = 0; i < nrows_scrolled; ++i)
16745 (start_row + i)->enabled_p = false;
16747 /* Re-compute Y positions. */
16748 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16749 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16750 for (row = start_row + nrows_scrolled;
16751 row < bottom_row;
16752 ++row)
16754 row->y = it.current_y;
16755 row->visible_height = row->height;
16757 if (row->y < min_y)
16758 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16759 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16760 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16761 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16762 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16764 it.current_y += row->height;
16766 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16767 last_reused_text_row = row;
16768 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it.last_visible_y)
16769 break;
16772 /* Disable lines in the current matrix which are now
16773 below the window. */
16774 for (++row; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16775 row->enabled_p = row->mode_line_p = 0;
16778 /* Update window_end_pos etc.; last_reused_text_row is the last
16779 reused row from the current matrix containing text, if any.
16780 The value of last_text_row is the last displayed line
16781 containing text. */
16782 if (last_reused_text_row)
16783 adjust_window_ends (w, last_reused_text_row, 1);
16784 else if (last_text_row)
16785 adjust_window_ends (w, last_text_row, 0);
16786 else
16788 /* This window must be completely empty. */
16789 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16790 w->window_end_pos = Z - ZV;
16791 w->window_end_vpos = 0;
16793 w->window_end_valid = 0;
16795 /* Update hint: don't try scrolling again in update_window. */
16796 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16798 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16799 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 1");
16800 #endif
16801 return 1;
16803 else if (CHARPOS (new_start) > CHARPOS (start))
16805 struct glyph_row *pt_row, *row;
16806 struct glyph_row *first_reusable_row;
16807 struct glyph_row *first_row_to_display;
16808 int dy;
16809 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16811 /* Find the row starting at new_start, if there is one. Don't
16812 reuse a partially visible line at the end. */
16813 first_reusable_row = start_row;
16814 while (first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16815 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) < yb
16816 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16817 < CHARPOS (new_start)))
16818 ++first_reusable_row;
16820 /* Give up if there is no row to reuse. */
16821 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) >= yb
16822 || !first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16823 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16824 != CHARPOS (new_start)))
16825 return 0;
16827 /* We can reuse fully visible rows beginning with
16828 first_reusable_row to the end of the window. Set
16829 first_row_to_display to the first row that cannot be reused.
16830 Set pt_row to the row containing point, if there is any. */
16831 pt_row = NULL;
16832 for (first_row_to_display = first_reusable_row;
16833 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_row_to_display) < yb;
16834 ++first_row_to_display)
16836 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16837 && (PT < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16838 || (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16839 && first_row_to_display->ends_at_zv_p
16840 && pt_row == NULL)))
16841 pt_row = first_row_to_display;
16844 /* Start displaying at the start of first_row_to_display. */
16845 eassert (first_row_to_display->y < yb);
16846 init_to_row_start (&it, w, first_row_to_display);
16848 nrows_scrolled = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_reusable_row, w->current_matrix)
16849 - start_vpos);
16850 it.vpos = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_row_to_display, w->current_matrix)
16851 - nrows_scrolled);
16852 it.current_y = (first_row_to_display->y - first_reusable_row->y
16853 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w));
16855 /* Display lines beginning with first_row_to_display in the
16856 desired matrix. Set last_text_row to the last row displayed
16857 that displays text. */
16858 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, it.vpos);
16859 if (pt_row == NULL)
16860 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16861 last_text_row = NULL;
16862 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !f->fonts_changed)
16863 if (display_line (&it))
16864 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16866 /* If point is in a reused row, adjust y and vpos of the cursor
16867 position. */
16868 if (pt_row)
16870 w->cursor.vpos -= nrows_scrolled;
16871 w->cursor.y -= first_reusable_row->y - start_row->y;
16874 /* Give up if point isn't in a row displayed or reused. (This
16875 also handles the case where w->cursor.vpos < nrows_scrolled
16876 after the calls to display_line, which can happen with scroll
16877 margins. See bug#1295.) */
16878 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16880 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16881 return 0;
16884 /* Scroll the display. */
16885 run.current_y = first_reusable_row->y;
16886 run.desired_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16887 run.height = it.last_visible_y - run.current_y;
16888 dy = run.current_y - run.desired_y;
16890 if (run.height)
16892 update_begin (f);
16893 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16894 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16895 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16896 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16897 update_end (f);
16900 /* Adjust Y positions of reused rows. */
16901 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16902 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16903 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16904 for (row = first_reusable_row; row < first_row_to_display; ++row)
16906 row->y -= dy;
16907 row->visible_height = row->height;
16908 if (row->y < min_y)
16909 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16910 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16911 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16912 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16913 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16916 /* Scroll the current matrix. */
16917 eassert (nrows_scrolled > 0);
16918 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16919 start_vpos,
16920 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16921 -nrows_scrolled);
16923 /* Disable rows not reused. */
16924 for (row -= nrows_scrolled; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16925 row->enabled_p = false;
16927 /* Point may have moved to a different line, so we cannot assume that
16928 the previous cursor position is valid; locate the correct row. */
16929 if (pt_row)
16931 for (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
16932 row < bottom_row
16933 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
16934 && !row->ends_at_zv_p;
16935 row++)
16937 w->cursor.vpos++;
16938 w->cursor.y = row->y;
16940 if (row < bottom_row)
16942 /* Can't simply scan the row for point with
16943 bidi-reordered glyph rows. Let set_cursor_from_row
16944 figure out where to put the cursor, and if it fails,
16945 give up. */
16946 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), bidi_display_reordering)))
16948 if (!set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
16949 0, 0, 0, 0))
16951 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16952 return 0;
16955 else
16957 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
16958 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
16960 for (; glyph < end
16961 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16962 || glyph->charpos < PT);
16963 glyph++)
16965 w->cursor.hpos++;
16966 w->cursor.x += glyph->pixel_width;
16972 /* Adjust window end. A null value of last_text_row means that
16973 the window end is in reused rows which in turn means that
16974 only its vpos can have changed. */
16975 if (last_text_row)
16976 adjust_window_ends (w, last_text_row, 0);
16977 else
16978 w->window_end_vpos -= nrows_scrolled;
16980 w->window_end_valid = 0;
16981 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16983 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16984 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 2");
16985 #endif
16986 return 1;
16989 return 0;
16994 /************************************************************************
16995 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has changed
16996 ************************************************************************/
16998 static struct glyph_row *find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *);
16999 static struct glyph_row *find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *,
17000 ptrdiff_t *, ptrdiff_t *);
17001 static struct glyph_row *
17002 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *, struct it *,
17003 struct glyph_row *);
17006 /* Return the last row in MATRIX displaying text. If row START is
17007 non-null, start searching with that row. IT gives the dimensions
17008 of the display. Value is null if matrix is empty; otherwise it is
17009 a pointer to the row found. */
17011 static struct glyph_row *
17012 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, struct it *it,
17013 struct glyph_row *start)
17015 struct glyph_row *row, *row_found;
17017 /* Set row_found to the last row in IT->w's current matrix
17018 displaying text. The loop looks funny but think of partially
17019 visible lines. */
17020 row_found = NULL;
17021 row = start ? start : MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (matrix);
17022 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
17024 eassert (row->enabled_p);
17025 row_found = row;
17026 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it->last_visible_y)
17027 break;
17028 ++row;
17031 return row_found;
17035 /* Return the last row in the current matrix of W that is not affected
17036 by changes at the start of current_buffer that occurred since W's
17037 current matrix was built. Value is null if no such row exists.
17039 BEG_UNCHANGED us the number of characters unchanged at the start of
17040 current_buffer. BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED is the buffer position of the
17041 first changed character in current_buffer. Characters at positions <
17042 BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED are at the same buffer positions as they were
17043 when the current matrix was built. */
17045 static struct glyph_row *
17046 find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *w)
17048 ptrdiff_t first_changed_pos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
17049 struct glyph_row *row;
17050 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
17051 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
17053 /* Find the last row displaying unchanged text. */
17054 for (row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
17055 MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
17056 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) < first_changed_pos;
17057 ++row)
17059 if (/* If row ends before first_changed_pos, it is unchanged,
17060 except in some case. */
17061 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) <= first_changed_pos
17062 /* When row ends in ZV and we write at ZV it is not
17063 unchanged. */
17064 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
17065 /* When first_changed_pos is the end of a continued line,
17066 row is not unchanged because it may be no longer
17067 continued. */
17068 && !(MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == first_changed_pos
17069 && (row->continued_p
17070 || row->exact_window_width_line_p))
17071 /* If ROW->end is beyond ZV, then ROW->end is outdated and
17072 needs to be recomputed, so don't consider this row as
17073 unchanged. This happens when the last line was
17074 bidi-reordered and was killed immediately before this
17075 redisplay cycle. In that case, ROW->end stores the
17076 buffer position of the first visual-order character of
17077 the killed text, which is now beyond ZV. */
17078 && CHARPOS (row->end.pos) <= ZV)
17079 row_found = row;
17081 /* Stop if last visible row. */
17082 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb)
17083 break;
17086 return row_found;
17090 /* Find the first glyph row in the current matrix of W that is not
17091 affected by changes at the end of current_buffer since the
17092 time W's current matrix was built.
17094 Return in *DELTA the number of chars by which buffer positions in
17095 unchanged text at the end of current_buffer must be adjusted.
17097 Return in *DELTA_BYTES the corresponding number of bytes.
17099 Value is null if no such row exists, i.e. all rows are affected by
17100 changes. */
17102 static struct glyph_row *
17103 find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *w,
17104 ptrdiff_t *delta, ptrdiff_t *delta_bytes)
17106 struct glyph_row *row;
17107 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
17109 *delta = *delta_bytes = 0;
17111 /* Display must not have been paused, otherwise the current matrix
17112 is not up to date. */
17113 eassert (w->window_end_valid);
17115 /* A value of window_end_pos >= END_UNCHANGED means that the window
17116 end is in the range of changed text. If so, there is no
17117 unchanged row at the end of W's current matrix. */
17118 if (w->window_end_pos >= END_UNCHANGED)
17119 return NULL;
17121 /* Set row to the last row in W's current matrix displaying text. */
17122 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->window_end_vpos);
17124 /* If matrix is entirely empty, no unchanged row exists. */
17125 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
17127 /* The value of row is the last glyph row in the matrix having a
17128 meaningful buffer position in it. The end position of row
17129 corresponds to window_end_pos. This allows us to translate
17130 buffer positions in the current matrix to current buffer
17131 positions for characters not in changed text. */
17132 ptrdiff_t Z_old =
17133 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + w->window_end_pos;
17134 ptrdiff_t Z_BYTE_old =
17135 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17136 ptrdiff_t last_unchanged_pos, last_unchanged_pos_old;
17137 struct glyph_row *first_text_row
17138 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
17140 *delta = Z - Z_old;
17141 *delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17143 /* Set last_unchanged_pos to the buffer position of the last
17144 character in the buffer that has not been changed. Z is the
17145 index + 1 of the last character in current_buffer, i.e. by
17146 subtracting END_UNCHANGED we get the index of the last
17147 unchanged character, and we have to add BEG to get its buffer
17148 position. */
17149 last_unchanged_pos = Z - END_UNCHANGED + BEG;
17150 last_unchanged_pos_old = last_unchanged_pos - *delta;
17152 /* Search backward from ROW for a row displaying a line that
17153 starts at a minimum position >= last_unchanged_pos_old. */
17154 for (; row > first_text_row; --row)
17156 /* This used to abort, but it can happen.
17157 It is ok to just stop the search instead here. KFS. */
17158 if (!row->enabled_p || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
17159 break;
17161 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) >= last_unchanged_pos_old)
17162 row_found = row;
17166 eassert (!row_found || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row_found));
17168 return row_found;
17172 /* Make sure that glyph rows in the current matrix of window W
17173 reference the same glyph memory as corresponding rows in the
17174 frame's frame matrix. This function is called after scrolling W's
17175 current matrix on a terminal frame in try_window_id and
17176 try_window_reusing_current_matrix. */
17178 static void
17179 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *w)
17181 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17182 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row;
17184 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window and full-width. Its frame
17185 must have a frame matrix. */
17186 eassert (BUFFERP (w->contents));
17187 eassert (WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w));
17188 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
17190 /* If W is a full-width window, glyph pointers in W's current matrix
17191 have, by definition, to be the same as glyph pointers in the
17192 corresponding frame matrix. Note that frame matrices have no
17193 marginal areas (see build_frame_matrix). */
17194 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows;
17195 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows;
17196 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w);
17197 while (window_row < window_row_end)
17199 struct glyph *start = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA];
17200 struct glyph *end = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA];
17202 frame_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = start;
17203 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = start;
17204 frame_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = end;
17205 frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = end;
17207 /* Disable frame rows whose corresponding window rows have
17208 been disabled in try_window_id. */
17209 if (!window_row->enabled_p)
17210 frame_row->enabled_p = false;
17212 ++window_row, ++frame_row;
17217 /* Find the glyph row in window W containing CHARPOS. Consider all
17218 rows between START and END (not inclusive). END null means search
17219 all rows to the end of the display area of W. Value is the row
17220 containing CHARPOS or null. */
17222 struct glyph_row *
17223 row_containing_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos,
17224 struct glyph_row *start, struct glyph_row *end, int dy)
17226 struct glyph_row *row = start;
17227 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
17228 ptrdiff_t mindif = BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->contents)) + 1;
17229 int last_y;
17231 /* If we happen to start on a header-line, skip that. */
17232 if (row->mode_line_p)
17233 ++row;
17235 if ((end && row >= end) || !row->enabled_p)
17236 return NULL;
17238 last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - dy;
17240 while (1)
17242 /* Give up if we have gone too far. */
17243 if (end && row >= end)
17244 return NULL;
17245 /* This formerly returned if they were equal.
17246 I think that both quantities are of a "last plus one" type;
17247 if so, when they are equal, the row is within the screen. -- rms. */
17248 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y)
17249 return NULL;
17251 /* If it is in this row, return this row. */
17252 if (! (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < charpos
17253 || (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == charpos
17254 /* The end position of a row equals the start
17255 position of the next row. If CHARPOS is there, we
17256 would rather consider it displayed in the next
17257 line, except when this line ends in ZV. */
17258 && !row_for_charpos_p (row, charpos)))
17259 && charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
17261 struct glyph *g;
17263 if (NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), bidi_display_reordering))
17264 || (!best_row && !row->continued_p))
17265 return row;
17266 /* In bidi-reordered rows, there could be several rows whose
17267 edges surround CHARPOS, all of these rows belonging to
17268 the same continued line. We need to find the row which
17269 fits CHARPOS the best. */
17270 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17271 g < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17272 g++)
17274 if (!STRINGP (g->object))
17276 if (g->charpos > 0 && eabs (g->charpos - charpos) < mindif)
17278 mindif = eabs (g->charpos - charpos);
17279 best_row = row;
17280 /* Exact match always wins. */
17281 if (mindif == 0)
17282 return best_row;
17287 else if (best_row && !row->continued_p)
17288 return best_row;
17289 ++row;
17294 /* Try to redisplay window W by reusing its existing display. W's
17295 current matrix must be up to date when this function is called,
17296 i.e. window_end_valid must be nonzero.
17298 Value is
17300 1 if display has been updated
17301 0 if otherwise unsuccessful
17302 -1 if redisplay with same window start is known not to succeed
17304 The following steps are performed:
17306 1. Find the last row in the current matrix of W that is not
17307 affected by changes at the start of current_buffer. If no such row
17308 is found, give up.
17310 2. Find the first row in W's current matrix that is not affected by
17311 changes at the end of current_buffer. Maybe there is no such row.
17313 3. Display lines beginning with the row + 1 found in step 1 to the
17314 row found in step 2 or, if step 2 didn't find a row, to the end of
17315 the window.
17317 4. If cursor is not known to appear on the window, give up.
17319 5. If display stopped at the row found in step 2, scroll the
17320 display and current matrix as needed.
17322 6. Maybe display some lines at the end of W, if we must. This can
17323 happen under various circumstances, like a partially visible line
17324 becoming fully visible, or because newly displayed lines are displayed
17325 in smaller font sizes.
17327 7. Update W's window end information. */
17329 static int
17330 try_window_id (struct window *w)
17332 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17333 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix;
17334 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix;
17335 struct glyph_row *last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17336 struct glyph_row *first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17337 struct glyph_row *row;
17338 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
17339 int bottom_vpos;
17340 struct it it;
17341 ptrdiff_t delta = 0, delta_bytes = 0, stop_pos;
17342 int dvpos, dy;
17343 struct text_pos start_pos;
17344 struct run run;
17345 int first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = 0;
17346 struct glyph_row *last_text_row, *last_text_row_at_end;
17347 struct text_pos start;
17348 ptrdiff_t first_changed_charpos, last_changed_charpos;
17350 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17351 if (inhibit_try_window_id)
17352 return 0;
17353 #endif
17355 /* This is handy for debugging. */
17356 #if 0
17357 #define GIVE_UP(X) \
17358 do { \
17359 fprintf (stderr, "try_window_id give up %d\n", (X)); \
17360 return 0; \
17361 } while (0)
17362 #else
17363 #define GIVE_UP(X) return 0
17364 #endif
17366 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
17368 /* Don't use this for mini-windows because these can show
17369 messages and mini-buffers, and we don't handle that here. */
17370 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
17371 GIVE_UP (1);
17373 /* This flag is used to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17374 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || f->cursor_type_changed)
17375 GIVE_UP (2);
17377 /* Verify that narrowing has not changed.
17378 Also verify that we were not told to prevent redisplay optimizations.
17379 It would be nice to further
17380 reduce the number of cases where this prevents try_window_id. */
17381 if (current_buffer->clip_changed
17382 || current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p)
17383 GIVE_UP (3);
17385 /* Window must either use window-based redisplay or be full width. */
17386 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
17387 && (!FRAME_LINE_INS_DEL_OK (f)
17388 || !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)))
17389 GIVE_UP (4);
17391 /* Give up if point is known NOT to appear in W. */
17392 if (PT < CHARPOS (start))
17393 GIVE_UP (5);
17395 /* Another way to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17396 if (w->last_modified == 0)
17397 GIVE_UP (6);
17399 /* Verify that window is not hscrolled. */
17400 if (w->hscroll != 0)
17401 GIVE_UP (7);
17403 /* Verify that display wasn't paused. */
17404 if (!w->window_end_valid)
17405 GIVE_UP (8);
17407 /* Likewise if highlighting trailing whitespace. */
17408 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
17409 GIVE_UP (11);
17411 /* Can't use this if overlay arrow position and/or string have
17412 changed. */
17413 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
17414 GIVE_UP (12);
17416 /* When word-wrap is on, adding a space to the first word of a
17417 wrapped line can change the wrap position, altering the line
17418 above it. It might be worthwhile to handle this more
17419 intelligently, but for now just redisplay from scratch. */
17420 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), word_wrap)))
17421 GIVE_UP (21);
17423 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
17424 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
17425 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
17426 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
17427 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
17428 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
17429 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization and
17430 redisplay from scratch. */
17431 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), bidi_display_reordering))
17432 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->contents), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
17433 GIVE_UP (22);
17435 /* Make sure beg_unchanged and end_unchanged are up to date. Do it
17436 only if buffer has really changed. The reason is that the gap is
17437 initially at Z for freshly visited files. The code below would
17438 set end_unchanged to 0 in that case. */
17439 if (MODIFF > SAVE_MODIFF
17440 /* This seems to happen sometimes after saving a buffer. */
17441 || BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED > Z_BYTE)
17443 if (GPT - BEG < BEG_UNCHANGED)
17444 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG;
17445 if (Z - GPT < END_UNCHANGED)
17446 END_UNCHANGED = Z - GPT;
17449 /* The position of the first and last character that has been changed. */
17450 first_changed_charpos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
17451 last_changed_charpos = Z - END_UNCHANGED;
17453 /* If window starts after a line end, and the last change is in
17454 front of that newline, then changes don't affect the display.
17455 This case happens with stealth-fontification. Note that although
17456 the display is unchanged, glyph positions in the matrix have to
17457 be adjusted, of course. */
17458 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->window_end_vpos);
17459 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
17460 && ((last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start)
17461 && CHARPOS (start) == BEGV)
17462 || (last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start) - 1
17463 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start) - 1) == '\n')))
17465 ptrdiff_t Z_old, Z_delta, Z_BYTE_old, Z_delta_bytes;
17466 struct glyph_row *r0;
17468 /* Compute how many chars/bytes have been added to or removed
17469 from the buffer. */
17470 Z_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + w->window_end_pos;
17471 Z_BYTE_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17472 Z_delta = Z - Z_old;
17473 Z_delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17475 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17476 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17477 front of the window start. */
17478 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta)
17479 GIVE_UP (13);
17481 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17482 as is, after adjusting glyph positions. No need to compute
17483 the window end again, since its offset from Z hasn't changed. */
17484 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17485 if (CHARPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r0) + Z_delta
17486 && BYTEPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (r0) + Z_delta_bytes
17487 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17488 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta
17489 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17491 /* Adjust positions in the glyph matrix. */
17492 if (Z_delta || Z_delta_bytes)
17494 struct glyph_row *r1
17495 = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17496 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
17497 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r0, current_matrix),
17498 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, current_matrix),
17499 Z_delta, Z_delta_bytes);
17502 /* Set the cursor. */
17503 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17504 if (row)
17505 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17506 return 1;
17510 /* Handle the case that changes are all below what is displayed in
17511 the window, and that PT is in the window. This shortcut cannot
17512 be taken if ZV is visible in the window, and text has been added
17513 there that is visible in the window. */
17514 if (first_changed_charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17515 /* ZV is not visible in the window, or there are no
17516 changes at ZV, actually. */
17517 && (current_matrix->zv > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17518 || first_changed_charpos == last_changed_charpos))
17520 struct glyph_row *r0;
17522 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17523 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17524 front of the window start. */
17525 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17526 GIVE_UP (14);
17528 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17529 as is, without changing glyph positions since no text has
17530 been added/removed in front of the window end. */
17531 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17532 if (TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, r0->minpos)
17533 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17534 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
17535 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17537 /* We have to compute the window end anew since text
17538 could have been added/removed after it. */
17539 w->window_end_pos = Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row);
17540 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17542 /* Set the cursor. */
17543 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17544 if (row)
17545 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17546 return 2;
17550 /* Give up if window start is in the changed area.
17552 The condition used to read
17554 (BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED != Z - BEG && ...)
17556 but why that was tested escapes me at the moment. */
17557 if (CHARPOS (start) >= first_changed_charpos
17558 && CHARPOS (start) <= last_changed_charpos)
17559 GIVE_UP (15);
17561 /* Check that window start agrees with the start of the first glyph
17562 row in its current matrix. Check this after we know the window
17563 start is not in changed text, otherwise positions would not be
17564 comparable. */
17565 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17566 if (!TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, row->minpos))
17567 GIVE_UP (16);
17569 /* Give up if the window ends in strings. Overlay strings
17570 at the end are difficult to handle, so don't try. */
17571 row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, w->window_end_vpos);
17572 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17573 GIVE_UP (20);
17575 /* Compute the position at which we have to start displaying new
17576 lines. Some of the lines at the top of the window might be
17577 reusable because they are not displaying changed text. Find the
17578 last row in W's current matrix not affected by changes at the
17579 start of current_buffer. Value is null if changes start in the
17580 first line of window. */
17581 last_unchanged_at_beg_row = find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (w);
17582 if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17584 /* Avoid starting to display in the middle of a character, a TAB
17585 for instance. This is easier than to set up the iterator
17586 exactly, and it's not a frequent case, so the additional
17587 effort wouldn't really pay off. */
17588 while ((MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17589 || last_unchanged_at_beg_row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
17590 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row > w->current_matrix->rows)
17591 --last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17593 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row))
17594 GIVE_UP (17);
17596 if (init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_unchanged_at_beg_row) == 0)
17597 GIVE_UP (18);
17598 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17600 /* Start displaying new lines in the desired matrix at the same
17601 vpos we would use in the current matrix, i.e. below
17602 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17603 it.vpos = 1 + MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row,
17604 current_matrix);
17605 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17606 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17608 eassert (it.hpos == 0 && it.current_x == 0);
17610 else
17612 /* There are no reusable lines at the start of the window.
17613 Start displaying in the first text line. */
17614 start_display (&it, w, start);
17615 it.vpos = it.first_vpos;
17616 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17619 /* Find the first row that is not affected by changes at the end of
17620 the buffer. Value will be null if there is no unchanged row, in
17621 which case we must redisplay to the end of the window. delta
17622 will be set to the value by which buffer positions beginning with
17623 first_unchanged_at_end_row have to be adjusted due to text
17624 changes. */
17625 first_unchanged_at_end_row
17626 = find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (w, &delta, &delta_bytes);
17627 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta = delta);
17628 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta_bytes = delta_bytes);
17630 /* Set stop_pos to the buffer position up to which we will have to
17631 display new lines. If first_unchanged_at_end_row != NULL, this
17632 is the buffer position of the start of the line displayed in that
17633 row. For first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL, use 0 to indicate
17634 that we don't stop at a buffer position. */
17635 stop_pos = 0;
17636 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17638 eassert (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL
17639 || first_unchanged_at_end_row >= last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17641 /* If this is a continuation line, move forward to the next one
17642 that isn't. Changes in lines above affect this line.
17643 Caution: this may move first_unchanged_at_end_row to a row
17644 not displaying text. */
17645 while (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17646 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17647 && (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17648 < it.last_visible_y))
17649 ++first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17651 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17652 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17653 >= it.last_visible_y))
17654 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17655 else
17657 stop_pos = (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17658 + delta);
17659 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos
17660 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, current_matrix);
17661 eassert (stop_pos >= Z - END_UNCHANGED);
17664 else if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL)
17665 GIVE_UP (19);
17668 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17670 /* Either there is no unchanged row at the end, or the one we have
17671 now displays text. This is a necessary condition for the window
17672 end pos calculation at the end of this function. */
17673 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17674 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row));
17676 debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos
17677 = (last_unchanged_at_beg_row
17678 ? MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row, current_matrix)
17679 : -1);
17680 debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
17682 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
17685 /* Display new lines. Set last_text_row to the last new line
17686 displayed which has text on it, i.e. might end up as being the
17687 line where the window_end_vpos is. */
17688 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17689 last_text_row = NULL;
17690 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
17691 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17692 && !f->fonts_changed
17693 && (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17694 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < stop_pos))
17696 if (display_line (&it))
17697 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
17700 if (f->fonts_changed)
17701 return -1;
17704 /* Compute differences in buffer positions, y-positions etc. for
17705 lines reused at the bottom of the window. Compute what we can
17706 scroll. */
17707 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17708 /* No lines reused because we displayed everything up to the
17709 bottom of the window. */
17710 && it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
17712 dvpos = (it.vpos
17713 - MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row,
17714 current_matrix));
17715 dy = it.current_y - first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17716 run.current_y = first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17717 run.desired_y = run.current_y + dy;
17718 run.height = it.last_visible_y - max (run.current_y, run.desired_y);
17720 else
17722 delta = delta_bytes = dvpos = dy
17723 = run.current_y = run.desired_y = run.height = 0;
17724 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17726 IF_DEBUG ((debug_dvpos = dvpos, debug_dy = dy));
17729 /* Find the cursor if not already found. We have to decide whether
17730 PT will appear on this window (it sometimes doesn't, but this is
17731 not a very frequent case.) This decision has to be made before
17732 the current matrix is altered. A value of cursor.vpos < 0 means
17733 that PT is either in one of the lines beginning at
17734 first_unchanged_at_end_row or below the window. Don't care for
17735 lines that might be displayed later at the window end; as
17736 mentioned, this is not a frequent case. */
17737 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17739 /* Cursor in unchanged rows at the top? */
17740 if (PT < CHARPOS (start_pos)
17741 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17743 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT,
17744 MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix),
17745 last_unchanged_at_beg_row + 1, 0);
17746 if (row)
17747 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17750 /* Start from first_unchanged_at_end_row looking for PT. */
17751 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17753 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT - delta,
17754 first_unchanged_at_end_row, NULL, 0);
17755 if (row)
17756 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, delta,
17757 delta_bytes, dy, dvpos);
17760 /* Give up if cursor was not found. */
17761 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17763 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17764 return -1;
17768 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
17770 int this_scroll_margin, cursor_height;
17771 int frame_line_height = default_line_pixel_height (w);
17772 int window_total_lines
17773 = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it.f) / frame_line_height;
17775 this_scroll_margin =
17776 max (0, min (scroll_margin, window_total_lines / 4));
17777 this_scroll_margin *= frame_line_height;
17778 cursor_height = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->height;
17780 if ((w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
17781 && CHARPOS (start) > BEGV)
17782 /* Old redisplay didn't take scroll margin into account at the bottom,
17783 but then global-hl-line-mode doesn't scroll. KFS 2004-06-14 */
17784 || (w->cursor.y + (make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p
17785 ? cursor_height + this_scroll_margin
17786 : 1)) > it.last_visible_y)
17788 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17789 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17790 return -1;
17794 /* Scroll the display. Do it before changing the current matrix so
17795 that xterm.c doesn't get confused about where the cursor glyph is
17796 found. */
17797 if (dy && run.height)
17799 update_begin (f);
17801 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17803 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
17804 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17805 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
17806 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
17808 else
17810 /* Terminal frame. In this case, dvpos gives the number of
17811 lines to scroll by; dvpos < 0 means scroll up. */
17812 int from_vpos
17813 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, w->current_matrix);
17814 int from = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) + from_vpos;
17815 int end = (WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w)
17816 + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0)
17817 + window_internal_height (w));
17819 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS)
17820 x_clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17821 #endif
17822 /* Perform the operation on the screen. */
17823 if (dvpos > 0)
17825 /* Scroll last_unchanged_at_beg_row to the end of the
17826 window down dvpos lines. */
17827 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17829 /* On dumb terminals delete dvpos lines at the end
17830 before inserting dvpos empty lines. */
17831 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17832 ins_del_lines (f, end - dvpos, -dvpos);
17834 /* Insert dvpos empty lines in front of
17835 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17836 ins_del_lines (f, from, dvpos);
17838 else if (dvpos < 0)
17840 /* Scroll up last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos to the end of
17841 the window to last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos - |dvpos|. */
17842 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17844 /* Delete dvpos lines in front of
17845 last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos. ins_del_lines will set
17846 the cursor to the given vpos and emit |dvpos| delete
17847 line sequences. */
17848 ins_del_lines (f, from + dvpos, dvpos);
17850 /* On a dumb terminal insert dvpos empty lines at the
17851 end. */
17852 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17853 ins_del_lines (f, end + dvpos, -dvpos);
17856 set_terminal_window (f, 0);
17859 update_end (f);
17862 /* Shift reused rows of the current matrix to the right position.
17863 BOTTOM_ROW is the last + 1 row in the current matrix reserved for
17864 text. */
17865 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17866 bottom_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, current_matrix);
17867 if (dvpos < 0)
17869 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17870 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17871 clear_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, bottom_vpos + dvpos,
17872 bottom_vpos);
17874 else if (dvpos > 0)
17876 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17877 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17878 clear_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17879 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos);
17882 /* For frame-based redisplay, make sure that current frame and window
17883 matrix are in sync with respect to glyph memory. */
17884 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17885 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (w);
17887 /* Adjust buffer positions in reused rows. */
17888 if (delta || delta_bytes)
17889 increment_matrix_positions (current_matrix,
17890 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17891 bottom_vpos, delta, delta_bytes);
17893 /* Adjust Y positions. */
17894 if (dy)
17895 shift_glyph_matrix (w, current_matrix,
17896 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17897 bottom_vpos, dy);
17899 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17901 first_unchanged_at_end_row += dvpos;
17902 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row->y >= it.last_visible_y
17903 || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row))
17904 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17907 /* If scrolling up, there may be some lines to display at the end of
17908 the window. */
17909 last_text_row_at_end = NULL;
17910 if (dy < 0)
17912 /* Scrolling up can leave for example a partially visible line
17913 at the end of the window to be redisplayed. */
17914 /* Set last_row to the glyph row in the current matrix where the
17915 window end line is found. It has been moved up or down in
17916 the matrix by dvpos. */
17917 int last_vpos = w->window_end_vpos + dvpos;
17918 struct glyph_row *last_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, last_vpos);
17920 /* If last_row is the window end line, it should display text. */
17921 eassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (last_row));
17923 /* If window end line was partially visible before, begin
17924 displaying at that line. Otherwise begin displaying with the
17925 line following it. */
17926 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row) - dy >= it.last_visible_y)
17928 init_to_row_start (&it, w, last_row);
17929 it.vpos = last_vpos;
17930 it.current_y = last_row->y;
17932 else
17934 init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_row);
17935 it.vpos = 1 + last_vpos;
17936 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row);
17937 ++last_row;
17940 /* We may start in a continuation line. If so, we have to
17941 get the right continuation_lines_width and current_x. */
17942 it.continuation_lines_width = last_row->continuation_lines_width;
17943 it.hpos = it.current_x = 0;
17945 /* Display the rest of the lines at the window end. */
17946 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17947 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !f->fonts_changed)
17949 /* Is it always sure that the display agrees with lines in
17950 the current matrix? I don't think so, so we mark rows
17951 displayed invalid in the current matrix by setting their
17952 enabled_p flag to zero. */
17953 SET_MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->current_matrix, it.vpos, false);
17954 if (display_line (&it))
17955 last_text_row_at_end = it.glyph_row - 1;
17959 /* Update window_end_pos and window_end_vpos. */
17960 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row && !last_text_row_at_end)
17962 /* Window end line if one of the preserved rows from the current
17963 matrix. Set row to the last row displaying text in current
17964 matrix starting at first_unchanged_at_end_row, after
17965 scrolling. */
17966 eassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row));
17967 row = find_last_row_displaying_text (w->current_matrix, &it,
17968 first_unchanged_at_end_row);
17969 eassert (row && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row));
17970 adjust_window_ends (w, row, 1);
17971 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17972 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "A"));
17974 else if (last_text_row_at_end)
17976 adjust_window_ends (w, last_text_row_at_end, 0);
17977 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17978 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "B"));
17980 else if (last_text_row)
17982 /* We have displayed either to the end of the window or at the
17983 end of the window, i.e. the last row with text is to be found
17984 in the desired matrix. */
17985 adjust_window_ends (w, last_text_row, 0);
17986 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17988 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17989 && last_text_row == NULL
17990 && last_text_row_at_end == NULL)
17992 /* Displayed to end of window, but no line containing text was
17993 displayed. Lines were deleted at the end of the window. */
17994 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
17995 int vpos = w->window_end_vpos;
17996 struct glyph_row *current_row = current_matrix->rows + vpos;
17997 struct glyph_row *desired_row = desired_matrix->rows + vpos;
17999 for (row = NULL;
18000 row == NULL && vpos >= first_vpos;
18001 --vpos, --current_row, --desired_row)
18003 if (desired_row->enabled_p)
18005 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (desired_row))
18006 row = desired_row;
18008 else if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (current_row))
18009 row = current_row;
18012 eassert (row != NULL);
18013 w->window_end_vpos = vpos + 1;
18014 w->window_end_pos = Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row);
18015 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
18016 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
18017 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "C"));
18019 else
18020 emacs_abort ();
18022 IF_DEBUG ((debug_end_pos = w->window_end_pos,
18023 debug_end_vpos = w->window_end_vpos));
18025 /* Record that display has not been completed. */
18026 w->window_end_valid = 0;
18027 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
18028 return 3;
18030 #undef GIVE_UP
18035 /***********************************************************************
18036 More debugging support
18037 ***********************************************************************/
18039 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
18041 void dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *, int, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
18042 void dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
18043 void dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
18046 /* Dump the contents of glyph matrix MATRIX on stderr.
18048 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
18049 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
18050 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
18052 void
18053 dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int glyphs)
18055 int i;
18056 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i)
18057 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, i), i, glyphs);
18061 /* Dump contents of glyph GLYPH to stderr. ROW and AREA are
18062 the glyph row and area where the glyph comes from. */
18064 void
18065 dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *row, struct glyph *glyph, int area)
18067 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18068 || glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH)
18070 fprintf (stderr,
18071 " %5"pD"d %c %9"pI"d %c %3d 0x%06x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18072 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18073 (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18074 ? 'C'
18075 : 'G'),
18076 glyph->charpos,
18077 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18078 ? 'B'
18079 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18080 ? 'S'
18081 : (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
18082 ? '0'
18083 : '-'))),
18084 glyph->pixel_width,
18085 glyph->u.ch,
18086 (glyph->u.ch < 0x80 && glyph->u.ch >= ' '
18087 ? glyph->u.ch
18088 : '.'),
18089 glyph->face_id,
18090 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18091 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18093 else if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18095 fprintf (stderr,
18096 " %5"pD"d %c %9"pI"d %c %3d 0x%06x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18097 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18098 'S',
18099 glyph->charpos,
18100 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18101 ? 'B'
18102 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18103 ? 'S'
18104 : (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
18105 ? '0'
18106 : '-'))),
18107 glyph->pixel_width,
18109 ' ',
18110 glyph->face_id,
18111 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18112 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18114 else if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
18116 fprintf (stderr,
18117 " %5"pD"d %c %9"pI"d %c %3d 0x%06x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18118 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18119 'I',
18120 glyph->charpos,
18121 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18122 ? 'B'
18123 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18124 ? 'S'
18125 : (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
18126 ? '0'
18127 : '-'))),
18128 glyph->pixel_width,
18129 glyph->u.img_id,
18130 '.',
18131 glyph->face_id,
18132 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18133 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18135 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
18137 fprintf (stderr,
18138 " %5"pD"d %c %9"pI"d %c %3d 0x%06x",
18139 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18140 '+',
18141 glyph->charpos,
18142 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18143 ? 'B'
18144 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18145 ? 'S'
18146 : (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
18147 ? '0'
18148 : '-'))),
18149 glyph->pixel_width,
18150 glyph->u.cmp.id);
18151 if (glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
18152 fprintf (stderr,
18153 "[%d-%d]",
18154 glyph->slice.cmp.from, glyph->slice.cmp.to);
18155 fprintf (stderr, " . %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18156 glyph->face_id,
18157 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18158 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18163 /* Dump the contents of glyph row at VPOS in MATRIX to stderr.
18164 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
18165 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
18166 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
18168 void
18169 dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *row, int vpos, int glyphs)
18171 if (glyphs != 1)
18173 fprintf (stderr, "Row Start End Used oE><\\CTZFesm X Y W H V A P\n");
18174 fprintf (stderr, "==============================================================================\n");
18176 fprintf (stderr, "%3d %9"pI"d %9"pI"d %4d %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d\
18177 %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d\n",
18178 vpos,
18179 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
18180 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row),
18181 row->used[TEXT_AREA],
18182 row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p,
18183 row->enabled_p,
18184 row->truncated_on_left_p,
18185 row->truncated_on_right_p,
18186 row->continued_p,
18187 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row),
18188 MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row),
18189 row->ends_at_zv_p,
18190 row->fill_line_p,
18191 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p,
18192 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p,
18193 row->mouse_face_p,
18194 row->x,
18195 row->y,
18196 row->pixel_width,
18197 row->height,
18198 row->visible_height,
18199 row->ascent,
18200 row->phys_ascent);
18201 /* The next 3 lines should align to "Start" in the header. */
18202 fprintf (stderr, " %9"pD"d %9"pD"d\t%5d\n", row->start.overlay_string_index,
18203 row->end.overlay_string_index,
18204 row->continuation_lines_width);
18205 fprintf (stderr, " %9"pI"d %9"pI"d\n",
18206 CHARPOS (row->start.string_pos),
18207 CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos));
18208 fprintf (stderr, " %9d %9d\n", row->start.dpvec_index,
18209 row->end.dpvec_index);
18212 if (glyphs > 1)
18214 int area;
18216 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18218 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area];
18219 struct glyph *glyph_end = glyph + row->used[area];
18221 /* Glyph for a line end in text. */
18222 if (area == TEXT_AREA && glyph == glyph_end && glyph->charpos > 0)
18223 ++glyph_end;
18225 if (glyph < glyph_end)
18226 fprintf (stderr, " Glyph# Type Pos O W Code C Face LR\n");
18228 for (; glyph < glyph_end; ++glyph)
18229 dump_glyph (row, glyph, area);
18232 else if (glyphs == 1)
18234 int area;
18236 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18238 char *s = alloca (row->used[area] + 4);
18239 int i;
18241 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i)
18243 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area] + i;
18244 if (i == row->used[area] - 1
18245 && area == TEXT_AREA
18246 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
18247 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18248 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')
18250 strcpy (&s[i], "[\\n]");
18251 i += 4;
18253 else if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18254 && glyph->u.ch < 0x80
18255 && glyph->u.ch >= ' ')
18256 s[i] = glyph->u.ch;
18257 else
18258 s[i] = '.';
18261 s[i] = '\0';
18262 fprintf (stderr, "%3d: (%d) '%s'\n", vpos, row->enabled_p, s);
18268 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-matrix", Fdump_glyph_matrix,
18269 Sdump_glyph_matrix, 0, 1, "p",
18270 doc: /* Dump the current matrix of the selected window to stderr.
18271 Shows contents of glyph row structures. With non-nil
18272 parameter GLYPHS, dump glyphs as well. If GLYPHS is 1 show
18273 glyphs in short form, otherwise show glyphs in long form. */)
18274 (Lisp_Object glyphs)
18276 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
18277 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->contents);
18279 fprintf (stderr, "PT = %"pI"d, BEGV = %"pI"d. ZV = %"pI"d\n",
18280 BUF_PT (buffer), BUF_BEGV (buffer), BUF_ZV (buffer));
18281 fprintf (stderr, "Cursor x = %d, y = %d, hpos = %d, vpos = %d\n",
18282 w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y, w->cursor.hpos, w->cursor.vpos);
18283 fprintf (stderr, "=============================================\n");
18284 dump_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix,
18285 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 0);
18286 return Qnil;
18290 DEFUN ("dump-frame-glyph-matrix", Fdump_frame_glyph_matrix,
18291 Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix, 0, 0, "", doc: /* */)
18292 (void)
18294 struct frame *f = XFRAME (selected_frame);
18295 dump_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix, 1);
18296 return Qnil;
18300 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-row", Fdump_glyph_row, Sdump_glyph_row, 1, 2, "",
18301 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW to stderr.
18302 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18303 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18304 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18305 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18307 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
18308 EMACS_INT vpos;
18310 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18311 matrix = XWINDOW (selected_window)->current_matrix;
18312 vpos = XINT (row);
18313 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < matrix->nrows)
18314 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, vpos),
18315 vpos,
18316 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18317 return Qnil;
18321 DEFUN ("dump-tool-bar-row", Fdump_tool_bar_row, Sdump_tool_bar_row, 1, 2, "",
18322 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW of the tool-bar of the current frame to stderr.
18323 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18324 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18325 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form.
18327 If there's no tool-bar, or if the tool-bar is not drawn by Emacs,
18328 do nothing. */)
18329 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18331 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM) && ! defined (USE_GTK) && ! defined (HAVE_NS)
18332 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
18333 struct glyph_matrix *m = XWINDOW (sf->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix;
18334 EMACS_INT vpos;
18336 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18337 vpos = XINT (row);
18338 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < m->nrows)
18339 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (m, vpos), vpos,
18340 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18341 #endif
18342 return Qnil;
18346 DEFUN ("trace-redisplay", Ftrace_redisplay, Strace_redisplay, 0, 1, "P",
18347 doc: /* Toggle tracing of redisplay.
18348 With ARG, turn tracing on if and only if ARG is positive. */)
18349 (Lisp_Object arg)
18351 if (NILP (arg))
18352 trace_redisplay_p = !trace_redisplay_p;
18353 else
18355 arg = Fprefix_numeric_value (arg);
18356 trace_redisplay_p = XINT (arg) > 0;
18359 return Qnil;
18363 DEFUN ("trace-to-stderr", Ftrace_to_stderr, Strace_to_stderr, 1, MANY, "",
18364 doc: /* Like `format', but print result to stderr.
18365 usage: (trace-to-stderr STRING &rest OBJECTS) */)
18366 (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
18368 Lisp_Object s = Fformat (nargs, args);
18369 fprintf (stderr, "%s", SDATA (s));
18370 return Qnil;
18373 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
18377 /***********************************************************************
18378 Building Desired Matrix Rows
18379 ***********************************************************************/
18381 /* Return a temporary glyph row holding the glyphs of an overlay arrow.
18382 Used for non-window-redisplay windows, and for windows w/o left fringe. */
18384 static struct glyph_row *
18385 get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *w, Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string)
18387 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
18388 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->contents);
18389 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
18390 const unsigned char *arrow_string = SDATA (overlay_arrow_string);
18391 int arrow_len = SCHARS (overlay_arrow_string);
18392 const unsigned char *arrow_end = arrow_string + arrow_len;
18393 const unsigned char *p;
18394 struct it it;
18395 bool multibyte_p;
18396 int n_glyphs_before;
18398 set_buffer_temp (buffer);
18399 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, &scratch_glyph_row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18400 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18401 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, 0, 0);
18403 multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
18404 p = arrow_string;
18405 while (p < arrow_end)
18407 Lisp_Object face, ilisp;
18409 /* Get the next character. */
18410 if (multibyte_p)
18411 it.c = it.char_to_display = string_char_and_length (p, &it.len);
18412 else
18414 it.c = it.char_to_display = *p, it.len = 1;
18415 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it.c))
18416 it.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it.c);
18418 p += it.len;
18420 /* Get its face. */
18421 ilisp = make_number (p - arrow_string);
18422 face = Fget_text_property (ilisp, Qface, overlay_arrow_string);
18423 it.face_id = compute_char_face (f, it.char_to_display, face);
18425 /* Compute its width, get its glyphs. */
18426 n_glyphs_before = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18427 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, -1, -1);
18428 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it);
18430 /* If this character doesn't fit any more in the line, we have
18431 to remove some glyphs. */
18432 if (it.current_x > it.last_visible_x)
18434 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
18435 break;
18439 set_buffer_temp (old);
18440 return it.glyph_row;
18444 /* Insert truncation glyphs at the start of IT->glyph_row. Which
18445 glyphs to insert is determined by produce_special_glyphs. */
18447 static void
18448 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *it)
18450 struct it truncate_it;
18451 struct glyph *from, *end, *to, *toend;
18453 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
18454 || (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18455 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0)
18456 || (it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18457 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0));
18459 /* Get the truncation glyphs. */
18460 truncate_it = *it;
18461 truncate_it.current_x = 0;
18462 truncate_it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18463 truncate_it.glyph_row = &scratch_glyph_row;
18464 truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18465 CHARPOS (truncate_it.position) = BYTEPOS (truncate_it.position) = -1;
18466 truncate_it.object = make_number (0);
18467 produce_special_glyphs (&truncate_it, IT_TRUNCATION);
18469 /* Overwrite glyphs from IT with truncation glyphs. */
18470 if (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18472 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18474 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18475 end = from + tused;
18476 to = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18477 toend = to + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18478 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18480 /* On GUI frames, when variable-size fonts are displayed,
18481 the truncation glyphs may need more pixels than the row's
18482 glyphs they overwrite. We overwrite more glyphs to free
18483 enough screen real estate, and enlarge the stretch glyph
18484 on the right (see display_line), if there is one, to
18485 preserve the screen position of the truncation glyphs on
18486 the right. */
18487 int w = 0;
18488 struct glyph *g = to;
18489 short used;
18491 /* The first glyph could be partially visible, in which case
18492 it->glyph_row->x will be negative. But we want the left
18493 truncation glyphs to be aligned at the left margin of the
18494 window, so we override the x coordinate at which the row
18495 will begin. */
18496 it->glyph_row->x = 0;
18497 while (g < toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18499 w += g->pixel_width;
18500 ++g;
18502 if (g - to - tused > 0)
18504 memmove (to + tused, g, (toend - g) * sizeof(*g));
18505 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] -= g - to - tused;
18507 used = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18508 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18509 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18510 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].type
18511 == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18513 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18515 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].pixel_width += extra;
18519 while (from < end)
18520 *to++ = *from++;
18522 /* There may be padding glyphs left over. Overwrite them too. */
18523 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18525 while (to < toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18527 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18528 while (from < end)
18529 *to++ = *from++;
18533 if (to > toend)
18534 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = to - it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18536 else
18538 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18540 /* In R2L rows, overwrite the last (rightmost) glyphs, and do
18541 that back to front. */
18542 end = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18543 from = end + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18544 toend = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18545 to = toend + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18546 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18548 int w = 0;
18549 struct glyph *g = to;
18551 while (g >= toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18553 w += g->pixel_width;
18554 --g;
18556 if (to - g - tused > 0)
18557 to = g + tused;
18558 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18559 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18560 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18562 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18564 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].pixel_width += extra;
18568 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18569 *to-- = *from--;
18570 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18572 while (to >= toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18574 from =
18575 truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
18576 + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18577 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18578 *to-- = *from--;
18581 if (from >= end)
18583 /* Need to free some room before prepending additional
18584 glyphs. */
18585 int move_by = from - end + 1;
18586 struct glyph *g0 = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18587 struct glyph *g = g0 + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18589 for ( ; g >= g0; g--)
18590 g[move_by] = *g;
18591 while (from >= end)
18592 *to-- = *from--;
18593 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] += move_by;
18598 /* Compute the hash code for ROW. */
18599 unsigned
18600 row_hash (struct glyph_row *row)
18602 int area, k;
18603 unsigned hashval = 0;
18605 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18606 for (k = 0; k < row->used[area]; ++k)
18607 hashval = ((((hashval << 4) + (hashval >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff)
18608 + row->glyphs[area][k].u.val
18609 + row->glyphs[area][k].face_id
18610 + row->glyphs[area][k].padding_p
18611 + (row->glyphs[area][k].type << 2));
18613 return hashval;
18616 /* Compute the pixel height and width of IT->glyph_row.
18618 Most of the time, ascent and height of a display line will be equal
18619 to the max_ascent and max_height values of the display iterator
18620 structure. This is not the case if
18622 1. We hit ZV without displaying anything. In this case, max_ascent
18623 and max_height will be zero.
18625 2. We have some glyphs that don't contribute to the line height.
18626 (The glyph row flag contributes_to_line_height_p is for future
18627 pixmap extensions).
18629 The first case is easily covered by using default values because in
18630 these cases, the line height does not really matter, except that it
18631 must not be zero. */
18633 static void
18634 compute_line_metrics (struct it *it)
18636 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
18638 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18640 int i, min_y, max_y;
18642 /* The line may consist of one space only, that was added to
18643 place the cursor on it. If so, the row's height hasn't been
18644 computed yet. */
18645 if (row->height == 0)
18647 if (it->max_ascent + it->max_descent == 0)
18648 it->max_descent = it->max_phys_descent = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
18649 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
18650 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
18651 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
18652 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
18653 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
18656 /* Compute the width of this line. */
18657 row->pixel_width = row->x;
18658 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ++i)
18659 row->pixel_width += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
18661 eassert (row->pixel_width >= 0);
18662 eassert (row->ascent >= 0 && row->height > 0);
18664 row->overlapping_p = (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row)
18665 || MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row));
18667 /* If first line's physical ascent is larger than its logical
18668 ascent, use the physical ascent, and make the row taller.
18669 This makes accented characters fully visible. */
18670 if (row == MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix)
18671 && row->phys_ascent > row->ascent)
18673 row->height += row->phys_ascent - row->ascent;
18674 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent;
18677 /* Compute how much of the line is visible. */
18678 row->visible_height = row->height;
18680 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (it->w);
18681 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w);
18683 if (row->y < min_y)
18684 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
18685 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
18686 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
18688 else
18690 row->pixel_width = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18691 if (row->continued_p)
18692 row->pixel_width -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
18693 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
18694 row->pixel_width -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
18695 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
18696 row->height = row->phys_height = row->visible_height = 1;
18697 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
18700 /* Compute a hash code for this row. */
18701 row->hash = row_hash (row);
18703 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
18704 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
18708 /* Append one space to the glyph row of iterator IT if doing a
18709 window-based redisplay. The space has the same face as
18710 IT->face_id. Value is non-zero if a space was added.
18712 This function is called to make sure that there is always one glyph
18713 at the end of a glyph row that the cursor can be set on under
18714 window-systems. (If there weren't such a glyph we would not know
18715 how wide and tall a box cursor should be displayed).
18717 At the same time this space let's a nicely handle clearing to the
18718 end of the line if the row ends in italic text. */
18720 static int
18721 append_space_for_newline (struct it *it, int default_face_p)
18723 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18725 int n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18727 if (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n
18728 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
18730 /* Save some values that must not be changed.
18731 Must save IT->c and IT->len because otherwise
18732 ITERATOR_AT_END_P wouldn't work anymore after
18733 append_space_for_newline has been called. */
18734 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18735 int saved_c = it->c, saved_len = it->len;
18736 int saved_char_to_display = it->char_to_display;
18737 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18738 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18739 int saved_box_end = it->end_of_box_run_p;
18740 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18741 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18742 struct face *face;
18744 saved_object = it->object;
18745 saved_pos = it->position;
18747 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18748 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18749 it->object = make_number (0);
18750 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18751 it->len = 1;
18753 /* If the default face was remapped, be sure to use the
18754 remapped face for the appended newline. */
18755 if (default_face_p)
18756 it->face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18757 else if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18758 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
18759 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
18760 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18761 /* In R2L rows, we will prepend a stretch glyph that will
18762 have the end_of_box_run_p flag set for it, so there's no
18763 need for the appended newline glyph to have that flag
18764 set. */
18765 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18766 /* But if the appended newline glyph goes all the way to
18767 the end of the row, there will be no stretch glyph,
18768 so leave the box flag set. */
18769 && saved_x + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f) < it->last_visible_x)
18770 it->end_of_box_run_p = 0;
18772 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18774 it->override_ascent = -1;
18775 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 0;
18776 it->current_x = saved_x;
18777 it->object = saved_object;
18778 it->position = saved_pos;
18779 it->what = saved_what;
18780 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18781 it->len = saved_len;
18782 it->c = saved_c;
18783 it->char_to_display = saved_char_to_display;
18784 it->end_of_box_run_p = saved_box_end;
18785 return 1;
18789 return 0;
18793 /* Extend the face of the last glyph in the text area of IT->glyph_row
18794 to the end of the display line. Called from display_line. If the
18795 glyph row is empty, add a space glyph to it so that we know the
18796 face to draw. Set the glyph row flag fill_line_p. If the glyph
18797 row is R2L, prepend a stretch glyph to cover the empty space to the
18798 left of the leftmost glyph. */
18800 static void
18801 extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *it)
18803 struct face *face, *default_face;
18804 struct frame *f = it->f;
18806 /* If line is already filled, do nothing. Non window-system frames
18807 get a grace of one more ``pixel'' because their characters are
18808 1-``pixel'' wide, so they hit the equality too early. This grace
18809 is needed only for R2L rows that are not continued, to produce
18810 one extra blank where we could display the cursor. */
18811 if (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x
18812 + (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18813 && it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18814 && !it->glyph_row->continued_p))
18815 return;
18817 /* The default face, possibly remapped. */
18818 default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, lookup_basic_face (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
18820 /* Face extension extends the background and box of IT->face_id
18821 to the end of the line. If the background equals the background
18822 of the frame, we don't have to do anything. */
18823 if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18824 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->saved_face_id);
18825 else
18826 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->face_id);
18828 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18829 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (it->glyph_row)
18830 && face->box == FACE_NO_BOX
18831 && face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f)
18832 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18833 && !face->stipple
18834 #endif
18835 && !it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18836 return;
18838 /* Set the glyph row flag indicating that the face of the last glyph
18839 in the text area has to be drawn to the end of the text area. */
18840 it->glyph_row->fill_line_p = 1;
18842 /* If current character of IT is not ASCII, make sure we have the
18843 ASCII face. This will be automatically undone the next time
18844 get_next_display_element returns a multibyte character. Note
18845 that the character will always be single byte in unibyte
18846 text. */
18847 if (!ASCII_CHAR_P (it->c))
18849 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18852 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
18854 /* If the row is empty, add a space with the current face of IT,
18855 so that we know which face to draw. */
18856 if (it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
18858 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0] = space_glyph;
18859 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].face_id = face->id;
18860 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 1;
18862 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18863 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18865 /* Prepend a stretch glyph to the row, such that the
18866 rightmost glyph will be drawn flushed all the way to the
18867 right margin of the window. The stretch glyph that will
18868 occupy the empty space, if any, to the left of the
18869 glyphs. */
18870 struct font *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (f);
18871 struct glyph *row_start = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18872 struct glyph *row_end = row_start + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18873 struct glyph *g;
18874 int row_width, stretch_ascent, stretch_width;
18875 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18876 int saved_face_id, saved_avoid_cursor, saved_box_start;
18878 for (row_width = 0, g = row_start; g < row_end; g++)
18879 row_width += g->pixel_width;
18880 stretch_width = window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) - row_width;
18881 if (stretch_width > 0)
18883 stretch_ascent =
18884 (((it->ascent + it->descent)
18885 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
18886 saved_pos = it->position;
18887 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18888 saved_avoid_cursor = it->avoid_cursor_p;
18889 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
18890 saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18891 saved_box_start = it->start_of_box_run_p;
18892 /* The last row's stretch glyph should get the default
18893 face, to avoid painting the rest of the window with
18894 the region face, if the region ends at ZV. */
18895 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18896 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18897 else
18898 it->face_id = face->id;
18899 it->start_of_box_run_p = 0;
18900 append_stretch_glyph (it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
18901 it->ascent + it->descent, stretch_ascent);
18902 it->position = saved_pos;
18903 it->avoid_cursor_p = saved_avoid_cursor;
18904 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18905 it->start_of_box_run_p = saved_box_start;
18908 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
18910 else
18912 /* Save some values that must not be changed. */
18913 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18914 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18915 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18916 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18917 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18919 saved_object = it->object;
18920 saved_pos = it->position;
18922 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18923 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18924 it->object = make_number (0);
18925 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18926 it->len = 1;
18927 /* The last row's blank glyphs should get the default face, to
18928 avoid painting the rest of the window with the region face,
18929 if the region ends at ZV. */
18930 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18931 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18932 else
18933 it->face_id = face->id;
18935 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18937 while (it->current_x <= it->last_visible_x)
18938 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18940 /* Don't count these blanks really. It would let us insert a left
18941 truncation glyph below and make us set the cursor on them, maybe. */
18942 it->current_x = saved_x;
18943 it->object = saved_object;
18944 it->position = saved_pos;
18945 it->what = saved_what;
18946 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18951 /* Value is non-zero if text starting at CHARPOS in current_buffer is
18952 trailing whitespace. */
18954 static int
18955 trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t charpos)
18957 ptrdiff_t bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
18958 int c = 0;
18960 while (bytepos < ZV_BYTE
18961 && (c = FETCH_CHAR (bytepos),
18962 c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
18963 ++bytepos;
18965 if (bytepos >= ZV_BYTE || c == '\n' || c == '\r')
18967 if (bytepos != PT_BYTE)
18968 return 1;
18970 return 0;
18974 /* Highlight trailing whitespace, if any, in ROW. */
18976 static void
18977 highlight_trailing_whitespace (struct frame *f, struct glyph_row *row)
18979 int used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18981 if (used)
18983 struct glyph *start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18984 struct glyph *glyph = start + used - 1;
18986 if (row->reversed_p)
18988 /* Right-to-left rows need to be processed in the opposite
18989 direction, so swap the edge pointers. */
18990 glyph = start;
18991 start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + used - 1;
18994 /* Skip over glyphs inserted to display the cursor at the
18995 end of a line, for extending the face of the last glyph
18996 to the end of the line on terminals, and for truncation
18997 and continuation glyphs. */
18998 if (!row->reversed_p)
19000 while (glyph >= start
19001 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
19002 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
19003 --glyph;
19005 else
19007 while (glyph <= start
19008 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
19009 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
19010 ++glyph;
19013 /* If last glyph is a space or stretch, and it's trailing
19014 whitespace, set the face of all trailing whitespace glyphs in
19015 IT->glyph_row to `trailing-whitespace'. */
19016 if ((row->reversed_p ? glyph <= start : glyph >= start)
19017 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
19018 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
19019 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
19020 && glyph->u.ch == ' '))
19021 && trailing_whitespace_p (glyph->charpos))
19023 int face_id = lookup_named_face (f, Qtrailing_whitespace, 0);
19024 if (face_id < 0)
19025 return;
19027 if (!row->reversed_p)
19029 while (glyph >= start
19030 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
19031 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
19032 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
19033 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
19034 (glyph--)->face_id = face_id;
19036 else
19038 while (glyph <= start
19039 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
19040 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
19041 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
19042 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
19043 (glyph++)->face_id = face_id;
19050 /* Value is non-zero if glyph row ROW should be
19051 considered to hold the buffer position CHARPOS. */
19053 static int
19054 row_for_charpos_p (struct glyph_row *row, ptrdiff_t charpos)
19056 int result = 1;
19058 if (charpos == CHARPOS (row->end.pos)
19059 || charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
19061 /* Suppose the row ends on a string.
19062 Unless the row is continued, that means it ends on a newline
19063 in the string. If it's anything other than a display string
19064 (e.g., a before-string from an overlay), we don't want the
19065 cursor there. (This heuristic seems to give the optimal
19066 behavior for the various types of multi-line strings.)
19067 One exception: if the string has `cursor' property on one of
19068 its characters, we _do_ want the cursor there. */
19069 if (CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos) >= 0)
19071 if (row->continued_p)
19072 result = 1;
19073 else
19075 /* Check for `display' property. */
19076 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19077 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
19078 struct glyph *glyph;
19080 result = 0;
19081 for (glyph = end; glyph >= beg; --glyph)
19082 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
19084 Lisp_Object prop
19085 = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos),
19086 Qdisplay, Qnil);
19087 result =
19088 (!NILP (prop)
19089 && display_prop_string_p (prop, glyph->object));
19090 /* If there's a `cursor' property on one of the
19091 string's characters, this row is a cursor row,
19092 even though this is not a display string. */
19093 if (!result)
19095 Lisp_Object s = glyph->object;
19097 for ( ; glyph >= beg && EQ (glyph->object, s); --glyph)
19099 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
19101 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
19102 Qcursor, s)))
19104 result = 1;
19105 break;
19109 break;
19113 else if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
19115 /* If the row ends in middle of a real character,
19116 and the line is continued, we want the cursor here.
19117 That's because CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) would equal
19118 PT if PT is before the character. */
19119 if (!row->ends_in_ellipsis_p)
19120 result = row->continued_p;
19121 else
19122 /* If the row ends in an ellipsis, then
19123 CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) will equal point after the
19124 invisible text. We want that position to be displayed
19125 after the ellipsis. */
19126 result = 0;
19128 /* If the row ends at ZV, display the cursor at the end of that
19129 row instead of at the start of the row below. */
19130 else if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
19131 result = 1;
19132 else
19133 result = 0;
19136 return result;
19139 /* Value is non-zero if glyph row ROW should be
19140 used to hold the cursor. */
19142 static int
19143 cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *row)
19145 return row_for_charpos_p (row, PT);
19150 /* Push the property PROP so that it will be rendered at the current
19151 position in IT. Return 1 if PROP was successfully pushed, 0
19152 otherwise. Called from handle_line_prefix to handle the
19153 `line-prefix' and `wrap-prefix' properties. */
19155 static int
19156 push_prefix_prop (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19158 struct text_pos pos =
19159 STRINGP (it->string) ? it->current.string_pos : it->current.pos;
19161 eassert (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
19162 || it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
19163 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING);
19165 /* We need to save the current buffer/string position, so it will be
19166 restored by pop_it, because iterate_out_of_display_property
19167 depends on that being set correctly, but some situations leave
19168 it->position not yet set when this function is called. */
19169 push_it (it, &pos);
19171 if (STRINGP (prop))
19173 if (SCHARS (prop) == 0)
19175 pop_it (it);
19176 return 0;
19179 it->string = prop;
19180 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 1;
19181 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
19182 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
19183 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
19184 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
19185 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
19186 it->stop_charpos = 0;
19187 it->prev_stop = 0;
19188 it->base_level_stop = 0;
19190 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
19191 buffer/string. */
19192 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
19193 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
19194 else
19195 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
19197 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
19198 if (it->bidi_p)
19200 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
19201 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
19202 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
19203 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
19204 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
19205 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
19206 it->bidi_it.w = it->w;
19207 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
19210 else if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qspace))
19212 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
19213 it->object = prop;
19215 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
19216 else if (IMAGEP (prop))
19218 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
19219 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
19220 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
19222 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
19223 else
19225 pop_it (it); /* bogus display property, give up */
19226 return 0;
19229 return 1;
19232 /* Return the character-property PROP at the current position in IT. */
19234 static Lisp_Object
19235 get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19237 Lisp_Object position, object = it->object;
19239 if (STRINGP (object))
19240 position = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
19241 else if (BUFFERP (object))
19243 position = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19244 object = it->window;
19246 else
19247 return Qnil;
19249 return Fget_char_property (position, prop, object);
19252 /* See if there's a line- or wrap-prefix, and if so, push it on IT. */
19254 static void
19255 handle_line_prefix (struct it *it)
19257 Lisp_Object prefix;
19259 if (it->continuation_lines_width > 0)
19261 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qwrap_prefix);
19262 if (NILP (prefix))
19263 prefix = Vwrap_prefix;
19265 else
19267 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qline_prefix);
19268 if (NILP (prefix))
19269 prefix = Vline_prefix;
19271 if (! NILP (prefix) && push_prefix_prop (it, prefix))
19273 /* If the prefix is wider than the window, and we try to wrap
19274 it, it would acquire its own wrap prefix, and so on till the
19275 iterator stack overflows. So, don't wrap the prefix. */
19276 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
19277 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
19283 /* Remove N glyphs at the start of a reversed IT->glyph_row. Called
19284 only for R2L lines from display_line and display_string, when they
19285 decide that too many glyphs were produced by PRODUCE_GLYPHS, and
19286 the line/string needs to be continued on the next glyph row. */
19287 static void
19288 unproduce_glyphs (struct it *it, int n)
19290 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
19292 eassert (it->glyph_row);
19293 eassert (it->glyph_row->reversed_p);
19294 eassert (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
19295 eassert (n <= it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
19297 if (n > it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19298 n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19299 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n;
19300 end = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19301 for ( ; glyph < end; glyph++)
19302 glyph[-n] = *glyph;
19305 /* Find the positions in a bidi-reordered ROW to serve as ROW->minpos
19306 and ROW->maxpos. */
19307 static void
19308 find_row_edges (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row,
19309 ptrdiff_t min_pos, ptrdiff_t min_bpos,
19310 ptrdiff_t max_pos, ptrdiff_t max_bpos)
19312 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19313 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19315 /* ROW->minpos is the value of min_pos, the minimal buffer position
19316 we have in ROW, or ROW->start.pos if that is smaller. */
19317 if (min_pos <= ZV && min_pos < row->start.pos.charpos)
19318 SET_TEXT_POS (row->minpos, min_pos, min_bpos);
19319 else
19320 /* We didn't find buffer positions smaller than ROW->start, or
19321 didn't find _any_ valid buffer positions in any of the glyphs,
19322 so we must trust the iterator's computed positions. */
19323 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19324 if (max_pos <= 0)
19326 max_pos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
19327 max_bpos = BYTEPOS (it->current.pos);
19330 /* Here are the various use-cases for ending the row, and the
19331 corresponding values for ROW->maxpos:
19333 Line ends in a newline from buffer eol_pos + 1
19334 Line is continued from buffer max_pos + 1
19335 Line is truncated on right it->current.pos
19336 Line ends in a newline from string max_pos + 1(*)
19337 (*) + 1 only when line ends in a forward scan
19338 Line is continued from string max_pos
19339 Line is continued from display vector max_pos
19340 Line is entirely from a string min_pos == max_pos
19341 Line is entirely from a display vector min_pos == max_pos
19342 Line that ends at ZV ZV
19344 If you discover other use-cases, please add them here as
19345 appropriate. */
19346 if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
19347 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19348 else if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19350 int seen_this_string = 0;
19351 struct glyph_row *r1 = row - 1;
19353 /* Did we see the same display string on the previous row? */
19354 if (STRINGP (it->object)
19355 /* this is not the first row */
19356 && row > it->w->desired_matrix->rows
19357 /* previous row is not the header line */
19358 && !r1->mode_line_p
19359 /* previous row also ends in a newline from a string */
19360 && r1->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
19362 struct glyph *start, *end;
19364 /* Search for the last glyph of the previous row that came
19365 from buffer or string. Depending on whether the row is
19366 L2R or R2L, we need to process it front to back or the
19367 other way round. */
19368 if (!r1->reversed_p)
19370 start = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19371 end = start + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19372 /* Glyphs inserted by redisplay have an integer (zero)
19373 as their object. */
19374 while (end > start
19375 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
19376 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
19377 --end;
19378 if (end > start)
19380 if (EQ ((end - 1)->object, it->object))
19381 seen_this_string = 1;
19383 else
19384 /* If all the glyphs of the previous row were inserted
19385 by redisplay, it means the previous row was
19386 produced from a single newline, which is only
19387 possible if that newline came from the same string
19388 as the one which produced this ROW. */
19389 seen_this_string = 1;
19391 else
19393 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
19394 start = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19395 while (end < start
19396 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
19397 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
19398 ++end;
19399 if (end < start)
19401 if (EQ ((end + 1)->object, it->object))
19402 seen_this_string = 1;
19404 else
19405 seen_this_string = 1;
19408 /* Take note of each display string that covers a newline only
19409 once, the first time we see it. This is for when a display
19410 string includes more than one newline in it. */
19411 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p && !seen_this_string)
19413 /* If we were scanning the buffer forward when we displayed
19414 the string, we want to account for at least one buffer
19415 position that belongs to this row (position covered by
19416 the display string), so that cursor positioning will
19417 consider this row as a candidate when point is at the end
19418 of the visual line represented by this row. This is not
19419 required when scanning back, because max_pos will already
19420 have a much larger value. */
19421 if (CHARPOS (row->end.pos) > max_pos)
19422 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19423 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19425 else if (CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) > 0)
19426 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos,
19427 CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1, BYTEPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1);
19428 else if (row->continued_p)
19430 /* If max_pos is different from IT's current position, it
19431 means IT->method does not belong to the display element
19432 at max_pos. However, it also means that the display
19433 element at max_pos was displayed in its entirety on this
19434 line, which is equivalent to saying that the next line
19435 starts at the next buffer position. */
19436 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == max_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19437 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19438 else
19440 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19441 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19444 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
19445 /* display_line already called reseat_at_next_visible_line_start,
19446 which puts the iterator at the beginning of the next line, in
19447 the logical order. */
19448 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19449 else if (max_pos == min_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19450 /* A line that is entirely from a string/image/stretch... */
19451 row->maxpos = row->minpos;
19452 else
19453 emacs_abort ();
19455 else
19456 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19459 /* Construct the glyph row IT->glyph_row in the desired matrix of
19460 IT->w from text at the current position of IT. See dispextern.h
19461 for an overview of struct it. Value is non-zero if
19462 IT->glyph_row displays text, as opposed to a line displaying ZV
19463 only. */
19465 static int
19466 display_line (struct it *it)
19468 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
19469 Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string;
19470 struct it wrap_it;
19471 void *wrap_data = NULL;
19472 int may_wrap = 0, wrap_x IF_LINT (= 0);
19473 int wrap_row_used = -1;
19474 int wrap_row_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19475 int wrap_row_phys_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_phys_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19476 int wrap_row_extra_line_spacing IF_LINT (= 0);
19477 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_min_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19478 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_max_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19479 int cvpos;
19480 ptrdiff_t min_pos = ZV + 1, max_pos = 0;
19481 ptrdiff_t min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0), max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19483 /* We always start displaying at hpos zero even if hscrolled. */
19484 eassert (it->hpos == 0 && it->current_x == 0);
19486 if (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, it->w->desired_matrix)
19487 >= it->w->desired_matrix->nrows)
19489 it->w->nrows_scale_factor++;
19490 it->f->fonts_changed = 1;
19491 return 0;
19494 /* Clear the result glyph row and enable it. */
19495 prepare_desired_row (row);
19497 row->y = it->current_y;
19498 row->start = it->start;
19499 row->continuation_lines_width = it->continuation_lines_width;
19500 row->displays_text_p = 1;
19501 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p;
19502 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 0;
19504 /* Arrange the overlays nicely for our purposes. Usually, we call
19505 display_line on only one line at a time, in which case this
19506 can't really hurt too much, or we call it on lines which appear
19507 one after another in the buffer, in which case all calls to
19508 recenter_overlay_lists but the first will be pretty cheap. */
19509 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19511 /* Move over display elements that are not visible because we are
19512 hscrolled. This may stop at an x-position < IT->first_visible_x
19513 if the first glyph is partially visible or if we hit a line end. */
19514 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
19516 enum move_it_result move_result;
19518 this_line_min_pos = row->start.pos;
19519 move_result = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, ZV, it->first_visible_x,
19520 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
19521 /* If we are under a large hscroll, move_it_in_display_line_to
19522 could hit the end of the line without reaching
19523 it->first_visible_x. Pretend that we did reach it. This is
19524 especially important on a TTY, where we will call
19525 extend_face_to_end_of_line, which needs to know how many
19526 blank glyphs to produce. */
19527 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x
19528 && (move_result == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
19529 || move_result == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV))
19530 it->current_x = it->first_visible_x;
19532 /* Record the smallest positions seen while we moved over
19533 display elements that are not visible. This is needed by
19534 redisplay_internal for optimizing the case where the cursor
19535 stays inside the same line. The rest of this function only
19536 considers positions that are actually displayed, so
19537 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS will not otherwise record positions that
19538 are hscrolled to the left of the left edge of the window. */
19539 min_pos = CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19540 min_bpos = BYTEPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19542 else
19544 /* We only do this when not calling `move_it_in_display_line_to'
19545 above, because move_it_in_display_line_to calls
19546 handle_line_prefix itself. */
19547 handle_line_prefix (it);
19550 /* Get the initial row height. This is either the height of the
19551 text hscrolled, if there is any, or zero. */
19552 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
19553 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
19554 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19555 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
19556 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
19558 /* Utility macro to record max and min buffer positions seen until now. */
19559 #define RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS(IT) \
19560 do \
19562 int composition_p = !STRINGP ((IT)->string) \
19563 && ((IT)->what == IT_COMPOSITION); \
19564 ptrdiff_t current_pos = \
19565 composition_p ? (IT)->cmp_it.charpos \
19566 : IT_CHARPOS (*(IT)); \
19567 ptrdiff_t current_bpos = \
19568 composition_p ? CHAR_TO_BYTE (current_pos) \
19569 : IT_BYTEPOS (*(IT)); \
19570 if (current_pos < min_pos) \
19572 min_pos = current_pos; \
19573 min_bpos = current_bpos; \
19575 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > max_pos) \
19577 max_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it); \
19578 max_bpos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it); \
19581 while (0)
19583 /* Loop generating characters. The loop is left with IT on the next
19584 character to display. */
19585 while (1)
19587 int n_glyphs_before, hpos_before, x_before;
19588 int x, nglyphs;
19589 int ascent = 0, descent = 0, phys_ascent = 0, phys_descent = 0;
19591 /* Retrieve the next thing to display. Value is zero if end of
19592 buffer reached. */
19593 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19595 /* Maybe add a space at the end of this line that is used to
19596 display the cursor there under X. Set the charpos of the
19597 first glyph of blank lines not corresponding to any text
19598 to -1. */
19599 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19600 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19601 else if ((append_space_for_newline (it, 1) && row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 1)
19602 || row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
19604 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = -1;
19605 row->displays_text_p = 0;
19607 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (it->w->contents), indicate_empty_lines))
19608 && (!MINI_WINDOW_P (it->w)
19609 || (minibuf_level && EQ (it->window, minibuf_window))))
19610 row->indicate_empty_line_p = 1;
19613 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19614 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19615 /* A row that displays right-to-left text must always have
19616 its last face extended all the way to the end of line,
19617 even if this row ends in ZV, because we still write to
19618 the screen left to right. We also need to extend the
19619 last face if the default face is remapped to some
19620 different face, otherwise the functions that clear
19621 portions of the screen will clear with the default face's
19622 background color. */
19623 if (row->reversed_p
19624 || lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID) != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
19625 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19626 break;
19629 /* Now, get the metrics of what we want to display. This also
19630 generates glyphs in `row' (which is IT->glyph_row). */
19631 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19632 x = it->current_x;
19634 /* Remember the line height so far in case the next element doesn't
19635 fit on the line. */
19636 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
19638 ascent = it->max_ascent;
19639 descent = it->max_descent;
19640 phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19641 phys_descent = it->max_phys_descent;
19643 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
19645 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
19646 may_wrap = 1;
19647 else if (may_wrap)
19649 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
19650 wrap_x = x;
19651 wrap_row_used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19652 wrap_row_ascent = row->ascent;
19653 wrap_row_height = row->height;
19654 wrap_row_phys_ascent = row->phys_ascent;
19655 wrap_row_phys_height = row->phys_height;
19656 wrap_row_extra_line_spacing = row->extra_line_spacing;
19657 wrap_row_min_pos = min_pos;
19658 wrap_row_min_bpos = min_bpos;
19659 wrap_row_max_pos = max_pos;
19660 wrap_row_max_bpos = max_bpos;
19661 may_wrap = 0;
19666 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
19668 /* If this display element was in marginal areas, continue with
19669 the next one. */
19670 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
19672 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19673 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19674 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19675 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19676 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19677 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19678 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19679 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19680 continue;
19683 /* Does the display element fit on the line? If we truncate
19684 lines, we should draw past the right edge of the window. If
19685 we don't truncate, we want to stop so that we can display the
19686 continuation glyph before the right margin. If lines are
19687 continued, there are two possible strategies for characters
19688 resulting in more than 1 glyph (e.g. tabs): Display as many
19689 glyphs as possible in this line and leave the rest for the
19690 continuation line, or display the whole element in the next
19691 line. Original redisplay did the former, so we do it also. */
19692 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
19693 hpos_before = it->hpos;
19694 x_before = x;
19696 if (/* Not a newline. */
19697 nglyphs > 0
19698 /* Glyphs produced fit entirely in the line. */
19699 && it->current_x < it->last_visible_x)
19701 it->hpos += nglyphs;
19702 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19703 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19704 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19705 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19706 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19707 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19708 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19709 if (it->current_x - it->pixel_width < it->first_visible_x)
19710 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19711 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions seen so
19712 far in glyphs that will be displayed by this row. */
19713 if (it->bidi_p)
19714 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19716 else
19718 int i, new_x;
19719 struct glyph *glyph;
19721 for (i = 0; i < nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
19723 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
19724 new_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
19726 if (/* Lines are continued. */
19727 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
19728 && (/* Glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
19729 new_x > it->last_visible_x
19730 /* Or it fits exactly on a window system frame. */
19731 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19732 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19733 && (row->reversed_p
19734 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19735 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
19737 /* End of a continued line. */
19739 if (it->hpos == 0
19740 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19741 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19742 && (row->reversed_p
19743 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19744 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w))))
19746 /* Current glyph is the only one on the line or
19747 fits exactly on the line. We must continue
19748 the line because we can't draw the cursor
19749 after the glyph. */
19750 row->continued_p = 1;
19751 it->current_x = new_x;
19752 it->continuation_lines_width += new_x;
19753 ++it->hpos;
19754 if (i == nglyphs - 1)
19756 /* If line-wrap is on, check if a previous
19757 wrap point was found. */
19758 if (wrap_row_used > 0
19759 /* Even if there is a previous wrap
19760 point, continue the line here as
19761 usual, if (i) the previous character
19762 was a space or tab AND (ii) the
19763 current character is not. */
19764 && (!may_wrap
19765 || IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it)))
19766 goto back_to_wrap;
19768 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer
19769 positions seen so far in glyphs that will be
19770 displayed by this row. */
19771 if (it->bidi_p)
19772 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19773 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19774 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19776 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19778 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19779 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19780 row->continued_p = 0;
19781 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19783 else if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19785 row->continued_p = 0;
19786 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19790 else if (it->bidi_p)
19791 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19793 else if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph)
19794 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19796 /* A padding glyph that doesn't fit on this line.
19797 This means the whole character doesn't fit
19798 on the line. */
19799 if (row->reversed_p)
19800 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19801 - n_glyphs_before);
19802 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
19804 /* Fill the rest of the row with continuation
19805 glyphs like in 20.x. */
19806 while (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19807 < row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
19808 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19810 row->continued_p = 1;
19811 it->current_x = x_before;
19812 it->continuation_lines_width += x_before;
19814 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19815 element not fitting on the line. */
19816 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19817 it->max_descent = descent;
19818 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19819 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19821 else if (wrap_row_used > 0)
19823 back_to_wrap:
19824 if (row->reversed_p)
19825 unproduce_glyphs (it,
19826 row->used[TEXT_AREA] - wrap_row_used);
19827 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
19828 it->continuation_lines_width += wrap_x;
19829 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = wrap_row_used;
19830 row->ascent = wrap_row_ascent;
19831 row->height = wrap_row_height;
19832 row->phys_ascent = wrap_row_phys_ascent;
19833 row->phys_height = wrap_row_phys_height;
19834 row->extra_line_spacing = wrap_row_extra_line_spacing;
19835 min_pos = wrap_row_min_pos;
19836 min_bpos = wrap_row_min_bpos;
19837 max_pos = wrap_row_max_pos;
19838 max_bpos = wrap_row_max_bpos;
19839 row->continued_p = 1;
19840 row->ends_at_zv_p = 0;
19841 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 0;
19842 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19844 /* Make sure that a non-default face is extended
19845 up to the right margin of the window. */
19846 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19848 else if (it->c == '\t' && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19850 /* A TAB that extends past the right edge of the
19851 window. This produces a single glyph on
19852 window system frames. We leave the glyph in
19853 this row and let it fill the row, but don't
19854 consume the TAB. */
19855 if ((row->reversed_p
19856 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19857 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19858 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19859 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
19860 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19861 row->continued_p = 1;
19862 glyph->pixel_width = it->last_visible_x - x;
19863 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19865 else
19867 /* Something other than a TAB that draws past
19868 the right edge of the window. Restore
19869 positions to values before the element. */
19870 if (row->reversed_p)
19871 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19872 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
19873 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
19875 /* Display continuation glyphs. */
19876 it->current_x = x_before;
19877 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19878 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19879 || (row->reversed_p
19880 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19881 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19882 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19883 row->continued_p = 1;
19885 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19887 if (nglyphs > 1 && i > 0)
19889 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19890 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19893 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19894 element not fitting on the line. */
19895 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19896 it->max_descent = descent;
19897 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19898 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19901 break;
19903 else if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
19905 /* Increment number of glyphs actually displayed. */
19906 ++it->hpos;
19908 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions
19909 seen so far in glyphs that will be displayed by
19910 this row. */
19911 if (it->bidi_p)
19912 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19914 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
19915 /* Glyph is partially visible, i.e. row starts at
19916 negative X position. */
19917 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19919 else
19921 /* Glyph is completely off the left margin of the
19922 window. This should not happen because of the
19923 move_it_in_display_line at the start of this
19924 function, unless the text display area of the
19925 window is empty. */
19926 eassert (it->first_visible_x <= it->last_visible_x);
19929 /* Even if this display element produced no glyphs at all,
19930 we want to record its position. */
19931 if (it->bidi_p && nglyphs == 0)
19932 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19934 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19935 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19936 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19937 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19938 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19939 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19940 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19942 /* End of this display line if row is continued. */
19943 if (row->continued_p || row->ends_at_zv_p)
19944 break;
19947 at_end_of_line:
19948 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're also done, after making
19949 sure that a non-default face is extended up to the right
19950 margin of the window. */
19951 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19953 int used_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19955 row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p = STRINGP (it->object);
19957 /* Add a space at the end of the line that is used to
19958 display the cursor there. */
19959 if (!IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19960 append_space_for_newline (it, 0);
19962 /* Extend the face to the end of the line. */
19963 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19965 /* Make sure we have the position. */
19966 if (used_before == 0)
19967 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
19969 /* Record the position of the newline, for use in
19970 find_row_edges. */
19971 it->eol_pos = it->current.pos;
19973 /* Consume the line end. This skips over invisible lines. */
19974 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19975 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19976 break;
19979 /* Proceed with next display element. Note that this skips
19980 over lines invisible because of selective display. */
19981 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19983 /* If we truncate lines, we are done when the last displayed
19984 glyphs reach past the right margin of the window. */
19985 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
19986 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19987 ? (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
19988 : (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)))
19990 /* Maybe add truncation glyphs. */
19991 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19992 || (row->reversed_p
19993 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19994 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19996 int i, n;
19998 if (!row->reversed_p)
20000 for (i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; i > 0; --i)
20001 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
20002 break;
20004 else
20006 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
20007 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
20008 break;
20009 /* Remove any padding glyphs at the front of ROW, to
20010 make room for the truncation glyphs we will be
20011 adding below. The loop below always inserts at
20012 least one truncation glyph, so also remove the
20013 last glyph added to ROW. */
20014 unproduce_glyphs (it, i + 1);
20015 /* Adjust i for the loop below. */
20016 i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (i + 1);
20019 it->current_x = x_before;
20020 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
20022 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i < n; ++i)
20024 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
20025 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
20028 else
20030 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
20031 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
20034 else if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
20036 /* Don't truncate if we can overflow newline into fringe. */
20037 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
20039 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
20040 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
20041 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
20042 break;
20044 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
20046 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
20047 goto at_end_of_line;
20049 it->current_x = x_before;
20052 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
20053 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
20054 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
20055 row->ends_at_zv_p = FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n';
20056 it->hpos = hpos_before;
20057 break;
20061 if (wrap_data)
20062 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
20064 /* If line is not empty and hscrolled, maybe insert truncation glyphs
20065 at the left window margin. */
20066 if (it->first_visible_x
20067 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) != CHARPOS (row->start.pos))
20069 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
20070 || (row->reversed_p
20071 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
20072 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
20073 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
20074 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
20077 /* Remember the position at which this line ends.
20079 BIDI Note: any code that needs MATRIX_ROW_START/END_CHARPOS
20080 cannot be before the call to find_row_edges below, since that is
20081 where these positions are determined. */
20082 row->end = it->current;
20083 if (!it->bidi_p)
20085 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
20086 row->maxpos = row->end.pos;
20088 else
20090 /* ROW->minpos and ROW->maxpos must be the smallest and
20091 `1 + the largest' buffer positions in ROW. But if ROW was
20092 bidi-reordered, these two positions can be anywhere in the
20093 row, so we must determine them now. */
20094 find_row_edges (it, row, min_pos, min_bpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
20097 /* If the start of this line is the overlay arrow-position, then
20098 mark this glyph row as the one containing the overlay arrow.
20099 This is clearly a mess with variable size fonts. It would be
20100 better to let it be displayed like cursors under X. */
20101 if ((MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row) || !overlay_arrow_seen)
20102 && (overlay_arrow_string = overlay_arrow_at_row (it, row),
20103 !NILP (overlay_arrow_string)))
20105 /* Overlay arrow in window redisplay is a fringe bitmap. */
20106 if (STRINGP (overlay_arrow_string))
20108 struct glyph_row *arrow_row
20109 = get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (it->w, overlay_arrow_string);
20110 struct glyph *glyph = arrow_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
20111 struct glyph *arrow_end = glyph + arrow_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20112 struct glyph *p = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
20113 struct glyph *p2, *end;
20115 /* Copy the arrow glyphs. */
20116 while (glyph < arrow_end)
20117 *p++ = *glyph++;
20119 /* Throw away padding glyphs. */
20120 p2 = p;
20121 end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20122 while (p2 < end && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*p2))
20123 ++p2;
20124 if (p2 > p)
20126 while (p2 < end)
20127 *p++ = *p2++;
20128 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = p2 - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
20131 else
20133 eassert (INTEGERP (overlay_arrow_string));
20134 row->overlay_arrow_bitmap = XINT (overlay_arrow_string);
20136 overlay_arrow_seen = 1;
20139 /* Highlight trailing whitespace. */
20140 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
20141 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it->f, it->glyph_row);
20143 /* Compute pixel dimensions of this line. */
20144 compute_line_metrics (it);
20146 /* Implementation note: No changes in the glyphs of ROW or in their
20147 faces can be done past this point, because compute_line_metrics
20148 computes ROW's hash value and stores it within the glyph_row
20149 structure. */
20151 /* Record whether this row ends inside an ellipsis. */
20152 row->ends_in_ellipsis_p
20153 = (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
20154 && it->ellipsis_p);
20156 /* Save fringe bitmaps in this row. */
20157 row->left_user_fringe_bitmap = it->left_user_fringe_bitmap;
20158 row->left_user_fringe_face_id = it->left_user_fringe_face_id;
20159 row->right_user_fringe_bitmap = it->right_user_fringe_bitmap;
20160 row->right_user_fringe_face_id = it->right_user_fringe_face_id;
20162 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
20163 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
20164 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
20165 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
20167 /* Maybe set the cursor. */
20168 cvpos = it->w->cursor.vpos;
20169 if ((cvpos < 0
20170 /* In bidi-reordered rows, keep checking for proper cursor
20171 position even if one has been found already, because buffer
20172 positions in such rows change non-linearly with ROW->VPOS,
20173 when a line is continued. One exception: when we are at ZV,
20174 display cursor on the first suitable glyph row, since all
20175 the empty rows after that also have their position set to ZV. */
20176 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
20177 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
20178 || (it->bidi_p
20179 && !MATRIX_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, cvpos)->ends_at_zv_p))
20180 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
20181 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
20182 && cursor_row_p (row))
20183 set_cursor_from_row (it->w, row, it->w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
20185 /* Prepare for the next line. This line starts horizontally at (X
20186 HPOS) = (0 0). Vertical positions are incremented. As a
20187 convenience for the caller, IT->glyph_row is set to the next
20188 row to be used. */
20189 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
20190 it->current_y += row->height;
20191 SET_TEXT_POS (it->eol_pos, 0, 0);
20192 ++it->vpos;
20193 ++it->glyph_row;
20194 /* The next row should by default use the same value of the
20195 reversed_p flag as this one. set_iterator_to_next decides when
20196 it's a new paragraph, and PRODUCE_GLYPHS recomputes the value of
20197 the flag accordingly. */
20198 if (it->glyph_row < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, it->w))
20199 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = row->reversed_p;
20200 it->start = row->end;
20201 return MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row);
20203 #undef RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS
20206 DEFUN ("current-bidi-paragraph-direction", Fcurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction,
20207 Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction, 0, 1, 0,
20208 doc: /* Return paragraph direction at point in BUFFER.
20209 Value is either `left-to-right' or `right-to-left'.
20210 If BUFFER is omitted or nil, it defaults to the current buffer.
20212 Paragraph direction determines how the text in the paragraph is displayed.
20213 In left-to-right paragraphs, text begins at the left margin of the window
20214 and the reading direction is generally left to right. In right-to-left
20215 paragraphs, text begins at the right margin and is read from right to left.
20217 See also `bidi-paragraph-direction'. */)
20218 (Lisp_Object buffer)
20220 struct buffer *buf = current_buffer;
20221 struct buffer *old = buf;
20223 if (! NILP (buffer))
20225 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
20226 buf = XBUFFER (buffer);
20229 if (NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_display_reordering))
20230 || NILP (BVAR (buf, enable_multibyte_characters))
20231 /* When we are loading loadup.el, the character property tables
20232 needed for bidi iteration are not yet available. */
20233 || !NILP (Vpurify_flag))
20234 return Qleft_to_right;
20235 else if (!NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction)))
20236 return BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction);
20237 else
20239 /* Determine the direction from buffer text. We could try to
20240 use current_matrix if it is up to date, but this seems fast
20241 enough as it is. */
20242 struct bidi_it itb;
20243 ptrdiff_t pos = BUF_PT (buf);
20244 ptrdiff_t bytepos = BUF_PT_BYTE (buf);
20245 int c;
20246 void *itb_data = bidi_shelve_cache ();
20248 set_buffer_temp (buf);
20249 /* bidi_paragraph_init finds the base direction of the paragraph
20250 by searching forward from paragraph start. We need the base
20251 direction of the current or _previous_ paragraph, so we need
20252 to make sure we are within that paragraph. To that end, find
20253 the previous non-empty line. */
20254 if (pos >= ZV && pos > BEGV)
20255 DEC_BOTH (pos, bytepos);
20256 if (fast_looking_at (build_string ("[\f\t ]*\n"),
20257 pos, bytepos, ZV, ZV_BYTE, Qnil) > 0)
20259 while ((c = FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)) == '\n'
20260 || c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\f')
20262 if (bytepos <= BEGV_BYTE)
20263 break;
20264 bytepos--;
20265 pos--;
20267 while (!CHAR_HEAD_P (FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)))
20268 bytepos--;
20270 bidi_init_it (pos, bytepos, FRAME_WINDOW_P (SELECTED_FRAME ()), &itb);
20271 itb.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
20272 itb.string.s = NULL;
20273 itb.string.lstring = Qnil;
20274 itb.string.bufpos = 0;
20275 itb.string.unibyte = 0;
20276 /* We have no window to use here for ignoring window-specific
20277 overlays. Using NULL for window pointer will cause
20278 compute_display_string_pos to use the current buffer. */
20279 itb.w = NULL;
20280 bidi_paragraph_init (NEUTRAL_DIR, &itb, 1);
20281 bidi_unshelve_cache (itb_data, 0);
20282 set_buffer_temp (old);
20283 switch (itb.paragraph_dir)
20285 case L2R:
20286 return Qleft_to_right;
20287 break;
20288 case R2L:
20289 return Qright_to_left;
20290 break;
20291 default:
20292 emacs_abort ();
20297 DEFUN ("move-point-visually", Fmove_point_visually,
20298 Smove_point_visually, 1, 1, 0,
20299 doc: /* Move point in the visual order in the specified DIRECTION.
20300 DIRECTION can be 1, meaning move to the right, or -1, which moves to the
20301 left.
20303 Value is the new character position of point. */)
20304 (Lisp_Object direction)
20306 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
20307 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->contents);
20308 struct glyph_row *row;
20309 int dir;
20310 Lisp_Object paragraph_dir;
20312 #define ROW_GLYPH_NEWLINE_P(ROW,GLYPH) \
20313 (!(ROW)->continued_p \
20314 && INTEGERP ((GLYPH)->object) \
20315 && (GLYPH)->type == CHAR_GLYPH \
20316 && (GLYPH)->u.ch == ' ' \
20317 && (GLYPH)->charpos >= 0 \
20318 && !(GLYPH)->avoid_cursor_p)
20320 CHECK_NUMBER (direction);
20321 dir = XINT (direction);
20322 if (dir > 0)
20323 dir = 1;
20324 else
20325 dir = -1;
20327 /* If current matrix is up-to-date, we can use the information
20328 recorded in the glyphs, at least as long as the goal is on the
20329 screen. */
20330 if (w->window_end_valid
20331 && !windows_or_buffers_changed
20332 && b
20333 && !b->clip_changed
20334 && !b->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
20335 && !window_outdated (w)
20336 && w->cursor.vpos >= 0
20337 && w->cursor.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows
20338 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos))->enabled_p)
20340 struct glyph *g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
20341 struct glyph *e = dir > 0 ? g + row->used[TEXT_AREA] : g - 1;
20342 struct glyph *gpt = g + w->cursor.hpos;
20344 for (g = gpt + dir; (dir > 0 ? g < e : g > e); g += dir)
20346 if (BUFFERP (g->object) && g->charpos != PT)
20348 SET_PT (g->charpos);
20349 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
20350 return make_number (PT);
20352 else if (!INTEGERP (g->object) && !EQ (g->object, gpt->object))
20354 ptrdiff_t new_pos;
20356 if (BUFFERP (gpt->object))
20358 new_pos = PT;
20359 if ((gpt->resolved_level - row->reversed_p) % 2 == 0)
20360 new_pos += (row->reversed_p ? -dir : dir);
20361 else
20362 new_pos -= (row->reversed_p ? -dir : dir);;
20364 else if (BUFFERP (g->object))
20365 new_pos = g->charpos;
20366 else
20367 break;
20368 SET_PT (new_pos);
20369 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
20370 return make_number (PT);
20372 else if (ROW_GLYPH_NEWLINE_P (row, g))
20374 /* Glyphs inserted at the end of a non-empty line for
20375 positioning the cursor have zero charpos, so we must
20376 deduce the value of point by other means. */
20377 if (g->charpos > 0)
20378 SET_PT (g->charpos);
20379 else if (row->ends_at_zv_p && PT != ZV)
20380 SET_PT (ZV);
20381 else if (PT != MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1)
20382 SET_PT (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1);
20383 else
20384 break;
20385 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
20386 return make_number (PT);
20389 if (g == e || INTEGERP (g->object))
20391 if (row->truncated_on_left_p || row->truncated_on_right_p)
20392 goto simulate_display;
20393 if (!row->reversed_p)
20394 row += dir;
20395 else
20396 row -= dir;
20397 if (row < MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix)
20398 || row > MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w))
20399 goto simulate_display;
20401 if (dir > 0)
20403 if (row->reversed_p && !row->continued_p)
20405 SET_PT (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1);
20406 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
20407 return make_number (PT);
20409 g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
20410 e = g + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20411 for ( ; g < e; g++)
20413 if (BUFFERP (g->object)
20414 /* Empty lines have only one glyph, which stands
20415 for the newline, and whose charpos is the
20416 buffer position of the newline. */
20417 || ROW_GLYPH_NEWLINE_P (row, g)
20418 /* When the buffer ends in a newline, the line at
20419 EOB also has one glyph, but its charpos is -1. */
20420 || (row->ends_at_zv_p
20421 && !row->reversed_p
20422 && INTEGERP (g->object)
20423 && g->type == CHAR_GLYPH
20424 && g->u.ch == ' '))
20426 if (g->charpos > 0)
20427 SET_PT (g->charpos);
20428 else if (!row->reversed_p
20429 && row->ends_at_zv_p
20430 && PT != ZV)
20431 SET_PT (ZV);
20432 else
20433 continue;
20434 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
20435 return make_number (PT);
20439 else
20441 if (!row->reversed_p && !row->continued_p)
20443 SET_PT (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1);
20444 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
20445 return make_number (PT);
20447 e = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
20448 g = e + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
20449 for ( ; g >= e; g--)
20451 if (BUFFERP (g->object)
20452 || (ROW_GLYPH_NEWLINE_P (row, g)
20453 && g->charpos > 0)
20454 /* Empty R2L lines on GUI frames have the buffer
20455 position of the newline stored in the stretch
20456 glyph. */
20457 || g->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
20458 || (row->ends_at_zv_p
20459 && row->reversed_p
20460 && INTEGERP (g->object)
20461 && g->type == CHAR_GLYPH
20462 && g->u.ch == ' '))
20464 if (g->charpos > 0)
20465 SET_PT (g->charpos);
20466 else if (row->reversed_p
20467 && row->ends_at_zv_p
20468 && PT != ZV)
20469 SET_PT (ZV);
20470 else
20471 continue;
20472 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
20473 return make_number (PT);
20480 simulate_display:
20482 /* If we wind up here, we failed to move by using the glyphs, so we
20483 need to simulate display instead. */
20485 if (b)
20486 paragraph_dir = Fcurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction (w->contents);
20487 else
20488 paragraph_dir = Qleft_to_right;
20489 if (EQ (paragraph_dir, Qright_to_left))
20490 dir = -dir;
20491 if (PT <= BEGV && dir < 0)
20492 xsignal0 (Qbeginning_of_buffer);
20493 else if (PT >= ZV && dir > 0)
20494 xsignal0 (Qend_of_buffer);
20495 else
20497 struct text_pos pt;
20498 struct it it;
20499 int pt_x, target_x, pixel_width, pt_vpos;
20500 bool at_eol_p;
20501 bool overshoot_expected = false;
20502 bool target_is_eol_p = false;
20504 /* Setup the arena. */
20505 SET_TEXT_POS (pt, PT, PT_BYTE);
20506 start_display (&it, w, pt);
20508 if ((it.cmp_it.id < 0
20509 && it.method == GET_FROM_STRING
20510 && it.area == TEXT_AREA
20511 && it.string_from_display_prop_p
20512 && (it.sp > 0 && it.stack[it.sp - 1].method == GET_FROM_BUFFER))
20513 || it.method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
20514 overshoot_expected = true;
20516 /* Find the X coordinate of point. We start from the beginning
20517 of this or previous line to make sure we are before point in
20518 the logical order (since the move_it_* functions can only
20519 move forward). */
20520 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
20521 it.current_x = it.hpos = it.current_y = it.vpos = 0;
20522 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) != PT)
20523 move_it_to (&it, overshoot_expected ? PT - 1 : PT,
20524 -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
20525 pt_x = it.current_x;
20526 pt_vpos = it.vpos;
20527 if (dir > 0 || overshoot_expected)
20529 struct glyph_row *row = it.glyph_row;
20531 /* When point is at beginning of line, we don't have
20532 information about the glyph there loaded into struct
20533 it. Calling get_next_display_element fixes that. */
20534 if (pt_x == 0)
20535 get_next_display_element (&it);
20536 at_eol_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it);
20537 it.glyph_row = NULL;
20538 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it); /* compute it.pixel_width */
20539 it.glyph_row = row;
20540 /* PRODUCE_GLYPHS advances it.current_x, so we must restore
20541 it, lest it will become out of sync with it's buffer
20542 position. */
20543 it.current_x = pt_x;
20545 else
20546 at_eol_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it);
20547 pixel_width = it.pixel_width;
20548 if (overshoot_expected && at_eol_p)
20549 pixel_width = 0;
20550 else if (pixel_width <= 0)
20551 pixel_width = 1;
20553 /* If there's a display string at point, we are actually at the
20554 glyph to the left of point, so we need to correct the X
20555 coordinate. */
20556 if (overshoot_expected)
20558 if (it.bidi_p)
20559 pt_x += pixel_width * it.bidi_it.scan_dir;
20560 else
20561 pt_x += pixel_width;
20564 /* Compute target X coordinate, either to the left or to the
20565 right of point. On TTY frames, all characters have the same
20566 pixel width of 1, so we can use that. On GUI frames we don't
20567 have an easy way of getting at the pixel width of the
20568 character to the left of point, so we use a different method
20569 of getting to that place. */
20570 if (dir > 0)
20571 target_x = pt_x + pixel_width;
20572 else
20573 target_x = pt_x - (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it.f)) * pixel_width;
20575 /* Target X coordinate could be one line above or below the line
20576 of point, in which case we need to adjust the target X
20577 coordinate. Also, if moving to the left, we need to begin at
20578 the left edge of the point's screen line. */
20579 if (dir < 0)
20581 if (pt_x > 0)
20583 start_display (&it, w, pt);
20584 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
20585 it.current_x = it.current_y = it.hpos = 0;
20586 if (pt_vpos != 0)
20587 move_it_by_lines (&it, pt_vpos);
20589 else
20591 move_it_by_lines (&it, -1);
20592 target_x = it.last_visible_x - !FRAME_WINDOW_P (it.f);
20593 target_is_eol_p = true;
20596 else
20598 if (at_eol_p
20599 || (target_x >= it.last_visible_x
20600 && it.line_wrap != TRUNCATE))
20602 if (pt_x > 0)
20603 move_it_by_lines (&it, 0);
20604 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
20605 target_x = 0;
20609 /* Move to the target X coordinate. */
20610 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
20611 /* On GUI frames, as we don't know the X coordinate of the
20612 character to the left of point, moving point to the left
20613 requires walking, one grapheme cluster at a time, until we
20614 find ourself at a place immediately to the left of the
20615 character at point. */
20616 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it.f) && dir < 0)
20618 struct text_pos new_pos = it.current.pos;
20619 enum move_it_result rc = MOVE_X_REACHED;
20621 while (it.current_x + it.pixel_width <= target_x
20622 && rc == MOVE_X_REACHED)
20624 int new_x = it.current_x + it.pixel_width;
20626 new_pos = it.current.pos;
20627 if (new_x == it.current_x)
20628 new_x++;
20629 rc = move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, ZV, new_x,
20630 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
20631 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it) && !target_is_eol_p)
20632 break;
20634 /* If we ended up on a composed character inside
20635 bidi-reordered text (e.g., Hebrew text with diacritics),
20636 the iterator gives us the buffer position of the last (in
20637 logical order) character of the composed grapheme cluster,
20638 which is not what we want. So we cheat: we compute the
20639 character position of the character that follows (in the
20640 logical order) the one where the above loop stopped. That
20641 character will appear on display to the left of point. */
20642 if (it.bidi_p
20643 && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
20644 && new_pos.charpos - IT_CHARPOS (it) > 1)
20646 new_pos.charpos = IT_CHARPOS (it) + 1;
20647 new_pos.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (new_pos.charpos);
20649 it.current.pos = new_pos;
20651 else
20652 #endif
20653 if (it.current_x != target_x)
20654 move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, ZV, target_x, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
20656 /* When lines are truncated, the above loop will stop at the
20657 window edge. But we want to get to the end of line, even if
20658 it is beyond the window edge; automatic hscroll will then
20659 scroll the window to show point as appropriate. */
20660 if (target_is_eol_p && it.line_wrap == TRUNCATE
20661 && get_next_display_element (&it))
20663 struct text_pos new_pos = it.current.pos;
20665 while (!ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it))
20667 set_iterator_to_next (&it, 0);
20668 if (it.method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
20669 new_pos = it.current.pos;
20670 if (!get_next_display_element (&it))
20671 break;
20674 it.current.pos = new_pos;
20677 /* If we ended up in a display string that covers point, move to
20678 buffer position to the right in the visual order. */
20679 if (dir > 0)
20681 while (IT_CHARPOS (it) == PT)
20683 set_iterator_to_next (&it, 0);
20684 if (!get_next_display_element (&it))
20685 break;
20689 /* Move point to that position. */
20690 SET_PT_BOTH (IT_CHARPOS (it), IT_BYTEPOS (it));
20693 return make_number (PT);
20695 #undef ROW_GLYPH_NEWLINE_P
20699 /***********************************************************************
20700 Menu Bar
20701 ***********************************************************************/
20703 /* Redisplay the menu bar in the frame for window W.
20705 The menu bar of X frames that don't have X toolkit support is
20706 displayed in a special window W->frame->menu_bar_window.
20708 The menu bar of terminal frames is treated specially as far as
20709 glyph matrices are concerned. Menu bar lines are not part of
20710 windows, so the update is done directly on the frame matrix rows
20711 for the menu bar. */
20713 static void
20714 display_menu_bar (struct window *w)
20716 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
20717 struct it it;
20718 Lisp_Object items;
20719 int i;
20721 /* Don't do all this for graphical frames. */
20722 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
20723 if (FRAME_W32_P (f))
20724 return;
20725 #endif
20726 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
20727 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
20728 return;
20729 #endif
20731 #ifdef HAVE_NS
20732 if (FRAME_NS_P (f))
20733 return;
20734 #endif /* HAVE_NS */
20736 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
20737 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
20738 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows, MENU_FACE_ID);
20739 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20740 /* PXW: Use FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) here? */
20741 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20742 #elif defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) /* X without toolkit. */
20743 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
20745 /* Menu bar lines are displayed in the desired matrix of the
20746 dummy window menu_bar_window. */
20747 struct window *menu_w;
20748 menu_w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
20749 init_iterator (&it, menu_w, -1, -1, menu_w->desired_matrix->rows,
20750 MENU_FACE_ID);
20751 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20752 /* PXW: Use FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) here? */
20753 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20755 else
20756 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT and not USE_GTK */
20758 /* This is a TTY frame, i.e. character hpos/vpos are used as
20759 pixel x/y. */
20760 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows,
20761 MENU_FACE_ID);
20762 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20763 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_COLS (f);
20766 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. See the
20767 comments in redisplay_tool_bar and display_mode_line about
20768 this. */
20769 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20771 /* Clear all rows of the menu bar. */
20772 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f); ++i)
20774 struct glyph_row *row = it.glyph_row + i;
20775 clear_glyph_row (row);
20776 row->enabled_p = true;
20777 row->full_width_p = 1;
20780 /* Display all items of the menu bar. */
20781 items = FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (it.f);
20782 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (items); i += 4)
20784 Lisp_Object string;
20786 /* Stop at nil string. */
20787 string = AREF (items, i + 1);
20788 if (NILP (string))
20789 break;
20791 /* Remember where item was displayed. */
20792 ASET (items, i + 3, make_number (it.hpos));
20794 /* Display the item, pad with one space. */
20795 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20796 display_string (NULL, string, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
20797 SCHARS (string) + 1, 0, 0, -1);
20800 /* Fill out the line with spaces. */
20801 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20802 display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, -1, 0, 0, -1);
20804 /* Compute the total height of the lines. */
20805 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20808 /* Deep copy of a glyph row, including the glyphs. */
20809 static void
20810 deep_copy_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *to, struct glyph_row *from)
20812 struct glyph *pointers[1 + LAST_AREA];
20813 int to_used = to->used[TEXT_AREA];
20815 /* Save glyph pointers of TO. */
20816 memcpy (pointers, to->glyphs, sizeof to->glyphs);
20818 /* Do a structure assignment. */
20819 *to = *from;
20821 /* Restore original glyph pointers of TO. */
20822 memcpy (to->glyphs, pointers, sizeof to->glyphs);
20824 /* Copy the glyphs. */
20825 memcpy (to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
20826 min (from->used[TEXT_AREA], to_used) * sizeof (struct glyph));
20828 /* If we filled only part of the TO row, fill the rest with
20829 space_glyph (which will display as empty space). */
20830 if (to_used > from->used[TEXT_AREA])
20831 fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces (to, to_used);
20834 /* Display one menu item on a TTY, by overwriting the glyphs in the
20835 frame F's desired glyph matrix with glyphs produced from the menu
20836 item text. Called from term.c to display TTY drop-down menus one
20837 item at a time.
20839 ITEM_TEXT is the menu item text as a C string.
20841 FACE_ID is the face ID to be used for this menu item. FACE_ID
20842 could specify one of 3 faces: a face for an enabled item, a face
20843 for a disabled item, or a face for a selected item.
20845 X and Y are coordinates of the first glyph in the frame's desired
20846 matrix to be overwritten by the menu item. Since this is a TTY, Y
20847 is the zero-based number of the glyph row and X is the zero-based
20848 glyph number in the row, starting from left, where to start
20849 displaying the item.
20851 SUBMENU non-zero means this menu item drops down a submenu, which
20852 should be indicated by displaying a proper visual cue after the
20853 item text. */
20855 void
20856 display_tty_menu_item (const char *item_text, int width, int face_id,
20857 int x, int y, int submenu)
20859 struct it it;
20860 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
20861 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
20862 int saved_used, saved_truncated, saved_width, saved_reversed;
20863 struct glyph_row *row;
20864 size_t item_len = strlen (item_text);
20866 eassert (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f));
20868 /* Don't write beyond the matrix's last row. This can happen for
20869 TTY screens that are not high enough to show the entire menu.
20870 (This is actually a bit of defensive programming, as
20871 tty_menu_display already limits the number of menu items to one
20872 less than the number of screen lines.) */
20873 if (y >= f->desired_matrix->nrows)
20874 return;
20876 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows + y, MENU_FACE_ID);
20877 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20878 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_COLS (f) - 1;
20879 row = it.glyph_row;
20880 /* Start with the row contents from the current matrix. */
20881 deep_copy_glyph_row (row, f->current_matrix->rows + y);
20882 saved_width = row->full_width_p;
20883 row->full_width_p = 1;
20884 saved_reversed = row->reversed_p;
20885 row->reversed_p = 0;
20886 row->enabled_p = true;
20888 /* Arrange for the menu item glyphs to start at (X,Y) and have the
20889 desired face. */
20890 eassert (x < f->desired_matrix->matrix_w);
20891 it.current_x = it.hpos = x;
20892 it.current_y = it.vpos = y;
20893 saved_used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20894 saved_truncated = row->truncated_on_right_p;
20895 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = x;
20896 it.face_id = face_id;
20897 it.line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
20899 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. See the
20900 comments in redisplay_tool_bar and display_mode_line about this.
20901 Also, if paragraph_embedding could ever be R2L, changes will be
20902 needed to avoid shifting to the right the row characters in
20903 term.c:append_glyph. */
20904 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20906 /* Pad with a space on the left. */
20907 display_string (" ", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, 1, 0, FRAME_COLS (f) - 1, -1);
20908 width--;
20909 /* Display the menu item, pad with spaces to WIDTH. */
20910 if (submenu)
20912 display_string (item_text, Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
20913 item_len, 0, FRAME_COLS (f) - 1, -1);
20914 width -= item_len;
20915 /* Indicate with " >" that there's a submenu. */
20916 display_string (" >", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, width, 0,
20917 FRAME_COLS (f) - 1, -1);
20919 else
20920 display_string (item_text, Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
20921 width, 0, FRAME_COLS (f) - 1, -1);
20923 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = max (saved_used, row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
20924 row->truncated_on_right_p = saved_truncated;
20925 row->hash = row_hash (row);
20926 row->full_width_p = saved_width;
20927 row->reversed_p = saved_reversed;
20930 /***********************************************************************
20931 Mode Line
20932 ***********************************************************************/
20934 /* Redisplay mode lines in the window tree whose root is WINDOW. If
20935 FORCE is non-zero, redisplay mode lines unconditionally.
20936 Otherwise, redisplay only mode lines that are garbaged. Value is
20937 the number of windows whose mode lines were redisplayed. */
20939 static int
20940 redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object window, bool force)
20942 int nwindows = 0;
20944 while (!NILP (window))
20946 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
20948 if (WINDOWP (w->contents))
20949 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->contents, force);
20950 else if (force
20951 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
20952 || !MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->enabled_p)
20954 struct text_pos lpoint;
20955 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
20957 /* Set the window's buffer for the mode line display. */
20958 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
20959 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->contents));
20961 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any
20962 other window, set up appropriate value. */
20963 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
20965 struct text_pos pt;
20967 CLIP_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (pt, w->pointm);
20968 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (pt), BYTEPOS (pt));
20971 /* Display mode lines. */
20972 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
20973 if (display_mode_lines (w))
20974 ++nwindows;
20976 /* Restore old settings. */
20977 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
20978 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
20981 window = w->next;
20984 return nwindows;
20988 /* Display the mode and/or header line of window W. Value is the
20989 sum number of mode lines and header lines displayed. */
20991 static int
20992 display_mode_lines (struct window *w)
20994 Lisp_Object old_selected_window = selected_window;
20995 Lisp_Object old_selected_frame = selected_frame;
20996 Lisp_Object new_frame = w->frame;
20997 Lisp_Object old_frame_selected_window = XFRAME (new_frame)->selected_window;
20998 int n = 0;
21000 selected_frame = new_frame;
21001 /* FIXME: If we were to allow the mode-line's computation changing the buffer
21002 or window's point, then we'd need select_window_1 here as well. */
21003 XSETWINDOW (selected_window, w);
21004 XFRAME (new_frame)->selected_window = selected_window;
21006 /* These will be set while the mode line specs are processed. */
21007 line_number_displayed = 0;
21008 w->column_number_displayed = -1;
21010 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
21012 struct window *sel_w = XWINDOW (old_selected_window);
21014 /* Select mode line face based on the real selected window. */
21015 display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID_3 (sel_w, sel_w, w),
21016 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
21017 ++n;
21020 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
21022 display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
21023 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
21024 ++n;
21027 XFRAME (new_frame)->selected_window = old_frame_selected_window;
21028 selected_frame = old_selected_frame;
21029 selected_window = old_selected_window;
21030 if (n > 0)
21031 w->must_be_updated_p = true;
21032 return n;
21036 /* Display mode or header line of window W. FACE_ID specifies which
21037 line to display; it is either MODE_LINE_FACE_ID or
21038 HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID. FORMAT is the mode/header line format to
21039 display. Value is the pixel height of the mode/header line
21040 displayed. */
21042 static int
21043 display_mode_line (struct window *w, enum face_id face_id, Lisp_Object format)
21045 struct it it;
21046 struct face *face;
21047 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
21049 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
21050 /* Don't extend on a previously drawn mode-line.
21051 This may happen if called from pos_visible_p. */
21052 it.glyph_row->enabled_p = false;
21053 prepare_desired_row (it.glyph_row);
21055 it.glyph_row->mode_line_p = 1;
21057 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But
21058 supporting such an option is not trivial, since the mode line is
21059 made up of many separate strings. */
21060 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
21062 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
21063 format_mode_line_unwind_data (NULL, NULL, Qnil, 0));
21065 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
21067 /* Temporarily make frame's keyboard the current kboard so that
21068 kboard-local variables in the mode_line_format will get the right
21069 values. */
21070 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
21071 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
21072 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
21073 pop_kboard ();
21075 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21077 /* Fill up with spaces. */
21078 display_string (" ", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, 10000, -1, -1, 0);
21080 compute_line_metrics (&it);
21081 it.glyph_row->full_width_p = 1;
21082 it.glyph_row->continued_p = 0;
21083 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
21084 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
21086 /* Make a 3D mode-line have a shadow at its right end. */
21087 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it.f, face_id);
21088 extend_face_to_end_of_line (&it);
21089 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
21091 struct glyph *last = (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
21092 + it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1);
21093 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
21096 return it.glyph_row->height;
21099 /* Move element ELT in LIST to the front of LIST.
21100 Return the updated list. */
21102 static Lisp_Object
21103 move_elt_to_front (Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object list)
21105 register Lisp_Object tail, prev;
21106 register Lisp_Object tem;
21108 tail = list;
21109 prev = Qnil;
21110 while (CONSP (tail))
21112 tem = XCAR (tail);
21114 if (EQ (elt, tem))
21116 /* Splice out the link TAIL. */
21117 if (NILP (prev))
21118 list = XCDR (tail);
21119 else
21120 Fsetcdr (prev, XCDR (tail));
21122 /* Now make it the first. */
21123 Fsetcdr (tail, list);
21124 return tail;
21126 else
21127 prev = tail;
21128 tail = XCDR (tail);
21129 QUIT;
21132 /* Not found--return unchanged LIST. */
21133 return list;
21136 /* Contribute ELT to the mode line for window IT->w. How it
21137 translates into text depends on its data type.
21139 IT describes the display environment in which we display, as usual.
21141 DEPTH is the depth in recursion. It is used to prevent
21142 infinite recursion here.
21144 FIELD_WIDTH is the number of characters the display of ELT should
21145 occupy in the mode line, and PRECISION is the maximum number of
21146 characters to display from ELT's representation. See
21147 display_string for details.
21149 Returns the hpos of the end of the text generated by ELT.
21151 PROPS is a property list to add to any string we encounter.
21153 If RISKY is nonzero, remove (disregard) any properties in any string
21154 we encounter, and ignore :eval and :propertize.
21156 The global variable `mode_line_target' determines whether the
21157 output is passed to `store_mode_line_noprop',
21158 `store_mode_line_string', or `display_string'. */
21160 static int
21161 display_mode_element (struct it *it, int depth, int field_width, int precision,
21162 Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object props, int risky)
21164 int n = 0, field, prec;
21165 int literal = 0;
21167 tail_recurse:
21168 if (depth > 100)
21169 elt = build_string ("*too-deep*");
21171 depth++;
21173 switch (XTYPE (elt))
21175 case Lisp_String:
21177 /* A string: output it and check for %-constructs within it. */
21178 unsigned char c;
21179 ptrdiff_t offset = 0;
21181 if (SCHARS (elt) > 0
21182 && (!NILP (props) || risky))
21184 Lisp_Object oprops, aelt;
21185 oprops = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), elt);
21187 /* If the starting string's properties are not what
21188 we want, translate the string. Also, if the string
21189 is risky, do that anyway. */
21191 if (NILP (Fequal (props, oprops)) || risky)
21193 /* If the starting string has properties,
21194 merge the specified ones onto the existing ones. */
21195 if (! NILP (oprops) && !risky)
21197 Lisp_Object tem;
21199 oprops = Fcopy_sequence (oprops);
21200 tem = props;
21201 while (CONSP (tem))
21203 oprops = Fplist_put (oprops, XCAR (tem),
21204 XCAR (XCDR (tem)));
21205 tem = XCDR (XCDR (tem));
21207 props = oprops;
21210 aelt = Fassoc (elt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
21211 if (! NILP (aelt) && !NILP (Fequal (props, XCDR (aelt))))
21213 /* AELT is what we want. Move it to the front
21214 without consing. */
21215 elt = XCAR (aelt);
21216 mode_line_proptrans_alist
21217 = move_elt_to_front (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
21219 else
21221 Lisp_Object tem;
21223 /* If AELT has the wrong props, it is useless.
21224 so get rid of it. */
21225 if (! NILP (aelt))
21226 mode_line_proptrans_alist
21227 = Fdelq (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
21229 elt = Fcopy_sequence (elt);
21230 Fset_text_properties (make_number (0), Flength (elt),
21231 props, elt);
21232 /* Add this item to mode_line_proptrans_alist. */
21233 mode_line_proptrans_alist
21234 = Fcons (Fcons (elt, props),
21235 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
21236 /* Truncate mode_line_proptrans_alist
21237 to at most 50 elements. */
21238 tem = Fnthcdr (make_number (50),
21239 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
21240 if (! NILP (tem))
21241 XSETCDR (tem, Qnil);
21246 offset = 0;
21248 if (literal)
21250 prec = precision - n;
21251 switch (mode_line_target)
21253 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
21254 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
21255 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt), -1, prec);
21256 break;
21257 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
21258 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, elt, 1, 0, prec, Qnil);
21259 break;
21260 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
21261 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, 0, it,
21262 0, prec, 0, STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
21263 break;
21266 break;
21269 /* Handle the non-literal case. */
21271 while ((precision <= 0 || n < precision)
21272 && SREF (elt, offset) != 0
21273 && (mode_line_target != MODE_LINE_DISPLAY
21274 || it->current_x < it->last_visible_x))
21276 ptrdiff_t last_offset = offset;
21278 /* Advance to end of string or next format specifier. */
21279 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) != '\0' && c != '%')
21282 if (offset - 1 != last_offset)
21284 ptrdiff_t nchars, nbytes;
21286 /* Output to end of string or up to '%'. Field width
21287 is length of string. Don't output more than
21288 PRECISION allows us. */
21289 offset--;
21291 prec = c_string_width (SDATA (elt) + last_offset,
21292 offset - last_offset, precision - n,
21293 &nchars, &nbytes);
21295 switch (mode_line_target)
21297 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
21298 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
21299 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt) + last_offset, 0, prec);
21300 break;
21301 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
21303 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
21304 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
21305 ptrdiff_t endpos = (precision <= 0
21306 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, offset)
21307 : charpos + nchars);
21309 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL,
21310 Fsubstring (elt, make_number (charpos),
21311 make_number (endpos)),
21312 0, 0, 0, Qnil);
21314 break;
21315 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
21317 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
21318 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
21320 if (precision <= 0)
21321 nchars = string_byte_to_char (elt, offset) - charpos;
21322 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, charpos,
21323 it, 0, nchars, 0,
21324 STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
21326 break;
21329 else /* c == '%' */
21331 ptrdiff_t percent_position = offset;
21333 /* Get the specified minimum width. Zero means
21334 don't pad. */
21335 field = 0;
21336 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) >= '0' && c <= '9')
21337 field = field * 10 + c - '0';
21339 /* Don't pad beyond the total padding allowed. */
21340 if (field_width - n > 0 && field > field_width - n)
21341 field = field_width - n;
21343 /* Note that either PRECISION <= 0 or N < PRECISION. */
21344 prec = precision - n;
21346 if (c == 'M')
21347 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field, prec,
21348 Vglobal_mode_string, props,
21349 risky);
21350 else if (c != 0)
21352 bool multibyte;
21353 ptrdiff_t bytepos, charpos;
21354 const char *spec;
21355 Lisp_Object string;
21357 bytepos = percent_position;
21358 charpos = (STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt)
21359 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos)
21360 : bytepos);
21361 spec = decode_mode_spec (it->w, c, field, &string);
21362 multibyte = STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string);
21364 switch (mode_line_target)
21366 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
21367 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
21368 n += store_mode_line_noprop (spec, field, prec);
21369 break;
21370 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
21372 Lisp_Object tem = build_string (spec);
21373 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (charpos), elt);
21374 /* Should only keep face property in props */
21375 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, tem, 0, field, prec, props);
21377 break;
21378 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
21380 int nglyphs_before, nwritten;
21382 nglyphs_before = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
21383 nwritten = display_string (spec, string, elt,
21384 charpos, 0, it,
21385 field, prec, 0,
21386 multibyte);
21388 /* Assign to the glyphs written above the
21389 string where the `%x' came from, position
21390 of the `%'. */
21391 if (nwritten > 0)
21393 struct glyph *glyph
21394 = (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
21395 + nglyphs_before);
21396 int i;
21398 for (i = 0; i < nwritten; ++i)
21400 glyph[i].object = elt;
21401 glyph[i].charpos = charpos;
21404 n += nwritten;
21407 break;
21410 else /* c == 0 */
21411 break;
21415 break;
21417 case Lisp_Symbol:
21418 /* A symbol: process the value of the symbol recursively
21419 as if it appeared here directly. Avoid error if symbol void.
21420 Special case: if value of symbol is a string, output the string
21421 literally. */
21423 register Lisp_Object tem;
21425 /* If the variable is not marked as risky to set
21426 then its contents are risky to use. */
21427 if (NILP (Fget (elt, Qrisky_local_variable)))
21428 risky = 1;
21430 tem = Fboundp (elt);
21431 if (!NILP (tem))
21433 tem = Fsymbol_value (elt);
21434 /* If value is a string, output that string literally:
21435 don't check for % within it. */
21436 if (STRINGP (tem))
21437 literal = 1;
21439 if (!EQ (tem, elt))
21441 /* Give up right away for nil or t. */
21442 elt = tem;
21443 goto tail_recurse;
21447 break;
21449 case Lisp_Cons:
21451 register Lisp_Object car, tem;
21453 /* A cons cell: five distinct cases.
21454 If first element is :eval or :propertize, do something special.
21455 If first element is a string or a cons, process all the elements
21456 and effectively concatenate them.
21457 If first element is a negative number, truncate displaying cdr to
21458 at most that many characters. If positive, pad (with spaces)
21459 to at least that many characters.
21460 If first element is a symbol, process the cadr or caddr recursively
21461 according to whether the symbol's value is non-nil or nil. */
21462 car = XCAR (elt);
21463 if (EQ (car, QCeval))
21465 /* An element of the form (:eval FORM) means evaluate FORM
21466 and use the result as mode line elements. */
21468 if (risky)
21469 break;
21471 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
21473 Lisp_Object spec;
21474 spec = safe_eval (XCAR (XCDR (elt)));
21475 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
21476 precision - n, spec, props,
21477 risky);
21480 else if (EQ (car, QCpropertize))
21482 /* An element of the form (:propertize ELT PROPS...)
21483 means display ELT but applying properties PROPS. */
21485 if (risky)
21486 break;
21488 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
21489 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
21490 precision - n, XCAR (XCDR (elt)),
21491 XCDR (XCDR (elt)), risky);
21493 else if (SYMBOLP (car))
21495 tem = Fboundp (car);
21496 elt = XCDR (elt);
21497 if (!CONSP (elt))
21498 goto invalid;
21499 /* elt is now the cdr, and we know it is a cons cell.
21500 Use its car if CAR has a non-nil value. */
21501 if (!NILP (tem))
21503 tem = Fsymbol_value (car);
21504 if (!NILP (tem))
21506 elt = XCAR (elt);
21507 goto tail_recurse;
21510 /* Symbol's value is nil (or symbol is unbound)
21511 Get the cddr of the original list
21512 and if possible find the caddr and use that. */
21513 elt = XCDR (elt);
21514 if (NILP (elt))
21515 break;
21516 else if (!CONSP (elt))
21517 goto invalid;
21518 elt = XCAR (elt);
21519 goto tail_recurse;
21521 else if (INTEGERP (car))
21523 register int lim = XINT (car);
21524 elt = XCDR (elt);
21525 if (lim < 0)
21527 /* Negative int means reduce maximum width. */
21528 if (precision <= 0)
21529 precision = -lim;
21530 else
21531 precision = min (precision, -lim);
21533 else if (lim > 0)
21535 /* Padding specified. Don't let it be more than
21536 current maximum. */
21537 if (precision > 0)
21538 lim = min (precision, lim);
21540 /* If that's more padding than already wanted, queue it.
21541 But don't reduce padding already specified even if
21542 that is beyond the current truncation point. */
21543 field_width = max (lim, field_width);
21545 goto tail_recurse;
21547 else if (STRINGP (car) || CONSP (car))
21549 Lisp_Object halftail = elt;
21550 int len = 0;
21552 while (CONSP (elt)
21553 && (precision <= 0 || n < precision))
21555 n += display_mode_element (it, depth,
21556 /* Do padding only after the last
21557 element in the list. */
21558 (! CONSP (XCDR (elt))
21559 ? field_width - n
21560 : 0),
21561 precision - n, XCAR (elt),
21562 props, risky);
21563 elt = XCDR (elt);
21564 len++;
21565 if ((len & 1) == 0)
21566 halftail = XCDR (halftail);
21567 /* Check for cycle. */
21568 if (EQ (halftail, elt))
21569 break;
21573 break;
21575 default:
21576 invalid:
21577 elt = build_string ("*invalid*");
21578 goto tail_recurse;
21581 /* Pad to FIELD_WIDTH. */
21582 if (field_width > 0 && n < field_width)
21584 switch (mode_line_target)
21586 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
21587 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
21588 n += store_mode_line_noprop ("", field_width - n, 0);
21589 break;
21590 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
21591 n += store_mode_line_string ("", Qnil, 0, field_width - n, 0, Qnil);
21592 break;
21593 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
21594 n += display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, it, field_width - n,
21595 0, 0, 0);
21596 break;
21600 return n;
21603 /* Store a mode-line string element in mode_line_string_list.
21605 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
21606 string LISP_STRING is displayed.
21608 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
21609 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
21610 with spaces. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
21612 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
21613 STRING. PRECISION <= 0 means don't truncate the string.
21615 If COPY_STRING is non-zero, make a copy of LISP_STRING before adding
21616 properties to the string.
21618 PROPS are the properties to add to the string.
21619 The mode_line_string_face face property is always added to the string.
21622 static int
21623 store_mode_line_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, int copy_string,
21624 int field_width, int precision, Lisp_Object props)
21626 ptrdiff_t len;
21627 int n = 0;
21629 if (string != NULL)
21631 len = strlen (string);
21632 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
21633 len = precision;
21634 lisp_string = make_string (string, len);
21635 if (NILP (props))
21636 props = mode_line_string_face_prop;
21637 else if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
21639 Lisp_Object face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
21640 props = Fcopy_sequence (props);
21641 if (NILP (face))
21642 face = mode_line_string_face;
21643 else
21644 face = list2 (face, mode_line_string_face);
21645 props = Fplist_put (props, Qface, face);
21647 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
21648 props, lisp_string);
21650 else
21652 len = XFASTINT (Flength (lisp_string));
21653 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
21655 len = precision;
21656 lisp_string = Fsubstring (lisp_string, make_number (0), make_number (len));
21657 precision = -1;
21659 if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
21661 Lisp_Object face;
21662 if (NILP (props))
21663 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), lisp_string);
21664 face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
21665 if (NILP (face))
21666 face = mode_line_string_face;
21667 else
21668 face = list2 (face, mode_line_string_face);
21669 props = list2 (Qface, face);
21670 if (copy_string)
21671 lisp_string = Fcopy_sequence (lisp_string);
21673 if (!NILP (props))
21674 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
21675 props, lisp_string);
21678 if (len > 0)
21680 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
21681 n += len;
21684 if (field_width > len)
21686 field_width -= len;
21687 lisp_string = Fmake_string (make_number (field_width), make_number (' '));
21688 if (!NILP (props))
21689 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (field_width),
21690 props, lisp_string);
21691 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
21692 n += field_width;
21695 return n;
21699 DEFUN ("format-mode-line", Fformat_mode_line, Sformat_mode_line,
21700 1, 4, 0,
21701 doc: /* Format a string out of a mode line format specification.
21702 First arg FORMAT specifies the mode line format (see `mode-line-format'
21703 for details) to use.
21705 By default, the format is evaluated for the currently selected window.
21707 Optional second arg FACE specifies the face property to put on all
21708 characters for which no face is specified. The value nil means the
21709 default face. The value t means whatever face the window's mode line
21710 currently uses (either `mode-line' or `mode-line-inactive',
21711 depending on whether the window is the selected window or not).
21712 An integer value means the value string has no text
21713 properties.
21715 Optional third and fourth args WINDOW and BUFFER specify the window
21716 and buffer to use as the context for the formatting (defaults
21717 are the selected window and the WINDOW's buffer). */)
21718 (Lisp_Object format, Lisp_Object face,
21719 Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object buffer)
21721 struct it it;
21722 int len;
21723 struct window *w;
21724 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
21725 int face_id;
21726 int no_props = INTEGERP (face);
21727 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
21728 Lisp_Object str;
21729 int string_start = 0;
21731 w = decode_any_window (window);
21732 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
21734 if (NILP (buffer))
21735 buffer = w->contents;
21736 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
21738 /* Make formatting the modeline a non-op when noninteractive, otherwise
21739 there will be problems later caused by a partially initialized frame. */
21740 if (NILP (format) || noninteractive)
21741 return empty_unibyte_string;
21743 if (no_props)
21744 face = Qnil;
21746 face_id = (NILP (face) || EQ (face, Qdefault)) ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
21747 : EQ (face, Qt) ? (EQ (window, selected_window)
21748 ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID : MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
21749 : EQ (face, Qmode_line) ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
21750 : EQ (face, Qmode_line_inactive) ? MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID
21751 : EQ (face, Qheader_line) ? HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID
21752 : EQ (face, Qtool_bar) ? TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
21753 : DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
21755 old_buffer = current_buffer;
21757 /* Save things including mode_line_proptrans_alist,
21758 and set that to nil so that we don't alter the outer value. */
21759 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
21760 format_mode_line_unwind_data
21761 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)),
21762 old_buffer, selected_window, 1));
21763 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
21765 Fselect_window (window, Qt);
21766 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
21768 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
21770 if (no_props)
21772 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_NOPROP;
21773 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
21774 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21775 string_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
21777 else
21779 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_STRING;
21780 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21781 mode_line_string_face = face;
21782 mode_line_string_face_prop
21783 = NILP (face) ? Qnil : list2 (Qface, face);
21786 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
21787 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
21788 pop_kboard ();
21790 if (no_props)
21792 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (string_start);
21793 str = make_string (mode_line_noprop_buf + string_start, len);
21795 else
21797 mode_line_string_list = Fnreverse (mode_line_string_list);
21798 str = Fmapconcat (intern ("identity"), mode_line_string_list,
21799 empty_unibyte_string);
21802 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21803 return str;
21806 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal representation of
21807 the positive integer D to BUF using a minimal field width WIDTH. */
21809 static void
21810 pint2str (register char *buf, register int width, register ptrdiff_t d)
21812 register char *p = buf;
21814 if (d <= 0)
21815 *p++ = '0';
21816 else
21818 while (d > 0)
21820 *p++ = d % 10 + '0';
21821 d /= 10;
21825 for (width -= (int) (p - buf); width > 0; --width)
21826 *p++ = ' ';
21827 *p-- = '\0';
21828 while (p > buf)
21830 d = *buf;
21831 *buf++ = *p;
21832 *p-- = d;
21836 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal and "human
21837 readable" representation of the nonnegative integer D to BUF using
21838 a minimal field width WIDTH. D should be smaller than 999.5e24. */
21840 static const char power_letter[] =
21842 0, /* no letter */
21843 'k', /* kilo */
21844 'M', /* mega */
21845 'G', /* giga */
21846 'T', /* tera */
21847 'P', /* peta */
21848 'E', /* exa */
21849 'Z', /* zetta */
21850 'Y' /* yotta */
21853 static void
21854 pint2hrstr (char *buf, int width, ptrdiff_t d)
21856 /* We aim to represent the nonnegative integer D as
21857 QUOTIENT.TENTHS * 10 ^ (3 * EXPONENT). */
21858 ptrdiff_t quotient = d;
21859 int remainder = 0;
21860 /* -1 means: do not use TENTHS. */
21861 int tenths = -1;
21862 int exponent = 0;
21864 /* Length of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21865 int length;
21867 char * psuffix;
21868 char * p;
21870 if (quotient >= 1000)
21872 /* Scale to the appropriate EXPONENT. */
21875 remainder = quotient % 1000;
21876 quotient /= 1000;
21877 exponent++;
21879 while (quotient >= 1000);
21881 /* Round to nearest and decide whether to use TENTHS or not. */
21882 if (quotient <= 9)
21884 tenths = remainder / 100;
21885 if (remainder % 100 >= 50)
21887 if (tenths < 9)
21888 tenths++;
21889 else
21891 quotient++;
21892 if (quotient == 10)
21893 tenths = -1;
21894 else
21895 tenths = 0;
21899 else
21900 if (remainder >= 500)
21902 if (quotient < 999)
21903 quotient++;
21904 else
21906 quotient = 1;
21907 exponent++;
21908 tenths = 0;
21913 /* Calculate the LENGTH of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21914 if (tenths == -1 && quotient <= 99)
21915 if (quotient <= 9)
21916 length = 1;
21917 else
21918 length = 2;
21919 else
21920 length = 3;
21921 p = psuffix = buf + max (width, length);
21923 /* Print EXPONENT. */
21924 *psuffix++ = power_letter[exponent];
21925 *psuffix = '\0';
21927 /* Print TENTHS. */
21928 if (tenths >= 0)
21930 *--p = '0' + tenths;
21931 *--p = '.';
21934 /* Print QUOTIENT. */
21937 int digit = quotient % 10;
21938 *--p = '0' + digit;
21940 while ((quotient /= 10) != 0);
21942 /* Print leading spaces. */
21943 while (buf < p)
21944 *--p = ' ';
21947 /* Set a mnemonic character for coding_system (Lisp symbol) in BUF.
21948 If EOL_FLAG is 1, set also a mnemonic character for end-of-line
21949 type of CODING_SYSTEM. Return updated pointer into BUF. */
21951 static unsigned char invalid_eol_type[] = "(*invalid*)";
21953 static char *
21954 decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object coding_system, register char *buf, int eol_flag)
21956 Lisp_Object val;
21957 bool multibyte = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
21958 const unsigned char *eol_str;
21959 int eol_str_len;
21960 /* The EOL conversion we are using. */
21961 Lisp_Object eoltype;
21963 val = CODING_SYSTEM_SPEC (coding_system);
21964 eoltype = Qnil;
21966 if (!VECTORP (val)) /* Not yet decided. */
21968 *buf++ = multibyte ? '-' : ' ';
21969 if (eol_flag)
21970 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21971 /* Don't mention EOL conversion if it isn't decided. */
21973 else
21975 Lisp_Object attrs;
21976 Lisp_Object eolvalue;
21978 attrs = AREF (val, 0);
21979 eolvalue = AREF (val, 2);
21981 *buf++ = multibyte
21982 ? XFASTINT (CODING_ATTR_MNEMONIC (attrs))
21983 : ' ';
21985 if (eol_flag)
21987 /* The EOL conversion that is normal on this system. */
21989 if (NILP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21990 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21991 else if (VECTORP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21992 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21993 else /* eolvalue is Qunix, Qdos, or Qmac. */
21994 eoltype = (EQ (eolvalue, Qunix)
21995 ? eol_mnemonic_unix
21996 : (EQ (eolvalue, Qdos) == 1
21997 ? eol_mnemonic_dos : eol_mnemonic_mac));
22001 if (eol_flag)
22003 /* Mention the EOL conversion if it is not the usual one. */
22004 if (STRINGP (eoltype))
22006 eol_str = SDATA (eoltype);
22007 eol_str_len = SBYTES (eoltype);
22009 else if (CHARACTERP (eoltype))
22011 unsigned char *tmp = alloca (MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH);
22012 int c = XFASTINT (eoltype);
22013 eol_str_len = CHAR_STRING (c, tmp);
22014 eol_str = tmp;
22016 else
22018 eol_str = invalid_eol_type;
22019 eol_str_len = sizeof (invalid_eol_type) - 1;
22021 memcpy (buf, eol_str, eol_str_len);
22022 buf += eol_str_len;
22025 return buf;
22028 /* Return a string for the output of a mode line %-spec for window W,
22029 generated by character C. FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad the string
22030 returned with spaces to that value. Return a Lisp string in
22031 *STRING if the resulting string is taken from that Lisp string.
22033 Note we operate on the current buffer for most purposes. */
22035 static char lots_of_dashes[] = "--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------";
22037 static const char *
22038 decode_mode_spec (struct window *w, register int c, int field_width,
22039 Lisp_Object *string)
22041 Lisp_Object obj;
22042 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
22043 char *decode_mode_spec_buf = f->decode_mode_spec_buffer;
22044 /* We are going to use f->decode_mode_spec_buffer as the buffer to
22045 produce strings from numerical values, so limit preposterously
22046 large values of FIELD_WIDTH to avoid overrunning the buffer's
22047 end. The size of the buffer is enough for FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE
22048 bytes plus the terminating null. */
22049 int width = min (field_width, FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f));
22050 struct buffer *b = current_buffer;
22052 obj = Qnil;
22053 *string = Qnil;
22055 switch (c)
22057 case '*':
22058 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
22059 return "%";
22060 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
22061 return "*";
22062 return "-";
22064 case '+':
22065 /* This differs from %* only for a modified read-only buffer. */
22066 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
22067 return "*";
22068 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
22069 return "%";
22070 return "-";
22072 case '&':
22073 /* This differs from %* in ignoring read-only-ness. */
22074 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
22075 return "*";
22076 return "-";
22078 case '%':
22079 return "%";
22081 case '[':
22083 int i;
22084 char *p;
22086 if (command_loop_level > 5)
22087 return "[[[... ";
22088 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
22089 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
22090 *p++ = '[';
22091 *p = 0;
22092 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22095 case ']':
22097 int i;
22098 char *p;
22100 if (command_loop_level > 5)
22101 return " ...]]]";
22102 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
22103 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
22104 *p++ = ']';
22105 *p = 0;
22106 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22109 case '-':
22111 register int i;
22113 /* Let lots_of_dashes be a string of infinite length. */
22114 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_NOPROP
22115 || mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_STRING)
22116 return "--";
22117 if (field_width <= 0
22118 || field_width > sizeof (lots_of_dashes))
22120 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) - 1; ++i)
22121 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '-';
22122 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '\0';
22123 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22125 else
22126 return lots_of_dashes;
22129 case 'b':
22130 obj = BVAR (b, name);
22131 break;
22133 case 'c':
22134 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'.
22135 (In redisplay_internal, the frame title is drawn _before_ the
22136 windows are updated, so the stuff which depends on actual
22137 window contents (such as %l) may fail to render properly, or
22138 even crash emacs.) */
22139 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
22140 return "";
22141 else
22143 ptrdiff_t col = current_column ();
22144 w->column_number_displayed = col;
22145 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, col);
22146 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22149 case 'e':
22150 #ifndef SYSTEM_MALLOC
22152 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
22153 return "";
22154 else
22155 return "!MEM FULL! ";
22157 #else
22158 return "";
22159 #endif
22161 case 'F':
22162 /* %F displays the frame name. */
22163 if (!NILP (f->title))
22164 return SSDATA (f->title);
22165 if (f->explicit_name || ! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
22166 return SSDATA (f->name);
22167 return "Emacs";
22169 case 'f':
22170 obj = BVAR (b, filename);
22171 break;
22173 case 'i':
22175 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
22176 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, size);
22177 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22180 case 'I':
22182 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
22183 pint2hrstr (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, size);
22184 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22187 case 'l':
22189 ptrdiff_t startpos, startpos_byte, line, linepos, linepos_byte;
22190 ptrdiff_t topline, nlines, height;
22191 ptrdiff_t junk;
22193 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'. */
22194 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
22195 return "";
22197 startpos = marker_position (w->start);
22198 startpos_byte = marker_byte_position (w->start);
22199 height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
22201 /* If we decided that this buffer isn't suitable for line numbers,
22202 don't forget that too fast. */
22203 if (w->base_line_pos == -1)
22204 goto no_value;
22206 /* If the buffer is very big, don't waste time. */
22207 if (INTEGERP (Vline_number_display_limit)
22208 && BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b) > XINT (Vline_number_display_limit))
22210 w->base_line_pos = 0;
22211 w->base_line_number = 0;
22212 goto no_value;
22215 if (w->base_line_number > 0
22216 && w->base_line_pos > 0
22217 && w->base_line_pos <= startpos)
22219 line = w->base_line_number;
22220 linepos = w->base_line_pos;
22221 linepos_byte = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (b, linepos);
22223 else
22225 line = 1;
22226 linepos = BUF_BEGV (b);
22227 linepos_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
22230 /* Count lines from base line to window start position. */
22231 nlines = display_count_lines (linepos_byte,
22232 startpos_byte,
22233 startpos, &junk);
22235 topline = nlines + line;
22237 /* Determine a new base line, if the old one is too close
22238 or too far away, or if we did not have one.
22239 "Too close" means it's plausible a scroll-down would
22240 go back past it. */
22241 if (startpos == BUF_BEGV (b))
22243 w->base_line_number = topline;
22244 w->base_line_pos = BUF_BEGV (b);
22246 else if (nlines < height + 25 || nlines > height * 3 + 50
22247 || linepos == BUF_BEGV (b))
22249 ptrdiff_t limit = BUF_BEGV (b);
22250 ptrdiff_t limit_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
22251 ptrdiff_t position;
22252 ptrdiff_t distance =
22253 (height * 2 + 30) * line_number_display_limit_width;
22255 if (startpos - distance > limit)
22257 limit = startpos - distance;
22258 limit_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
22261 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
22262 limit_byte,
22263 - (height * 2 + 30),
22264 &position);
22265 /* If we couldn't find the lines we wanted within
22266 line_number_display_limit_width chars per line,
22267 give up on line numbers for this window. */
22268 if (position == limit_byte && limit == startpos - distance)
22270 w->base_line_pos = -1;
22271 w->base_line_number = 0;
22272 goto no_value;
22275 w->base_line_number = topline - nlines;
22276 w->base_line_pos = BYTE_TO_CHAR (position);
22279 /* Now count lines from the start pos to point. */
22280 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
22281 PT_BYTE, PT, &junk);
22283 /* Record that we did display the line number. */
22284 line_number_displayed = 1;
22286 /* Make the string to show. */
22287 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, topline + nlines);
22288 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22289 no_value:
22291 char* p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
22292 int pad = width - 2;
22293 while (pad-- > 0)
22294 *p++ = ' ';
22295 *p++ = '?';
22296 *p++ = '?';
22297 *p = '\0';
22298 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22301 break;
22303 case 'm':
22304 obj = BVAR (b, mode_name);
22305 break;
22307 case 'n':
22308 if (BUF_BEGV (b) > BUF_BEG (b) || BUF_ZV (b) < BUF_Z (b))
22309 return " Narrow";
22310 break;
22312 case 'p':
22314 ptrdiff_t pos = marker_position (w->start);
22315 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
22317 if (w->window_end_pos <= BUF_Z (b) - BUF_ZV (b))
22319 if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
22320 return "All";
22321 else
22322 return "Bottom";
22324 else if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
22325 return "Top";
22326 else
22328 if (total > 1000000)
22329 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
22330 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
22331 else
22332 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
22333 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
22334 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
22335 if (total == 100)
22336 total = 99;
22337 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
22338 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22342 /* Display percentage of size above the bottom of the screen. */
22343 case 'P':
22345 ptrdiff_t toppos = marker_position (w->start);
22346 ptrdiff_t botpos = BUF_Z (b) - w->window_end_pos;
22347 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
22349 if (botpos >= BUF_ZV (b))
22351 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
22352 return "All";
22353 else
22354 return "Bottom";
22356 else
22358 if (total > 1000000)
22359 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
22360 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
22361 else
22362 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
22363 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
22364 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
22365 if (total == 100)
22366 total = 99;
22367 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
22368 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "Top%2"pD"d%%", total);
22369 else
22370 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
22371 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22375 case 's':
22376 /* status of process */
22377 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
22378 if (NILP (obj))
22379 return "no process";
22380 #ifndef MSDOS
22381 obj = Fsymbol_name (Fprocess_status (obj));
22382 #endif
22383 break;
22385 case '@':
22387 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
22388 Lisp_Object val = call1 (intern ("file-remote-p"),
22389 BVAR (current_buffer, directory));
22390 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
22392 if (NILP (val))
22393 return "-";
22394 else
22395 return "@";
22398 case 'z':
22399 /* coding-system (not including end-of-line format) */
22400 case 'Z':
22401 /* coding-system (including end-of-line type) */
22403 int eol_flag = (c == 'Z');
22404 char *p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
22406 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
22408 /* No need to mention EOL here--the terminal never needs
22409 to do EOL conversion. */
22410 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
22411 (FRAME_KEYBOARD_CODING (f)->id),
22412 p, 0);
22413 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
22414 (FRAME_TERMINAL_CODING (f)->id),
22415 p, 0);
22417 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (BVAR (b, buffer_file_coding_system),
22418 p, eol_flag);
22420 #if 0 /* This proves to be annoying; I think we can do without. -- rms. */
22421 #ifdef subprocesses
22422 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
22423 if (PROCESSP (obj))
22425 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
22426 (XPROCESS (obj)->decode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
22427 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
22428 (XPROCESS (obj)->encode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
22430 #endif /* subprocesses */
22431 #endif /* 0 */
22432 *p = 0;
22433 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
22437 if (STRINGP (obj))
22439 *string = obj;
22440 return SSDATA (obj);
22442 else
22443 return "";
22447 /* Count up to COUNT lines starting from START_BYTE. COUNT negative
22448 means count lines back from START_BYTE. But don't go beyond
22449 LIMIT_BYTE. Return the number of lines thus found (always
22450 nonnegative).
22452 Set *BYTE_POS_PTR to the byte position where we stopped. This is
22453 either the position COUNT lines after/before START_BYTE, if we
22454 found COUNT lines, or LIMIT_BYTE if we hit the limit before finding
22455 COUNT lines. */
22457 static ptrdiff_t
22458 display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t start_byte,
22459 ptrdiff_t limit_byte, ptrdiff_t count,
22460 ptrdiff_t *byte_pos_ptr)
22462 register unsigned char *cursor;
22463 unsigned char *base;
22465 register ptrdiff_t ceiling;
22466 register unsigned char *ceiling_addr;
22467 ptrdiff_t orig_count = count;
22469 /* If we are not in selective display mode,
22470 check only for newlines. */
22471 int selective_display = (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
22472 && !INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)));
22474 if (count > 0)
22476 while (start_byte < limit_byte)
22478 ceiling = BUFFER_CEILING_OF (start_byte);
22479 ceiling = min (limit_byte - 1, ceiling);
22480 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) + 1;
22481 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte));
22485 if (selective_display)
22487 while (*cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015
22488 && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
22489 continue;
22490 if (cursor == ceiling_addr)
22491 break;
22493 else
22495 cursor = memchr (cursor, '\n', ceiling_addr - cursor);
22496 if (! cursor)
22497 break;
22500 cursor++;
22502 if (--count == 0)
22504 start_byte += cursor - base;
22505 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
22506 return orig_count;
22509 while (cursor < ceiling_addr);
22511 start_byte += ceiling_addr - base;
22514 else
22516 while (start_byte > limit_byte)
22518 ceiling = BUFFER_FLOOR_OF (start_byte - 1);
22519 ceiling = max (limit_byte, ceiling);
22520 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling);
22521 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte - 1) + 1);
22522 while (1)
22524 if (selective_display)
22526 while (--cursor >= ceiling_addr
22527 && *cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015)
22528 continue;
22529 if (cursor < ceiling_addr)
22530 break;
22532 else
22534 cursor = memrchr (ceiling_addr, '\n', cursor - ceiling_addr);
22535 if (! cursor)
22536 break;
22539 if (++count == 0)
22541 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
22542 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
22543 /* When scanning backwards, we should
22544 not count the newline posterior to which we stop. */
22545 return - orig_count - 1;
22548 start_byte += ceiling_addr - base;
22552 *byte_pos_ptr = limit_byte;
22554 if (count < 0)
22555 return - orig_count + count;
22556 return orig_count - count;
22562 /***********************************************************************
22563 Displaying strings
22564 ***********************************************************************/
22566 /* Display a NUL-terminated string, starting with index START.
22568 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
22569 string LISP_STRING is displayed. There's a case that STRING is
22570 non-null and LISP_STRING is not nil. It means STRING is a string
22571 data of LISP_STRING. In that case, we display LISP_STRING while
22572 ignoring its text properties.
22574 If FACE_STRING is not nil, FACE_STRING_POS is a position in
22575 FACE_STRING. Display STRING or LISP_STRING with the face at
22576 FACE_STRING_POS in FACE_STRING:
22578 Display the string in the environment given by IT, but use the
22579 standard display table, temporarily.
22581 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
22582 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
22583 with spaces. If STRING has more characters, more than FIELD_WIDTH
22584 glyphs will be produced. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
22586 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
22587 STRING. PRECISION < 0 means don't truncate the string.
22589 This is roughly equivalent to printf format specifiers:
22591 FIELD_WIDTH PRECISION PRINTF
22592 ----------------------------------------
22593 -1 -1 %s
22594 -1 10 %.10s
22595 10 -1 %10s
22596 20 10 %20.10s
22598 MULTIBYTE zero means do not display multibyte chars, > 0 means do
22599 display them, and < 0 means obey the current buffer's value of
22600 enable_multibyte_characters.
22602 Value is the number of columns displayed. */
22604 static int
22605 display_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, Lisp_Object face_string,
22606 ptrdiff_t face_string_pos, ptrdiff_t start, struct it *it,
22607 int field_width, int precision, int max_x, int multibyte)
22609 int hpos_at_start = it->hpos;
22610 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
22611 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
22612 ptrdiff_t it_charpos;
22614 /* Initialize the iterator IT for iteration over STRING beginning
22615 with index START. */
22616 reseat_to_string (it, NILP (lisp_string) ? string : NULL, lisp_string, start,
22617 precision, field_width, multibyte);
22618 if (string && STRINGP (lisp_string))
22619 /* LISP_STRING is the one returned by decode_mode_spec. We should
22620 ignore its text properties. */
22621 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
22623 /* If displaying STRING, set up the face of the iterator from
22624 FACE_STRING, if that's given. */
22625 if (STRINGP (face_string))
22627 ptrdiff_t endptr;
22628 struct face *face;
22630 it->face_id
22631 = face_at_string_position (it->w, face_string, face_string_pos,
22632 0, &endptr, it->base_face_id, 0);
22633 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
22634 it->face_box_p = face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
22637 /* Set max_x to the maximum allowed X position. Don't let it go
22638 beyond the right edge of the window. */
22639 if (max_x <= 0)
22640 max_x = it->last_visible_x;
22641 else
22642 max_x = min (max_x, it->last_visible_x);
22644 /* Skip over display elements that are not visible. because IT->w is
22645 hscrolled. */
22646 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
22647 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, 100000, it->first_visible_x,
22648 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
22650 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
22651 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
22652 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
22653 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
22654 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
22656 if (STRINGP (it->string))
22657 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
22658 else
22659 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
22661 /* This condition is for the case that we are called with current_x
22662 past last_visible_x. */
22663 while (it->current_x < max_x)
22665 int x_before, x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
22667 /* Get the next display element. */
22668 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
22669 break;
22671 /* Produce glyphs. */
22672 x_before = it->current_x;
22673 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
22674 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
22676 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
22677 i = 0;
22678 x = x_before;
22679 while (i < nglyphs)
22681 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
22683 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
22684 && x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
22686 /* End of continued line or max_x reached. */
22687 if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph))
22689 /* A wide character is unbreakable. */
22690 if (row->reversed_p)
22691 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
22692 - n_glyphs_before);
22693 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
22694 it->current_x = x_before;
22696 else
22698 if (row->reversed_p)
22699 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
22700 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
22701 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
22702 it->current_x = x;
22704 break;
22706 else if (x + glyph->pixel_width >= it->first_visible_x)
22708 /* Glyph is at least partially visible. */
22709 ++it->hpos;
22710 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
22711 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
22713 else
22715 /* Glyph is off the left margin of the display area.
22716 Should not happen. */
22717 emacs_abort ();
22720 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
22721 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
22722 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
22723 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
22724 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
22725 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
22726 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
22727 x += glyph->pixel_width;
22728 ++i;
22731 /* Stop if max_x reached. */
22732 if (i < nglyphs)
22733 break;
22735 /* Stop at line ends. */
22736 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
22738 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
22739 break;
22742 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
22743 if (STRINGP (it->string))
22744 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
22745 else
22746 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
22748 /* Stop if truncating at the right edge. */
22749 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
22750 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
22752 /* Add truncation mark, but don't do it if the line is
22753 truncated at a padding space. */
22754 if (it_charpos < it->string_nchars)
22756 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
22758 int ii, n;
22760 if (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)
22762 if (!row->reversed_p)
22764 for (ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; ii > 0; --ii)
22765 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22766 break;
22768 else
22770 for (ii = 0; ii < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii++)
22771 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22772 break;
22773 unproduce_glyphs (it, ii + 1);
22774 ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (ii + 1);
22776 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii < n; ++ii)
22778 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = ii;
22779 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22782 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22784 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
22786 break;
22790 /* Maybe insert a truncation at the left. */
22791 if (it->first_visible_x
22792 && it_charpos > 0)
22794 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22795 || (row->reversed_p
22796 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22797 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
22798 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
22799 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
22802 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
22804 /* Value is number of columns displayed. */
22805 return it->hpos - hpos_at_start;
22810 /* This is like a combination of memq and assq. Return 1/2 if PROPVAL
22811 appears as an element of LIST or as the car of an element of LIST.
22812 If PROPVAL is a list, compare each element against LIST in that
22813 way, and return 1/2 if any element of PROPVAL is found in LIST.
22814 Otherwise return 0. This function cannot quit.
22815 The return value is 2 if the text is invisible but with an ellipsis
22816 and 1 if it's invisible and without an ellipsis. */
22819 invisible_p (register Lisp_Object propval, Lisp_Object list)
22821 register Lisp_Object tail, proptail;
22823 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22825 register Lisp_Object tem;
22826 tem = XCAR (tail);
22827 if (EQ (propval, tem))
22828 return 1;
22829 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propval, XCAR (tem)))
22830 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22833 if (CONSP (propval))
22835 for (proptail = propval; CONSP (proptail); proptail = XCDR (proptail))
22837 Lisp_Object propelt;
22838 propelt = XCAR (proptail);
22839 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22841 register Lisp_Object tem;
22842 tem = XCAR (tail);
22843 if (EQ (propelt, tem))
22844 return 1;
22845 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propelt, XCAR (tem)))
22846 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22851 return 0;
22854 DEFUN ("invisible-p", Finvisible_p, Sinvisible_p, 1, 1, 0,
22855 doc: /* Non-nil if the property makes the text invisible.
22856 POS-OR-PROP can be a marker or number, in which case it is taken to be
22857 a position in the current buffer and the value of the `invisible' property
22858 is checked; or it can be some other value, which is then presumed to be the
22859 value of the `invisible' property of the text of interest.
22860 The non-nil value returned can be t for truly invisible text or something
22861 else if the text is replaced by an ellipsis. */)
22862 (Lisp_Object pos_or_prop)
22864 Lisp_Object prop
22865 = (NATNUMP (pos_or_prop) || MARKERP (pos_or_prop)
22866 ? Fget_char_property (pos_or_prop, Qinvisible, Qnil)
22867 : pos_or_prop);
22868 int invis = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
22869 return (invis == 0 ? Qnil
22870 : invis == 1 ? Qt
22871 : make_number (invis));
22874 /* Calculate a width or height in pixels from a specification using
22875 the following elements:
22877 SPEC ::=
22878 NUM - a (fractional) multiple of the default font width/height
22879 (NUM) - specifies exactly NUM pixels
22880 UNIT - a fixed number of pixels, see below.
22881 ELEMENT - size of a display element in pixels, see below.
22882 (NUM . SPEC) - equals NUM * SPEC
22883 (+ SPEC SPEC ...) - add pixel values
22884 (- SPEC SPEC ...) - subtract pixel values
22885 (- SPEC) - negate pixel value
22887 NUM ::=
22888 INT or FLOAT - a number constant
22889 SYMBOL - use symbol's (buffer local) variable binding.
22891 UNIT ::=
22892 in - pixels per inch *)
22893 mm - pixels per 1/1000 meter *)
22894 cm - pixels per 1/100 meter *)
22895 width - width of current font in pixels.
22896 height - height of current font in pixels.
22898 *) using the ratio(s) defined in display-pixels-per-inch.
22900 ELEMENT ::=
22902 left-fringe - left fringe width in pixels
22903 right-fringe - right fringe width in pixels
22905 left-margin - left margin width in pixels
22906 right-margin - right margin width in pixels
22908 scroll-bar - scroll-bar area width in pixels
22910 Examples:
22912 Pixels corresponding to 5 inches:
22913 (5 . in)
22915 Total width of non-text areas on left side of window (if scroll-bar is on left):
22916 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin scroll-bar))
22918 Align to first text column (in header line):
22919 '(space :align-to 0)
22921 Align to middle of text area minus half the width of variable `my-image'
22922 containing a loaded image:
22923 '(space :align-to (0.5 . (- text my-image)))
22925 Width of left margin minus width of 1 character in the default font:
22926 '(space :width (- left-margin 1))
22928 Width of left margin minus width of 2 characters in the current font:
22929 '(space :width (- left-margin (2 . width)))
22931 Center 1 character over left-margin (in header line):
22932 '(space :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin) -0.5))
22934 Different ways to express width of left fringe plus left margin minus one pixel:
22935 '(space :width (- (+ left-fringe left-margin) (1)))
22936 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (- (1))))
22937 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (-1)))
22941 static int
22942 calc_pixel_width_or_height (double *res, struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop,
22943 struct font *font, int width_p, int *align_to)
22945 double pixels;
22947 #define OK_PIXELS(val) ((*res = (double)(val)), 1)
22948 #define OK_ALIGN_TO(val) ((*align_to = (int)(val)), 1)
22950 if (NILP (prop))
22951 return OK_PIXELS (0);
22953 eassert (FRAME_LIVE_P (it->f));
22955 if (SYMBOLP (prop))
22957 if (SCHARS (SYMBOL_NAME (prop)) == 2)
22959 char *unit = SSDATA (SYMBOL_NAME (prop));
22961 if (unit[0] == 'i' && unit[1] == 'n')
22962 pixels = 1.0;
22963 else if (unit[0] == 'm' && unit[1] == 'm')
22964 pixels = 25.4;
22965 else if (unit[0] == 'c' && unit[1] == 'm')
22966 pixels = 2.54;
22967 else
22968 pixels = 0;
22969 if (pixels > 0)
22971 double ppi = (width_p ? FRAME_RES_X (it->f)
22972 : FRAME_RES_Y (it->f));
22974 if (ppi > 0)
22975 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22976 return 0;
22980 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22981 if (EQ (prop, Qheight))
22982 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_HEIGHT (font) : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22983 if (EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22984 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_WIDTH (font) : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f));
22985 #else
22986 if (EQ (prop, Qheight) || EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22987 return OK_PIXELS (1);
22988 #endif
22990 if (EQ (prop, Qtext))
22991 return OK_PIXELS (width_p
22992 ? window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22993 : WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w));
22995 if (align_to && *align_to < 0)
22997 *res = 0;
22998 if (EQ (prop, Qleft))
22999 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
23000 if (EQ (prop, Qright))
23001 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
23002 if (EQ (prop, Qcenter))
23003 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
23004 + window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) / 2);
23005 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
23006 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
23007 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w)
23008 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
23009 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
23010 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
23011 ? window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
23012 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
23013 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
23014 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
23015 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
23016 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA));
23017 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
23018 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (it->w)
23020 : (window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
23021 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
23022 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
23023 : 0)));
23025 else
23027 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
23028 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
23029 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
23030 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
23031 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
23032 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
23033 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
23034 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
23035 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
23036 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w));
23039 prop = buffer_local_value_1 (prop, it->w->contents);
23040 if (EQ (prop, Qunbound))
23041 prop = Qnil;
23044 if (INTEGERP (prop) || FLOATP (prop))
23046 int base_unit = (width_p
23047 ? FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f)
23048 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
23049 return OK_PIXELS (XFLOATINT (prop) * base_unit);
23052 if (CONSP (prop))
23054 Lisp_Object car = XCAR (prop);
23055 Lisp_Object cdr = XCDR (prop);
23057 if (SYMBOLP (car))
23059 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23060 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
23061 && valid_image_p (prop))
23063 ptrdiff_t id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
23064 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, id);
23066 return OK_PIXELS (width_p ? img->width : img->height);
23068 #endif
23069 if (EQ (car, Qplus) || EQ (car, Qminus))
23071 int first = 1;
23072 double px;
23074 pixels = 0;
23075 while (CONSP (cdr))
23077 if (!calc_pixel_width_or_height (&px, it, XCAR (cdr),
23078 font, width_p, align_to))
23079 return 0;
23080 if (first)
23081 pixels = (EQ (car, Qplus) ? px : -px), first = 0;
23082 else
23083 pixels += px;
23084 cdr = XCDR (cdr);
23086 if (EQ (car, Qminus))
23087 pixels = -pixels;
23088 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
23091 car = buffer_local_value_1 (car, it->w->contents);
23092 if (EQ (car, Qunbound))
23093 car = Qnil;
23096 if (INTEGERP (car) || FLOATP (car))
23098 double fact;
23099 pixels = XFLOATINT (car);
23100 if (NILP (cdr))
23101 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
23102 if (calc_pixel_width_or_height (&fact, it, cdr,
23103 font, width_p, align_to))
23104 return OK_PIXELS (pixels * fact);
23105 return 0;
23108 return 0;
23111 return 0;
23115 /***********************************************************************
23116 Glyph Display
23117 ***********************************************************************/
23119 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
23121 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
23123 void
23124 dump_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
23126 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
23127 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
23128 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
23129 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
23130 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
23131 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
23132 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
23133 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
23134 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
23135 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
23136 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
23137 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
23140 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
23142 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
23143 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
23144 init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
23145 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
23146 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
23147 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
23148 face-override for drawing S. */
23150 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
23151 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc,
23152 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc;
23153 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f) hdc = get_frame_dc ((f))
23154 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f) release_frame_dc ((f), (hdc))
23155 #endif
23157 #ifndef OPTIONAL_HDC
23158 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc)
23159 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc)
23160 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f)
23161 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f)
23162 #endif
23164 static void
23165 init_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s,
23166 OPTIONAL_HDC (hdc)
23167 XChar2b *char2b, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
23168 enum glyph_row_area area, int start, enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
23170 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
23171 s->w = w;
23172 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
23173 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
23174 s->hdc = hdc;
23175 #endif
23176 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
23177 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
23178 s->char2b = char2b;
23179 s->hl = hl;
23180 s->row = row;
23181 s->area = area;
23182 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
23183 s->height = row->height;
23184 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
23185 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
23189 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
23190 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
23192 static void
23193 append_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
23194 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
23196 if (h)
23198 if (*head)
23199 (*tail)->next = h;
23200 else
23201 *head = h;
23202 h->prev = *tail;
23203 *tail = t;
23208 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
23209 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
23210 result. */
23212 static void
23213 prepend_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
23214 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
23216 if (h)
23218 if (*head)
23219 (*head)->prev = t;
23220 else
23221 *tail = t;
23222 t->next = *head;
23223 *head = h;
23228 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
23229 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
23231 static void
23232 append_glyph_string (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
23233 struct glyph_string *s)
23235 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
23236 append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
23240 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame F.
23241 The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
23242 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
23243 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
23244 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
23246 static struct face *
23247 get_char_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, int c, int face_id,
23248 XChar2b *char2b, int display_p)
23250 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
23251 unsigned code = 0;
23253 if (face->font)
23255 code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, c);
23257 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
23258 code = 0;
23260 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
23262 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
23263 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
23264 if (display_p)
23265 #endif
23267 eassert (face != NULL);
23268 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
23271 return face;
23275 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
23276 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
23277 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
23279 static struct face *
23280 get_glyph_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph,
23281 XChar2b *char2b, int *two_byte_p)
23283 struct face *face;
23284 unsigned code = 0;
23286 eassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
23287 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
23289 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
23290 eassert (face != NULL);
23291 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
23293 if (two_byte_p)
23294 *two_byte_p = 0;
23296 if (face->font)
23298 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (glyph->u.ch))
23299 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (glyph->u.ch);
23300 else
23301 code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, glyph->u.ch);
23303 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
23304 code = 0;
23307 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
23308 return face;
23312 /* Get glyph code of character C in FONT in the two-byte form CHAR2B.
23313 Return 1 if FONT has a glyph for C, otherwise return 0. */
23315 static int
23316 get_char_glyph_code (int c, struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
23318 unsigned code;
23320 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
23321 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
23322 else
23323 code = font->driver->encode_char (font, c);
23325 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
23326 return 0;
23327 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
23328 return 1;
23332 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
23334 BASE_FACE is the base face of the composition.
23335 S->cmp_from is the index of the first component for S.
23337 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
23338 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
23340 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
23342 static int
23343 fill_composite_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, struct face *base_face,
23344 int overlaps)
23346 int i;
23347 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
23348 S->cmp_from, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
23349 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
23350 struct face *face;
23352 eassert (s);
23354 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
23355 s->face = NULL;
23356 s->font = NULL;
23357 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp->glyph_len; i++)
23359 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, i);
23361 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding space
23362 on the left or right. */
23363 if (c != '\t')
23365 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, base_face->ascii_face, c,
23366 -1, Qnil);
23368 face = get_char_face_and_encoding (s->f, c, face_id,
23369 s->char2b + i, 1);
23370 if (face)
23372 if (! s->face)
23374 s->face = face;
23375 s->font = s->face->font;
23377 else if (s->face != face)
23378 break;
23381 ++s->nchars;
23383 s->cmp_to = i;
23385 if (s->face == NULL)
23387 s->face = base_face->ascii_face;
23388 s->font = s->face->font;
23391 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
23392 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
23393 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
23395 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
23396 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
23397 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
23398 characters of the glyph string. */
23399 if (s->font == NULL)
23401 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
23402 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
23405 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
23406 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
23408 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
23409 s->two_byte_p = 1;
23411 return s->cmp_to;
23414 static int
23415 fill_gstring_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
23416 int start, int end, int overlaps)
23418 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
23419 Lisp_Object lgstring;
23420 int i;
23422 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
23423 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
23424 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
23425 s->cmp_id = glyph->u.cmp.id;
23426 s->cmp_from = glyph->slice.cmp.from;
23427 s->cmp_to = glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1;
23428 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
23429 lgstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
23430 s->font = XFONT_OBJECT (LGSTRING_FONT (lgstring));
23431 glyph++;
23432 while (glyph < last
23433 && glyph->u.cmp.automatic
23434 && glyph->u.cmp.id == s->cmp_id
23435 && s->cmp_to == glyph->slice.cmp.from)
23436 s->cmp_to = (glyph++)->slice.cmp.to + 1;
23438 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
23440 Lisp_Object lglyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (lgstring, i);
23441 unsigned code = LGLYPH_CODE (lglyph);
23443 STORE_XCHAR2B ((s->char2b + i), code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
23445 s->width = composition_gstring_width (lgstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, NULL);
23446 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23450 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence glyphs for glyphless characters.
23451 See the comment of fill_glyph_string for arguments.
23452 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
23455 static int
23456 fill_glyphless_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
23457 int start, int end, int overlaps)
23459 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
23460 int voffset;
23462 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH);
23463 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
23464 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
23465 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
23466 voffset = glyph->voffset;
23467 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
23468 s->font = s->face->font ? s->face->font : FRAME_FONT (s->f);
23469 s->nchars = 1;
23470 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
23471 glyph++;
23472 while (glyph < last
23473 && glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
23474 && glyph->voffset == voffset
23475 && glyph->face_id == face_id)
23477 s->nchars++;
23478 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
23479 glyph++;
23481 s->ybase += voffset;
23482 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23486 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
23488 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
23489 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
23490 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
23491 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
23493 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
23495 static int
23496 fill_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
23497 int start, int end, int overlaps)
23499 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
23500 int voffset;
23501 int glyph_not_available_p;
23503 eassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
23504 eassert (s->nchars == 0);
23505 eassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
23507 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
23508 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
23509 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
23510 voffset = glyph->voffset;
23511 s->padding_p = glyph->padding_p;
23512 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
23514 while (glyph < last
23515 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
23516 && glyph->voffset == voffset
23517 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
23518 && glyph->face_id == face_id
23519 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
23521 int two_byte_p;
23523 s->face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
23524 s->char2b + s->nchars,
23525 &two_byte_p);
23526 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
23527 ++s->nchars;
23528 eassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
23529 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
23530 if (glyph++->padding_p != s->padding_p)
23531 break;
23534 s->font = s->face->font;
23536 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
23537 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
23538 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
23539 characters of the glyph string. */
23540 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
23542 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
23543 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
23546 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
23547 s->ybase += voffset;
23549 eassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
23550 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23554 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
23556 static void
23557 fill_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
23559 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
23560 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
23561 eassert (s->img);
23562 s->slice = s->first_glyph->slice.img;
23563 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
23564 s->font = s->face->font;
23565 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
23567 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
23568 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
23572 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
23574 START is the index of the first glyph to consider,
23575 END is the index of the last + 1.
23577 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
23579 static int
23580 fill_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int end)
23582 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
23583 int voffset, face_id;
23585 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
23587 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
23588 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
23589 face_id = glyph->face_id;
23590 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
23591 s->font = s->face->font;
23592 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
23593 s->nchars = 1;
23594 voffset = glyph->voffset;
23596 for (++glyph;
23597 (glyph < last
23598 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
23599 && glyph->voffset == voffset
23600 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
23601 ++glyph)
23602 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
23604 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
23605 s->ybase += voffset;
23607 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
23608 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
23609 eassert (s->face);
23610 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23613 static struct font_metrics *
23614 get_per_char_metric (struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
23616 static struct font_metrics metrics;
23617 unsigned code;
23619 if (! font)
23620 return NULL;
23621 code = (XCHAR2B_BYTE1 (char2b) << 8) | XCHAR2B_BYTE2 (char2b);
23622 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
23623 return NULL;
23624 font->driver->text_extents (font, &code, 1, &metrics);
23625 return &metrics;
23628 /* EXPORT for RIF:
23629 Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
23630 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
23631 assumed to be zero. */
23633 void
23634 x_get_glyph_overhangs (struct glyph *glyph, struct frame *f, int *left, int *right)
23636 *left = *right = 0;
23638 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
23640 struct face *face;
23641 XChar2b char2b;
23642 struct font_metrics *pcm;
23644 face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
23645 if (face->font && (pcm = get_per_char_metric (face->font, &char2b)))
23647 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
23648 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
23649 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
23650 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
23653 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
23655 if (! glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
23657 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[glyph->u.cmp.id];
23659 if (cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width)
23660 *right = cmp->rbearing - cmp->pixel_width;
23661 if (cmp->lbearing < 0)
23662 *left = - cmp->lbearing;
23664 else
23666 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (glyph->u.cmp.id);
23667 struct font_metrics metrics;
23669 composition_gstring_width (gstring, glyph->slice.cmp.from,
23670 glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1, &metrics);
23671 if (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width)
23672 *right = metrics.rbearing - metrics.width;
23673 if (metrics.lbearing < 0)
23674 *left = - metrics.lbearing;
23680 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23681 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
23682 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
23684 static int
23685 left_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23687 int k;
23689 if (s->left_overhang)
23691 int x = 0, i;
23692 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23693 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23695 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
23696 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23698 k = i + 1;
23700 else
23701 k = -1;
23703 return k;
23707 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23708 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
23709 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
23711 static int
23712 left_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23714 int i, k, x;
23715 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23716 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23718 k = -1;
23719 x = 0;
23720 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
23722 int left, right;
23723 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23724 if (x + right > 0)
23725 k = i;
23726 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23729 return k;
23733 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
23734 overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
23735 no such glyph is found. */
23737 static int
23738 right_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23740 int k = -1;
23742 if (s->right_overhang)
23744 int x = 0, i;
23745 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23746 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs
23747 + (s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH ? 1 : s->nchars));
23748 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23750 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
23751 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23753 k = i;
23756 return k;
23760 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
23761 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
23762 if no such glyph is found. */
23764 static int
23765 right_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23767 int i, k, x;
23768 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23769 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23770 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs
23771 + (s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH ? 1 : s->nchars));
23773 k = -1;
23774 x = 0;
23775 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
23777 int left, right;
23778 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23779 if (x - left < 0)
23780 k = i;
23781 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23784 return k;
23788 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
23789 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
23790 in the drawing area. */
23792 static void
23793 set_glyph_string_background_width (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int last_x)
23795 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
23796 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
23798 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
23799 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
23800 && ((s->row->fill_line_p
23801 && (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
23802 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
23803 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN))
23804 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE))
23805 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
23807 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
23808 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
23809 area. */
23810 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
23811 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
23812 else
23813 s->background_width = s->width;
23817 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
23818 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
23819 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
23821 static void
23822 compute_overhangs_and_x (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int backward_p)
23824 if (backward_p)
23826 while (s)
23828 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23829 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23830 x -= s->width;
23831 s->x = x;
23832 s = s->prev;
23835 else
23837 while (s)
23839 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23840 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23841 s->x = x;
23842 x += s->width;
23843 s = s->next;
23850 /* The following macros are only called from draw_glyphs below.
23851 They reference the following parameters of that function directly:
23852 `w', `row', `area', and `overlap_p'
23853 as well as the following local variables:
23854 `s', `f', and `hdc' (in W32) */
23856 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
23857 /* On W32, silently add local `hdc' variable to argument list of
23858 init_glyph_string. */
23859 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23860 init_glyph_string (s, hdc, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23861 #else
23862 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23863 init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23864 #endif
23866 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
23867 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
23868 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23869 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23870 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23871 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23872 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23874 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
23875 and below -- keep them on one line. */
23876 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23877 do \
23879 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23880 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23881 START = fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, START, END); \
23882 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23883 s->x = (X); \
23885 while (0)
23888 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
23889 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
23890 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23891 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23892 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23893 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23894 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23896 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23897 do \
23899 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23900 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23901 fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
23902 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23903 ++START; \
23904 s->x = (X); \
23906 while (0)
23909 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
23910 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
23911 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
23912 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
23913 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
23914 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
23915 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
23916 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23918 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23919 do \
23921 int face_id; \
23922 XChar2b *char2b; \
23924 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23926 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23927 char2b = alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
23928 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23929 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23930 s->x = (X); \
23931 START = fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23933 while (0)
23936 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
23937 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
23938 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
23939 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
23940 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
23941 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
23942 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
23943 x-position of the drawing area. */
23945 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23946 do { \
23947 int face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23948 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id); \
23949 ptrdiff_t cmp_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id; \
23950 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
23951 XChar2b *char2b; \
23952 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
23953 int n; \
23955 char2b = alloca (cmp->glyph_len * sizeof *char2b); \
23957 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
23958 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
23959 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
23961 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23962 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23963 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23964 s->cmp = cmp; \
23965 s->cmp_from = n; \
23966 s->x = (X); \
23967 if (n == 0) \
23968 first_s = s; \
23969 n = fill_composite_glyph_string (s, base_face, overlaps); \
23972 ++START; \
23973 s = first_s; \
23974 } while (0)
23977 /* Add a glyph string for a glyph-string sequence to the list of strings
23978 between HEAD and TAIL. */
23980 #define BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23981 do { \
23982 int face_id; \
23983 XChar2b *char2b; \
23984 Lisp_Object gstring; \
23986 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23987 gstring = (composition_gstring_from_id \
23988 ((row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id)); \
23989 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23990 char2b = alloca (LGSTRING_GLYPH_LEN (gstring) * sizeof *char2b); \
23991 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23992 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23993 s->x = (X); \
23994 START = fill_gstring_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23995 } while (0)
23998 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of glyphless character's glyphs
23999 to the list of strings between HEAD and TAIL. The meanings of
24000 arguments are the same as those of BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS. */
24002 #define BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
24003 do \
24005 int face_id; \
24007 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
24009 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
24010 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
24011 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
24012 s->x = (X); \
24013 START = fill_glyphless_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
24014 overlaps); \
24016 while (0)
24019 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
24020 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
24021 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
24022 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
24023 x-positions of the drawing area.
24025 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
24026 to allocate glyph strings (because draw_glyphs can be called
24027 asynchronously). */
24029 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
24030 do \
24032 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
24033 while (START < END) \
24035 struct glyph *first_glyph = (row)->glyphs[area] + START; \
24036 switch (first_glyph->type) \
24038 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
24039 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
24040 HL, X, LAST_X); \
24041 break; \
24043 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
24044 if (first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic) \
24045 BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
24046 HL, X, LAST_X); \
24047 else \
24048 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
24049 HL, X, LAST_X); \
24050 break; \
24052 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
24053 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
24054 HL, X, LAST_X); \
24055 break; \
24057 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
24058 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
24059 HL, X, LAST_X); \
24060 break; \
24062 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH: \
24063 BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
24064 HL, X, LAST_X); \
24065 break; \
24067 default: \
24068 emacs_abort (); \
24071 if (s) \
24073 set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
24074 (X) += s->width; \
24077 } while (0)
24080 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
24081 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
24082 face-override with the following meaning:
24084 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
24085 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
24086 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
24087 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
24088 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
24089 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
24091 If OVERLAPS is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters and
24092 clip to the physical height of ROW. Non-zero value also defines
24093 the overlapping part to be drawn:
24095 OVERLAPS_PRED overlap with preceding rows
24096 OVERLAPS_SUCC overlap with succeeding rows
24097 OVERLAPS_BOTH overlap with both preceding/succeeding rows
24098 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR overlap with erased cursor area
24100 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
24102 static int
24103 draw_glyphs (struct window *w, int x, struct glyph_row *row,
24104 enum glyph_row_area area, ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end,
24105 enum draw_glyphs_face hl, int overlaps)
24107 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
24108 struct glyph_string *s;
24109 struct glyph_string *clip_head = NULL, *clip_tail = NULL;
24110 int i, j, x_reached, last_x, area_left = 0;
24111 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
24112 DECLARE_HDC (hdc);
24114 ALLOCATE_HDC (hdc, f);
24116 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
24117 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
24118 start = clip_to_bounds (0, start, end);
24120 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
24121 end of the drawing area. */
24122 if (row->full_width_p)
24124 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
24125 or fringes. */
24126 area_left = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
24127 last_x = (WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w) + WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w)
24128 - (row->mode_line_p ? WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w) : 0));
24130 else
24132 area_left = window_box_left (w, area);
24133 last_x = area_left + window_box_width (w, area);
24135 x += area_left;
24137 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
24138 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
24139 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
24140 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
24141 i = start;
24142 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x);
24143 if (tail)
24144 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
24145 else
24146 x_reached = x;
24148 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
24149 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
24150 strings built above. */
24151 if (head && !overlaps && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
24153 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
24154 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
24155 int mouse_beg_col IF_LINT (= 0), mouse_end_col IF_LINT (= 0);
24156 int check_mouse_face = 0;
24157 int dummy_x = 0;
24159 /* If mouse highlighting is on, we may need to draw adjacent
24160 glyphs using mouse-face highlighting. */
24161 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->mouse_face_p
24162 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row >= 0
24163 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row >= 0)
24165 ptrdiff_t row_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix);
24167 if (row_vpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
24168 && row_vpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
24170 check_mouse_face = 1;
24171 mouse_beg_col = (row_vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row)
24172 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col : 0;
24173 mouse_end_col = (row_vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
24174 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
24175 : row->used[TEXT_AREA];
24179 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
24180 if (FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
24181 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
24182 FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
24184 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
24185 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
24186 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
24187 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
24188 draws over it. */
24189 i = left_overwritten (head);
24190 if (i >= 0)
24192 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
24194 /* If this row contains mouse highlighting, attempt to draw
24195 the overlapped glyphs with the correct highlight. This
24196 code fails if the overlap encompasses more than one glyph
24197 and mouse-highlight spans only some of these glyphs.
24198 However, making it work perfectly involves a lot more
24199 code, and I don't know if the pathological case occurs in
24200 practice, so we'll stick to this for now. --- cyd */
24201 if (check_mouse_face
24202 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
24203 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
24204 else
24205 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
24207 j = i;
24208 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (j, start, h, t,
24209 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
24210 start = i;
24211 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
24212 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
24213 clip_head = head;
24216 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
24217 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
24218 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
24219 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
24220 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
24221 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
24222 strings exist. */
24223 i = left_overwriting (head);
24224 if (i >= 0)
24226 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
24228 if (check_mouse_face
24229 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
24230 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
24231 else
24232 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
24234 clip_head = head;
24235 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, start, h, t,
24236 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
24237 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
24238 s->background_filled_p = 1;
24239 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
24240 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
24243 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
24244 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
24245 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
24246 over it. */
24247 i = right_overwritten (tail);
24248 if (i >= 0)
24250 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
24252 if (check_mouse_face
24253 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
24254 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
24255 else
24256 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
24258 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
24259 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
24260 /* Because BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS updates the first argument,
24261 we don't have `end = i;' here. */
24262 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
24263 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
24264 clip_tail = tail;
24267 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
24268 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
24269 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
24270 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
24271 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
24272 i = right_overwriting (tail);
24273 if (i >= 0)
24275 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
24276 if (check_mouse_face
24277 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
24278 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
24279 else
24280 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
24282 clip_tail = tail;
24283 i++; /* We must include the Ith glyph. */
24284 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
24285 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
24286 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
24287 s->background_filled_p = 1;
24288 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
24289 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
24291 if (clip_head || clip_tail)
24292 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
24294 s->clip_head = clip_head;
24295 s->clip_tail = clip_tail;
24299 /* Draw all strings. */
24300 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
24301 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_glyph_string (s);
24303 #ifndef HAVE_NS
24304 /* When focus a sole frame and move horizontally, this sets on_p to 0
24305 causing a failure to erase prev cursor position. */
24306 if (area == TEXT_AREA
24307 && !row->full_width_p
24308 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
24309 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
24310 completely. */
24311 && !overlaps)
24313 int x0 = clip_head ? clip_head->x : (head ? head->x : x);
24314 int x1 = (clip_tail ? clip_tail->x + clip_tail->background_width
24315 : (tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x));
24316 x0 -= area_left;
24317 x1 -= area_left;
24319 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, TEXT_AREA, x0, x1,
24320 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
24322 #endif
24324 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
24325 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
24326 if (row->full_width_p)
24327 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
24328 else
24329 x_reached -= area_left;
24331 RELEASE_HDC (hdc, f);
24333 return x_reached;
24336 /* Expand row matrix if too narrow. Don't expand if area
24337 is not present. */
24339 #define IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH(it, area) \
24341 if (!it->f->fonts_changed \
24342 && (it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] \
24343 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])) \
24345 it->w->ncols_scale_factor++; \
24346 it->f->fonts_changed = 1; \
24350 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
24351 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
24353 static void
24354 append_glyph (struct it *it)
24356 struct glyph *glyph;
24357 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24359 eassert (it->glyph_row);
24360 eassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
24362 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24363 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24365 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24366 rather than append it. */
24367 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24369 struct glyph *g;
24371 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24372 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24373 g[1] = *g;
24374 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24376 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24377 glyph->object = it->object;
24378 if (it->pixel_width > 0)
24380 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24381 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24383 else
24385 /* Assure at least 1-pixel width. Otherwise, cursor can't
24386 be displayed correctly. */
24387 glyph->pixel_width = 1;
24388 glyph->padding_p = 1;
24390 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
24391 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24392 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24393 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
24394 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24395 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24396 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24398 /* In R2L rows, the left and the right box edges need to be
24399 drawn in reverse direction. */
24400 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24401 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24403 else
24405 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24406 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24408 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
24409 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
24410 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
24411 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24412 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
24413 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
24414 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24415 if (it->bidi_p)
24417 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24418 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24419 emacs_abort ();
24420 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24422 else
24424 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
24425 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
24427 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24429 else
24430 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24433 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_it.id in
24434 IT->glyph_row. Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is
24435 non-null. */
24437 static void
24438 append_composite_glyph (struct it *it)
24440 struct glyph *glyph;
24441 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24443 eassert (it->glyph_row);
24445 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24446 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24448 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24449 rather than append it. */
24450 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
24452 struct glyph *g;
24454 /* Make room for the new glyph. */
24455 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area]; g--)
24456 g[1] = *g;
24457 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area];
24459 glyph->charpos = it->cmp_it.charpos;
24460 glyph->object = it->object;
24461 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24462 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
24463 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24464 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24465 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
24466 if (it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
24468 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 0;
24469 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
24470 glyph->slice.cmp.from = glyph->slice.cmp.to = 0;
24472 else
24474 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 1;
24475 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
24476 glyph->slice.cmp.from = it->cmp_it.from;
24477 glyph->slice.cmp.to = it->cmp_it.to - 1;
24479 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24480 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24481 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24483 /* In R2L rows, the left and the right box edges need to be
24484 drawn in reverse direction. */
24485 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24486 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24488 else
24490 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24491 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24493 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
24494 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
24495 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24496 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24497 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24498 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24499 if (it->bidi_p)
24501 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24502 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24503 emacs_abort ();
24504 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24506 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24508 else
24509 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24513 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
24514 IT->voffset. */
24516 static void
24517 take_vertical_position_into_account (struct it *it)
24519 if (it->voffset)
24521 if (it->voffset < 0)
24522 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
24523 in the line. */
24524 it->ascent -= it->voffset;
24525 else
24526 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
24527 in the line. */
24528 it->descent += it->voffset;
24533 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
24534 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
24535 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
24537 static void
24538 produce_image_glyph (struct it *it)
24540 struct image *img;
24541 struct face *face;
24542 int glyph_ascent, crop;
24543 struct glyph_slice slice;
24545 eassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
24547 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24548 eassert (face);
24549 /* Make sure X resources of the face is loaded. */
24550 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24552 if (it->image_id < 0)
24554 /* Fringe bitmap. */
24555 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = 0;
24556 it->descent = it->phys_descent = 0;
24557 it->pixel_width = 0;
24558 it->nglyphs = 0;
24559 return;
24562 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
24563 eassert (img);
24564 /* Make sure X resources of the image is loaded. */
24565 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
24567 slice.x = slice.y = 0;
24568 slice.width = img->width;
24569 slice.height = img->height;
24571 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.x))
24572 slice.x = XINT (it->slice.x);
24573 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.x))
24574 slice.x = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.x) * img->width;
24576 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.y))
24577 slice.y = XINT (it->slice.y);
24578 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.y))
24579 slice.y = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.y) * img->height;
24581 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.width))
24582 slice.width = XINT (it->slice.width);
24583 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.width))
24584 slice.width = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.width) * img->width;
24586 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.height))
24587 slice.height = XINT (it->slice.height);
24588 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.height))
24589 slice.height = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.height) * img->height;
24591 if (slice.x >= img->width)
24592 slice.x = img->width;
24593 if (slice.y >= img->height)
24594 slice.y = img->height;
24595 if (slice.x + slice.width >= img->width)
24596 slice.width = img->width - slice.x;
24597 if (slice.y + slice.height > img->height)
24598 slice.height = img->height - slice.y;
24600 if (slice.width == 0 || slice.height == 0)
24601 return;
24603 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = glyph_ascent = image_ascent (img, face, &slice);
24605 it->descent = slice.height - glyph_ascent;
24606 if (slice.y == 0)
24607 it->descent += img->vmargin;
24608 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
24609 it->descent += img->vmargin;
24610 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24612 it->pixel_width = slice.width;
24613 if (slice.x == 0)
24614 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
24615 if (slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
24616 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
24618 /* It's quite possible for images to have an ascent greater than
24619 their height, so don't get confused in that case. */
24620 if (it->descent < 0)
24621 it->descent = 0;
24623 it->nglyphs = 1;
24625 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24627 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
24629 if (slice.y == 0)
24630 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
24631 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
24632 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
24635 if (it->start_of_box_run_p && slice.x == 0)
24636 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
24637 if (it->end_of_box_run_p && slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
24638 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
24641 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24643 /* Automatically crop wide image glyphs at right edge so we can
24644 draw the cursor on same display row. */
24645 if ((crop = it->pixel_width - (it->last_visible_x - it->current_x), crop > 0)
24646 && (it->hpos == 0 || it->pixel_width > it->last_visible_x / 4))
24648 it->pixel_width -= crop;
24649 slice.width -= crop;
24652 if (it->glyph_row)
24654 struct glyph *glyph;
24655 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24657 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24658 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24660 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24661 glyph->object = it->object;
24662 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24663 glyph->ascent = glyph_ascent;
24664 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24665 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24666 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
24667 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24668 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24669 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24671 /* In R2L rows, the left and the right box edges need to be
24672 drawn in reverse direction. */
24673 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24674 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24676 else
24678 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24679 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24681 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24682 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24683 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24684 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24685 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
24686 glyph->slice.img = slice;
24687 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24688 if (it->bidi_p)
24690 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24691 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24692 emacs_abort ();
24693 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24695 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24697 else
24698 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24703 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
24704 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
24705 stretch. ASCENT is the ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= HEIGHT). */
24707 static void
24708 append_stretch_glyph (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object,
24709 int width, int height, int ascent)
24711 struct glyph *glyph;
24712 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24714 eassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= height);
24716 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24717 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24719 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24720 rather than append it. */
24721 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24723 struct glyph *g;
24725 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24726 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24727 g[1] = *g;
24728 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24730 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24731 glyph->object = object;
24732 glyph->pixel_width = width;
24733 glyph->ascent = ascent;
24734 glyph->descent = height - ascent;
24735 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24736 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
24737 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24738 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24739 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24741 /* In R2L rows, the left and the right box edges need to be
24742 drawn in reverse direction. */
24743 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24744 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24746 else
24748 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24749 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24751 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24752 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24753 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24754 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24755 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = ascent;
24756 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
24757 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
24758 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24759 if (it->bidi_p)
24761 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24762 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24763 emacs_abort ();
24764 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24766 else
24768 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
24769 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
24771 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24773 else
24774 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24777 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24779 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
24780 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
24781 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
24782 being recognized:
24784 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
24785 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
24786 point number.
24788 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
24789 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
24790 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
24792 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
24793 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
24795 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
24797 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
24798 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
24800 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
24801 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
24802 the glyph property.
24804 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
24806 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
24807 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
24808 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
24810 void
24811 produce_stretch_glyph (struct it *it)
24813 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT ...) */
24814 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
24815 int width = 0, height = 0, align_to = -1;
24816 int zero_width_ok_p = 0;
24817 double tem;
24818 struct font *font = NULL;
24820 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24821 int ascent = 0;
24822 int zero_height_ok_p = 0;
24824 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24826 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24827 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24828 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24830 #endif
24832 /* List should start with `space'. */
24833 eassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
24834 plist = XCDR (it->object);
24836 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
24837 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth), !NILP (prop))
24838 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, 0))
24840 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
24841 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24842 width = (int)tem;
24844 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24845 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
24846 && (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width), NUMVAL (prop) > 0))
24848 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
24849 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
24850 property. */
24851 struct it it2;
24852 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
24854 it2 = *it;
24855 if (it->multibyte_p)
24856 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it2.len);
24857 else
24859 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = *p, it2.len = 1;
24860 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it2.c))
24861 it2.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it2.c);
24864 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
24865 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24866 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
24867 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
24869 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24870 else if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to), !NILP (prop))
24871 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, &align_to))
24873 if (it->glyph_row == NULL || !it->glyph_row->mode_line_p)
24874 align_to = (align_to < 0
24876 : align_to - window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
24877 else if (align_to < 0)
24878 align_to = window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA);
24879 width = max (0, (int)tem + align_to - it->current_x);
24880 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24882 else
24883 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
24884 width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
24886 if (width <= 0 && (width < 0 || !zero_width_ok_p))
24887 width = 1;
24889 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24890 /* Compute height. */
24891 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24893 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight), !NILP (prop))
24894 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24896 height = (int)tem;
24897 zero_height_ok_p = 1;
24899 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
24900 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
24901 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
24902 else
24903 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24905 if (height <= 0 && (height < 0 || !zero_height_ok_p))
24906 height = 1;
24908 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
24909 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
24910 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
24911 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
24912 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
24913 ascent = height * NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
24914 else if (!NILP (prop)
24915 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24916 ascent = min (max (0, (int)tem), height);
24917 else
24918 ascent = (height * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24920 else
24921 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24922 height = 1;
24924 if (width > 0 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
24925 && it->current_x + width > it->last_visible_x)
24927 width = it->last_visible_x - it->current_x;
24928 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24929 /* Subtract one more pixel from the stretch width, but only on
24930 GUI frames, since on a TTY each glyph is one "pixel" wide. */
24931 width -= FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f);
24932 #endif
24935 if (width > 0 && height > 0 && it->glyph_row)
24937 Lisp_Object o_object = it->object;
24938 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
24939 int n = width;
24941 if (!STRINGP (object))
24942 object = it->w->contents;
24943 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24944 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24945 append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
24946 else
24947 #endif
24949 it->object = object;
24950 it->char_to_display = ' ';
24951 it->pixel_width = it->len = 1;
24952 while (n--)
24953 tty_append_glyph (it);
24954 it->object = o_object;
24958 it->pixel_width = width;
24959 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24960 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24962 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = ascent;
24963 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
24964 it->nglyphs = width > 0 && height > 0 ? 1 : 0;
24965 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24967 else
24968 #endif
24969 it->nglyphs = width;
24972 /* Get information about special display element WHAT in an
24973 environment described by IT. WHAT is one of IT_TRUNCATION or
24974 IT_CONTINUATION. Maybe produce glyphs for WHAT if IT has a
24975 non-null glyph_row member. This function ensures that fields like
24976 face_id, c, len of IT are left untouched. */
24978 static void
24979 produce_special_glyphs (struct it *it, enum display_element_type what)
24981 struct it temp_it;
24982 Lisp_Object gc;
24983 GLYPH glyph;
24985 temp_it = *it;
24986 temp_it.object = make_number (0);
24987 memset (&temp_it.current, 0, sizeof temp_it.current);
24989 if (what == IT_CONTINUATION)
24991 /* Continuation glyph. For R2L lines, we mirror it by hand. */
24992 if (it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
24993 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '/');
24994 else
24995 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '\\');
24996 if (it->dp
24997 && (gc = DISP_CONTINUE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24999 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
25000 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
25001 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
25004 else if (what == IT_TRUNCATION)
25006 /* Truncation glyph. */
25007 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '$');
25008 if (it->dp
25009 && (gc = DISP_TRUNC_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
25011 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
25012 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
25013 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
25016 else
25017 emacs_abort ();
25019 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25020 /* On a GUI frame, when the right fringe (left fringe for R2L rows)
25021 is turned off, we precede the truncation/continuation glyphs by a
25022 stretch glyph whose width is computed such that these special
25023 glyphs are aligned at the window margin, even when very different
25024 fonts are used in different glyph rows. */
25025 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (temp_it.f)
25026 /* init_iterator calls this with it->glyph_row == NULL, and it
25027 wants only the pixel width of the truncation/continuation
25028 glyphs. */
25029 && temp_it.glyph_row
25030 /* insert_left_trunc_glyphs calls us at the beginning of the
25031 row, and it has its own calculation of the stretch glyph
25032 width. */
25033 && temp_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
25034 && (temp_it.glyph_row->reversed_p
25035 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)
25036 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)) == 0)
25038 int stretch_width = temp_it.last_visible_x - temp_it.current_x;
25040 if (stretch_width > 0)
25042 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (temp_it.f, temp_it.face_id);
25043 struct font *font =
25044 face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (temp_it.f);
25045 int stretch_ascent =
25046 (((temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent)
25047 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
25049 append_stretch_glyph (&temp_it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
25050 temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent,
25051 stretch_ascent);
25054 #endif
25056 temp_it.dp = NULL;
25057 temp_it.what = IT_CHARACTER;
25058 temp_it.len = 1;
25059 temp_it.c = temp_it.char_to_display = GLYPH_CHAR (glyph);
25060 temp_it.face_id = GLYPH_FACE (glyph);
25061 temp_it.len = CHAR_BYTES (temp_it.c);
25063 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&temp_it);
25064 it->pixel_width = temp_it.pixel_width;
25065 it->nglyphs = temp_it.pixel_width;
25068 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25070 /* Calculate line-height and line-spacing properties.
25071 An integer value specifies explicit pixel value.
25072 A float value specifies relative value to current face height.
25073 A cons (float . face-name) specifies relative value to
25074 height of specified face font.
25076 Returns height in pixels, or nil. */
25079 static Lisp_Object
25080 calc_line_height_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object val, struct font *font,
25081 int boff, int override)
25083 Lisp_Object face_name = Qnil;
25084 int ascent, descent, height;
25086 if (NILP (val) || INTEGERP (val) || (override && EQ (val, Qt)))
25087 return val;
25089 if (CONSP (val))
25091 face_name = XCAR (val);
25092 val = XCDR (val);
25093 if (!NUMBERP (val))
25094 val = make_number (1);
25095 if (NILP (face_name))
25097 height = it->ascent + it->descent;
25098 goto scale;
25102 if (NILP (face_name))
25104 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
25105 boff = FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (it->f);
25107 else if (EQ (face_name, Qt))
25109 override = 0;
25111 else
25113 int face_id;
25114 struct face *face;
25116 face_id = lookup_named_face (it->f, face_name, 0);
25117 if (face_id < 0)
25118 return make_number (-1);
25120 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
25121 font = face->font;
25122 if (font == NULL)
25123 return make_number (-1);
25124 boff = font->baseline_offset;
25125 if (font->vertical_centering)
25126 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
25129 ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
25130 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
25132 if (override)
25134 it->override_ascent = ascent;
25135 it->override_descent = descent;
25136 it->override_boff = boff;
25139 height = ascent + descent;
25141 scale:
25142 if (FLOATP (val))
25143 height = (int)(XFLOAT_DATA (val) * height);
25144 else if (INTEGERP (val))
25145 height *= XINT (val);
25147 return make_number (height);
25151 /* Append a glyph for a glyphless character to IT->glyph_row. FACE_ID
25152 is a face ID to be used for the glyph. FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if
25153 and only if this is for a character for which no font was found.
25155 If the display method (it->glyphless_method) is
25156 GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM or GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE, LEN is a
25157 length of the acronym or the hexadecimal string, UPPER_XOFF and
25158 UPPER_YOFF are pixel offsets for the upper part of the string,
25159 LOWER_XOFF and LOWER_YOFF are for the lower part.
25161 For the other display methods, LEN through LOWER_YOFF are zero. */
25163 static void
25164 append_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int face_id, int for_no_font, int len,
25165 short upper_xoff, short upper_yoff,
25166 short lower_xoff, short lower_yoff)
25168 struct glyph *glyph;
25169 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
25171 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
25172 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
25174 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
25175 rather than append it. */
25176 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
25178 struct glyph *g;
25180 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
25181 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
25182 g[1] = *g;
25183 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
25185 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
25186 glyph->object = it->object;
25187 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
25188 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
25189 glyph->descent = it->descent;
25190 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
25191 glyph->type = GLYPHLESS_GLYPH;
25192 glyph->u.glyphless.method = it->glyphless_method;
25193 glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font = for_no_font;
25194 glyph->u.glyphless.len = len;
25195 glyph->u.glyphless.ch = it->c;
25196 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff = upper_xoff;
25197 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff = upper_yoff;
25198 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff = lower_xoff;
25199 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff = lower_yoff;
25200 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
25201 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
25202 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
25204 /* In R2L rows, the left and the right box edges need to be
25205 drawn in reverse direction. */
25206 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
25207 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
25209 else
25211 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
25212 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
25214 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
25215 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
25216 glyph->padding_p = 0;
25217 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
25218 glyph->face_id = face_id;
25219 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
25220 if (it->bidi_p)
25222 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
25223 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
25224 emacs_abort ();
25225 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
25227 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
25229 else
25230 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
25234 /* Produce a glyph for a glyphless character for iterator IT.
25235 IT->glyphless_method specifies which method to use for displaying
25236 the character. See the description of enum
25237 glyphless_display_method in dispextern.h for the detail.
25239 FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if and only if this is for a character for
25240 which no font was found. ACRONYM, if non-nil, is an acronym string
25241 for the character. */
25243 static void
25244 produce_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int for_no_font, Lisp_Object acronym)
25246 int face_id;
25247 struct face *face;
25248 struct font *font;
25249 int base_width, base_height, width, height;
25250 short upper_xoff, upper_yoff, lower_xoff, lower_yoff;
25251 int len;
25253 /* Get the metrics of the base font. We always refer to the current
25254 ASCII face. */
25255 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id)->ascii_face;
25256 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
25257 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + font->baseline_offset;
25258 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - font->baseline_offset;
25259 base_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
25260 base_width = font->average_width;
25262 face_id = merge_glyphless_glyph_face (it);
25264 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
25266 it->pixel_width = THIN_SPACE_WIDTH;
25267 len = 0;
25268 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
25270 else if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX)
25272 width = CHAR_WIDTH (it->c);
25273 if (width == 0)
25274 width = 1;
25275 else if (width > 4)
25276 width = 4;
25277 it->pixel_width = base_width * width;
25278 len = 0;
25279 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
25281 else
25283 char buf[7];
25284 const char *str;
25285 unsigned int code[6];
25286 int upper_len;
25287 int ascent, descent;
25288 struct font_metrics metrics_upper, metrics_lower;
25290 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
25291 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
25292 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
25294 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
25296 if (! STRINGP (acronym) && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display))
25297 acronym = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, it->c);
25298 if (CONSP (acronym))
25299 acronym = XCAR (acronym);
25300 str = STRINGP (acronym) ? SSDATA (acronym) : "";
25302 else
25304 eassert (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE);
25305 sprintf (buf, "%0*X", it->c < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6, it->c);
25306 str = buf;
25308 for (len = 0; str[len] && ASCII_BYTE_P (str[len]) && len < 6; len++)
25309 code[len] = font->driver->encode_char (font, str[len]);
25310 upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
25311 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, upper_len,
25312 &metrics_upper);
25313 font->driver->text_extents (font, code + upper_len, len - upper_len,
25314 &metrics_lower);
25318 /* +4 is for vertical bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at both side. */
25319 width = max (metrics_upper.width, metrics_lower.width) + 4;
25320 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = 2; /* the typical case */
25321 if (base_width >= width)
25323 /* Align the upper to the left, the lower to the right. */
25324 it->pixel_width = base_width;
25325 lower_xoff = base_width - 2 - metrics_lower.width;
25327 else
25329 /* Center the shorter one. */
25330 it->pixel_width = width;
25331 if (metrics_upper.width >= metrics_lower.width)
25332 lower_xoff = (width - metrics_lower.width) / 2;
25333 else
25335 /* FIXME: This code doesn't look right. It formerly was
25336 missing the "lower_xoff = 0;", which couldn't have
25337 been right since it left lower_xoff uninitialized. */
25338 lower_xoff = 0;
25339 upper_xoff = (width - metrics_upper.width) / 2;
25343 /* +5 is for horizontal bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at
25344 top, bottom, and between upper and lower strings. */
25345 height = (metrics_upper.ascent + metrics_upper.descent
25346 + metrics_lower.ascent + metrics_lower.descent) + 5;
25347 /* Center vertically.
25348 H:base_height, D:base_descent
25349 h:height, ld:lower_descent, la:lower_ascent, ud:upper_descent
25351 ascent = - (D - H/2 - h/2 + 1); "+ 1" for rounding up
25352 descent = D - H/2 + h/2;
25353 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - ld;
25354 upper_yoff = lower_yoff - la - 1 - ud; */
25355 ascent = - (it->descent - (base_height + height + 1) / 2);
25356 descent = it->descent - (base_height - height) / 2;
25357 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - metrics_lower.descent;
25358 upper_yoff = (lower_yoff - metrics_lower.ascent - 1
25359 - metrics_upper.descent);
25360 /* Don't make the height shorter than the base height. */
25361 if (height > base_height)
25363 it->ascent = ascent;
25364 it->descent = descent;
25368 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
25369 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
25370 if (it->glyph_row)
25371 append_glyphless_glyph (it, face_id, for_no_font, len,
25372 upper_xoff, upper_yoff,
25373 lower_xoff, lower_yoff);
25374 it->nglyphs = 1;
25375 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25379 /* RIF:
25380 Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
25381 loaded with. See the description of struct it in dispextern.h
25382 for an overview of struct it. */
25384 void
25385 x_produce_glyphs (struct it *it)
25387 int extra_line_spacing = it->extra_line_spacing;
25389 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
25391 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
25393 XChar2b char2b;
25394 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
25395 struct font *font = face->font;
25396 struct font_metrics *pcm = NULL;
25397 int boff; /* Baseline offset. */
25399 if (font == NULL)
25401 /* When no suitable font is found, display this character by
25402 the method specified in the first extra slot of
25403 Vglyphless_char_display. */
25404 Lisp_Object acronym = lookup_glyphless_char_display (-1, it);
25406 eassert (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS);
25407 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 1, STRINGP (acronym) ? acronym : Qnil);
25408 goto done;
25411 boff = font->baseline_offset;
25412 if (font->vertical_centering)
25413 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
25415 if (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t')
25417 int stretched_p;
25419 it->nglyphs = 1;
25421 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
25423 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
25424 it->descent = it->override_descent;
25425 boff = it->override_boff;
25427 else
25429 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
25430 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
25433 if (get_char_glyph_code (it->char_to_display, font, &char2b))
25435 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25436 if (pcm->width == 0
25437 && pcm->rbearing == 0 && pcm->lbearing == 0)
25438 pcm = NULL;
25441 if (pcm)
25443 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
25444 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
25445 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
25447 else
25449 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
25450 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
25451 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
25452 it->pixel_width = font->space_width;
25455 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
25457 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
25459 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
25460 it->descent = it->max_descent;
25462 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
25464 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
25465 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
25467 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
25468 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
25469 extra_line_spacing = 0;
25472 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
25473 `space-width' property, change its width. */
25474 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
25475 if (stretched_p)
25476 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
25478 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
25479 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
25480 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
25481 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25483 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25485 if (thick > 0)
25487 it->ascent += thick;
25488 it->descent += thick;
25490 else
25491 thick = -thick;
25493 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25494 it->pixel_width += thick;
25495 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25496 it->pixel_width += thick;
25499 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25500 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25501 if (face->overline_p)
25502 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25504 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
25506 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
25507 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
25508 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
25509 it->descent = it->max_descent;
25512 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25514 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
25515 if (it->glyph_row)
25517 if (stretched_p)
25519 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
25520 into a stretch glyph. */
25521 int ascent = (((it->ascent + it->descent) * FONT_BASE (font))
25522 / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
25523 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
25524 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
25526 else
25527 append_glyph (it);
25529 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
25530 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
25531 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
25532 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
25533 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25535 if (! stretched_p && it->pixel_width == 0)
25536 /* We assure that all visible glyphs have at least 1-pixel
25537 width. */
25538 it->pixel_width = 1;
25540 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
25542 /* A newline has no width, but we need the height of the
25543 line. But if previous part of the line sets a height,
25544 don't increase that height. */
25546 Lisp_Object height;
25547 Lisp_Object total_height = Qnil;
25549 it->override_ascent = -1;
25550 it->pixel_width = 0;
25551 it->nglyphs = 0;
25553 height = get_it_property (it, Qline_height);
25554 /* Split (line-height total-height) list. */
25555 if (CONSP (height)
25556 && CONSP (XCDR (height))
25557 && NILP (XCDR (XCDR (height))))
25559 total_height = XCAR (XCDR (height));
25560 height = XCAR (height);
25562 height = calc_line_height_property (it, height, font, boff, 1);
25564 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
25566 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
25567 it->descent = it->override_descent;
25568 boff = it->override_boff;
25570 else
25572 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
25573 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
25576 if (EQ (height, Qt))
25578 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
25580 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
25581 it->descent = it->max_descent;
25583 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
25585 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
25586 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
25588 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
25589 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
25590 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 1;
25591 extra_line_spacing = 0;
25593 else
25595 Lisp_Object spacing;
25597 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
25598 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
25600 if ((it->max_ascent > 0 || it->max_descent > 0)
25601 && face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
25602 && face->box_line_width > 0)
25604 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
25605 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
25607 if (!NILP (height)
25608 && XINT (height) > it->ascent + it->descent)
25609 it->ascent = XINT (height) - it->descent;
25611 if (!NILP (total_height))
25612 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, total_height, font, boff, 0);
25613 else
25615 spacing = get_it_property (it, Qline_spacing);
25616 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, spacing, font, boff, 0);
25618 if (INTEGERP (spacing))
25620 extra_line_spacing = XINT (spacing);
25621 if (!NILP (total_height))
25622 extra_line_spacing -= (it->phys_ascent + it->phys_descent);
25626 else /* i.e. (it->char_to_display == '\t') */
25628 if (font->space_width > 0)
25630 int tab_width = it->tab_width * font->space_width;
25631 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
25632 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
25634 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
25635 stop is less than a space character width, use the
25636 tab stop after that. */
25637 if (next_tab_x - x < font->space_width)
25638 next_tab_x += tab_width;
25640 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
25641 it->nglyphs = 1;
25642 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
25643 it->descent = it->phys_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
25645 if (it->glyph_row)
25647 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
25648 it->ascent + it->descent, it->ascent);
25651 else
25653 it->pixel_width = 0;
25654 it->nglyphs = 1;
25658 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
25660 /* A static composition.
25662 Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
25663 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs.
25665 Important note: pixel_width, ascent, and descent are the
25666 values of what is drawn by draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of
25667 the overall glyphs composed). */
25668 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
25669 int boff; /* baseline offset */
25670 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
25671 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len;
25672 struct font *font = face->font;
25674 it->nglyphs = 1;
25676 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
25677 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
25678 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
25679 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
25680 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This may
25681 lead to incorrect display, but it's very rare, and C-l
25682 (recenter-top-bottom) can correct the display anyway. */
25683 if (! cmp->font || cmp->font != font)
25685 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character
25686 of this composition (adjusted by baseline offset).
25687 Ascent and descent of overall glyphs should not be less
25688 than these, respectively. */
25689 int font_ascent, font_descent, font_height;
25690 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25691 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
25692 int lbearing, rbearing;
25693 int i, width, ascent, descent;
25694 int left_padded = 0, right_padded = 0;
25695 int c IF_LINT (= 0); /* cmp->glyph_len can't be zero; see Bug#8512 */
25696 XChar2b char2b;
25697 struct font_metrics *pcm;
25698 int font_not_found_p;
25699 ptrdiff_t pos;
25701 for (glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; glyph_len > 0; glyph_len--)
25702 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, glyph_len - 1)) != '\t')
25703 break;
25704 if (glyph_len < cmp->glyph_len)
25705 right_padded = 1;
25706 for (i = 0; i < glyph_len; i++)
25708 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
25709 break;
25710 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25712 if (i > 0)
25713 left_padded = 1;
25715 pos = (STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
25716 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
25717 /* If no suitable font is found, use the default font. */
25718 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
25719 if (font_not_found_p)
25721 face = face->ascii_face;
25722 font = face->font;
25724 boff = font->baseline_offset;
25725 if (font->vertical_centering)
25726 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
25727 font_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
25728 font_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
25729 font_height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
25731 cmp->font = font;
25733 pcm = NULL;
25734 if (! font_not_found_p)
25736 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, c, it->face_id,
25737 &char2b, 0);
25738 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25741 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
25742 if (pcm)
25744 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? pcm->width : 0;
25745 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25746 descent = pcm->descent;
25747 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25748 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25750 else
25752 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? font->space_width : 0;
25753 ascent = FONT_BASE (font);
25754 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font);
25755 lbearing = 0;
25756 rbearing = width;
25759 rightmost = width;
25760 leftmost = 0;
25761 lowest = - descent + boff;
25762 highest = ascent + boff;
25764 if (! font_not_found_p
25765 && font->default_ascent
25766 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
25767 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
25768 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
25769 highest = font->default_ascent + boff;
25771 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
25772 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn
25773 at the left. */
25774 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = 0;
25775 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = boff;
25776 cmp->lbearing = lbearing;
25777 cmp->rbearing = rbearing;
25779 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
25780 for (i++; i < glyph_len; i++)
25782 int left, right, btm, top;
25783 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
25784 int face_id;
25785 struct face *this_face;
25787 if (ch == '\t')
25788 ch = ' ';
25789 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch, pos, it->string);
25790 this_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
25791 font = this_face->font;
25793 if (font == NULL)
25794 pcm = NULL;
25795 else
25797 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face_id,
25798 &char2b, 0);
25799 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25801 if (! pcm)
25802 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25803 else
25805 width = pcm->width;
25806 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25807 descent = pcm->descent;
25808 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25809 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25810 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
25812 /* Relative composition with or without
25813 alternate chars. */
25814 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
25815 btm = - descent + boff;
25816 if (font->relative_compose
25817 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
25818 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
25819 make_number (ch)))))
25822 if (- descent >= font->relative_compose)
25823 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25824 btm = highest + 1;
25825 else if (ascent <= 0)
25826 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25827 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
25830 else
25832 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
25833 value that encodes global and new reference
25834 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
25835 specified by numbers as below:
25837 0---1---2 -- ascent
25841 9--10--11 -- center
25843 ---3---4---5--- baseline
25845 6---7---8 -- descent
25847 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
25848 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy, xoff, yoff;
25850 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref, xoff, yoff);
25851 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
25852 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
25853 if (xoff)
25854 xoff = font_height * (xoff - 128) / 256;
25855 if (yoff)
25856 yoff = font_height * (yoff - 128) / 256;
25858 left = (leftmost
25859 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
25860 - nrefx * width / 2
25861 + xoff);
25863 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
25864 : grefy == 1 ? 0
25865 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
25866 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
25867 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
25868 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
25869 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
25870 : (ascent + descent) / 2)
25871 + yoff);
25874 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
25875 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
25877 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25878 if (width > 0)
25880 right = left + width;
25881 if (left < leftmost)
25882 leftmost = left;
25883 if (right > rightmost)
25884 rightmost = right;
25886 top = btm + descent + ascent;
25887 if (top > highest)
25888 highest = top;
25889 if (btm < lowest)
25890 lowest = btm;
25892 if (cmp->lbearing > left + lbearing)
25893 cmp->lbearing = left + lbearing;
25894 if (cmp->rbearing < left + rbearing)
25895 cmp->rbearing = left + rbearing;
25899 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
25900 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
25901 non-negative. */
25902 if (leftmost < 0)
25904 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25905 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
25906 rightmost -= leftmost;
25907 cmp->lbearing -= leftmost;
25908 cmp->rbearing -= leftmost;
25911 if (left_padded && cmp->lbearing < 0)
25913 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25914 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= cmp->lbearing;
25915 rightmost -= cmp->lbearing;
25916 cmp->rbearing -= cmp->lbearing;
25917 cmp->lbearing = 0;
25919 if (right_padded && rightmost < cmp->rbearing)
25921 rightmost = cmp->rbearing;
25924 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
25925 cmp->ascent = highest;
25926 cmp->descent = - lowest;
25927 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
25928 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
25929 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
25930 cmp->descent = font_descent;
25933 if (it->glyph_row
25934 && (cmp->lbearing < 0
25935 || cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width))
25936 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25938 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
25939 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
25940 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
25941 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25943 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25945 if (thick > 0)
25947 it->ascent += thick;
25948 it->descent += thick;
25950 else
25951 thick = - thick;
25953 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25954 it->pixel_width += thick;
25955 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25956 it->pixel_width += thick;
25959 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25960 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25961 if (face->overline_p)
25962 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25964 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25965 if (it->ascent < 0)
25966 it->ascent = 0;
25967 if (it->descent < 0)
25968 it->descent = 0;
25970 if (it->glyph_row && cmp->glyph_len > 0)
25971 append_composite_glyph (it);
25973 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
25975 /* A dynamic (automatic) composition. */
25976 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
25977 Lisp_Object gstring;
25978 struct font_metrics metrics;
25980 it->nglyphs = 1;
25982 gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
25983 it->pixel_width
25984 = composition_gstring_width (gstring, it->cmp_it.from, it->cmp_it.to,
25985 &metrics);
25986 if (it->glyph_row
25987 && (metrics.lbearing < 0 || metrics.rbearing > metrics.width))
25988 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25989 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = metrics.ascent;
25990 it->descent = it->phys_descent = metrics.descent;
25991 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25993 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25995 if (thick > 0)
25997 it->ascent += thick;
25998 it->descent += thick;
26000 else
26001 thick = - thick;
26003 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
26004 it->pixel_width += thick;
26005 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
26006 it->pixel_width += thick;
26008 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
26009 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
26010 if (face->overline_p)
26011 it->ascent += overline_margin;
26012 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
26013 if (it->ascent < 0)
26014 it->ascent = 0;
26015 if (it->descent < 0)
26016 it->descent = 0;
26018 if (it->glyph_row)
26019 append_composite_glyph (it);
26021 else if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
26022 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 0, Qnil);
26023 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
26024 produce_image_glyph (it);
26025 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
26026 produce_stretch_glyph (it);
26028 done:
26029 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
26030 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
26031 eassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
26032 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
26033 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
26035 if (extra_line_spacing > 0)
26037 it->descent += extra_line_spacing;
26038 if (extra_line_spacing > it->max_extra_line_spacing)
26039 it->max_extra_line_spacing = extra_line_spacing;
26042 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
26043 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
26044 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
26045 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
26048 /* EXPORT for RIF:
26049 Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
26050 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. UPDATED_ROW is the glyph row
26051 being updated, and UPDATED_AREA is the area of that row being updated. */
26053 void
26054 x_write_glyphs (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *updated_row,
26055 struct glyph *start, enum glyph_row_area updated_area, int len)
26057 int x, hpos, chpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26059 eassert (updated_row);
26060 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26061 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26062 margin in that case. */
26063 if (!updated_row->reversed_p && chpos < 0)
26064 chpos = 0;
26065 if (updated_row->reversed_p && chpos >= updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26066 chpos = updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26068 block_input ();
26070 /* Write glyphs. */
26072 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
26073 x = draw_glyphs (w, w->output_cursor.x,
26074 updated_row, updated_area,
26075 hpos, hpos + len,
26076 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
26078 /* Invalidate old phys cursor if the glyph at its hpos is redrawn. */
26079 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
26080 && w->phys_cursor_on_p
26081 && w->phys_cursor.vpos == w->output_cursor.vpos
26082 && chpos >= hpos
26083 && chpos < hpos + len)
26084 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26086 unblock_input ();
26088 /* Advance the output cursor. */
26089 w->output_cursor.hpos += len;
26090 w->output_cursor.x = x;
26094 /* EXPORT for RIF:
26095 Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
26097 void
26098 x_insert_glyphs (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *updated_row,
26099 struct glyph *start, enum glyph_row_area updated_area, int len)
26101 struct frame *f;
26102 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
26103 struct glyph_row *row;
26104 struct glyph *glyph;
26105 int frame_x, frame_y;
26106 ptrdiff_t hpos;
26108 eassert (updated_row);
26109 block_input ();
26110 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
26112 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
26113 row = updated_row;
26114 line_height = row->height;
26116 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
26117 shift_by_width = 0;
26118 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
26119 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
26121 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
26122 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
26123 - w->output_cursor.x
26124 - shift_by_width);
26126 /* Shift right. */
26127 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + w->output_cursor.x;
26128 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->output_cursor.y);
26130 FRAME_RIF (f)->shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, frame_x, frame_y, shifted_region_width,
26131 line_height, shift_by_width);
26133 /* Write the glyphs. */
26134 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
26135 draw_glyphs (w, w->output_cursor.x, row, updated_area,
26136 hpos, hpos + len,
26137 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
26139 /* Advance the output cursor. */
26140 w->output_cursor.hpos += len;
26141 w->output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
26142 unblock_input ();
26146 /* EXPORT for RIF:
26147 Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
26148 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
26149 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
26151 TO_X is a pixel position relative to UPDATED_AREA of currently
26152 updated window W. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
26154 void
26155 x_clear_end_of_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *updated_row,
26156 enum glyph_row_area updated_area, int to_x)
26158 struct frame *f;
26159 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
26160 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
26162 eassert (updated_row);
26163 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26165 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
26166 max_x = (WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w)
26167 - (updated_row->mode_line_p ? WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w) : 0));
26168 else
26169 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
26170 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26172 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
26173 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
26174 if (to_x == 0)
26175 return;
26176 else if (to_x < 0)
26177 to_x = max_x;
26178 else
26179 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
26181 to_y = min (max_y, w->output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
26183 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
26184 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
26185 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
26186 w->output_cursor.x, -1,
26187 updated_row->y,
26188 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
26190 from_x = w->output_cursor.x;
26192 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
26193 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
26195 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
26196 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
26198 else
26200 int area_left = window_box_left (w, updated_area);
26201 from_x += area_left;
26202 to_x += area_left;
26205 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
26206 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, w->output_cursor.y));
26207 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
26209 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
26210 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
26212 block_input ();
26213 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, from_x, from_y,
26214 to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y);
26215 unblock_input ();
26219 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26223 /***********************************************************************
26224 Cursor types
26225 ***********************************************************************/
26227 /* Value is the internal representation of the specified cursor type
26228 ARG. If type is BAR_CURSOR, return in *WIDTH the specified width
26229 of the bar cursor. */
26231 static enum text_cursor_kinds
26232 get_specified_cursor_type (Lisp_Object arg, int *width)
26234 enum text_cursor_kinds type;
26236 if (NILP (arg))
26237 return NO_CURSOR;
26239 if (EQ (arg, Qbox))
26240 return FILLED_BOX_CURSOR;
26242 if (EQ (arg, Qhollow))
26243 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
26245 if (EQ (arg, Qbar))
26247 *width = 2;
26248 return BAR_CURSOR;
26251 if (CONSP (arg)
26252 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qbar)
26253 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
26255 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
26256 return BAR_CURSOR;
26259 if (EQ (arg, Qhbar))
26261 *width = 2;
26262 return HBAR_CURSOR;
26265 if (CONSP (arg)
26266 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qhbar)
26267 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
26269 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
26270 return HBAR_CURSOR;
26273 /* Treat anything unknown as "hollow box cursor".
26274 It was bad to signal an error; people have trouble fixing
26275 .Xdefaults with Emacs, when it has something bad in it. */
26276 type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
26278 return type;
26281 /* Set the default cursor types for specified frame. */
26282 void
26283 set_frame_cursor_types (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object arg)
26285 int width = 1;
26286 Lisp_Object tem;
26288 FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f) = get_specified_cursor_type (arg, &width);
26289 FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
26291 /* By default, set up the blink-off state depending on the on-state. */
26293 tem = Fassoc (arg, Vblink_cursor_alist);
26294 if (!NILP (tem))
26296 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f)
26297 = get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (tem), &width);
26298 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
26300 else
26301 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
26303 /* Make sure the cursor gets redrawn. */
26304 f->cursor_type_changed = 1;
26308 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26310 /* Return the cursor we want to be displayed in window W. Return
26311 width of bar/hbar cursor through WIDTH arg. Return with
26312 ACTIVE_CURSOR arg set to 1 if cursor in window W is `active'
26313 (i.e. if the `system caret' should track this cursor).
26315 In a mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we
26316 are reading input from this window. For the selected window, we
26317 want the cursor type given by the frame parameter or buffer local
26318 setting of cursor-type. If explicitly marked off, draw no cursor.
26319 In all other cases, we want a hollow box cursor. */
26321 static enum text_cursor_kinds
26322 get_window_cursor_type (struct window *w, struct glyph *glyph, int *width,
26323 int *active_cursor)
26325 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26326 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->contents);
26327 int cursor_type = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
26328 Lisp_Object alt_cursor;
26329 int non_selected = 0;
26331 *active_cursor = 1;
26333 /* Echo area */
26334 if (cursor_in_echo_area
26335 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
26336 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
26338 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
26340 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt) || NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
26342 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
26343 return FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
26345 else
26346 return get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
26349 *active_cursor = 0;
26350 non_selected = 1;
26353 /* Detect a nonselected window or nonselected frame. */
26354 else if (w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window)
26355 || f != FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
26357 *active_cursor = 0;
26359 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
26360 return NO_CURSOR;
26362 non_selected = 1;
26365 /* Never display a cursor in a window in which cursor-type is nil. */
26366 if (NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
26367 return NO_CURSOR;
26369 /* Get the normal cursor type for this window. */
26370 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt))
26372 cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
26373 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
26375 else
26376 cursor_type = get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
26378 /* Use cursor-in-non-selected-windows instead
26379 for non-selected window or frame. */
26380 if (non_selected)
26382 alt_cursor = BVAR (b, cursor_in_non_selected_windows);
26383 if (!EQ (Qt, alt_cursor))
26384 return get_specified_cursor_type (alt_cursor, width);
26385 /* t means modify the normal cursor type. */
26386 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
26387 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
26388 else if (cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && *width > 1)
26389 --*width;
26390 return cursor_type;
26393 /* Use normal cursor if not blinked off. */
26394 if (!w->cursor_off_p)
26396 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
26398 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
26400 /* Using a block cursor on large images can be very annoying.
26401 So use a hollow cursor for "large" images.
26402 If image is not transparent (no mask), also use hollow cursor. */
26403 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
26404 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
26406 /* Arbitrarily, interpret "Large" as >32x32 and >NxN
26407 where N = size of default frame font size.
26408 This should cover most of the "tiny" icons people may use. */
26409 if (!img->mask
26410 || img->width > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w))
26411 || img->height > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w)))
26412 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
26415 else if (cursor_type != NO_CURSOR)
26417 /* Display current only supports BOX and HOLLOW cursors for images.
26418 So for now, unconditionally use a HOLLOW cursor when cursor is
26419 not a solid box cursor. */
26420 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
26423 return cursor_type;
26426 /* Cursor is blinked off, so determine how to "toggle" it. */
26428 /* First look for an entry matching the buffer's cursor-type in blink-cursor-alist. */
26429 if ((alt_cursor = Fassoc (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Vblink_cursor_alist), !NILP (alt_cursor)))
26430 return get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (alt_cursor), width);
26432 /* Then see if frame has specified a specific blink off cursor type. */
26433 if (FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) != DEFAULT_CURSOR)
26435 *width = FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
26436 return FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f);
26439 #if 0
26440 /* Some people liked having a permanently visible blinking cursor,
26441 while others had very strong opinions against it. So it was
26442 decided to remove it. KFS 2003-09-03 */
26444 /* Finally perform built-in cursor blinking:
26445 filled box <-> hollow box
26446 wide [h]bar <-> narrow [h]bar
26447 narrow [h]bar <-> no cursor
26448 other type <-> no cursor */
26450 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
26451 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
26453 if ((cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR) && *width > 1)
26455 *width = 1;
26456 return cursor_type;
26458 #endif
26460 return NO_CURSOR;
26464 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
26465 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
26466 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
26467 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
26468 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
26469 are window-relative. */
26471 static void
26472 notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area,
26473 int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
26475 int cx0, cx1, cy0, cy1;
26476 struct glyph_row *row;
26478 if (!w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26479 return;
26480 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
26481 return;
26483 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos < 0
26484 || w->phys_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26485 || (row = w->current_matrix->rows + w->phys_cursor.vpos,
26486 !(row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))))
26487 return;
26489 if (row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
26491 row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
26492 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, row->reversed_p);
26493 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26494 return;
26497 cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
26498 cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
26499 if (x0 > cx0 || (x1 >= 0 && x1 < cx1))
26500 return;
26502 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
26503 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
26504 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
26505 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
26506 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
26507 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
26508 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
26509 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
26510 over the cursor image.
26512 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
26513 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
26514 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
26515 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
26516 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
26518 cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
26519 cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
26520 if ((y0 < cy0 || y0 >= cy1) && (y1 <= cy0 || y1 >= cy1))
26521 return;
26523 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26526 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26529 /************************************************************************
26530 Mouse Face
26531 ************************************************************************/
26533 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26535 /* EXPORT for RIF:
26536 Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W
26537 with respect to the overlapping part OVERLAPS. */
26539 void
26540 x_fix_overlapping_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
26541 enum glyph_row_area area, int overlaps)
26543 int i, x;
26545 block_input ();
26547 x = 0;
26548 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
26550 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
26552 int start = i, start_x = x;
26556 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
26557 ++i;
26559 while (i < row->used[area]
26560 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
26562 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area,
26563 start, i,
26564 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, overlaps);
26566 else
26568 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
26569 ++i;
26573 unblock_input ();
26577 /* EXPORT:
26578 Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
26579 comment of draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
26581 void
26582 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
26583 enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
26585 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
26586 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
26587 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
26588 if ((row->reversed_p
26589 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= 0)
26590 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
26592 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
26593 int x1;
26594 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26596 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26597 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26598 window margin in that case. */
26599 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26600 hpos = 0;
26601 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26602 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26604 x1 = draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA, hpos, hpos + 1,
26605 hl, 0);
26606 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
26608 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
26609 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
26610 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
26611 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
26612 are redrawn. */
26613 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
26615 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
26617 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
26618 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
26619 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA,
26620 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
26622 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
26623 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
26624 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA,
26625 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
26631 /* Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
26633 #ifndef HAVE_NTGUI
26634 static
26635 #endif
26636 void
26637 erase_phys_cursor (struct window *w)
26639 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26640 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
26641 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26642 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26643 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
26644 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
26645 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
26646 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
26647 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
26649 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
26650 screen. */
26651 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
26652 goto mark_cursor_off;
26654 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
26655 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
26656 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
26657 goto mark_cursor_off;
26659 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
26660 can do. */
26661 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
26662 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
26663 goto mark_cursor_off;
26665 /* If line spacing is > 0, old cursor may only be partially visible in
26666 window after split-window. So adjust visible height. */
26667 cursor_row->visible_height = min (cursor_row->visible_height,
26668 window_text_bottom_y (w) - cursor_row->y);
26670 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
26671 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
26672 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
26673 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
26674 goto mark_cursor_off;
26676 /* If cursor is in the fringe, erase by drawing actual bitmap there. */
26677 if (cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
26679 cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
26680 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, cursor_row, cursor_row->reversed_p);
26681 goto mark_cursor_off;
26684 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
26685 In this case, either draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
26686 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
26687 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
26688 cursor glyph at hand. */
26689 if ((cursor_row->reversed_p
26690 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
26691 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
26692 goto mark_cursor_off;
26694 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26695 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26696 margin in that case. */
26697 if (!cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26698 hpos = 0;
26699 if (cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26700 hpos = cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26702 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
26703 we clear the cursor. */
26704 if (! NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26705 && coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos)
26706 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
26707 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
26708 mouse highlighting does not. */
26709 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos && hpos >= 0)
26710 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
26712 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
26713 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
26715 int x, y, left_x;
26716 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
26717 int width;
26719 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
26720 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
26721 goto mark_cursor_off;
26723 width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
26724 left_x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA);
26725 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
26726 if (x < left_x)
26727 width -= left_x - x;
26728 width = min (width, window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA) - x);
26729 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height, cursor_row->y));
26730 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, max (x, left_x));
26732 if (width > 0)
26733 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, cursor_row->visible_height);
26736 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
26737 if (mouse_face_here_p)
26738 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
26739 else
26740 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
26741 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
26743 mark_cursor_off:
26744 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26745 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
26749 /* EXPORT:
26750 Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
26751 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
26752 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
26754 void
26755 display_and_set_cursor (struct window *w, bool on,
26756 int hpos, int vpos, int x, int y)
26758 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26759 int new_cursor_type;
26760 int new_cursor_width;
26761 int active_cursor;
26762 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
26763 struct glyph *glyph;
26765 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
26766 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
26767 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
26768 window. */
26769 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
26770 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
26771 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26772 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26773 return;
26775 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
26776 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26777 return;
26779 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26780 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
26781 display the cursor. */
26782 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
26784 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26785 return;
26788 glyph = NULL;
26789 if (!glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
26790 || (0 <= hpos && hpos < glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]))
26791 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
26793 eassert (input_blocked_p ());
26795 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. */
26796 new_cursor_type = get_window_cursor_type (w, glyph,
26797 &new_cursor_width, &active_cursor);
26799 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
26800 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
26801 erase it. */
26802 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
26803 && (!on
26804 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
26805 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
26806 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
26807 || ((new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || new_cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR)
26808 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
26809 erase_phys_cursor (w);
26811 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
26812 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
26813 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
26814 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
26815 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
26816 if (on)
26818 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
26819 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
26821 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
26822 of them may need the information. */
26823 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
26824 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
26825 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
26826 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
26829 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y,
26830 new_cursor_type, new_cursor_width,
26831 on, active_cursor);
26835 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
26836 of ON. */
26838 static void
26839 update_window_cursor (struct window *w, bool on)
26841 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
26842 of being deleted. */
26843 if (w->current_matrix)
26845 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26846 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26847 struct glyph_row *row;
26849 if (vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26850 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26851 return;
26853 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26855 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26856 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26857 window margin in that case. */
26858 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26859 hpos = 0;
26860 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26861 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26863 block_input ();
26864 display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos,
26865 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26866 unblock_input ();
26871 /* Call update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
26872 in the window tree rooted at W. */
26874 static void
26875 update_cursor_in_window_tree (struct window *w, bool on_p)
26877 while (w)
26879 if (WINDOWP (w->contents))
26880 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->contents), on_p);
26881 else
26882 update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
26884 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
26889 /* EXPORT:
26890 Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
26891 Don't change the cursor's position. */
26893 void
26894 x_update_cursor (struct frame *f, bool on_p)
26896 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
26900 /* EXPORT:
26901 Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
26902 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
26903 is about to be rewritten. */
26905 void
26906 x_clear_cursor (struct window *w)
26908 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26909 update_window_cursor (w, 0);
26912 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26914 /* Implementation of draw_row_with_mouse_face for GUI sessions, GPM,
26915 and MSDOS. */
26916 static void
26917 draw_row_with_mouse_face (struct window *w, int start_x, struct glyph_row *row,
26918 int start_hpos, int end_hpos,
26919 enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26921 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26922 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
26924 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
26925 return;
26927 #endif
26928 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS) || defined (WINDOWSNT)
26929 tty_draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, row, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26930 #endif
26933 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_* according to DRAW. */
26935 static void
26936 show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo, enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26938 struct window *w = XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window);
26939 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
26941 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
26942 to do anything. */
26943 w->current_matrix != NULL
26944 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
26945 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
26946 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
26947 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
26948 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
26950 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
26951 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
26953 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
26954 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
26956 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
26958 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
26960 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
26961 if (row == first)
26963 /* R2L rows have BEG and END in reversed order, but the
26964 screen drawing geometry is always left to right. So
26965 we need to mirror the beginning and end of the
26966 highlighted area in R2L rows. */
26967 if (!row->reversed_p)
26969 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26970 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
26972 else if (row == last)
26974 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26975 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26977 else
26979 start_hpos = 0;
26980 start_x = 0;
26983 else if (row->reversed_p && row == last)
26985 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26986 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26988 else
26990 start_hpos = 0;
26991 start_x = 0;
26994 if (row == last)
26996 if (!row->reversed_p)
26997 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26998 else if (row == first)
26999 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
27000 else
27002 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
27003 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
27004 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
27007 else if (row->reversed_p && row == first)
27008 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
27009 else
27011 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
27012 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
27013 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
27016 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
27018 draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, start_x, row,
27019 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
27021 row->mouse_face_p
27022 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
27026 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27027 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
27028 be displayed again. */
27029 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
27030 && phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
27032 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
27034 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
27035 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
27036 window margin in that case. */
27037 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
27038 hpos = 0;
27039 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
27040 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27042 block_input ();
27043 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
27044 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
27045 unblock_input ();
27047 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27050 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27051 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
27052 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27054 #if ! defined (USE_GTK) && ! defined (HAVE_NS)
27055 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
27056 && !EQ (hlinfo->mouse_face_window, f->tool_bar_window))
27057 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor);
27058 else
27059 #endif
27060 if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
27061 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor);
27062 else
27063 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor);
27065 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27068 /* EXPORT:
27069 Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
27070 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
27071 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
27074 clear_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo)
27076 int cleared = 0;
27078 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && !NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
27080 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
27081 cleared = 1;
27084 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
27085 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
27086 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
27087 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
27088 return cleared;
27091 /* Return true if the coordinates HPOS and VPOS on windows W are
27092 within the mouse face on that window. */
27093 static bool
27094 coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w, int hpos, int vpos)
27096 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
27098 /* Quickly resolve the easy cases. */
27099 if (!(WINDOWP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27100 && XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window) == w))
27101 return false;
27102 if (vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
27103 || vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
27104 return false;
27105 if (vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
27106 && vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
27107 return true;
27109 if (!MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p)
27111 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
27113 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
27114 return true;
27116 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
27117 && hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
27118 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
27119 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
27120 return true;
27122 else
27124 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
27126 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col < hpos && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
27127 return true;
27129 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
27130 && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
27131 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
27132 && hpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
27133 return true;
27135 return false;
27139 /* EXPORT:
27140 True if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
27142 bool
27143 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w)
27145 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
27146 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
27147 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27149 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
27150 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
27151 margin in that case. */
27152 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
27153 hpos = 0;
27154 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
27155 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27157 return coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
27162 /* Find the glyph rows START_ROW and END_ROW of window W that display
27163 characters between buffer positions START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS
27164 (excluding END_CHARPOS). DISP_STRING is a display string that
27165 covers these buffer positions. This is similar to
27166 row_containing_pos, but is more accurate when bidi reordering makes
27167 buffer positions change non-linearly with glyph rows. */
27168 static void
27169 rows_from_pos_range (struct window *w,
27170 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
27171 Lisp_Object disp_string,
27172 struct glyph_row **start, struct glyph_row **end)
27174 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27175 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27176 struct glyph_row *row;
27178 *start = NULL;
27179 *end = NULL;
27181 while (!first->enabled_p
27182 && first < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w))
27183 first++;
27185 /* Find the START row. */
27186 for (row = first;
27187 row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y;
27188 row++)
27190 /* A row can potentially be the START row if the range of the
27191 characters it displays intersects the range
27192 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS). */
27193 if (! ((start_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
27194 && end_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
27195 /* See the commentary in row_containing_pos, for the
27196 explanation of the complicated way to check whether
27197 some position is beyond the end of the characters
27198 displayed by a row. */
27199 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
27200 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
27201 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
27202 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
27203 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
27204 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
27205 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
27206 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))))))
27208 /* Found a candidate row. Now make sure at least one of the
27209 glyphs it displays has a charpos from the range
27210 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS).
27212 This is not obvious because bidi reordering could make
27213 buffer positions of a row be 1,2,3,102,101,100, and if we
27214 want to highlight characters in [50..60), we don't want
27215 this row, even though [50..60) does intersect [1..103),
27216 the range of character positions given by the row's start
27217 and end positions. */
27218 struct glyph *g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27219 struct glyph *e = g + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
27221 while (g < e)
27223 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
27224 && start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
27225 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
27226 definition to be highlighted. */
27227 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
27228 *start = row;
27229 g++;
27231 if (*start)
27232 break;
27236 /* Find the END row. */
27237 if (!*start
27238 /* If the last row is partially visible, start looking for END
27239 from that row, instead of starting from FIRST. */
27240 && !(row->enabled_p
27241 && row->y < last_y && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y))
27242 row = first;
27243 for ( ; row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y; row++)
27245 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1;
27246 ptrdiff_t next_start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next);
27248 if (!next->enabled_p
27249 || next >= MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w)
27250 /* The first row >= START whose range of displayed characters
27251 does NOT intersect the range [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS]
27252 is the row END + 1. */
27253 || (start_charpos < next_start
27254 && end_charpos < next_start)
27255 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
27256 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
27257 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
27258 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))
27259 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
27260 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
27261 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
27262 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))))
27264 *end = row;
27265 break;
27267 else
27269 /* If the next row's edges intersect [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS],
27270 but none of the characters it displays are in the range, it is
27271 also END + 1. */
27272 struct glyph *g = next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27273 struct glyph *s = g;
27274 struct glyph *e = g + next->used[TEXT_AREA];
27276 while (g < e)
27278 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
27279 && ((start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
27280 /* If the buffer position of the first glyph in
27281 the row is equal to END_CHARPOS, it means
27282 the last character to be highlighted is the
27283 newline of ROW, and we must consider NEXT as
27284 END, not END+1. */
27285 || (((!next->reversed_p && g == s)
27286 || (next->reversed_p && g == e - 1))
27287 && (g->charpos == end_charpos
27288 /* Special case for when NEXT is an
27289 empty line at ZV. */
27290 || (g->charpos == -1
27291 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
27292 && next_start == end_charpos)))))
27293 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
27294 definition to be highlighted. */
27295 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
27296 break;
27297 g++;
27299 if (g == e)
27301 *end = row;
27302 break;
27304 /* The first row that ends at ZV must be the last to be
27305 highlighted. */
27306 else if (next->ends_at_zv_p)
27308 *end = next;
27309 break;
27315 /* This function sets the mouse_face_* elements of HLINFO, assuming
27316 the mouse cursor is on a glyph with buffer charpos MOUSE_CHARPOS in
27317 window WINDOW. START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS are buffer positions
27318 for the overlay or run of text properties specifying the mouse
27319 face. BEFORE_STRING and AFTER_STRING, if non-nil, are a
27320 before-string and after-string that must also be highlighted.
27321 DISP_STRING, if non-nil, is a display string that may cover some
27322 or all of the highlighted text. */
27324 static void
27325 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (Lisp_Object window,
27326 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
27327 ptrdiff_t mouse_charpos,
27328 ptrdiff_t start_charpos,
27329 ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
27330 Lisp_Object before_string,
27331 Lisp_Object after_string,
27332 Lisp_Object disp_string)
27334 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
27335 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27336 struct glyph_row *r1, *r2;
27337 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
27338 ptrdiff_t ignore, pos;
27339 int x;
27341 eassert (NILP (disp_string) || STRINGP (disp_string));
27342 eassert (NILP (before_string) || STRINGP (before_string));
27343 eassert (NILP (after_string) || STRINGP (after_string));
27345 /* Find the rows corresponding to START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
27346 rows_from_pos_range (w, start_charpos, end_charpos, disp_string, &r1, &r2);
27347 if (r1 == NULL)
27348 r1 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->window_end_vpos);
27349 /* If the before-string or display-string contains newlines,
27350 rows_from_pos_range skips to its last row. Move back. */
27351 if (!NILP (before_string) || !NILP (disp_string))
27353 struct glyph_row *prev;
27354 while ((prev = r1 - 1, prev >= first)
27355 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (prev) == start_charpos
27356 && prev->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0)
27358 struct glyph *beg = prev->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27359 glyph = beg + prev->used[TEXT_AREA];
27360 while (--glyph >= beg && INTEGERP (glyph->object));
27361 if (glyph < beg
27362 || !(EQ (glyph->object, before_string)
27363 || EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)))
27364 break;
27365 r1 = prev;
27368 if (r2 == NULL)
27370 r2 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->window_end_vpos);
27371 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 1;
27373 else if (!NILP (after_string))
27375 /* If the after-string has newlines, advance to its last row. */
27376 struct glyph_row *next;
27377 struct glyph_row *last
27378 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->window_end_vpos);
27380 for (next = r2 + 1;
27381 next <= last
27382 && next->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
27383 && EQ (next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->object, after_string);
27384 ++next)
27385 r2 = next;
27387 /* The rest of the display engine assumes that mouse_face_beg_row is
27388 either above mouse_face_end_row or identical to it. But with
27389 bidi-reordered continued lines, the row for START_CHARPOS could
27390 be below the row for END_CHARPOS. If so, swap the rows and store
27391 them in correct order. */
27392 if (r1->y > r2->y)
27394 struct glyph_row *tem = r2;
27396 r2 = r1;
27397 r1 = tem;
27400 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, w->current_matrix);
27401 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r2, w->current_matrix);
27403 /* For a bidi-reordered row, the positions of BEFORE_STRING,
27404 AFTER_STRING, DISP_STRING, START_CHARPOS, and END_CHARPOS
27405 could be anywhere in the row and in any order. The strategy
27406 below is to find the leftmost and the rightmost glyph that
27407 belongs to either of these 3 strings, or whose position is
27408 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS, and highlight all the
27409 glyphs between those two. This may cover more than just the text
27410 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS if the range of characters
27411 strides the bidi level boundary, e.g. if the beginning is in R2L
27412 text while the end is in L2R text or vice versa. */
27413 if (!r1->reversed_p)
27415 /* This row is in a left to right paragraph. Scan it left to
27416 right. */
27417 glyph = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27418 end = glyph + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
27419 x = r1->x;
27421 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
27422 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (r1))
27423 for (; glyph < end
27424 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27425 && glyph->charpos < 0;
27426 ++glyph)
27427 x += glyph->pixel_width;
27429 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
27430 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
27431 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
27432 for (; glyph < end
27433 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27434 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
27435 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
27436 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
27437 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
27438 ++glyph)
27440 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
27441 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
27442 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
27443 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
27445 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string,
27446 start_charpos);
27447 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
27448 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
27449 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
27450 break;
27452 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
27454 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
27455 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
27456 break;
27458 x += glyph->pixel_width;
27460 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
27461 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27463 else
27465 /* This row is in a right to left paragraph. Scan it right to
27466 left. */
27467 struct glyph *g;
27469 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27470 glyph = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
27472 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
27473 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (r1))
27474 for (; glyph > end
27475 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27476 && glyph->charpos < 0;
27477 --glyph)
27480 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
27481 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
27482 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
27483 for (; glyph > end
27484 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27485 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
27486 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
27487 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
27488 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
27489 --glyph)
27491 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
27492 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
27493 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
27494 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
27496 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
27497 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
27498 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
27499 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
27500 break;
27502 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
27504 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
27505 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
27506 break;
27510 glyph++; /* first glyph to the right of the highlighted area */
27511 for (g = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = r1->x; g < glyph; g++)
27512 x += g->pixel_width;
27513 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
27514 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27517 /* If the highlight ends in a different row, compute GLYPH and END
27518 for the end row. Otherwise, reuse the values computed above for
27519 the row where the highlight begins. */
27520 if (r2 != r1)
27522 if (!r2->reversed_p)
27524 glyph = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27525 end = glyph + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
27526 x = r2->x;
27528 else
27530 end = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27531 glyph = end + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
27535 if (!r2->reversed_p)
27537 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
27538 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
27539 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
27540 while (end > glyph
27541 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object))
27542 --end;
27543 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
27544 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
27545 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
27546 and END_CHARPOS */
27547 for (--end;
27548 end > glyph
27549 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
27550 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
27551 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
27552 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
27553 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
27554 --end)
27556 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
27557 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
27558 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
27559 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
27561 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
27562 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
27563 break;
27565 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
27567 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
27568 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
27569 break;
27572 /* Find the X coordinate of the last glyph to be highlighted. */
27573 for (; glyph <= end; ++glyph)
27574 x += glyph->pixel_width;
27576 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
27577 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = glyph - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27579 else
27581 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
27582 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
27583 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
27584 x = r2->x;
27585 end++;
27586 while (end < glyph
27587 && INTEGERP (end->object))
27589 x += end->pixel_width;
27590 ++end;
27592 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
27593 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
27594 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
27595 and END_CHARPOS */
27596 for ( ;
27597 end < glyph
27598 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
27599 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
27600 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
27601 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
27602 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
27603 ++end)
27605 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
27606 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
27607 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
27608 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
27610 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
27611 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
27612 break;
27614 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
27616 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
27617 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
27618 break;
27620 x += end->pixel_width;
27622 /* If we exited the above loop because we arrived at the last
27623 glyph of the row, and its buffer position is still not in
27624 range, it means the last character in range is the preceding
27625 newline. Bump the end column and x values to get past the
27626 last glyph. */
27627 if (end == glyph
27628 && BUFFERP (end->object)
27629 && (end->charpos < start_charpos
27630 || end->charpos >= end_charpos))
27632 x += end->pixel_width;
27633 ++end;
27635 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
27636 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = end - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27639 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27640 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
27641 = face_at_buffer_position (w, mouse_charpos, &ignore,
27642 mouse_charpos + 1,
27643 !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden, -1);
27644 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27647 /* The following function is not used anymore (replaced with
27648 mouse_face_from_string_pos), but I leave it here for the time
27649 being, in case someone would. */
27651 #if 0 /* not used */
27653 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
27654 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
27655 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
27657 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
27658 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
27660 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
27661 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
27662 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
27663 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
27664 next larger position in OBJECT.
27666 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
27668 static int
27669 fast_find_string_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t pos, Lisp_Object object,
27670 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *x, int *y, int right_p)
27672 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27673 struct glyph_row *r;
27674 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
27675 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
27676 int best_x = 0;
27678 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27679 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
27680 ++r)
27682 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27683 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27684 int gx;
27686 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
27687 if (EQ (g->object, object))
27689 if (g->charpos == pos)
27691 best_glyph = g;
27692 best_x = gx;
27693 best_row = r;
27694 goto found;
27696 else if (best_glyph == NULL
27697 || ((eabs (g->charpos - pos)
27698 < eabs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
27699 && (right_p
27700 ? g->charpos < pos
27701 : g->charpos > pos)))
27703 best_glyph = g;
27704 best_x = gx;
27705 best_row = r;
27710 found:
27712 if (best_glyph)
27714 *x = best_x;
27715 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27717 if (right_p)
27719 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
27720 ++*hpos;
27723 *y = best_row->y;
27724 *vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (best_row, w->current_matrix);
27727 return best_glyph != NULL;
27729 #endif /* not used */
27731 /* Find the positions of the first and the last glyphs in window W's
27732 current matrix that occlude positions [STARTPOS..ENDPOS) in OBJECT
27733 (assumed to be a string), and return in HLINFO's mouse_face_*
27734 members the pixel and column/row coordinates of those glyphs. */
27736 static void
27737 mouse_face_from_string_pos (struct window *w, Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
27738 Lisp_Object object,
27739 ptrdiff_t startpos, ptrdiff_t endpos)
27741 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27742 struct glyph_row *r;
27743 struct glyph *g, *e;
27744 int gx;
27745 int found = 0;
27747 /* Find the glyph row with at least one position in the range
27748 [STARTPOS..ENDPOS), and the first glyph in that row whose
27749 position belongs to that range. */
27750 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27751 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
27752 ++r)
27754 if (!r->reversed_p)
27756 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27757 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27758 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
27759 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27760 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < endpos)
27762 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
27763 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r, w->current_matrix);
27764 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27765 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27766 found = 1;
27767 break;
27770 else
27772 struct glyph *g1;
27774 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27775 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27776 for ( ; g > e; --g)
27777 if (EQ ((g-1)->object, object)
27778 && startpos <= (g-1)->charpos && (g-1)->charpos < endpos)
27780 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
27781 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r, w->current_matrix);
27782 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27783 for (gx = r->x, g1 = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; g1 < g; ++g1)
27784 gx += g1->pixel_width;
27785 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27786 found = 1;
27787 break;
27790 if (found)
27791 break;
27794 if (!found)
27795 return;
27797 /* Starting with the next row, look for the first row which does NOT
27798 include any glyphs whose positions are in the range. */
27799 for (++r; r->enabled_p && r->y < yb; ++r)
27801 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27802 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27803 found = 0;
27804 for ( ; g < e; ++g)
27805 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27806 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < endpos)
27808 found = 1;
27809 break;
27811 if (!found)
27812 break;
27815 /* The highlighted region ends on the previous row. */
27816 r--;
27818 /* Set the end row. */
27819 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r, w->current_matrix);
27821 /* Compute and set the end column and the end column's horizontal
27822 pixel coordinate. */
27823 if (!r->reversed_p)
27825 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27826 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27827 for ( ; e > g; --e)
27828 if (EQ ((e-1)->object, object)
27829 && startpos <= (e-1)->charpos && (e-1)->charpos < endpos)
27830 break;
27831 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - g;
27833 for (gx = r->x; g < e; ++g)
27834 gx += g->pixel_width;
27835 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27837 else
27839 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27840 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27841 for (gx = r->x ; e < g; ++e)
27843 if (EQ (e->object, object)
27844 && startpos <= e->charpos && e->charpos < endpos)
27845 break;
27846 gx += e->pixel_width;
27848 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27849 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27853 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27855 /* See if position X, Y is within a hot-spot of an image. */
27857 static int
27858 on_hot_spot_p (Lisp_Object hot_spot, int x, int y)
27860 if (!CONSP (hot_spot))
27861 return 0;
27863 if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qrect))
27865 /* CDR is (Top-Left . Bottom-Right) = ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1)) */
27866 Lisp_Object rect = XCDR (hot_spot);
27867 Lisp_Object tem;
27868 if (!CONSP (rect))
27869 return 0;
27870 if (!CONSP (XCAR (rect)))
27871 return 0;
27872 if (!CONSP (XCDR (rect)))
27873 return 0;
27874 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x >= XINT (tem)))
27875 return 0;
27876 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y >= XINT (tem)))
27877 return 0;
27878 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x <= XINT (tem)))
27879 return 0;
27880 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y <= XINT (tem)))
27881 return 0;
27882 return 1;
27884 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qcircle))
27886 /* CDR is (Center . Radius) = ((x0 . y0) . r) */
27887 Lisp_Object circ = XCDR (hot_spot);
27888 Lisp_Object lr, lx0, ly0;
27889 if (CONSP (circ)
27890 && CONSP (XCAR (circ))
27891 && (lr = XCDR (circ), INTEGERP (lr) || FLOATP (lr))
27892 && (lx0 = XCAR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (lx0))
27893 && (ly0 = XCDR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (ly0)))
27895 double r = XFLOATINT (lr);
27896 double dx = XINT (lx0) - x;
27897 double dy = XINT (ly0) - y;
27898 return (dx * dx + dy * dy <= r * r);
27901 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qpoly))
27903 /* CDR is [x0 y0 x1 y1 x2 y2 ...x(n-1) y(n-1)] */
27904 if (VECTORP (XCDR (hot_spot)))
27906 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (XCDR (hot_spot));
27907 Lisp_Object *poly = v->contents;
27908 ptrdiff_t n = v->header.size;
27909 ptrdiff_t i;
27910 int inside = 0;
27911 Lisp_Object lx, ly;
27912 int x0, y0;
27914 /* Need an even number of coordinates, and at least 3 edges. */
27915 if (n < 6 || n & 1)
27916 return 0;
27918 /* Count edge segments intersecting line from (X,Y) to (X,infinity).
27919 If count is odd, we are inside polygon. Pixels on edges
27920 may or may not be included depending on actual geometry of the
27921 polygon. */
27922 if ((lx = poly[n-2], !INTEGERP (lx))
27923 || (ly = poly[n-1], !INTEGERP (lx)))
27924 return 0;
27925 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27926 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 2)
27928 int x1 = x0, y1 = y0;
27929 if ((lx = poly[i], !INTEGERP (lx))
27930 || (ly = poly[i+1], !INTEGERP (ly)))
27931 return 0;
27932 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27934 /* Does this segment cross the X line? */
27935 if (x0 >= x)
27937 if (x1 >= x)
27938 continue;
27940 else if (x1 < x)
27941 continue;
27942 if (y > y0 && y > y1)
27943 continue;
27944 if (y < y0 + ((y1 - y0) * (x - x0)) / (x1 - x0))
27945 inside = !inside;
27947 return inside;
27950 return 0;
27953 Lisp_Object
27954 find_hot_spot (Lisp_Object map, int x, int y)
27956 while (CONSP (map))
27958 if (CONSP (XCAR (map))
27959 && on_hot_spot_p (XCAR (XCAR (map)), x, y))
27960 return XCAR (map);
27961 map = XCDR (map);
27964 return Qnil;
27967 DEFUN ("lookup-image-map", Flookup_image_map, Slookup_image_map,
27968 3, 3, 0,
27969 doc: /* Lookup in image map MAP coordinates X and Y.
27970 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
27971 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
27972 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
27973 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
27974 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
27975 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
27976 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
27977 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
27978 Returns the alist element for the first matching AREA in MAP. */)
27979 (Lisp_Object map, Lisp_Object x, Lisp_Object y)
27981 if (NILP (map))
27982 return Qnil;
27984 CHECK_NUMBER (x);
27985 CHECK_NUMBER (y);
27987 return find_hot_spot (map,
27988 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (x), INT_MAX),
27989 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (y), INT_MAX));
27993 /* Display frame CURSOR, optionally using shape defined by POINTER. */
27994 static void
27995 define_frame_cursor1 (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor, Lisp_Object pointer)
27997 /* Do not change cursor shape while dragging mouse. */
27998 if (!NILP (do_mouse_tracking))
27999 return;
28001 if (!NILP (pointer))
28003 if (EQ (pointer, Qarrow))
28004 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
28005 else if (EQ (pointer, Qhand))
28006 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor;
28007 else if (EQ (pointer, Qtext))
28008 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
28009 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hdrag")))
28010 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
28011 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("nhdrag")))
28012 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->vertical_drag_cursor;
28013 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28014 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("vdrag")))
28015 cursor = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
28016 #endif
28017 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hourglass")))
28018 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hourglass_cursor;
28019 else if (EQ (pointer, Qmodeline))
28020 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->modeline_cursor;
28021 else
28022 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
28025 if (cursor != No_Cursor)
28026 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, cursor);
28029 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28031 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
28032 or marginal area AREA of window W, x-position X and y-position Y.
28033 X is relative to the start of the text display area of W, so the
28034 width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted to get a
28035 position relative to the start of the mode line. */
28037 static void
28038 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (Lisp_Object window, int x, int y,
28039 enum window_part area)
28041 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
28042 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28043 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28044 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28045 Display_Info *dpyinfo;
28046 #endif
28047 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
28048 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil;
28049 int dx, dy, width, height;
28050 ptrdiff_t charpos;
28051 Lisp_Object string, object = Qnil;
28052 Lisp_Object pos IF_LINT (= Qnil), help;
28054 Lisp_Object mouse_face;
28055 int original_x_pixel = x;
28056 struct glyph * glyph = NULL, * row_start_glyph = NULL;
28057 struct glyph_row *row IF_LINT (= 0);
28059 if (area == ON_MODE_LINE || area == ON_HEADER_LINE)
28061 int x0;
28062 struct glyph *end;
28064 /* Kludge alert: mode_line_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
28065 returns them in row/column units! */
28066 string = mode_line_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
28067 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
28069 row = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
28070 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
28071 : MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
28073 /* Find the glyph under the mouse pointer. */
28074 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p)
28076 glyph = row_start_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
28077 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
28079 for (x0 = original_x_pixel;
28080 glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width;
28081 ++glyph)
28082 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width;
28084 if (glyph >= end)
28085 glyph = NULL;
28088 else
28090 x -= WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
28091 /* Kludge alert: marginal_area_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
28092 returns them in row/column units! */
28093 string = marginal_area_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
28094 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
28097 help = Qnil;
28099 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28100 if (IMAGEP (object))
28102 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
28103 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCmap),
28104 !NILP (image_map))
28105 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map, dx, dy),
28106 CONSP (hotspot))
28107 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
28109 Lisp_Object plist;
28111 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave this hot-spot.
28112 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
28113 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
28114 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
28115 if (CONSP (hotspot)
28116 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
28118 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
28119 if (NILP (pointer))
28120 pointer = Qhand;
28121 help = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
28122 if (!NILP (help))
28124 help_echo_string = help;
28125 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
28126 help_echo_object = w->contents;
28127 help_echo_pos = charpos;
28131 if (NILP (pointer))
28132 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCpointer);
28134 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28136 if (STRINGP (string))
28137 pos = make_number (charpos);
28139 /* Set the help text and mouse pointer. If the mouse is on a part
28140 of the mode line without any text (e.g. past the right edge of
28141 the mode line text), use the default help text and pointer. */
28142 if (STRINGP (string) || area == ON_MODE_LINE)
28144 /* Arrange to display the help by setting the global variables
28145 help_echo_string, help_echo_object, and help_echo_pos. */
28146 if (NILP (help))
28148 if (STRINGP (string))
28149 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
28151 if (!NILP (help))
28153 help_echo_string = help;
28154 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
28155 help_echo_object = string;
28156 help_echo_pos = charpos;
28158 else if (area == ON_MODE_LINE)
28160 Lisp_Object default_help
28161 = buffer_local_value_1 (Qmode_line_default_help_echo,
28162 w->contents);
28164 if (STRINGP (default_help))
28166 help_echo_string = default_help;
28167 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
28168 help_echo_object = Qnil;
28169 help_echo_pos = -1;
28174 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28175 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under it. */
28176 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
28178 dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
28179 if (STRINGP (string))
28181 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
28183 if (NILP (pointer))
28184 pointer = Fget_text_property (pos, Qpointer, string);
28186 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
28187 if (NILP (pointer)
28188 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE)))
28190 Lisp_Object map;
28191 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
28192 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
28193 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
28194 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
28195 cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
28198 else
28199 /* Default mode-line pointer. */
28200 cursor = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
28202 #endif
28205 /* Change the mouse face according to what is under X/Y. */
28206 if (STRINGP (string))
28208 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (pos, Qmouse_face, string);
28209 if (!NILP (Vmouse_highlight) && !NILP (mouse_face)
28210 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
28211 && glyph)
28213 Lisp_Object b, e;
28215 struct glyph * tmp_glyph;
28217 int gpos;
28218 int gseq_length;
28219 int total_pixel_width;
28220 ptrdiff_t begpos, endpos, ignore;
28222 int vpos, hpos;
28224 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (charpos + 1),
28225 Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
28226 if (NILP (b))
28227 begpos = 0;
28228 else
28229 begpos = XINT (b);
28231 e = Fnext_single_property_change (pos, Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
28232 if (NILP (e))
28233 endpos = SCHARS (string);
28234 else
28235 endpos = XINT (e);
28237 /* Calculate the glyph position GPOS of GLYPH in the
28238 displayed string, relative to the beginning of the
28239 highlighted part of the string.
28241 Note: GPOS is different from CHARPOS. CHARPOS is the
28242 position of GLYPH in the internal string object. A mode
28243 line string format has structures which are converted to
28244 a flattened string by the Emacs Lisp interpreter. The
28245 internal string is an element of those structures. The
28246 displayed string is the flattened string. */
28247 tmp_glyph = row_start_glyph;
28248 while (tmp_glyph < glyph
28249 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
28250 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
28251 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos)))
28252 tmp_glyph++;
28253 gpos = glyph - tmp_glyph;
28255 /* Calculate the length GSEQ_LENGTH of the glyph sequence of
28256 the highlighted part of the displayed string to which
28257 GLYPH belongs. Note: GSEQ_LENGTH is different from
28258 SCHARS (STRING), because the latter returns the length of
28259 the internal string. */
28260 for (tmp_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
28261 tmp_glyph > glyph
28262 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
28263 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
28264 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos));
28265 tmp_glyph--)
28267 gseq_length = gpos + (tmp_glyph - glyph) + 1;
28269 /* Calculate the total pixel width of all the glyphs between
28270 the beginning of the highlighted area and GLYPH. */
28271 total_pixel_width = 0;
28272 for (tmp_glyph = glyph - gpos; tmp_glyph != glyph; tmp_glyph++)
28273 total_pixel_width += tmp_glyph->pixel_width;
28275 /* Pre calculation of re-rendering position. Note: X is in
28276 column units here, after the call to mode_line_string or
28277 marginal_area_string. */
28278 hpos = x - gpos;
28279 vpos = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
28280 ? (w->current_matrix)->nrows - 1
28281 : 0);
28283 /* If GLYPH's position is included in the region that is
28284 already drawn in mouse face, we have nothing to do. */
28285 if ( EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
28286 && (!row->reversed_p
28287 ? (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos
28288 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
28289 /* In R2L rows we swap BEG and END, see below. */
28290 : (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col <= hpos
28291 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
28292 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == vpos )
28293 return;
28295 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
28296 cursor = No_Cursor;
28298 if (!row->reversed_p)
28300 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
28301 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = original_x_pixel
28302 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
28303 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + gseq_length;
28304 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = 0;
28306 else
28308 /* In R2L rows, show_mouse_face expects BEG and END
28309 coordinates to be swapped. */
28310 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos;
28311 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = original_x_pixel
28312 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
28313 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos + gseq_length;
28314 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = 0;
28317 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
28318 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
28319 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
28320 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
28322 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = face_at_string_position (w, string,
28323 charpos,
28324 0, &ignore,
28325 glyph->face_id,
28327 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
28329 if (NILP (pointer))
28330 pointer = Qhand;
28332 else if ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
28333 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28335 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28336 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
28337 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
28338 #endif
28342 /* EXPORT:
28343 Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
28344 frame F with regards to highlighting portions of display that have
28345 mouse-face properties. Also de-highlight portions of display where
28346 the mouse was before, set the mouse pointer shape as appropriate
28347 for the mouse coordinates, and activate help echo (tooltips).
28348 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
28350 void
28351 note_mouse_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
28353 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28354 enum window_part part = ON_NOTHING;
28355 Lisp_Object window;
28356 struct window *w;
28357 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
28358 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil; /* Takes precedence over cursor! */
28359 struct buffer *b;
28361 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
28362 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (MSDOS)
28363 if (popup_activated ())
28364 return;
28365 #endif
28367 if (!f->glyphs_initialized_p
28368 || f->pointer_invisible)
28369 return;
28371 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
28372 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
28373 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
28375 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_defer)
28376 return;
28378 /* Which window is that in? */
28379 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 1);
28381 /* If displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
28382 if (! EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
28383 /* Also clear if we move out of text area in same window. */
28384 || (!NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
28385 && !NILP (window)
28386 && part != ON_TEXT
28387 && part != ON_MODE_LINE
28388 && part != ON_HEADER_LINE))
28389 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28391 /* Not on a window -> return. */
28392 if (!WINDOWP (window))
28393 return;
28395 /* Reset help_echo_string. It will get recomputed below. */
28396 help_echo_string = Qnil;
28398 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
28399 w = XWINDOW (window);
28400 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
28402 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM) && ! defined (USE_GTK) && ! defined (HAVE_NS)
28403 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
28404 buffer. */
28405 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
28407 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
28408 return;
28410 #endif
28412 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
28413 if (part == ON_MODE_LINE || part == ON_HEADER_LINE
28414 || part == ON_LEFT_MARGIN || part == ON_RIGHT_MARGIN)
28416 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (window, x, y, part);
28417 return;
28420 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28421 if (part == ON_VERTICAL_BORDER)
28423 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
28424 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
28426 else if (part == ON_RIGHT_DIVIDER)
28428 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
28429 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
28431 else if (part == ON_BOTTOM_DIVIDER)
28433 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->vertical_drag_cursor;
28434 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
28436 else if (part == ON_LEFT_FRINGE || part == ON_RIGHT_FRINGE
28437 || part == ON_SCROLL_BAR)
28438 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
28439 else
28440 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
28441 #endif
28443 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
28444 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
28445 b = XBUFFER (w->contents);
28446 if (part == ON_TEXT && w->window_end_valid && !window_outdated (w))
28448 int hpos, vpos, dx, dy, area = LAST_AREA;
28449 ptrdiff_t pos;
28450 struct glyph *glyph;
28451 Lisp_Object object;
28452 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, position;
28453 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
28454 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
28455 struct buffer *obuf;
28456 ptrdiff_t obegv, ozv;
28457 int same_region;
28459 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
28460 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &dx, &dy, &area);
28462 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28463 /* Look for :pointer property on image. */
28464 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
28466 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
28467 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
28469 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
28470 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCmap),
28471 !NILP (image_map))
28472 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map,
28473 glyph->slice.img.x + dx,
28474 glyph->slice.img.y + dy),
28475 CONSP (hotspot))
28476 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
28478 Lisp_Object plist;
28480 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave
28481 this hot-spot.
28482 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
28483 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
28484 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
28485 if (CONSP (hotspot)
28486 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
28488 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
28489 if (NILP (pointer))
28490 pointer = Qhand;
28491 help_echo_string = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
28492 if (!NILP (help_echo_string))
28494 help_echo_window = window;
28495 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
28496 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
28500 if (NILP (pointer))
28501 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCpointer);
28504 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28506 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
28507 if (glyph == NULL
28508 || area != TEXT_AREA
28509 || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos))
28510 /* Glyph's OBJECT is an integer for glyphs inserted by the
28511 display engine for its internal purposes, like truncation
28512 and continuation glyphs and blanks beyond the end of
28513 line's text on text terminals. If we are over such a
28514 glyph, we are not over any text. */
28515 || INTEGERP (glyph->object)
28516 /* R2L rows have a stretch glyph at their front, which
28517 stands for no text, whereas L2R rows have no glyphs at
28518 all beyond the end of text. Treat such stretch glyphs
28519 like we do with NULL glyphs in L2R rows. */
28520 || (MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p
28521 && glyph == MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (w->current_matrix, vpos)
28522 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
28523 && glyph->avoid_cursor_p))
28525 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
28526 cursor = No_Cursor;
28527 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28528 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
28530 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
28531 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
28532 else
28533 pointer = Vvoid_text_area_pointer;
28535 #endif
28536 goto set_cursor;
28539 pos = glyph->charpos;
28540 object = glyph->object;
28541 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
28542 goto set_cursor;
28544 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
28545 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
28546 goto set_cursor;
28548 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
28549 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
28550 obuf = current_buffer;
28551 current_buffer = b;
28552 obegv = BEGV;
28553 ozv = ZV;
28554 BEGV = BEG;
28555 ZV = Z;
28557 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
28558 position = make_number (pos);
28560 if (BUFFERP (object))
28562 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec. */
28563 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlay_vec, noverlays, NULL, 0);
28564 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
28565 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
28567 else
28568 noverlays = 0;
28570 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight))
28572 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28573 goto check_help_echo;
28576 same_region = coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
28578 if (same_region)
28579 cursor = No_Cursor;
28581 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
28582 if (! same_region
28583 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
28584 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
28585 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
28586 highlight only that. */
28587 || (OVERLAYP (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
28588 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
28590 /* Find the highest priority overlay with a mouse-face. */
28591 Lisp_Object overlay = Qnil;
28592 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
28594 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
28595 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
28596 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
28599 /* If we're highlighting the same overlay as before, there's
28600 no need to do that again. */
28601 if (!NILP (overlay) && EQ (overlay, hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
28602 goto check_help_echo;
28603 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
28605 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
28606 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
28607 cursor = No_Cursor;
28609 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
28610 if (NILP (overlay))
28611 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
28613 /* Next, compute the bounds of the mouse highlighting and
28614 display it. */
28615 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
28617 /* The mouse-highlighting comes from a display string
28618 with a mouse-face. */
28619 Lisp_Object s, e;
28620 ptrdiff_t ignore;
28622 s = Fprevious_single_property_change
28623 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
28624 e = Fnext_single_property_change
28625 (position, Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
28626 if (NILP (s))
28627 s = make_number (0);
28628 if (NILP (e))
28629 e = make_number (SCHARS (object));
28630 mouse_face_from_string_pos (w, hlinfo, object,
28631 XINT (s), XINT (e));
28632 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
28633 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
28634 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
28635 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, &ignore,
28636 glyph->face_id, 1);
28637 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
28638 cursor = No_Cursor;
28640 else
28642 /* The mouse-highlighting, if any, comes from an overlay
28643 or text property in the buffer. */
28644 Lisp_Object buffer IF_LINT (= Qnil);
28645 Lisp_Object disp_string IF_LINT (= Qnil);
28647 if (STRINGP (object))
28649 /* If we are on a display string with no mouse-face,
28650 check if the text under it has one. */
28651 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28652 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28653 pos = string_buffer_position (object, start);
28654 if (pos > 0)
28656 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay
28657 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, w->contents, &overlay);
28658 buffer = w->contents;
28659 disp_string = object;
28662 else
28664 buffer = object;
28665 disp_string = Qnil;
28668 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
28670 Lisp_Object before, after;
28671 Lisp_Object before_string, after_string;
28672 /* To correctly find the limits of mouse highlight
28673 in a bidi-reordered buffer, we must not use the
28674 optimization of limiting the search in
28675 previous-single-property-change and
28676 next-single-property-change, because
28677 rows_from_pos_range needs the real start and end
28678 positions to DTRT in this case. That's because
28679 the first row visible in a window does not
28680 necessarily display the character whose position
28681 is the smallest. */
28682 Lisp_Object lim1
28683 = NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
28684 ? Fmarker_position (w->start)
28685 : Qnil;
28686 Lisp_Object lim2
28687 = NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
28688 ? make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
28689 - w->window_end_pos)
28690 : Qnil;
28692 if (NILP (overlay))
28694 /* Handle the text property case. */
28695 before = Fprevious_single_property_change
28696 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim1);
28697 after = Fnext_single_property_change
28698 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim2);
28699 before_string = after_string = Qnil;
28701 else
28703 /* Handle the overlay case. */
28704 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
28705 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
28706 before_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string);
28707 after_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string);
28709 if (!STRINGP (before_string)) before_string = Qnil;
28710 if (!STRINGP (after_string)) after_string = Qnil;
28713 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (window, hlinfo, pos,
28714 NILP (before)
28716 : XFASTINT (before),
28717 NILP (after)
28718 ? BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
28719 : XFASTINT (after),
28720 before_string, after_string,
28721 disp_string);
28722 cursor = No_Cursor;
28727 check_help_echo:
28729 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
28730 if (NILP (help_echo_string)) {
28731 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
28733 /* Check overlays first. */
28734 help = overlay = Qnil;
28735 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
28737 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
28738 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
28741 if (!NILP (help))
28743 help_echo_string = help;
28744 help_echo_window = window;
28745 help_echo_object = overlay;
28746 help_echo_pos = pos;
28748 else
28750 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28751 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28753 /* Try text properties. */
28754 if (STRINGP (obj)
28755 && charpos >= 0
28756 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28758 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28759 Qhelp_echo, obj);
28760 if (NILP (help))
28762 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
28763 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28764 struct glyph_row *r
28765 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28766 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28767 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28768 if (p > 0)
28770 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28771 Qhelp_echo, w->contents);
28772 if (!NILP (help))
28774 charpos = p;
28775 obj = w->contents;
28780 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28781 && charpos >= BEGV
28782 && charpos < ZV)
28783 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
28784 obj);
28786 if (!NILP (help))
28788 help_echo_string = help;
28789 help_echo_window = window;
28790 help_echo_object = obj;
28791 help_echo_pos = charpos;
28796 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28797 /* Look for a `pointer' property. */
28798 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
28800 /* Check overlays first. */
28801 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (pointer); --i)
28802 pointer = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qpointer);
28804 if (NILP (pointer))
28806 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28807 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28809 /* Try text properties. */
28810 if (STRINGP (obj)
28811 && charpos >= 0
28812 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28814 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28815 Qpointer, obj);
28816 if (NILP (pointer))
28818 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a pointer,
28819 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28820 struct glyph_row *r
28821 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28822 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28823 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28824 if (p > 0)
28825 pointer = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28826 Qpointer, w->contents);
28829 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28830 && charpos >= BEGV
28831 && charpos < ZV)
28832 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28833 Qpointer, obj);
28836 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28838 BEGV = obegv;
28839 ZV = ozv;
28840 current_buffer = obuf;
28843 set_cursor:
28845 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28846 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
28847 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
28848 #else
28849 /* This is here to prevent a compiler error, about "label at end of
28850 compound statement". */
28851 return;
28852 #endif
28856 /* EXPORT for RIF:
28857 Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
28858 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
28859 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
28861 void
28862 x_clear_window_mouse_face (struct window *w)
28864 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
28865 Lisp_Object window;
28867 block_input ();
28868 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
28869 if (EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
28870 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28871 unblock_input ();
28875 /* EXPORT:
28876 Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
28877 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
28879 void
28880 cancel_mouse_face (struct frame *f)
28882 Lisp_Object window;
28883 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28885 window = hlinfo->mouse_face_window;
28886 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
28887 reset_mouse_highlight (hlinfo);
28892 /***********************************************************************
28893 Exposure Events
28894 ***********************************************************************/
28896 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28898 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
28899 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
28901 static void
28902 expose_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r,
28903 enum glyph_row_area area)
28905 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
28906 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
28907 struct glyph *last;
28908 int first_x, start_x, x;
28910 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
28911 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
28912 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area,
28913 0, row->used[area],
28914 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28915 else
28917 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
28918 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
28919 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
28920 start_x = window_box_left_offset (w, area);
28921 x = start_x;
28922 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
28923 x += row->x;
28925 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
28926 while (first < end
28927 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
28929 x += first->pixel_width;
28930 ++first;
28933 /* Find the last one. */
28934 last = first;
28935 first_x = x;
28936 while (last < end
28937 && x < r->x + r->width)
28939 x += last->pixel_width;
28940 ++last;
28943 /* Repaint. */
28944 if (last > first)
28945 draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
28946 first - row->glyphs[area], last - row->glyphs[area],
28947 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28952 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
28953 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
28954 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
28956 static int
28957 expose_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r)
28959 eassert (row->enabled_p);
28961 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
28962 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA,
28963 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
28964 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28965 else
28967 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28968 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
28969 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28970 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
28971 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28972 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
28973 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
28976 return row->mouse_face_p;
28980 /* Redraw those parts of glyphs rows during expose event handling that
28981 overlap other rows. Redrawing of an exposed line writes over parts
28982 of lines overlapping that exposed line; this function fixes that.
28984 W is the window being exposed. FIRST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the first
28985 row in W's current matrix that is exposed and overlaps other rows.
28986 LAST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the last such row. */
28988 static void
28989 expose_overlaps (struct window *w,
28990 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row,
28991 struct glyph_row *last_overlapping_row,
28992 XRectangle *r)
28994 struct glyph_row *row;
28996 for (row = first_overlapping_row; row <= last_overlapping_row; ++row)
28997 if (row->overlapping_p)
28999 eassert (row->enabled_p && !row->mode_line_p);
29001 row->clip = r;
29002 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
29003 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
29005 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
29006 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
29008 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
29009 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
29010 row->clip = NULL;
29015 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
29017 static int
29018 phys_cursor_in_rect_p (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
29020 XRectangle cr, result;
29021 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
29022 struct glyph_row *row;
29024 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos >= 0
29025 && w->phys_cursor.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows
29026 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos),
29027 row->enabled_p)
29028 && row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
29030 /* Cursor is in the fringe. */
29031 cr.x = window_box_right_offset (w,
29032 (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
29033 ? RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
29034 : TEXT_AREA));
29035 cr.y = row->y;
29036 cr.width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
29037 cr.height = row->height;
29038 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
29041 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
29042 if (cursor_glyph)
29044 /* r is relative to W's box, but w->phys_cursor.x is relative
29045 to left edge of W's TEXT area. Adjust it. */
29046 cr.x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + w->phys_cursor.x;
29047 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
29048 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
29049 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
29050 /* ++KFS: W32 version used W32-specific IntersectRect here, but
29051 I assume the effect is the same -- and this is portable. */
29052 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
29054 /* If we don't understand the format, pretend we're not in the hot-spot. */
29055 return 0;
29059 /* EXPORT:
29060 Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
29061 have vertical scroll bars. */
29063 void
29064 x_draw_vertical_border (struct window *w)
29066 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
29068 /* We could do better, if we knew what type of scroll-bar the adjacent
29069 windows (on either side) have... But we don't :-(
29070 However, I think this works ok. ++KFS 2003-04-25 */
29072 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
29073 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
29074 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
29075 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
29076 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f) || FRAME_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (f))
29077 return;
29079 /* Note: It is necessary to redraw both the left and the right
29080 borders, for when only this single window W is being
29081 redisplayed. */
29082 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
29083 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
29085 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
29087 window_box_edges (w, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
29088 y1 -= 1;
29090 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
29091 x1 -= 1;
29093 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x1, y0, y1);
29096 if (!WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
29097 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
29099 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
29101 window_box_edges (w, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
29102 y1 -= 1;
29104 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
29105 x0 -= 1;
29107 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x0, y0, y1);
29112 /* Draw window dividers for window W. */
29114 void
29115 x_draw_right_divider (struct window *w)
29117 struct frame *f = WINDOW_XFRAME (w);
29119 if (w->mini || w->pseudo_window_p)
29120 return;
29121 else if (WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
29123 int x0 = WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (w) - WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w);
29124 int x1 = WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (w);
29125 int y0 = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
29126 int y1 = WINDOW_BOTTOM_EDGE_Y (w);
29128 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_divider (w, x0, x1, y0, y1);
29132 static void
29133 x_draw_bottom_divider (struct window *w)
29135 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
29137 if (w->mini || w->pseudo_window_p)
29138 return;
29139 else if (WINDOW_BOTTOM_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
29141 int x0 = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
29142 int x1 = WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (w);
29143 int y0 = WINDOW_BOTTOM_EDGE_Y (w) - WINDOW_BOTTOM_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w);
29144 int y1 = WINDOW_BOTTOM_EDGE_Y (w);
29146 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_divider (w, x0, x1, y0, y1);
29150 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
29151 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
29152 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
29153 mouse-face. */
29155 static int
29156 expose_window (struct window *w, XRectangle *fr)
29158 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
29159 XRectangle wr, r;
29160 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
29162 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
29163 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
29164 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
29165 created window. */
29166 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
29167 return 0;
29169 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
29170 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
29171 later. */
29172 if (w->must_be_updated_p)
29174 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
29175 return 0;
29178 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
29179 wr.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
29180 wr.y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
29181 wr.width = WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w);
29182 wr.height = WINDOW_PIXEL_HEIGHT (w);
29184 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
29186 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
29187 struct glyph_row *row;
29188 int cursor_cleared_p, phys_cursor_on_p;
29189 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row, *last_overlapping_row;
29191 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
29192 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
29194 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
29195 r.x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
29196 r.y -= WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
29198 /* Turn off the cursor. */
29199 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
29200 && phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
29202 x_clear_cursor (w);
29203 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
29205 else
29206 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
29208 /* If the row containing the cursor extends face to end of line,
29209 then expose_area might overwrite the cursor outside the
29210 rectangle and thus notice_overwritten_cursor might clear
29211 w->phys_cursor_on_p. We remember the original value and
29212 check later if it is changed. */
29213 phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
29215 /* Update lines intersecting rectangle R. */
29216 first_overlapping_row = last_overlapping_row = NULL;
29217 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
29218 row->enabled_p;
29219 ++row)
29221 int y0 = row->y;
29222 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
29224 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
29225 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
29226 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
29227 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
29229 /* A header line may be overlapping, but there is no need
29230 to fix overlapping areas for them. KFS 2005-02-12 */
29231 if (row->overlapping_p && !row->mode_line_p)
29233 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
29234 first_overlapping_row = row;
29235 last_overlapping_row = row;
29238 row->clip = fr;
29239 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
29240 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
29241 row->clip = NULL;
29243 else if (row->overlapping_p)
29245 /* We must redraw a row overlapping the exposed area. */
29246 if (y0 < r.y
29247 ? y0 + row->phys_height > r.y
29248 : y0 + row->ascent - row->phys_ascent < r.y +r.height)
29250 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
29251 first_overlapping_row = row;
29252 last_overlapping_row = row;
29256 if (y1 >= yb)
29257 break;
29260 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
29261 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
29262 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
29263 row->enabled_p)
29264 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
29266 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
29267 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
29270 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
29272 /* Fix the display of overlapping rows. */
29273 if (first_overlapping_row)
29274 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row,
29275 fr);
29277 /* Draw border between windows. */
29278 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
29279 x_draw_right_divider (w);
29280 else
29281 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
29283 if (WINDOW_BOTTOM_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
29284 x_draw_bottom_divider (w);
29286 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
29287 if (cursor_cleared_p
29288 || (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p))
29289 update_window_cursor (w, 1);
29293 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
29298 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
29299 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
29300 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
29302 static int
29303 expose_window_tree (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
29305 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
29306 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
29308 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
29310 if (WINDOWP (w->contents))
29311 mouse_face_overwritten_p
29312 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->contents), r);
29313 else
29314 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
29316 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
29319 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
29323 /* EXPORT:
29324 Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
29325 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
29326 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
29327 the entire frame. */
29329 void
29330 expose_frame (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int w, int h)
29332 XRectangle r;
29333 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
29335 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
29337 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
29338 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
29340 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
29341 return;
29344 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
29345 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
29346 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
29347 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
29348 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
29350 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
29351 return;
29354 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
29356 r.x = r.y = 0;
29357 r.width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) * FRAME_COLS (f);
29358 r.height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f);
29360 else
29362 r.x = x;
29363 r.y = y;
29364 r.width = w;
29365 r.height = h;
29368 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
29369 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
29371 #if ! defined (USE_GTK) && ! defined (HAVE_NS)
29372 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
29373 mouse_face_overwritten_p
29374 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
29375 #endif
29377 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29378 #ifndef MSDOS
29379 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
29380 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
29381 mouse_face_overwritten_p
29382 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
29383 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT and not USE_GTK */
29384 #endif
29385 #endif
29387 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
29388 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
29389 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
29390 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
29391 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
29392 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
29393 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
29394 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
29395 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
29396 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
29397 /* Included in Windows version because Windows most likely does not
29398 do the right thing if any third party tool offers
29399 focus-follows-mouse with delayed raise. --jason 2001-10-12 */
29400 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
29402 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
29403 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
29405 int mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
29406 int mouse_y = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
29407 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
29408 note_mouse_highlight (f, mouse_x, mouse_y);
29414 /* EXPORT:
29415 Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
29416 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
29417 empty. */
29420 x_intersect_rectangles (XRectangle *r1, XRectangle *r2, XRectangle *result)
29422 XRectangle *left, *right;
29423 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
29424 int intersection_p = 0;
29426 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
29427 if (r1->x < r2->x)
29428 left = r1, right = r2;
29429 else
29430 left = r2, right = r1;
29432 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
29433 otherwise there is no intersection. */
29434 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
29436 result->x = right->x;
29438 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of
29439 the right ends of left and right. */
29440 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
29441 - result->x);
29443 /* Same game for Y. */
29444 if (r1->y < r2->y)
29445 upper = r1, lower = r2;
29446 else
29447 upper = r2, lower = r1;
29449 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
29450 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
29451 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
29453 result->y = lower->y;
29455 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
29456 ends of upper and lower. */
29457 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
29458 upper->y + upper->height)
29459 - result->y);
29460 intersection_p = 1;
29464 return intersection_p;
29467 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
29470 /***********************************************************************
29471 Initialization
29472 ***********************************************************************/
29474 void
29475 syms_of_xdisp (void)
29477 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
29478 staticpro (&Vwith_echo_area_save_vector);
29480 Vmessage_stack = Qnil;
29481 staticpro (&Vmessage_stack);
29483 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_redisplay, "inhibit-redisplay");
29484 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_internal, "redisplay_internal (C function)");
29486 message_dolog_marker1 = Fmake_marker ();
29487 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker1);
29488 message_dolog_marker2 = Fmake_marker ();
29489 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker2);
29490 message_dolog_marker3 = Fmake_marker ();
29491 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker3);
29493 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
29494 defsubr (&Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix);
29495 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_matrix);
29496 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_row);
29497 defsubr (&Sdump_tool_bar_row);
29498 defsubr (&Strace_redisplay);
29499 defsubr (&Strace_to_stderr);
29500 #endif
29501 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
29502 defsubr (&Stool_bar_height);
29503 defsubr (&Slookup_image_map);
29504 #endif
29505 defsubr (&Sline_pixel_height);
29506 defsubr (&Sformat_mode_line);
29507 defsubr (&Sinvisible_p);
29508 defsubr (&Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction);
29509 defsubr (&Swindow_text_pixel_size);
29510 defsubr (&Smove_point_visually);
29512 DEFSYM (Qmenu_bar_update_hook, "menu-bar-update-hook");
29513 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, "overriding-terminal-local-map");
29514 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_local_map, "overriding-local-map");
29515 DEFSYM (Qwindow_scroll_functions, "window-scroll-functions");
29516 DEFSYM (Qwindow_text_change_functions, "window-text-change-functions");
29517 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions, "redisplay-end-trigger-functions");
29518 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, "inhibit-point-motion-hooks");
29519 DEFSYM (Qeval, "eval");
29520 DEFSYM (QCdata, ":data");
29521 DEFSYM (Qdisplay, "display");
29522 DEFSYM (Qspace_width, "space-width");
29523 DEFSYM (Qraise, "raise");
29524 DEFSYM (Qslice, "slice");
29525 DEFSYM (Qspace, "space");
29526 DEFSYM (Qmargin, "margin");
29527 DEFSYM (Qpointer, "pointer");
29528 DEFSYM (Qleft_margin, "left-margin");
29529 DEFSYM (Qright_margin, "right-margin");
29530 DEFSYM (Qcenter, "center");
29531 DEFSYM (Qline_height, "line-height");
29532 DEFSYM (QCalign_to, ":align-to");
29533 DEFSYM (QCrelative_width, ":relative-width");
29534 DEFSYM (QCrelative_height, ":relative-height");
29535 DEFSYM (QCeval, ":eval");
29536 DEFSYM (QCpropertize, ":propertize");
29537 DEFSYM (QCfile, ":file");
29538 DEFSYM (Qfontified, "fontified");
29539 DEFSYM (Qfontification_functions, "fontification-functions");
29540 DEFSYM (Qtrailing_whitespace, "trailing-whitespace");
29541 DEFSYM (Qescape_glyph, "escape-glyph");
29542 DEFSYM (Qnobreak_space, "nobreak-space");
29543 DEFSYM (Qimage, "image");
29544 DEFSYM (Qtext, "text");
29545 DEFSYM (Qboth, "both");
29546 DEFSYM (Qboth_horiz, "both-horiz");
29547 DEFSYM (Qtext_image_horiz, "text-image-horiz");
29548 DEFSYM (QCmap, ":map");
29549 DEFSYM (QCpointer, ":pointer");
29550 DEFSYM (Qrect, "rect");
29551 DEFSYM (Qcircle, "circle");
29552 DEFSYM (Qpoly, "poly");
29553 DEFSYM (Qmessage_truncate_lines, "message-truncate-lines");
29554 DEFSYM (Qgrow_only, "grow-only");
29555 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_menubar_update, "inhibit-menubar-update");
29556 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay, "inhibit-eval-during-redisplay");
29557 DEFSYM (Qposition, "position");
29558 DEFSYM (Qbuffer_position, "buffer-position");
29559 DEFSYM (Qobject, "object");
29560 DEFSYM (Qbar, "bar");
29561 DEFSYM (Qhbar, "hbar");
29562 DEFSYM (Qbox, "box");
29563 DEFSYM (Qhollow, "hollow");
29564 DEFSYM (Qhand, "hand");
29565 DEFSYM (Qarrow, "arrow");
29566 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, "inhibit-free-realized-faces");
29568 list_of_error = list1 (list2 (intern_c_string ("error"),
29569 intern_c_string ("void-variable")));
29570 staticpro (&list_of_error);
29572 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_position, "last-arrow-position");
29573 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_string, "last-arrow-string");
29574 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_string, "overlay-arrow-string");
29575 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap, "overlay-arrow-bitmap");
29577 echo_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1] = Qnil;
29578 staticpro (&echo_buffer[0]);
29579 staticpro (&echo_buffer[1]);
29581 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
29582 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[0]);
29583 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[1]);
29585 Vmessages_buffer_name = build_pure_c_string ("*Messages*");
29586 staticpro (&Vmessages_buffer_name);
29588 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
29589 staticpro (&mode_line_proptrans_alist);
29590 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
29591 staticpro (&mode_line_string_list);
29592 mode_line_string_face = Qnil;
29593 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face);
29594 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
29595 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face_prop);
29596 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
29597 staticpro (&Vmode_line_unwind_vector);
29599 DEFSYM (Qmode_line_default_help_echo, "mode-line-default-help-echo");
29601 help_echo_string = Qnil;
29602 staticpro (&help_echo_string);
29603 help_echo_object = Qnil;
29604 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
29605 help_echo_window = Qnil;
29606 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
29607 previous_help_echo_string = Qnil;
29608 staticpro (&previous_help_echo_string);
29609 help_echo_pos = -1;
29611 DEFSYM (Qright_to_left, "right-to-left");
29612 DEFSYM (Qleft_to_right, "left-to-right");
29614 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
29615 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", x_stretch_cursor_p,
29616 doc: /* Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
29617 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
29618 wide as that tab on the display. */);
29619 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
29620 #endif
29622 DEFVAR_LISP ("show-trailing-whitespace", Vshow_trailing_whitespace,
29623 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight trailing whitespace.
29624 The face used for trailing whitespace is `trailing-whitespace'. */);
29625 Vshow_trailing_whitespace = Qnil;
29627 DEFVAR_LISP ("nobreak-char-display", Vnobreak_char_display,
29628 doc: /* Control highlighting of non-ASCII space and hyphen chars.
29629 If the value is t, Emacs highlights non-ASCII chars which have the
29630 same appearance as an ASCII space or hyphen, using the `nobreak-space'
29631 or `escape-glyph' face respectively.
29633 U+00A0 (no-break space), U+00AD (soft hyphen), U+2010 (hyphen), and
29634 U+2011 (non-breaking hyphen) are affected.
29636 Any other non-nil value means to display these characters as a escape
29637 glyph followed by an ordinary space or hyphen.
29639 A value of nil means no special handling of these characters. */);
29640 Vnobreak_char_display = Qt;
29642 DEFVAR_LISP ("void-text-area-pointer", Vvoid_text_area_pointer,
29643 doc: /* The pointer shape to show in void text areas.
29644 A value of nil means to show the text pointer. Other options are `arrow',
29645 `text', `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'. */);
29646 Vvoid_text_area_pointer = Qarrow;
29648 DEFVAR_LISP ("inhibit-redisplay", Vinhibit_redisplay,
29649 doc: /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay.
29650 This is used for internal purposes. */);
29651 Vinhibit_redisplay = Qnil;
29653 DEFVAR_LISP ("global-mode-string", Vglobal_mode_string,
29654 doc: /* String (or mode line construct) included (normally) in `mode-line-format'. */);
29655 Vglobal_mode_string = Qnil;
29657 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-position", Voverlay_arrow_position,
29658 doc: /* Marker for where to display an arrow on top of the buffer text.
29659 This must be the beginning of a line in order to work.
29660 See also `overlay-arrow-string'. */);
29661 Voverlay_arrow_position = Qnil;
29663 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-string", Voverlay_arrow_string,
29664 doc: /* String to display as an arrow in non-window frames.
29665 See also `overlay-arrow-position'. */);
29666 Voverlay_arrow_string = build_pure_c_string ("=>");
29668 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-variable-list", Voverlay_arrow_variable_list,
29669 doc: /* List of variables (symbols) which hold markers for overlay arrows.
29670 The symbols on this list are examined during redisplay to determine
29671 where to display overlay arrows. */);
29672 Voverlay_arrow_variable_list
29673 = list1 (intern_c_string ("overlay-arrow-position"));
29675 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-step", emacs_scroll_step,
29676 doc: /* The number of lines to try scrolling a window by when point moves out.
29677 If that fails to bring point back on frame, point is centered instead.
29678 If this is zero, point is always centered after it moves off frame.
29679 If you want scrolling to always be a line at a time, you should set
29680 `scroll-conservatively' to a large value rather than set this to 1. */);
29682 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-conservatively", scroll_conservatively,
29683 doc: /* Scroll up to this many lines, to bring point back on screen.
29684 If point moves off-screen, redisplay will scroll by up to
29685 `scroll-conservatively' lines in order to bring point just barely
29686 onto the screen again. If that cannot be done, then redisplay
29687 recenters point as usual.
29689 If the value is greater than 100, redisplay will never recenter point,
29690 but will always scroll just enough text to bring point into view, even
29691 if you move far away.
29693 A value of zero means always recenter point if it moves off screen. */);
29694 scroll_conservatively = 0;
29696 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-margin", scroll_margin,
29697 doc: /* Number of lines of margin at the top and bottom of a window.
29698 Recenter the window whenever point gets within this many lines
29699 of the top or bottom of the window. */);
29700 scroll_margin = 0;
29702 DEFVAR_LISP ("display-pixels-per-inch", Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch,
29703 doc: /* Pixels per inch value for non-window system displays.
29704 Value is a number or a cons (WIDTH-DPI . HEIGHT-DPI). */);
29705 Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch = make_float (72.0);
29707 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
29708 DEFVAR_INT ("debug-end-pos", debug_end_pos, doc: /* Don't ask. */);
29709 #endif
29711 DEFVAR_LISP ("truncate-partial-width-windows",
29712 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows,
29713 doc: /* Non-nil means truncate lines in windows narrower than the frame.
29714 For an integer value, truncate lines in each window narrower than the
29715 full frame width, provided the window width is less than that integer;
29716 otherwise, respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
29718 For any other non-nil value, truncate lines in all windows that do
29719 not span the full frame width.
29721 A value of nil means to respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
29723 If `word-wrap' is enabled, you might want to reduce this. */);
29724 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows = make_number (50);
29726 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-number-display-limit", Vline_number_display_limit,
29727 doc: /* Maximum buffer size for which line number should be displayed.
29728 If the buffer is bigger than this, the line number does not appear
29729 in the mode line. A value of nil means no limit. */);
29730 Vline_number_display_limit = Qnil;
29732 DEFVAR_INT ("line-number-display-limit-width",
29733 line_number_display_limit_width,
29734 doc: /* Maximum line width (in characters) for line number display.
29735 If the average length of the lines near point is bigger than this, then the
29736 line number may be omitted from the mode line. */);
29737 line_number_display_limit_width = 200;
29739 DEFVAR_BOOL ("highlight-nonselected-windows", highlight_nonselected_windows,
29740 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight region even in nonselected windows. */);
29741 highlight_nonselected_windows = 0;
29743 DEFVAR_BOOL ("multiple-frames", multiple_frames,
29744 doc: /* Non-nil if more than one frame is visible on this display.
29745 Minibuffer-only frames don't count, but iconified frames do.
29746 This variable is not guaranteed to be accurate except while processing
29747 `frame-title-format' and `icon-title-format'. */);
29749 DEFVAR_LISP ("frame-title-format", Vframe_title_format,
29750 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of visible frames.
29751 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
29753 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format', except that
29754 the %c and %l constructs are ignored. It is used only on frames for
29755 which no explicit name has been set \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
29757 DEFVAR_LISP ("icon-title-format", Vicon_title_format,
29758 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of an iconified frame.
29759 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
29760 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format' (which see),
29761 and is used only on frames for which no explicit name has been set
29762 \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
29763 Vicon_title_format
29764 = Vframe_title_format
29765 = listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 3,
29766 intern_c_string ("multiple-frames"),
29767 build_pure_c_string ("%b"),
29768 listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 4,
29769 empty_unibyte_string,
29770 intern_c_string ("invocation-name"),
29771 build_pure_c_string ("@"),
29772 intern_c_string ("system-name")));
29774 DEFVAR_LISP ("message-log-max", Vmessage_log_max,
29775 doc: /* Maximum number of lines to keep in the message log buffer.
29776 If nil, disable message logging. If t, log messages but don't truncate
29777 the buffer when it becomes large. */);
29778 Vmessage_log_max = make_number (1000);
29780 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-size-change-functions", Vwindow_size_change_functions,
29781 doc: /* Functions called before redisplay, if window sizes have changed.
29782 The value should be a list of functions that take one argument.
29783 Just before redisplay, for each frame, if any of its windows have changed
29784 size since the last redisplay, or have been split or deleted,
29785 all the functions in the list are called, with the frame as argument. */);
29786 Vwindow_size_change_functions = Qnil;
29788 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-scroll-functions", Vwindow_scroll_functions,
29789 doc: /* List of functions to call before redisplaying a window with scrolling.
29790 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and its new
29791 display-start position. Note that these functions are also called by
29792 `set-window-buffer'. Also note that the value of `window-end' is not
29793 valid when these functions are called.
29795 Warning: Do not use this feature to alter the way the window
29796 is scrolled. It is not designed for that, and such use probably won't
29797 work. */);
29798 Vwindow_scroll_functions = Qnil;
29800 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-text-change-functions",
29801 Vwindow_text_change_functions,
29802 doc: /* Functions to call in redisplay when text in the window might change. */);
29803 Vwindow_text_change_functions = Qnil;
29805 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay-end-trigger-functions", Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions,
29806 doc: /* Functions called when redisplay of a window reaches the end trigger.
29807 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and the end trigger value.
29808 See `set-window-redisplay-end-trigger'. */);
29809 Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions = Qnil;
29811 DEFVAR_LISP ("mouse-autoselect-window", Vmouse_autoselect_window,
29812 doc: /* Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer.
29813 If nil, do not autoselect windows.
29814 A positive number means delay autoselection by that many seconds: a
29815 window is autoselected only after the mouse has remained in that
29816 window for the duration of the delay.
29817 A negative number has a similar effect, but causes windows to be
29818 autoselected only after the mouse has stopped moving. \(Because of
29819 the way Emacs compares mouse events, you will occasionally wait twice
29820 that time before the window gets selected.\)
29821 Any other value means to autoselect window instantaneously when the
29822 mouse pointer enters it.
29824 Autoselection selects the minibuffer only if it is active, and never
29825 unselects the minibuffer if it is active.
29827 When customizing this variable make sure that the actual value of
29828 `focus-follows-mouse' matches the behavior of your window manager. */);
29829 Vmouse_autoselect_window = Qnil;
29831 DEFVAR_LISP ("auto-resize-tool-bars", Vauto_resize_tool_bars,
29832 doc: /* Non-nil means automatically resize tool-bars.
29833 This dynamically changes the tool-bar's height to the minimum height
29834 that is needed to make all tool-bar items visible.
29835 If value is `grow-only', the tool-bar's height is only increased
29836 automatically; to decrease the tool-bar height, use \\[recenter]. */);
29837 Vauto_resize_tool_bars = Qt;
29839 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons", auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p,
29840 doc: /* Non-nil means raise tool-bar buttons when the mouse moves over them. */);
29841 auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p = 1;
29843 DEFVAR_BOOL ("make-cursor-line-fully-visible", make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p,
29844 doc: /* Non-nil means to scroll (recenter) cursor line if it is not fully visible. */);
29845 make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p = 1;
29847 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-border", Vtool_bar_border,
29848 doc: /* Border below tool-bar in pixels.
29849 If an integer, use it as the height of the border.
29850 If it is one of `internal-border-width' or `border-width', use the
29851 value of the corresponding frame parameter.
29852 Otherwise, no border is added below the tool-bar. */);
29853 Vtool_bar_border = Qinternal_border_width;
29855 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-button-margin", Vtool_bar_button_margin,
29856 doc: /* Margin around tool-bar buttons in pixels.
29857 If an integer, use that for both horizontal and vertical margins.
29858 Otherwise, value should be a pair of integers `(HORZ . VERT)' with
29859 HORZ specifying the horizontal margin, and VERT specifying the
29860 vertical margin. */);
29861 Vtool_bar_button_margin = make_number (DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN);
29863 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-button-relief", tool_bar_button_relief,
29864 doc: /* Relief thickness of tool-bar buttons. */);
29865 tool_bar_button_relief = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
29867 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-style", Vtool_bar_style,
29868 doc: /* Tool bar style to use.
29869 It can be one of
29870 image - show images only
29871 text - show text only
29872 both - show both, text below image
29873 both-horiz - show text to the right of the image
29874 text-image-horiz - show text to the left of the image
29875 any other - use system default or image if no system default.
29877 This variable only affects the GTK+ toolkit version of Emacs. */);
29878 Vtool_bar_style = Qnil;
29880 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-max-label-size", tool_bar_max_label_size,
29881 doc: /* Maximum number of characters a label can have to be shown.
29882 The tool bar style must also show labels for this to have any effect, see
29883 `tool-bar-style'. */);
29884 tool_bar_max_label_size = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_LABEL_SIZE;
29886 DEFVAR_LISP ("fontification-functions", Vfontification_functions,
29887 doc: /* List of functions to call to fontify regions of text.
29888 Each function is called with one argument POS. Functions must
29889 fontify a region starting at POS in the current buffer, and give
29890 fontified regions the property `fontified'. */);
29891 Vfontification_functions = Qnil;
29892 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qfontification_functions);
29894 DEFVAR_BOOL ("unibyte-display-via-language-environment",
29895 unibyte_display_via_language_environment,
29896 doc: /* Non-nil means display unibyte text according to language environment.
29897 Specifically, this means that raw bytes in the range 160-255 decimal
29898 are displayed by converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters
29899 according to the current language environment. As a result, they are
29900 displayed according to the current fontset.
29902 Note that this variable affects only how these bytes are displayed,
29903 but does not change the fact they are interpreted as raw bytes. */);
29904 unibyte_display_via_language_environment = 0;
29906 DEFVAR_LISP ("max-mini-window-height", Vmax_mini_window_height,
29907 doc: /* Maximum height for resizing mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29908 If a float, it specifies a fraction of the mini-window frame's height.
29909 If an integer, it specifies a number of lines. */);
29910 Vmax_mini_window_height = make_float (0.25);
29912 DEFVAR_LISP ("resize-mini-windows", Vresize_mini_windows,
29913 doc: /* How to resize mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29914 A value of nil means don't automatically resize mini-windows.
29915 A value of t means resize them to fit the text displayed in them.
29916 A value of `grow-only', the default, means let mini-windows grow only;
29917 they return to their normal size when the minibuffer is closed, or the
29918 echo area becomes empty. */);
29919 Vresize_mini_windows = Qgrow_only;
29921 DEFVAR_LISP ("blink-cursor-alist", Vblink_cursor_alist,
29922 doc: /* Alist specifying how to blink the cursor off.
29923 Each element has the form (ON-STATE . OFF-STATE). Whenever the
29924 `cursor-type' frame-parameter or variable equals ON-STATE,
29925 comparing using `equal', Emacs uses OFF-STATE to specify
29926 how to blink it off. ON-STATE and OFF-STATE are values for
29927 the `cursor-type' frame parameter.
29929 If a frame's ON-STATE has no entry in this list,
29930 the frame's other specifications determine how to blink the cursor off. */);
29931 Vblink_cursor_alist = Qnil;
29933 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-hscroll-mode", automatic_hscrolling_p,
29934 doc: /* Allow or disallow automatic horizontal scrolling of windows.
29935 If non-nil, windows are automatically scrolled horizontally to make
29936 point visible. */);
29937 automatic_hscrolling_p = 1;
29938 DEFSYM (Qauto_hscroll_mode, "auto-hscroll-mode");
29940 DEFVAR_INT ("hscroll-margin", hscroll_margin,
29941 doc: /* How many columns away from the window edge point is allowed to get
29942 before automatic hscrolling will horizontally scroll the window. */);
29943 hscroll_margin = 5;
29945 DEFVAR_LISP ("hscroll-step", Vhscroll_step,
29946 doc: /* How many columns to scroll the window when point gets too close to the edge.
29947 When point is less than `hscroll-margin' columns from the window
29948 edge, automatic hscrolling will scroll the window by the amount of columns
29949 determined by this variable. If its value is a positive integer, scroll that
29950 many columns. If it's a positive floating-point number, it specifies the
29951 fraction of the window's width to scroll. If it's nil or zero, point will be
29952 centered horizontally after the scroll. Any other value, including negative
29953 numbers, are treated as if the value were zero.
29955 Automatic hscrolling always moves point outside the scroll margin, so if
29956 point was more than scroll step columns inside the margin, the window will
29957 scroll more than the value given by the scroll step.
29959 Note that the lower bound for automatic hscrolling specified by `scroll-left'
29960 and `scroll-right' overrides this variable's effect. */);
29961 Vhscroll_step = make_number (0);
29963 DEFVAR_BOOL ("message-truncate-lines", message_truncate_lines,
29964 doc: /* If non-nil, messages are truncated instead of resizing the echo area.
29965 Bind this around calls to `message' to let it take effect. */);
29966 message_truncate_lines = 0;
29968 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-bar-update-hook", Vmenu_bar_update_hook,
29969 doc: /* Normal hook run to update the menu bar definitions.
29970 Redisplay runs this hook before it redisplays the menu bar.
29971 This is used to update submenus such as Buffers,
29972 whose contents depend on various data. */);
29973 Vmenu_bar_update_hook = Qnil;
29975 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-updating-frame", Vmenu_updating_frame,
29976 doc: /* Frame for which we are updating a menu.
29977 The enable predicate for a menu binding should check this variable. */);
29978 Vmenu_updating_frame = Qnil;
29980 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-menubar-update", inhibit_menubar_update,
29981 doc: /* Non-nil means don't update menu bars. Internal use only. */);
29982 inhibit_menubar_update = 0;
29984 DEFVAR_LISP ("wrap-prefix", Vwrap_prefix,
29985 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all continuation lines at display time.
29986 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29987 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29989 This variable is overridden by any `wrap-prefix' text or overlay
29990 property.
29992 To add a prefix to non-continuation lines, use `line-prefix'. */);
29993 Vwrap_prefix = Qnil;
29994 DEFSYM (Qwrap_prefix, "wrap-prefix");
29995 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qwrap_prefix);
29997 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-prefix", Vline_prefix,
29998 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all non-continuation lines at display time.
29999 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
30000 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
30002 This variable is overridden by any `line-prefix' text or overlay
30003 property.
30005 To add a prefix to continuation lines, use `wrap-prefix'. */);
30006 Vline_prefix = Qnil;
30007 DEFSYM (Qline_prefix, "line-prefix");
30008 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qline_prefix);
30010 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-eval-during-redisplay", inhibit_eval_during_redisplay,
30011 doc: /* Non-nil means don't eval Lisp during redisplay. */);
30012 inhibit_eval_during_redisplay = 0;
30014 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-free-realized-faces", inhibit_free_realized_faces,
30015 doc: /* Non-nil means don't free realized faces. Internal use only. */);
30016 inhibit_free_realized_faces = 0;
30018 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
30019 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-id", inhibit_try_window_id,
30020 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_id display optimization. */);
30021 inhibit_try_window_id = 0;
30023 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-reusing", inhibit_try_window_reusing,
30024 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_reusing display optimization. */);
30025 inhibit_try_window_reusing = 0;
30027 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-cursor-movement", inhibit_try_cursor_movement,
30028 doc: /* Inhibit try_cursor_movement display optimization. */);
30029 inhibit_try_cursor_movement = 0;
30030 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
30032 DEFVAR_INT ("overline-margin", overline_margin,
30033 doc: /* Space between overline and text, in pixels.
30034 The default value is 2: the height of the overline (1 pixel) plus 1 pixel
30035 margin to the character height. */);
30036 overline_margin = 2;
30038 DEFVAR_INT ("underline-minimum-offset",
30039 underline_minimum_offset,
30040 doc: /* Minimum distance between baseline and underline.
30041 This can improve legibility of underlined text at small font sizes,
30042 particularly when using variable `x-use-underline-position-properties'
30043 with fonts that specify an UNDERLINE_POSITION relatively close to the
30044 baseline. The default value is 1. */);
30045 underline_minimum_offset = 1;
30047 DEFVAR_BOOL ("display-hourglass", display_hourglass_p,
30048 doc: /* Non-nil means show an hourglass pointer, when Emacs is busy.
30049 This feature only works when on a window system that can change
30050 cursor shapes. */);
30051 display_hourglass_p = 1;
30053 DEFVAR_LISP ("hourglass-delay", Vhourglass_delay,
30054 doc: /* Seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass pointer when Emacs is busy. */);
30055 Vhourglass_delay = make_number (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY);
30057 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
30058 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
30059 hourglass_shown_p = 0;
30060 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
30062 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char, "glyphless-char");
30063 DEFSYM (Qhex_code, "hex-code");
30064 DEFSYM (Qempty_box, "empty-box");
30065 DEFSYM (Qthin_space, "thin-space");
30066 DEFSYM (Qzero_width, "zero-width");
30068 DEFVAR_LISP ("pre-redisplay-function", Vpre_redisplay_function,
30069 doc: /* Function run just before redisplay.
30070 It is called with one argument, which is the set of windows that are to
30071 be redisplayed. This set can be nil (meaning, only the selected window),
30072 or t (meaning all windows). */);
30073 Vpre_redisplay_function = intern ("ignore");
30075 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char_display, "glyphless-char-display");
30076 Fput (Qglyphless_char_display, Qchar_table_extra_slots, make_number (1));
30078 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyphless-char-display", Vglyphless_char_display,
30079 doc: /* Char-table defining glyphless characters.
30080 Each element, if non-nil, should be one of the following:
30081 an ASCII acronym string: display this string in a box
30082 `hex-code': display the hexadecimal code of a character in a box
30083 `empty-box': display as an empty box
30084 `thin-space': display as 1-pixel width space
30085 `zero-width': don't display
30086 An element may also be a cons cell (GRAPHICAL . TEXT), which specifies the
30087 display method for graphical terminals and text terminals respectively.
30088 GRAPHICAL and TEXT should each have one of the values listed above.
30090 The char-table has one extra slot to control the display of a character for
30091 which no font is found. This slot only takes effect on graphical terminals.
30092 Its value should be an ASCII acronym string, `hex-code', `empty-box', or
30093 `thin-space'. The default is `empty-box'.
30095 If a character has a non-nil entry in an active display table, the
30096 display table takes effect; in this case, Emacs does not consult
30097 `glyphless-char-display' at all. */);
30098 Vglyphless_char_display = Fmake_char_table (Qglyphless_char_display, Qnil);
30099 Fset_char_table_extra_slot (Vglyphless_char_display, make_number (0),
30100 Qempty_box);
30102 DEFVAR_LISP ("debug-on-message", Vdebug_on_message,
30103 doc: /* If non-nil, debug if a message matching this regexp is displayed. */);
30104 Vdebug_on_message = Qnil;
30106 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay--all-windows-cause", Vredisplay__all_windows_cause,
30107 doc: /* */);
30108 Vredisplay__all_windows_cause
30109 = Fmake_vector (make_number (100), make_number (0));
30111 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay--mode-lines-cause", Vredisplay__mode_lines_cause,
30112 doc: /* */);
30113 Vredisplay__mode_lines_cause
30114 = Fmake_vector (make_number (100), make_number (0));
30118 /* Initialize this module when Emacs starts. */
30120 void
30121 init_xdisp (void)
30123 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
30125 if (!noninteractive)
30127 struct window *m = XWINDOW (minibuf_window);
30128 Lisp_Object frame = m->frame;
30129 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
30130 Lisp_Object root = FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f);
30131 struct window *r = XWINDOW (root);
30132 int i;
30134 echo_area_window = minibuf_window;
30136 r->top_line = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f);
30137 r->pixel_top = r->top_line * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
30138 r->total_cols = FRAME_COLS (f);
30139 r->pixel_width = r->total_cols * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
30140 r->total_lines = FRAME_LINES (f) - 1 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f);
30141 r->pixel_height = r->total_lines * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
30143 m->top_line = FRAME_LINES (f) - 1;
30144 m->pixel_top = m->top_line * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
30145 m->total_cols = FRAME_COLS (f);
30146 m->pixel_width = m->total_cols * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
30147 m->total_lines = 1;
30148 m->pixel_height = m->total_lines * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
30150 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = scratch_glyphs;
30151 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA + 1]
30152 = scratch_glyphs + MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS;
30154 /* The default ellipsis glyphs `...'. */
30155 for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
30156 default_invis_vector[i] = make_number ('.');
30160 /* Allocate the buffer for frame titles.
30161 Also used for `format-mode-line'. */
30162 int size = 100;
30163 mode_line_noprop_buf = xmalloc (size);
30164 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
30165 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf;
30166 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
30169 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
30172 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
30174 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
30176 /* Cancel a currently active hourglass timer, and start a new one. */
30177 void
30178 start_hourglass (void)
30180 struct timespec delay;
30182 cancel_hourglass ();
30184 if (INTEGERP (Vhourglass_delay)
30185 && XINT (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
30186 delay = make_timespec (min (XINT (Vhourglass_delay),
30187 TYPE_MAXIMUM (time_t)),
30189 else if (FLOATP (Vhourglass_delay)
30190 && XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
30191 delay = dtotimespec (XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay));
30192 else
30193 delay = make_timespec (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY, 0);
30195 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
30197 extern void w32_note_current_window (void);
30198 w32_note_current_window ();
30200 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */
30202 hourglass_atimer = start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, delay,
30203 show_hourglass, NULL);
30207 /* Cancel the hourglass cursor timer if active, hide a busy cursor if
30208 shown. */
30209 void
30210 cancel_hourglass (void)
30212 if (hourglass_atimer)
30214 cancel_atimer (hourglass_atimer);
30215 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
30218 if (hourglass_shown_p)
30219 hide_hourglass ();
30222 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */